12398 lines
580 KiB
Plaintext
12398 lines
580 KiB
Plaintext
**The Project Gutenberg Etext of 20,000 Leagues Under the Sea**
|
|
*****This file should be named 2000010.txt or 2000010.zip******
|
|
|
|
|
|
Please take a look at the important information in this header.
|
|
We encourage you to keep this file on your own disk, keeping an
|
|
electronic path open for the next readers. Do not remove this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts**
|
|
|
|
**Etexts Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971**
|
|
|
|
*These Etexts Prepared By Hundreds of Volunteers and Donations*
|
|
|
|
Information on contacting Project Gutenberg to get Etexts, and
|
|
further information is included below. We need your donations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
20,000 Leagues Under the Sea
|
|
by Jules Verne
|
|
|
|
September, 1994 [Etext #164]
|
|
|
|
|
|
This etext was done by a number of anonymous volunteers of the
|
|
Gutenberg Projec, to whom we owe a great deal of thanks and to
|
|
whom we dedicate this book.
|
|
|
|
|
|
*****Twenty Thousand Leagues Under the Sea by Jules Verne*****
|
|
*****This file should be named 2000010.txt or 2000010.zip*****
|
|
|
|
Corrected EDITIONS of our etexts get a new NUMBER, 2000011.txt.
|
|
VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, 2000010a.txt.
|
|
|
|
If our Etexts manage to make it to an average about 100 million
|
|
people, on about 250 million computers currently in existence:
|
|
then we will have given about 16.4 billion Etexts away when the
|
|
Etext you are now reading is spread across the nets.
|
|
|
|
|
|
We are now trying to release all our books one month in advance
|
|
of the official release dates, for time for better editing.
|
|
|
|
The official release date of all Project Gutenberg Etexts is at
|
|
Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A
|
|
preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment
|
|
and editing by those who wish to do so. To be sure you have an
|
|
up to date first edition [xxxxx10x.xxx] please check file sizes
|
|
in the first week of the next month. Since our ftp program has
|
|
a bug in it that scrambles the date [tried to fix and failed] a
|
|
look at the file size will have to do, but we will try to see a
|
|
new copy has at least one byte more or less.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Information about Project Gutenberg (one page)
|
|
|
|
We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The
|
|
fifty hours is one conservative estimate for how long it we take
|
|
to get any etext selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright
|
|
searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. This
|
|
projected audience is one hundred million readers. If our value
|
|
per text is nominally estimated at one dollar, then we produce 2
|
|
million dollars per hour this year we, will have to do four text
|
|
files per month: thus upping our productivity from one million.
|
|
The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away One Trillion Etext
|
|
Files by the December 31, 2001. [10,000 x 100,000,000=Trillion]
|
|
This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers,
|
|
which is 10% of the expected number of computer users by the end
|
|
of the year 2001.
|
|
|
|
We need your donations more than ever!
|
|
|
|
All donations should be made to "Project Gutenberg/IBC", and are
|
|
tax deductible to the extent allowable by law ("IBC" is Illinois
|
|
Benedictine College). (Subscriptions to our paper newsletter go
|
|
to IBC, too)
|
|
|
|
For these and other matters, please mail to:
|
|
|
|
Project Gutenberg
|
|
P. O. Box 2782
|
|
Champaign, IL 61825
|
|
|
|
When all other email fails try our Michael S. Hart, Executive
|
|
Director:
|
|
hart@vmd.cso.uiuc.edu (internet) hart@uiucvmd (bitnet)
|
|
|
|
We would prefer to send you this information by email
|
|
(Internet, Bitnet, Compuserve, ATTMAIL or MCImail).
|
|
|
|
******
|
|
If you have an FTP program (or emulator), please
|
|
FTP directly to the Project Gutenberg archives:
|
|
[Mac users, do NOT point and click. . .type]
|
|
|
|
ftp mrcnext.cso.uiuc.edu
|
|
login: anonymous
|
|
password: your@login
|
|
cd etext/etext91
|
|
or cd etext92
|
|
or cd etext93 [for new books] [now also in cd etext/etext93]
|
|
or cd etext/articles [get suggest gut for more information]
|
|
dir [to see files]
|
|
get or mget [to get files. . .set bin for zip files]
|
|
get INDEX100.GUT
|
|
get INDEX200.GUT
|
|
for a list of books
|
|
and
|
|
get NEW.GUT for general information
|
|
and
|
|
mget GUT* for newsletters.
|
|
|
|
**Information prepared by the Project Gutenberg legal advisor**
|
|
(Three Pages)
|
|
|
|
|
|
***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS**START***
|
|
Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers.
|
|
They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with
|
|
your copy of this etext, even if you got it for free from
|
|
someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our
|
|
fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement
|
|
disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how
|
|
you can distribute copies of this etext if you want to.
|
|
|
|
*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS ETEXT
|
|
By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
|
|
etext, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept
|
|
this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive
|
|
a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this etext by
|
|
sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person
|
|
you got it from. If you received this etext on a physical
|
|
medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request.
|
|
|
|
ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM ETEXTS
|
|
This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-
|
|
tm etexts, is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor
|
|
Michael S. Hart through the Project Gutenberg Association at
|
|
Illinois Benedictine College (the "Project"). Among other
|
|
things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright
|
|
on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and
|
|
distribute it in the United States without permission and
|
|
without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth
|
|
below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this etext
|
|
under the Project's "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark.
|
|
|
|
To create these etexts, the Project expends considerable
|
|
efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain
|
|
works. Despite these efforts, the Project's etexts and any
|
|
medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other
|
|
things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or
|
|
corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
|
|
intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged
|
|
disk or other etext medium, a computer virus, or computer
|
|
codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment.
|
|
|
|
LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES
|
|
But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below,
|
|
[1] the Project (and any other party you may receive this
|
|
etext from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm etext) disclaims all
|
|
liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including
|
|
legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR
|
|
UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT,
|
|
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE
|
|
OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE
|
|
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
|
|
|
|
If you discover a Defect in this etext within 90 days of
|
|
receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any)
|
|
you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that
|
|
time to the person you received it from. If you received it
|
|
on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and
|
|
such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement
|
|
copy. If you received it electronically, such person may
|
|
choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to
|
|
receive it electronically.
|
|
|
|
THIS ETEXT IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER
|
|
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS
|
|
TO THE ETEXT OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT
|
|
LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
|
|
PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
|
|
|
|
Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or
|
|
the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the
|
|
above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you
|
|
may have other legal rights.
|
|
|
|
INDEMNITY
|
|
You will indemnify and hold the Project, its directors,
|
|
officers, members and agents harmless from all liability, cost
|
|
and expense, including legal fees, that arise directly or
|
|
indirectly from any of the following that you do or cause:
|
|
[1] distribution of this etext, [2] alteration, modification,
|
|
or addition to the etext, or [3] any Defect.
|
|
|
|
DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm"
|
|
You may distribute copies of this etext electronically, or by
|
|
disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this
|
|
"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg,
|
|
or:
|
|
|
|
[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this
|
|
requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the
|
|
etext or this "small print!" statement. You may however,
|
|
if you wish, distribute this etext in machine readable
|
|
binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form,
|
|
including any form resulting from conversion by word pro-
|
|
cessing or hypertext software, but only so long as
|
|
*EITHER*:
|
|
|
|
[*] The etext, when displayed, is clearly readable, and
|
|
does *not* contain characters other than those
|
|
intended by the author of the work, although tilde
|
|
(~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may
|
|
be used to convey punctuation intended by the
|
|
author, and additional characters may be used to
|
|
indicate hypertext links; OR
|
|
|
|
[*] The etext may be readily converted by the reader at
|
|
no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent
|
|
form by the program that displays the etext (as is
|
|
the case, for instance, with most word processors);
|
|
OR
|
|
|
|
[*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at
|
|
no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the
|
|
etext in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC
|
|
or other equivalent proprietary form).
|
|
|
|
[2] Honor the etext refund and replacement provisions of this
|
|
"Small Print!" statement.
|
|
|
|
[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Project of 20% of the
|
|
net profits you derive calculated using the method you
|
|
already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you
|
|
don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are
|
|
payable to "Project Gutenberg Association / Illinois
|
|
Benedictine College" within the 60 days following each
|
|
date you prepare (or were legally required to prepare)
|
|
your annual (or equivalent periodic) tax return.
|
|
|
|
WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO?
|
|
The Project gratefully accepts contributions in money, time,
|
|
scanning machines, OCR software, public domain etexts, royalty
|
|
free copyright licenses, and every other sort of contribution
|
|
you can think of. Money should be paid to "Project Gutenberg
|
|
Association / Illinois Benedictine College".
|
|
|
|
This "Small Print!" by Charles B. Kramer, Attorney
|
|
Internet (72600.2026@compuserve.com); TEL: (212-254-5093)
|
|
*END*THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN ETEXTS*Ver.04.29.93*END*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TWENTY THOUSAND LEAGUES UNDER THE SEA by JULES VERNE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
PART ONE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER I
|
|
|
|
A SHIFTING REEF
|
|
|
|
The year 1866 was signalised by a remarkable incident, a mysterious
|
|
and puzzling phenomenon, which doubtless no one has yet forgotten.
|
|
Not to mention rumours which agitated the maritime population
|
|
and excited the public mind, even in the interior of continents,
|
|
seafaring men were particularly excited. Merchants, common sailors,
|
|
captains of vessels, skippers, both of Europe and America,
|
|
naval officers of all countries, and the Governments of several States
|
|
on the two continents, were deeply interested in the matter.
|
|
|
|
For some time past vessels had been met by "an enormous thing,"
|
|
a long object, spindle-shaped, occasionally phosphorescent,
|
|
and infinitely larger and more rapid in its movements than a whale.
|
|
|
|
The facts relating to this apparition (entered in various log-books)
|
|
agreed in most respects as to the shape of the object or creature in question,
|
|
the untiring rapidity of its movements, its surprising power of locomotion,
|
|
and the peculiar life with which it seemed endowed. If it was a whale,
|
|
it surpassed in size all those hitherto classified in science.
|
|
Taking into consideration the mean of observations made at divers times--
|
|
rejecting the timid estimate of those who assigned to this object
|
|
a length of two hundred feet, equally with the exaggerated opinions
|
|
which set it down as a mile in width and three in length--we might fairly
|
|
conclude that this mysterious being surpassed greatly all dimensions
|
|
admitted by the learned ones of the day, if it existed at all.
|
|
And that it DID exist was an undeniable fact; and, with that tendency
|
|
which disposes the human mind in favour of the marvellous, we can understand
|
|
the excitement produced in the entire world by this supernatural apparition.
|
|
As to classing it in the list of fables, the idea was out of the question.
|
|
|
|
On the 20th of July, 1866, the steamer Governor Higginson,
|
|
of the Calcutta and Burnach Steam Navigation Company, had met
|
|
this moving mass five miles off the east coast of Australia.
|
|
Captain Baker thought at first that he was in the presence of an
|
|
unknown sandbank; he even prepared to determine its exact position
|
|
when two columns of water, projected by the mysterious object,
|
|
shot with a hissing noise a hundred and fifty feet up into the air.
|
|
Now, unless the sandbank had been submitted to the intermittent
|
|
eruption of a geyser, the Governor Higginson had to do neither
|
|
more nor less than with an aquatic mammal, unknown till then,
|
|
which threw up from its blow-holes columns of water mixed with
|
|
air and vapour.
|
|
|
|
Similar facts were observed on the 23rd of July in the same year,
|
|
in the Pacific Ocean, by the Columbus, of the West India
|
|
and Pacific Steam Navigation Company. But this extraordinary
|
|
creature could transport itself from one place to another
|
|
with surprising velocity; as, in an interval of three days,
|
|
the Governor Higginson and the Columbus had observed it at
|
|
two different points of the chart, separated by a distance
|
|
of more than seven hundred nautical leagues.
|
|
|
|
Fifteen days later, two thousand miles farther off, the Helvetia,
|
|
of the Compagnie-Nationale, and the Shannon, of the Royal
|
|
Mail Steamship Company, sailing to windward in that portion
|
|
of the Atlantic lying between the United States and Europe,
|
|
respectively signalled the monster to each other in 42@ 15' N. lat.
|
|
and 60@ 35' W. long. In these simultaneous observations they
|
|
thought themselves justified in estimating the minimum length
|
|
of the mammal at more than three hundred and fifty feet,
|
|
as the Shannon and Helvetia were of smaller dimensions than it,
|
|
though they measured three hundred feet over all.
|
|
|
|
Now the largest whales, those which frequent those parts of the sea round
|
|
the Aleutian, Kulammak, and Umgullich islands, have never exceeded the length
|
|
of sixty yards, if they attain that.
|
|
|
|
In every place of great resort the monster was the fashion.
|
|
They sang of it in the cafes, ridiculed it in the papers, and represented
|
|
it on the stage. All kinds of stories were circulated regarding it.
|
|
There appeared in the papers caricatures of every gigantic and
|
|
imaginary creature, from the white whale, the terrible "Moby Dick"
|
|
of sub-arctic regions, to the immense kraken, whose tentacles could entangle
|
|
a ship of five hundred tons and hurry it into the abyss of the ocean.
|
|
The legends of ancient times were even revived.
|
|
|
|
Then burst forth the unending argument between the believers and the
|
|
unbelievers in the societies of the wise and the scientific journals.
|
|
"The question of the monster" inflamed all minds. Editors of
|
|
scientific journals, quarrelling with believers in the supernatural,
|
|
spilled seas of ink during this memorable campaign, some even drawing blood;
|
|
for from the sea-serpent they came to direct personalities.
|
|
|
|
During the first months of the year 1867 the question seemed buried,
|
|
never to revive, when new facts were brought before the public.
|
|
It was then no longer a scientific problem to be solved, but a real
|
|
danger seriously to be avoided. The question took quite another shape.
|
|
The monster became a small island, a rock, a reef, but a reef of indefinite
|
|
and shifting proportions.
|
|
|
|
On the 5th of March, 1867, the Moravian, of the Montreal Ocean Company,
|
|
finding herself during the night in 27@ 30' lat. and 72@ 15' long., struck
|
|
on her starboard quarter a rock, marked in no chart for that part of the sea.
|
|
Under the combined efforts of the wind and its four hundred horse power,
|
|
it was going at the rate of thirteen knots. Had it not been for the superior
|
|
strength of the hull of the Moravian, she would have been broken by the shock
|
|
and gone down with the 237 passengers she was bringing home from Canada.
|
|
|
|
The accident happened about five o'clock in the morning, as the day
|
|
was breaking. The officers of the quarter-deck hurried to the after-part
|
|
of the vessel. They examined the sea with the most careful attention.
|
|
They saw nothing but a strong eddy about three cables' length distant,
|
|
as if the surface had been violently agitated. The bearings of the place were
|
|
taken exactly, and the Moravian continued its route without apparent damage.
|
|
Had it struck on a submerged rock, or on an enormous wreck? They could
|
|
not tell; but, on examination of the ship's bottom when undergoing repairs,
|
|
it was found that part of her keel was broken.
|
|
|
|
This fact, so grave in itself, might perhaps have been forgotten
|
|
like many others if, three weeks after, it had not been re-enacted
|
|
under similar circumstances. But, thanks to the nationality of
|
|
the victim of the shock, thanks to the reputation of the company to
|
|
which the vessel belonged, the circumstance became extensively circulated.
|
|
|
|
The 13th of April, 1867, the sea being beautiful, the breeze favourable,
|
|
the Scotia, of the Cunard Company's line, found herself in 15@ 12' long.
|
|
and 45@ 37' lat. She was going at the speed of thirteen knots and a half.
|
|
|
|
At seventeen minutes past four in the afternoon, whilst the passengers were
|
|
assembled at lunch in the great saloon, a slight shock was felt on the hull
|
|
of the Scotia, on her quarter, a little aft of the port-paddle.
|
|
|
|
The Scotia had not struck, but she had been struck, and seemingly
|
|
by something rather sharp and penetrating than blunt.
|
|
The shock had been so slight that no one had been alarmed,
|
|
had it not been for the shouts of the carpenter's watch,
|
|
who rushed on to the bridge, exclaiming, "We are sinking! we
|
|
are sinking!" At first the passengers were much frightened,
|
|
but Captain Anderson hastened to reassure them. The danger could
|
|
not be imminent. The Scotia, divided into seven compartments
|
|
by strong partitions, could brave with impunity any leak.
|
|
Captain Anderson went down immediately into the hold.
|
|
He found that the sea was pouring into the fifth compartment;
|
|
and the rapidity of the influx proved that the force of the water
|
|
was considerable. Fortunately this compartment did not hold
|
|
the boilers, or the fires would have been immediately extinguished.
|
|
Captain Anderson ordered the engines to be stopped at once,
|
|
and one of the men went down to ascertain the extent of the injury.
|
|
Some minutes afterwards they discovered the existence of a
|
|
large hole, two yards in diameter, in the ship's bottom.
|
|
Such a leak could not be stopped; and the Scotia, her paddles
|
|
half submerged, was obliged to continue her course. She was then
|
|
three hundred miles from Cape Clear, and, after three days' delay,
|
|
which caused great uneasiness in Liverpool, she entered the basin
|
|
of the company.
|
|
|
|
The engineers visited the Scotia, which was put in dry dock.
|
|
They could scarcely believe it possible; at two yards and a half below
|
|
water-mark was a regular rent, in the form of an isosceles triangle.
|
|
The broken place in the iron plates was so perfectly defined
|
|
that it could not have been more neatly done by a punch.
|
|
It was clear, then, that the instrument producing the perforation
|
|
was not of a common stamp and, after having been driven with
|
|
prodigious strength, and piercing an iron plate 1 3/8 inches thick,
|
|
had withdrawn itself by a backward motion.
|
|
|
|
Such was the last fact, which resulted in exciting once more the torrent
|
|
of public opinion. From this moment all unlucky casualties which could
|
|
not be otherwise accounted for were put down to the monster.
|
|
|
|
Upon this imaginary creature rested the responsibility of all
|
|
these shipwrecks, which unfortunately were considerable;
|
|
for of three thousand ships whose loss was annually recorded
|
|
at Lloyd's, the number of sailing and steam-ships supposed
|
|
to be totally lost, from the absence of all news, amounted to
|
|
not less than two hundred!
|
|
|
|
Now, it was the "monster" who, justly or unjustly, was accused
|
|
of their disappearance, and, thanks to it, communication between
|
|
the different continents became more and more dangerous.
|
|
The public demanded sharply that the seas should at any price be
|
|
relieved from this formidable cetacean. [1]
|
|
|
|
[1] Member of the whale family.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER II
|
|
|
|
PRO AND CON
|
|
|
|
At the period when these events took place, I had just returned
|
|
from a scientific research in the disagreeable territory
|
|
of Nebraska, in the United States. In virtue of my office
|
|
as Assistant Professor in the Museum of Natural History in Paris,
|
|
the French Government had attached me to that expedition.
|
|
After six months in Nebraska, I arrived in New York towards
|
|
the end of March, laden with a precious collection.
|
|
My departure for France was fixed for the first days in May.
|
|
Meanwhile I was occupying myself in classifying my mineralogical,
|
|
botanical, and zoological riches, when the accident happened
|
|
to the Scotia.
|
|
|
|
I was perfectly up in the subject which was the question of the day.
|
|
How could I be otherwise? I had read and reread all the American
|
|
and European papers without being any nearer a conclusion.
|
|
This mystery puzzled me. Under the impossibility of forming
|
|
an opinion, I jumped from one extreme to the other.
|
|
That there really was something could not be doubted,
|
|
and the incredulous were invited to put their finger on the wound
|
|
of the Scotia.
|
|
|
|
On my arrival at New York the question was at its height.
|
|
The theory of the floating island, and the unapproachable sandbank,
|
|
supported by minds little competent to form a judgment, was abandoned.
|
|
And, indeed, unless this shoal had a machine in its stomach,
|
|
how could it change its position with such astonishing rapidity?
|
|
|
|
From the same cause, the idea of a floating hull of an enormous
|
|
wreck was given up.
|
|
|
|
There remained, then, only two possible solutions of the question,
|
|
which created two distinct parties: on one side, those who were
|
|
for a monster of colossal strength; on the other, those who were
|
|
for a submarine vessel of enormous motive power.
|
|
|
|
But this last theory, plausible as it was, could not stand against
|
|
inquiries made in both worlds. That a private gentleman should have
|
|
such a machine at his command was not likely. Where, when, and how
|
|
was it built? and how could its construction have been kept secret?
|
|
Certainly a Government might possess such a destructive machine.
|
|
And in these disastrous times, when the ingenuity of man has
|
|
multiplied the power of weapons of war, it was possible that,
|
|
without the knowledge of others, a State might try to work such
|
|
a formidable engine.
|
|
|
|
But the idea of a war machine fell before the declaration of Governments.
|
|
As public interest was in question, and transatlantic communications
|
|
suffered, their veracity could not be doubted. But how admit that
|
|
the construction of this submarine boat had escaped the public eye?
|
|
For a private gentleman to keep the secret under such circumstances would
|
|
be very difficult, and for a State whose every act is persistently watched
|
|
by powerful rivals, certainly impossible.
|
|
|
|
Upon my arrival in New York several persons did me
|
|
the honour of consulting me on the phenomenon in question.
|
|
I had published in France a work in quarto, in two volumes,
|
|
entitled Mysteries of the Great Submarine Grounds. This book,
|
|
highly approved of in the learned world, gained for me a special
|
|
reputation in this rather obscure branch of Natural History.
|
|
My advice was asked. As long as I could deny the reality
|
|
of the fact, I confined myself to a decided negative.
|
|
But soon, finding myself driven into a corner, I was
|
|
obliged to explain myself point by point. I discussed
|
|
the question in all its forms, politically and scientifically;
|
|
and I give here an extract from a carefully-studied article
|
|
which I published in the number of the 30th of April.
|
|
It ran as follows:
|
|
|
|
"After examining one by one the different theories, rejecting all
|
|
other suggestions, it becomes necessary to admit the existence
|
|
of a marine animal of enormous power.
|
|
|
|
"The great depths of the ocean are entirely unknown to us.
|
|
Soundings cannot reach them. What passes in those remote depths--
|
|
what beings live, or can live, twelve or fifteen miles beneath
|
|
the surface of the waters--what is the organisation of these animals,
|
|
we can scarcely conjecture. However, the solution of the problem
|
|
submitted to me may modify the form of the dilemma. Either we do know
|
|
all the varieties of beings which people our planet, or we do not.
|
|
If we do NOT know them all--if Nature has still secrets in the deeps
|
|
for us, nothing is more conformable to reason than to admit the existence
|
|
of fishes, or cetaceans of other kinds, or even of new species,
|
|
of an organisation formed to inhabit the strata inaccessible to soundings,
|
|
and which an accident of some sort has brought at long intervals
|
|
to the upper level of the ocean.
|
|
|
|
"If, on the contrary, we DO know all living kinds, we must
|
|
necessarily seek for the animal in question amongst those marine
|
|
beings already classed; and, in that case, I should be disposed
|
|
to admit the existence of a gigantic narwhal.
|
|
|
|
"The common narwhal, or unicorn of the sea, often attains
|
|
a length of sixty feet. Increase its size fivefold or tenfold,
|
|
give it strength proportionate to its size, lengthen its
|
|
destructive weapons, and you obtain the animal required.
|
|
It will have the proportions determined by the officers
|
|
of the Shannon, the instrument required by the perforation
|
|
of the Scotia, and the power necessary to pierce the hull
|
|
of the steamer.
|
|
|
|
"Indeed, the narwhal is armed with a sort of ivory sword,
|
|
a halberd, according to the expression of certain naturalists.
|
|
The principal tusk has the hardness of steel. Some of these tusks
|
|
have been found buried in the bodies of whales, which the unicorn
|
|
always attacks with success. Others have been drawn out,
|
|
not without trouble, from the bottoms of ships, which they
|
|
had pierced through and through, as a gimlet pierces a barrel.
|
|
The Museum of the Faculty of Medicine of Paris possesses one
|
|
of these defensive weapons, two yards and a quarter in length,
|
|
and fifteen inches in diameter at the base.
|
|
|
|
"Very well! suppose this weapon to be six times stronger and the animal
|
|
ten times more powerful; launch it at the rate of twenty miles an hour,
|
|
and you obtain a shock capable of producing the catastrophe required.
|
|
Until further information, therefore, I shall maintain it to be
|
|
a sea-unicorn of colossal dimensions, armed not with a halberd,
|
|
but with a real spur, as the armoured frigates, or the `rams' of war,
|
|
whose massiveness and motive power it would possess at the same time.
|
|
Thus may this puzzling phenomenon be explained, unless there be something over
|
|
and above all that one has ever conjectured, seen, perceived, or experienced;
|
|
which is just within the bounds of possibility."
|
|
|
|
These last words were cowardly on my part; but, up to a certain point,
|
|
I wished to shelter my dignity as professor, and not give
|
|
too much cause for laughter to the Americans, who laugh well
|
|
when they do laugh. I reserved for myself a way of escape.
|
|
In effect, however, I admitted the existence of the "monster."
|
|
My article was warmly discussed, which procured it a high reputation.
|
|
It rallied round it a certain number of partisans. The solution
|
|
it proposed gave, at least, full liberty to the imagination.
|
|
The human mind delights in grand conceptions of supernatural beings.
|
|
And the sea is precisely their best vehicle, the only medium
|
|
through which these giants (against which terrestrial animals,
|
|
such as elephants or rhinoceroses, are as nothing) can be produced
|
|
or developed.
|
|
|
|
The industrial and commercial papers treated the question chiefly from this
|
|
point of view. The Shipping and Mercantile Gazette, the Lloyd's List,
|
|
the Packet-Boat, and the Maritime and Colonial Review, all papers devoted
|
|
to insurance companies which threatened to raise their rates of premium,
|
|
were unanimous on this point. Public opinion had been pronounced.
|
|
The United States were the first in the field; and in New York they
|
|
made preparations for an expedition destined to pursue this narwhal.
|
|
A frigate of great speed, the Abraham Lincoln, was put in commission
|
|
as soon as possible. The arsenals were opened to Commander Farragut,
|
|
who hastened the arming of his frigate; but, as it always happens,
|
|
the moment it was decided to pursue the monster, the monster did not appear.
|
|
For two months no one heard it spoken of. No ship met with it.
|
|
It seemed as if this unicorn knew of the plots weaving around it.
|
|
It had been so much talked of, even through the Atlantic cable, that jesters
|
|
pretended that this slender fly had stopped a telegram on its passage and was
|
|
making the most of it.
|
|
|
|
So when the frigate had been armed for a long campaign, and provided with
|
|
formidable fishing apparatus, no one could tell what course to pursue.
|
|
Impatience grew apace, when, on the 2nd of July, they learned that a
|
|
steamer of the line of San Francisco, from California to Shanghai,
|
|
had seen the animal three weeks before in the North Pacific Ocean.
|
|
The excitement caused by this news was extreme. The ship was revictualled
|
|
and well stocked with coal.
|
|
|
|
Three hours before the Abraham Lincoln left Brooklyn pier,
|
|
I received a letter worded as follows:
|
|
|
|
To M. ARONNAX, Professor in the Museum of Paris, Fifth Avenue Hotel, New York.
|
|
|
|
SIR,--If you will consent to join the Abraham Lincoln
|
|
in this expedition, the Government of the United States
|
|
will with pleasure see France represented in the enterprise.
|
|
Commander Farragut has a cabin at your disposal.
|
|
|
|
Very cordially yours, J.B. HOBSON, Secretary of Marine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER III
|
|
|
|
I FORM MY RESOLUTION
|
|
|
|
Three seconds before the arrival of J. B. Hobson's letter I no more thought
|
|
of pursuing the unicorn than of attempting the passage of the North Sea.
|
|
Three seconds after reading the letter of the honourable Secretary of Marine,
|
|
I felt that my true vocation, the sole end of my life, was to chase this
|
|
disturbing monster and purge it from the world.
|
|
|
|
But I had just returned from a fatiguing journey, weary and longing
|
|
for repose. I aspired to nothing more than again seeing my country,
|
|
my friends, my little lodging by the Jardin des Plantes,
|
|
my dear and precious collections--but nothing could keep me back!
|
|
I forgot all--fatigue, friends and collections--and accepted without
|
|
hesitation the offer of the American Government.
|
|
|
|
"Besides," thought I, "all roads lead back to Europe; and the unicorn
|
|
may be amiable enough to hurry me towards the coast of France.
|
|
This worthy animal may allow itself to be caught in the seas of Europe
|
|
(for my particular benefit), and I will not bring back less than half
|
|
a yard of his ivory halberd to the Museum of Natural History."
|
|
But in the meanwhile I must seek this narwhal in the North
|
|
Pacific Ocean, which, to return to France, was taking the road
|
|
to the antipodes.
|
|
|
|
"Conseil," I called in an impatient voice.
|
|
|
|
Conseil was my servant, a true, devoted Flemish boy, who had accompanied
|
|
me in all my travels. I liked him, and he returned the liking well.
|
|
He was quiet by nature, regular from principle, zealous from habit,
|
|
evincing little disturbance at the different surprises of life,
|
|
very quick with his hands, and apt at any service required of him;
|
|
and, despite his name, never giving advice--even when asked for it.
|
|
|
|
Conseil had followed me for the last ten years wherever science led.
|
|
Never once did he complain of the length or fatigue of a journey,
|
|
never make an objection to pack his portmanteau for whatever
|
|
country it might be, or however far away, whether China or Congo.
|
|
Besides all this, he had good health, which defied all sickness,
|
|
and solid muscles, but no nerves; good morals are understood.
|
|
This boy was thirty years old, and his age to that of his master
|
|
as fifteen to twenty. May I be excused for saying that I was
|
|
forty years old?
|
|
|
|
But Conseil had one fault: he was ceremonious to a degree,
|
|
and would never speak to me but in the third person,
|
|
which was sometimes provoking.
|
|
|
|
"Conseil," said I again, beginning with feverish hands to make
|
|
preparations for my departure.
|
|
|
|
Certainly I was sure of this devoted boy. As a rule, I never asked
|
|
him if it were convenient for him or not to follow me in my travels;
|
|
but this time the expedition in question might be prolonged,
|
|
and the enterprise might be hazardous in pursuit of an animal capable
|
|
of sinking a frigate as easily as a nutshell. Here there was matter
|
|
for reflection even to the most impassive man in the world.
|
|
What would Conseil say?
|
|
|
|
"Conseil," I called a third time.
|
|
|
|
Conseil appeared.
|
|
|
|
"Did you call, sir?" said he, entering.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, my boy; make preparations for me and yourself too.
|
|
We leave in two hours."
|
|
|
|
"As you please, sir," replied Conseil, quietly.
|
|
|
|
"Not an instant to lose; lock in my trunk all travelling utensils,
|
|
coats, shirts, and stockings--without counting, as many as you can,
|
|
and make haste."
|
|
|
|
"And your collections, sir?" observed Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"They will keep them at the hotel."
|
|
|
|
"We are not returning to Paris, then?" said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Oh! certainly," I answered, evasively, "by making a curve."
|
|
|
|
"Will the curve please you, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"Oh! it will be nothing; not quite so direct a road, that is all.
|
|
We take our passage in the Abraham, Lincoln."
|
|
|
|
"As you think proper, sir," coolly replied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"You see, my friend, it has to do with the monster--
|
|
the famous narwhal. We are going to purge it from the seas.
|
|
A glorious mission, but a dangerous one! We cannot tell
|
|
where we may go; these animals can be very capricious.
|
|
But we will go whether or no; we have got a captain who
|
|
is pretty wide-awake."
|
|
|
|
Our luggage was transported to the deck of the frigate immediately.
|
|
I hastened on board and asked for Commander Farragut.
|
|
One of the sailors conducted me to the poop, where I found myself
|
|
in the presence of a good-looking officer, who held out his
|
|
hand to me.
|
|
|
|
"Monsieur Pierre Aronnax?" said he.
|
|
|
|
"Himself," replied I. "Commander Farragut?"
|
|
|
|
"You are welcome, Professor; your cabin is ready for you."
|
|
|
|
I bowed, and desired to be conducted to the cabin destined for me.
|
|
|
|
The Abraham Lincoln had been well chosen and equipped
|
|
for her new destination. She was a frigate of great speed,
|
|
fitted with high-pressure engines which admitted a pressure
|
|
of seven atmospheres. Under this the Abraham Lincoln attained
|
|
the mean speed of nearly eighteen knots and a third an hour--
|
|
a considerable speed, but, nevertheless, insufficient to grapple
|
|
with this gigantic cetacean.
|
|
|
|
The interior arrangements of the frigate corresponded to its
|
|
nautical qualities. I was well satisfied with my cabin,
|
|
which was in the after part, opening upon the gunroom.
|
|
|
|
"We shall be well off here," said I to Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"As well, by your honour's leave, as a hermit-crab in the shell
|
|
of a whelk," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
I left Conseil to stow our trunks conveniently away, and remounted
|
|
the poop in order to survey the preparations for departure.
|
|
|
|
At that moment Commander Farragut was ordering the last moorings
|
|
to be cast loose which held the Abraham Lincoln to the pier
|
|
of Brooklyn. So in a quarter of an hour, perhaps less,
|
|
the frigate would have sailed without me. I should have missed
|
|
this extraordinary, supernatural, and incredible expedition,
|
|
the recital of which may well meet with some suspicion.
|
|
|
|
But Commander Farragut would not lose a day nor an hour
|
|
in scouring the seas in which the animal had been sighted.
|
|
He sent for the engineer.
|
|
|
|
"Is the steam full on?" asked he.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir," replied the engineer.
|
|
|
|
"Go ahead," cried Commander Farragut.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER IV
|
|
|
|
NED LAND
|
|
|
|
Captain Farragut was a good seaman, worthy of the frigate he commanded.
|
|
His vessel and he were one. He was the soul of it. On the question
|
|
of the monster there was no doubt in his mind, and he would not allow
|
|
the existence of the animal to be disputed on board. He believed in it,
|
|
as certain good women believe in the leviathan--by faith, not by reason.
|
|
The monster did exist, and he had sworn to rid the seas of it. Either Captain
|
|
Farragut would kill the narwhal, or the narwhal would kill the captain.
|
|
There was no third course.
|
|
|
|
The officers on board shared the opinion of their chief.
|
|
They were ever chatting, discussing, and calculating the various
|
|
chances of a meeting, watching narrowly the vast surface of the ocean.
|
|
More than one took up his quarters voluntarily in the cross-trees,
|
|
who would have cursed such a berth under any other circumstances.
|
|
As long as the sun described its daily course, the rigging was
|
|
crowded with sailors, whose feet were burnt to such an extent by
|
|
the heat of the deck as to render it unbearable; still the Abraham
|
|
Lincoln had not yet breasted the suspected waters of the Pacific.
|
|
As to the ship's company, they desired nothing better than to meet
|
|
the unicorn, to harpoon it, hoist it on board, and despatch it.
|
|
They watched the sea with eager attention.
|
|
|
|
Besides, Captain Farragut had spoken of a certain sum of two thousand dollars,
|
|
set apart for whoever should first sight the monster, were he cabin-boy,
|
|
common seaman, or officer.
|
|
|
|
I leave you to judge how eyes were used on board the Abraham Lincoln.
|
|
|
|
For my own part I was not behind the others, and, left to no one my share
|
|
of daily observations. The frigate might have been called the Argus,
|
|
for a hundred reasons. Only one amongst us, Conseil, seemed to protest
|
|
by his indifference against the question which so interested us all,
|
|
and seemed to be out of keeping with the general enthusiasm on board.
|
|
|
|
I have said that Captain Farragut had carefully provided his
|
|
ship with every apparatus for catching the gigantic cetacean.
|
|
No whaler had ever been better armed. We possessed every
|
|
known engine, from the harpoon thrown by the hand to the barbed
|
|
arrows of the blunderbuss, and the explosive balls of the duck-gun.
|
|
On the forecastle lay the perfection of a breech-loading gun,
|
|
very thick at the breech, and very narrow in the bore,
|
|
the model of which had been in the Exhibition of 1867.
|
|
This precious weapon of American origin could throw with ease
|
|
a conical projectile of nine pounds to a mean distance
|
|
of ten miles.
|
|
|
|
Thus the Abraham Lincoln wanted for no means of destruction; and, what was
|
|
better still she had on board Ned Land, the prince of harpooners.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land was a Canadian, with an uncommon quickness of hand, and who knew
|
|
no equal in his dangerous occupation. Skill, coolness, audacity, and cunning
|
|
he possessed in a superior degree, and it must be a cunning whale to escape
|
|
the stroke of his harpoon.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land was about forty years of age; he was a tall man
|
|
(more than six feet high), strongly built, grave and taciturn,
|
|
occasionally violent, and very passionate when contradicted.
|
|
His person attracted attention, but above all the boldness
|
|
of his look, which gave a singular expression to his face.
|
|
|
|
Who calls himself Canadian calls himself French; and, little communicative
|
|
as Ned Land was, I must admit that he took a certain liking for me.
|
|
My nationality drew him to me, no doubt. It was an opportunity for him
|
|
to talk, and for me to hear, that old language of Rabelais, which is still
|
|
in use in some Canadian provinces. The harpooner's family was originally
|
|
from Quebec, and was already a tribe of hardy fishermen when this town
|
|
belonged to France.
|
|
|
|
Little by little, Ned Land acquired a taste for chatting, and I
|
|
loved to hear the recital of his adventures in the polar seas.
|
|
He related his fishing, and his combats, with natural poetry
|
|
of expression; his recital took the form of an epic poem,
|
|
and I seemed to be listening to a Canadian Homer singing the Iliad
|
|
of the regions of the North.
|
|
|
|
I am portraying this hardy companion as I really knew him.
|
|
We are old friends now, united in that unchangeable friendship
|
|
which is born and cemented amidst extreme dangers. Ah, brave Ned!
|
|
I ask no more than to live a hundred years longer, that I may have more
|
|
time to dwell the longer on your memory.
|
|
|
|
Now, what was Ned Land's opinion upon the question of the marine monster?
|
|
I must admit that he did not believe in the unicorn, and was
|
|
the only one on board who did not share that universal conviction.
|
|
He even avoided the subject, which I one day thought it my duty
|
|
to press upon him. One magnificent evening, the 30th July (that is
|
|
to say, three weeks after our departure), the frigate was abreast
|
|
of Cape Blanc, thirty miles to leeward of the coast of Patagonia.
|
|
We had crossed the tropic of Capricorn, and the Straits of Magellan
|
|
opened less than seven hundred miles to the south. Before eight
|
|
days were over the Abraham Lincoln would be ploughing the waters
|
|
of the Pacific.
|
|
|
|
Seated on the poop, Ned Land and I were chatting of one thing
|
|
and another as we looked at this mysterious sea, whose great
|
|
depths had up to this time been inaccessible to the eye of man.
|
|
I naturally led up the conversation to the giant unicorn, and examined
|
|
the various chances of success or failure of the expedition.
|
|
But, seeing that Ned Land let me speak without saying too much himself,
|
|
I pressed him more closely.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Ned," said I, "is it possible that you are not convinced
|
|
of the existence of this cetacean that we are following?
|
|
Have you any particular reason for being so incredulous?"
|
|
|
|
The harpooner looked at me fixedly for some moments
|
|
before answering, struck his broad forehead with his hand
|
|
(a habit of his), as if to collect himself, and said at last,
|
|
"Perhaps I have, Mr. Aronnax."
|
|
|
|
"But, Ned, you, a whaler by profession, familiarised with all
|
|
the great marine mammalia--YOU ought to be the last to doubt
|
|
under such circumstances!"
|
|
|
|
"That is just what deceives you, Professor," replied Ned.
|
|
"As a whaler I have followed many a cetacean, harpooned a great number,
|
|
and killed several; but, however strong or well-armed they may
|
|
have been, neither their tails nor their weapons would have been
|
|
able even to scratch the iron plates of a steamer."
|
|
|
|
"But, Ned, they tell of ships which the teeth of the narwhal
|
|
have pierced through and through."
|
|
|
|
"Wooden ships--that is possible," replied the Canadian,
|
|
"but I have never seen it done; and, until further proof,
|
|
I deny that whales, cetaceans, or sea-unicorns could ever produce
|
|
the effect you describe."
|
|
|
|
"Well, Ned, I repeat it with a conviction resting on the logic of facts.
|
|
I believe in the existence of a mammal power fully organised, belonging to
|
|
the branch of vertebrata, like the whales, the cachalots, or the dolphins,
|
|
and furnished with a horn of defence of great penetrating power."
|
|
|
|
"Hum!" said the harpooner, shaking his head with the air of a man
|
|
who would not be convinced.
|
|
|
|
"Notice one thing, my worthy Canadian," I resumed.
|
|
"If such an animal is in existence, if it inhabits the depths
|
|
of the ocean, if it frequents the strata lying miles below
|
|
the surface of the water, it must necessarily possess an
|
|
organisation the strength of which would defy all comparison."
|
|
|
|
"And why this powerful organisation?" demanded Ned.
|
|
|
|
"Because it requires incalculable strength to keep one's self
|
|
in these strata and resist their pressure. Listen to me.
|
|
Let us admit that the pressure of the atmosphere is represented
|
|
by the weight of a column of water thirty-two feet high.
|
|
In reality the column of water would be shorter, as we are
|
|
speaking of sea water, the density of which is greater than
|
|
that of fresh water. Very well, when you dive, Ned, as many
|
|
times 32 feet of water as there are above you, so many times
|
|
does your body bear a pressure equal to that of the atmosphere,
|
|
that is to say, 15 lb. for each square inch of its surface.
|
|
It follows, then, that at 320 feet this pressure equals
|
|
that of 10 atmospheres, of 100 atmospheres at 3,200 feet,
|
|
and of 1,000 atmospheres at 32,000 feet, that is, about 6 miles;
|
|
which is equivalent to saying that if you could attain this
|
|
depth in the ocean, each square three-eighths of an inch
|
|
of the surface of your body would bear a pressure of 5,600 lb.
|
|
Ah! my brave Ned, do you know how many square inches you carry on
|
|
the surface of your body?"
|
|
|
|
"I have no idea, Mr. Aronnax."
|
|
|
|
"About 6,500; and as in reality the atmospheric pressure is about 15 lb.
|
|
to the square inch, your 6,500 square inches bear at this moment a pressure
|
|
of 97,500 lb."
|
|
|
|
"Without my perceiving it?"
|
|
|
|
"Without your perceiving it. And if you are not crushed by
|
|
such a pressure, it is because the air penetrates the interior
|
|
of your body with equal pressure. Hence perfect equilibrium
|
|
between the interior and exterior pressure, which thus neutralise
|
|
each other, and which allows you to bear it without inconvenience.
|
|
But in the water it is another thing."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, I understand," replied Ned, becoming more attentive;
|
|
"because the water surrounds me, but does not penetrate."
|
|
|
|
"Precisely, Ned: so that at 32 feet beneath the surface of the sea you would
|
|
undergo a pressure of 97,500 lb.; at 320 feet, ten times that pressure;
|
|
at 3,200 feet, a hundred times that pressure; lastly, at 32,000 feet,
|
|
a thousand times that pressure would be 97,500,000 lb.--that is to say,
|
|
that you would be flattened as if you had been drawn from the plates of
|
|
a hydraulic machine!"
|
|
|
|
"The devil!" exclaimed Ned.
|
|
|
|
"Very well, my worthy harpooner, if some vertebrate, several hundred
|
|
yards long, and large in proportion, can maintain itself in such depths--
|
|
of those whose surface is represented by millions of square inches, that is
|
|
by tens of millions of pounds, we must estimate the pressure they undergo.
|
|
Consider, then, what must be the resistance of their bony structure,
|
|
and the strength of their organisation to withstand such pressure!"
|
|
|
|
"Why!" exclaimed Ned Land, "they must be made of iron plates
|
|
eight inches thick, like the armoured frigates."
|
|
|
|
"As you say, Ned. And think what destruction such a mass would cause,
|
|
if hurled with the speed of an express train against the hull of a vessel."
|
|
|
|
"Yes--certainly--perhaps," replied the Canadian, shaken by these figures,
|
|
but not yet willing to give in.
|
|
|
|
"Well, have I convinced you?"
|
|
|
|
"You have convinced me of one thing, sir, which is that,
|
|
if such animals do exist at the bottom of the seas, they must
|
|
necessarily be as strong as you say."
|
|
|
|
"But if they do not exist, mine obstinate harpooner, how explain
|
|
the accident to the Scotia?"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER V
|
|
|
|
AT A VENTURE
|
|
|
|
The voyage of the Abraham Lincoln was for a long time marked
|
|
by no special incident. But one circumstance happened which showed
|
|
the wonderful dexterity of Ned Land, and proved what confidence
|
|
we might place in him.
|
|
|
|
The 30th of June, the frigate spoke some American whalers,
|
|
from whom we learned that they knew nothing about the narwhal.
|
|
But one of them, the captain of the Monroe, knowing that Ned Land had
|
|
shipped on board the Abraham Lincoln, begged for his help in chasing
|
|
a whale they had in sight. Commander Farragut, desirous of seeing
|
|
Ned Land at work, gave him permission to go on board the Monroe.
|
|
And fate served our Canadian so well that, instead of one whale,
|
|
he harpooned two with a double blow, striking one straight to the heart,
|
|
and catching the other after some minutes' pursuit.
|
|
|
|
Decidedly, if the monster ever had to do with Ned Land's harpoon,
|
|
I would not bet in its favour.
|
|
|
|
The frigate skirted the south-east coast of America with great rapidity.
|
|
The 3rd of July we were at the opening of the Straits of Magellan, level with
|
|
Cape Vierges. But Commander Farragut would not take a tortuous passage,
|
|
but doubled Cape Horn.
|
|
|
|
The ship's crew agreed with him. And certainly it was possible
|
|
that they might meet the narwhal in this narrow pass.
|
|
Many of the sailors affirmed that the monster could not pass there,
|
|
"that he was too big for that!"
|
|
|
|
The 6th of July, about three o'clock in the afternoon, the Abraham Lincoln,
|
|
at fifteen miles to the south, doubled the solitary island,
|
|
this lost rock at the extremity of the American continent, to which
|
|
some Dutch sailors gave the name of their native town, Cape Horn.
|
|
The course was taken towards the north-west, and the next day the screw
|
|
of the frigate was at last beating the waters of the Pacific.
|
|
|
|
"Keep your eyes open!" called out the sailors.
|
|
|
|
And they were opened widely. Both eyes and glasses, a little dazzled,
|
|
it is true, by the prospect of two thousand dollars, had not
|
|
an instant's repose.
|
|
|
|
I myself, for whom money had no charms, was not the least
|
|
attentive on board. Giving but few minutes to my meals,
|
|
but a few hours to sleep, indifferent to either rain or sunshine,
|
|
I did not leave the poop of the vessel. Now leaning on the netting
|
|
of the forecastle, now on the taffrail, I devoured with eagerness
|
|
the soft foam which whitened the sea as far as the eye could reach;
|
|
and how often have I shared the emotion of the majority of the crew,
|
|
when some capricious whale raised its black back above the waves!
|
|
The poop of the vessel was crowded on a moment. The cabins
|
|
poured forth a torrent of sailors and officers, each with heaving
|
|
breast and troubled eye watching the course of the cetacean.
|
|
I looked and looked till I was nearly blind, whilst Conseil kept
|
|
repeating in a calm voice:
|
|
|
|
"If, sir, you would not squint so much, you would see better!"
|
|
|
|
But vain excitement! The Abraham Lincoln checked its speed and made
|
|
for the animal signalled, a simple whale, or common cachalot,
|
|
which soon disappeared amidst a storm of abuse.
|
|
|
|
But the weather was good. The voyage was being accomplished under
|
|
the most favourable auspices. It was then the bad season in Australia,
|
|
the July of that zone corresponding to our January in Europe,
|
|
but the sea was beautiful and easily scanned round a vast circumference.
|
|
|
|
The 20th of July, the tropic of Capricorn was cut by 105d of longitude,
|
|
and the 27th of the same month we crossed the Equator on the 110th meridian.
|
|
This passed, the frigate took a more decided westerly direction,
|
|
and scoured the central waters of the Pacific. Commander Farragut thought,
|
|
and with reason, that it was better to remain in deep water, and keep
|
|
clear of continents or islands, which the beast itself seemed to shun
|
|
(perhaps because there was not enough water for him! suggested
|
|
the greater part of the crew). The frigate passed at some distance from
|
|
the Marquesas and the Sandwich Islands, crossed the tropic of Cancer,
|
|
and made for the China Seas. We were on the theatre of the last diversions
|
|
of the monster: and, to say truth, we no longer LIVED on board.
|
|
The entire ship's crew were undergoing a nervous excitement, of which I
|
|
can give no idea: they could not eat, they could not sleep--twenty times
|
|
a day, a misconception or an optical illusion of some sailor seated
|
|
on the taffrail, would cause dreadful perspirations, and these emotions,
|
|
twenty times repeated, kept us in a state of excitement so violent that a
|
|
reaction was unavoidable.
|
|
|
|
And truly, reaction soon showed itself. For three months,
|
|
during which a day seemed an age, the Abraham Lincoln furrowed
|
|
all the waters of the Northern Pacific, running at whales,
|
|
making sharp deviations from her course, veering suddenly
|
|
from one tack to another, stopping suddenly, putting on steam,
|
|
and backing ever and anon at the risk of deranging her machinery,
|
|
and not one point of the Japanese or American coast
|
|
was left unexplored.
|
|
|
|
The warmest partisans of the enterprise now became its most
|
|
ardent detractors. Reaction mounted from the crew to the captain himself,
|
|
and certainly, had it not been for the resolute determination on the part
|
|
of Captain Farragut, the frigate would have headed due southward.
|
|
This useless search could not last much longer. The Abraham Lincoln
|
|
had nothing to reproach herself with, she had done her best to succeed.
|
|
Never had an American ship's crew shown more zeal or patience;
|
|
its failure could not be placed to their charge--there remained nothing
|
|
but to return.
|
|
|
|
This was represented to the commander. The sailors could
|
|
not hide their discontent, and the service suffered.
|
|
I will not say there was a mutiny on board, but after a reasonable
|
|
period of obstinacy, Captain Farragut (as Columbus did)
|
|
asked for three days' patience. If in three days the monster did
|
|
not appear, the man at the helm should give three turns of the wheel,
|
|
and the Abraham Lincoln would make for the European seas.
|
|
|
|
This promise was made on the 2nd of November. It had the effect of
|
|
rallying the ship's crew. The ocean was watched with renewed attention.
|
|
Each one wished for a last glance in which to sum up his remembrance.
|
|
Glasses were used with feverish activity. It was a grand defiance
|
|
given to the giant narwhal, and he could scarcely fail to answer
|
|
the summons and "appear."
|
|
|
|
Two days passed, the steam was at half pressure; a thousand
|
|
schemes were tried to attract the attention and stimulate
|
|
the apathy of the animal in case it should be met in those parts.
|
|
Large quantities of bacon were trailed in the wake of the ship,
|
|
to the great satisfaction (I must say) of the sharks.
|
|
Small craft radiated in all directions round the Abraham Lincoln
|
|
as she lay to, and did not leave a spot of the sea unexplored.
|
|
But the night of the 4th of November arrived without the unveiling of
|
|
this submarine mystery.
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 5th of November, at twelve, the delay would
|
|
(morally speaking) expire; after that time, Commander Farragut,
|
|
faithful to his promise, was to turn the course to the south-east
|
|
and abandon for ever the northern regions of the Pacific.
|
|
|
|
The frigate was then in 31@ 15' N. lat. and 136@ 42' E. long.
|
|
The coast of Japan still remained less than two hundred miles to leeward.
|
|
Night was approaching. They had just struck eight bells;
|
|
large clouds veiled the face of the moon, then in its first quarter.
|
|
The sea undulated peaceably under the stern of the vessel.
|
|
|
|
At that moment I was leaning forward on the starboard netting.
|
|
Conseil, standing near me, was looking straight before him.
|
|
The crew, perched in the ratlines, examined the horizon which
|
|
contracted and darkened by degrees. Officers with their night
|
|
glasses scoured the growing darkness: sometimes the ocean sparkled
|
|
under the rays of the moon, which darted between two clouds,
|
|
then all trace of light was lost in the darkness.
|
|
|
|
In looking at Conseil, I could see he was undergoing a little
|
|
of the general influence. At least I thought so. Perhaps for
|
|
the first time his nerves vibrated to a sentiment of curiosity.
|
|
|
|
"Come, Conseil," said I, "this is the last chance of pocketing
|
|
the two thousand dollars."
|
|
|
|
"May I be permitted to say, sir," replied Conseil, "that I never reckoned
|
|
on getting the prize; and, had the government of the Union offered a hundred
|
|
thousand dollars, it would have been none the poorer."
|
|
|
|
"You are right, Conseil. It is a foolish affair after all, and one upon
|
|
which we entered too lightly. What time lost, what useless emotions!
|
|
We should have been back in France six months ago."
|
|
|
|
"In your little room, sir," replied Conseil, "and in your museum, sir; and I
|
|
should have already classed all your fossils, sir. And the Babiroussa would
|
|
have been installed in its cage in the Jardin des Plantes, and have drawn
|
|
all the curious people of the capital!"
|
|
|
|
"As you say, Conseil. I fancy we shall run a fair chance of being
|
|
laughed at for our pains."
|
|
|
|
"That's tolerably certain," replied Conseil, quietly; "I think
|
|
they will make fun of you, sir. And, must I say it----?"
|
|
|
|
"Go on, my good friend."
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir, you will only get your deserts."
|
|
|
|
"Indeed!"
|
|
|
|
"When one has the honour of being a savant as you are, sir, one should
|
|
not expose one's self to----"
|
|
|
|
Conseil had not time to finish his compliment.
|
|
In the midst of general silence a voice had just been heard.
|
|
It was the voice of Ned Land shouting:
|
|
|
|
"Look out there! The very thing we are looking for--
|
|
on our weather beam!"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER VI
|
|
|
|
AT FULL STEAM
|
|
|
|
At this cry the whole ship's crew hurried towards the harpooner--
|
|
commander, officers, masters, sailors, cabin boys; even the engineers
|
|
left their engines, and the stokers their furnaces.
|
|
|
|
The order to stop her had been given, and the frigate now simply went
|
|
on by her own momentum. The darkness was then profound, and, however good
|
|
the Canadian's eyes were, I asked myself how he had managed to see,
|
|
and what he had been able to see. My heart beat as if it would break.
|
|
But Ned Land was not mistaken, and we all perceived the object
|
|
he pointed to. At two cables' length from the Abraham Lincoln,
|
|
on the starboard quarter, the sea seemed to be illuminated all over.
|
|
It was not a mere phosphoric phenomenon. The monster emerged some fathoms
|
|
from the water, and then threw out that very intense but mysterious
|
|
light mentioned in the report of several captains. This magnificent
|
|
irradiation must have been produced by an agent of great SHINING power.
|
|
The luminous part traced on the sea an immense oval, much elongated,
|
|
the centre of which condensed a burning heat, whose overpowering brilliancy
|
|
died out by successive gradations.
|
|
|
|
"It is only a massing of phosphoric particles," cried one of the officers.
|
|
|
|
"No, sir, certainly not," I replied. "That brightness is of an
|
|
essentially electrical nature. Besides, see, see! it moves;
|
|
it is moving forwards, backwards; it is darting towards us!"
|
|
|
|
A general cry arose from the frigate.
|
|
|
|
"Silence!" said the captain. "Up with the helm, reverse the engines."
|
|
|
|
The steam was shut off, and the Abraham Lincoln, beating to port,
|
|
described a semicircle.
|
|
|
|
"Right the helm, go ahead," cried the captain.
|
|
|
|
These orders were executed, and the frigate moved rapidly
|
|
from the burning light.
|
|
|
|
I was mistaken. She tried to sheer off, but the supernatural
|
|
animal approached with a velocity double her own.
|
|
|
|
We gasped for breath. Stupefaction more than fear made us dumb
|
|
and motionless. The animal gained on us, sporting with the waves.
|
|
It made the round of the frigate, which was then making fourteen knots,
|
|
and enveloped it with its electric rings like luminous dust.
|
|
|
|
Then it moved away two or three miles, leaving a phosphorescent track,
|
|
like those volumes of steam that the express trains leave behind.
|
|
All at once from the dark line of the horizon whither it retired
|
|
to gain its momentum, the monster rushed suddenly towards the Abraham
|
|
Lincoln with alarming rapidity, stopped suddenly about twenty feet
|
|
from the hull, and died out--not diving under the water, for its
|
|
brilliancy did not abate--but suddenly, and as if the source of this
|
|
brilliant emanation was exhausted. Then it reappeared on the other
|
|
side of the vessel, as if it had turned and slid under the hull.
|
|
Any moment a collision might have occurred which would have been fatal
|
|
to us. However, I was astonished at the manoeuvres of the frigate.
|
|
She fled and did not attack.
|
|
|
|
On the captain's face, generally so impassive, was an expression
|
|
of unaccountable astonishment.
|
|
|
|
"Mr. Aronnax," he said, "I do not know with what formidable
|
|
being I have to deal, and I will not imprudently risk my
|
|
frigate in the midst of this darkness. Besides, how attack
|
|
this unknown thing, how defend one's self from it?
|
|
Wait for daylight, and the scene will change."
|
|
|
|
"You have no further doubt, captain, of the nature of the animal?"
|
|
|
|
"No, sir; it is evidently a gigantic narwhal, and an electric one."
|
|
|
|
"Perhaps," added I, "one can only approach it with a torpedo."
|
|
|
|
"Undoubtedly," replied the captain, "if it possesses such
|
|
dreadful power, it is the most terrible animal that ever was created.
|
|
That is why, sir, I must be on my guard."
|
|
|
|
The crew were on their feet all night. No one thought of sleep.
|
|
The Abraham Lincoln, not being able to struggle with such velocity,
|
|
had moderated its pace, and sailed at half speed. For its part,
|
|
the narwhal, imitating the frigate, let the waves rock it at will,
|
|
and seemed decided not to leave the scene of the struggle.
|
|
Towards midnight, however, it disappeared, or, to use a more
|
|
appropriate term, it "died out" like a large glow-worm. Had it fled?
|
|
One could only fear, not hope it. But at seven minutes to one o'clock
|
|
in the morning a deafening whistling was heard, like that produced
|
|
by a body of water rushing with great violence.
|
|
|
|
The captain, Ned Land, and I were then on the poop, eagerly peering
|
|
through the profound darkness.
|
|
|
|
"Ned Land," asked the commander, "you have often heard the roaring of whales?"
|
|
|
|
"Often, sir; but never such whales the sight of which brought me
|
|
in two thousand dollars. If I can only approach within four harpoons'
|
|
length of it!"
|
|
|
|
"But to approach it," said the commander, "I ought to put a whaler
|
|
at your disposal?"
|
|
|
|
"Certainly, sir."
|
|
|
|
"That will be trifling with the lives of my men."
|
|
|
|
"And mine too," simply said the harpooner.
|
|
|
|
Towards two o'clock in the morning, the burning light reappeared,
|
|
not less intense, about five miles to windward of the Abraham Lincoln.
|
|
Notwithstanding the distance, and the noise of the wind and sea,
|
|
one heard distinctly the loud strokes of the animal's tail,
|
|
and even its panting breath. It seemed that, at the moment
|
|
that the enormous narwhal had come to take breath at the surface
|
|
of the water, the air was engulfed in its lungs, like the steam
|
|
in the vast cylinders of a machine of two thousand horse-power.
|
|
|
|
"Hum!" thought I, "a whale with the strength of a cavalry regiment
|
|
would be a pretty whale!"
|
|
|
|
We were on the qui vive till daylight, and prepared for the combat.
|
|
The fishing implements were laid along the hammock nettings.
|
|
The second lieutenant loaded the blunder busses, which could throw harpoons
|
|
to the distance of a mile, and long duck-guns, with explosive bullets,
|
|
which inflicted mortal wounds even to the most terrible animals.
|
|
Ned Land contented himself with sharpening his harpoon--a terrible weapon
|
|
in his hands.
|
|
|
|
At six o'clock day began to break; and, with the first glimmer
|
|
of light, the electric light of the narwhal disappeared.
|
|
At seven o'clock the day was sufficiently advanced, but a very thick sea
|
|
fog obscured our view, and the best spy glasses could not pierce it.
|
|
That caused disappointment and anger.
|
|
|
|
I climbed the mizzen-mast. Some officers were already perched
|
|
on the mast-heads. At eight o'clock the fog lay heavily
|
|
on the waves, and its thick scrolls rose little by little.
|
|
The horizon grew wider and clearer at the same time.
|
|
Suddenly, just as on the day before, Ned Land's voice was heard:
|
|
|
|
"The thing itself on the port quarter!" cried the harpooner.
|
|
|
|
Every eye was turned towards the point indicated. There, a mile and a half
|
|
from the frigate, a long blackish body emerged a yard above the waves.
|
|
Its tail, violently agitated, produced a considerable eddy.
|
|
Never did a tail beat the sea with such violence. An immense track,
|
|
of dazzling whiteness, marked the passage of the animal, and described
|
|
a long curve.
|
|
|
|
The frigate approached the cetacean. I examined it thoroughly.
|
|
|
|
The reports of the Shannon and of the Helvetia had rather
|
|
exaggerated its size, and I estimated its length at
|
|
only two hundred and fifty feet. As to its dimensions,
|
|
I could only conjecture them to be admirably proportioned.
|
|
While I watched this phenomenon, two jets of steam and water
|
|
were ejected from its vents, and rose to the height of 120 feet;
|
|
thus I ascertained its way of breathing. I concluded definitely
|
|
that it belonged to the vertebrate branch, class mammalia.
|
|
|
|
The crew waited impatiently for their chief's orders. The latter,
|
|
after having observed the animal attentively, called the engineer.
|
|
The engineer ran to him.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said the commander, "you have steam up?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir," answered the engineer.
|
|
|
|
"Well, make up your fires and put on all steam."
|
|
|
|
Three hurrahs greeted this order. The time for the struggle had arrived.
|
|
Some moments after, the two funnels of the frigate vomited torrents of
|
|
black smoke, and the bridge quaked under the trembling of the boilers.
|
|
|
|
The Abraham Lincoln, propelled by her wonderful screw,
|
|
went straight at the animal. The latter allowed it to come
|
|
within half a cable's length; then, as if disdaining to dive,
|
|
it took a little turn, and stopped a short distance off.
|
|
|
|
This pursuit lasted nearly three-quarters of an hour,
|
|
without the frigate gaining two yards on the cetacean.
|
|
It was quite evident that at that rate we should never come
|
|
up with it.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Mr. Land," asked the captain, "do you advise me to put
|
|
the boats out to sea?"
|
|
|
|
"No, sir," replied Ned Land; "because we shall not take that beast easily."
|
|
|
|
"What shall we do then?"
|
|
|
|
"Put on more steam if you can, sir. With your leave, I mean to post
|
|
myself under the bowsprit, and, if we get within harpooning distance,
|
|
I shall throw my harpoon."
|
|
|
|
"Go, Ned," said the captain. "Engineer, put on more pressure."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land went to his post. The fires were increased, the screw revolved
|
|
forty-three times a minute, and the steam poured out of the valves.
|
|
We heaved the log, and calculated that the Abraham Lincoln was going
|
|
at the rate of 18 1/2 miles an hour.
|
|
|
|
But the accursed animal swam at the same speed.
|
|
|
|
For a whole hour the frigate kept up this pace, without gaining six feet.
|
|
It was humiliating for one of the swiftest sailers in the American navy.
|
|
A stubborn anger seized the crew; the sailors abused the monster, who,
|
|
as before, disdained to answer them; the captain no longer contented himself
|
|
with twisting his beard--he gnawed it.
|
|
|
|
The engineer was called again.
|
|
|
|
"You have turned full steam on?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir," replied the engineer.
|
|
|
|
The speed of the Abraham Lincoln increased. Its masts trembled
|
|
down to their stepping holes, and the clouds of smoke could hardly
|
|
find way out of the narrow funnels.
|
|
|
|
They heaved the log a second time.
|
|
|
|
"Well?" asked the captain of the man at the wheel.
|
|
|
|
"Nineteen miles and three-tenths, sir."
|
|
|
|
"Clap on more steam."
|
|
|
|
The engineer obeyed. The manometer showed ten degrees.
|
|
But the cetacean grew warm itself, no doubt; for without
|
|
straining itself, it made 19 3/10 miles.
|
|
|
|
What a pursuit! No, I cannot describe the emotion that vibrated through me.
|
|
Ned Land kept his post, harpoon in hand. Several times the animal let us
|
|
gain upon it.--"We shall catch it! we shall catch it!" cried the Canadian.
|
|
But just as he was going to strike, the cetacean stole away with a rapidity
|
|
that could not be estimated at less than thirty miles an hour, and even during
|
|
our maximum of speed, it bullied the frigate, going round and round it.
|
|
A cry of fury broke from everyone!
|
|
|
|
At noon we were no further advanced than at eight o'clock in the morning.
|
|
|
|
The captain then decided to take more direct means.
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" said he, "that animal goes quicker than the Abraham Lincoln.
|
|
Very well! we will see whether it will escape these conical bullets.
|
|
Send your men to the forecastle, sir."
|
|
|
|
The forecastle gun was immediately loaded and slewed round.
|
|
But the shot passed some feet above the cetacean, which was half
|
|
a mile off.
|
|
|
|
"Another, more to the right," cried the commander, "and five
|
|
dollars to whoever will hit that infernal beast."
|
|
|
|
An old gunner with a grey beard--that I can see now--with steady
|
|
eye and grave face, went up to the gun and took a long aim.
|
|
A loud report was heard, with which were mingled the cheers
|
|
of the crew.
|
|
|
|
The bullet did its work; it hit the animal, and, sliding off
|
|
the rounded surface, was lost in two miles depth of sea.
|
|
|
|
The chase began again, and the captain, leaning towards me, said:
|
|
|
|
"I will pursue that beast till my frigate bursts up."
|
|
|
|
"Yes," answered I; "and you will be quite right to do it."
|
|
|
|
I wished the beast would exhaust itself, and not be insensible
|
|
to fatigue like a steam engine. But it was of no use.
|
|
Hours passed, without its showing any signs of exhaustion.
|
|
|
|
However, it must be said in praise of the Abraham Lincoln that she
|
|
struggled on indefatigably. I cannot reckon the distance she made
|
|
under three hundred miles during this unlucky day, November the 6th.
|
|
But night came on, and overshadowed the rough ocean.
|
|
|
|
Now I thought our expedition was at an end, and that we should
|
|
never again see the extraordinary animal. I was mistaken.
|
|
At ten minutes to eleven in the evening, the electric light
|
|
reappeared three miles to windward of the frigate, as pure,
|
|
as intense as during the preceding night.
|
|
|
|
The narwhal seemed motionless; perhaps, tired with its day's work,
|
|
it slept, letting itself float with the undulation of the waves.
|
|
Now was a chance of which the captain resolved to take advantage.
|
|
|
|
He gave his orders. The Abraham Lincoln kept up half steam,
|
|
and advanced cautiously so as not to awake its adversary.
|
|
It is no rare thing to meet in the middle of the ocean whales
|
|
so sound asleep that they can be successfully attacked,
|
|
and Ned Land had harpooned more than one during its sleep.
|
|
The Canadian went to take his place again under the bowsprit.
|
|
|
|
The frigate approached noiselessly, stopped at two cables'
|
|
lengths from the animal, and following its track.
|
|
No one breathed; a deep silence reigned on the bridge.
|
|
We were not a hundred feet from the burning focus, the light of
|
|
which increased and dazzled our eyes.
|
|
|
|
At this moment, leaning on the forecastle bulwark, I saw below me Ned
|
|
Land grappling the martingale in one hand, brandishing his terrible
|
|
harpoon in the other, scarcely twenty feet from the motionless animal.
|
|
Suddenly his arm straightened, and the harpoon was thrown; I heard
|
|
the sonorous stroke of the weapon, which seemed to have struck a hard body.
|
|
The electric light went out suddenly, and two enormous waterspouts
|
|
broke over the bridge of the frigate, rushing like a torrent from stem
|
|
to stern, overthrowing men, and breaking the lashings of the spars.
|
|
A fearful shock followed, and, thrown over the rail without having
|
|
time to stop myself, I fell into the sea.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER VII
|
|
|
|
AN UNKNOWN SPECIES OF WHALE
|
|
|
|
This unexpected fall so stunned me that I have no
|
|
clear recollection of my sensations at the time.
|
|
I was at first drawn down to a depth of about twenty feet.
|
|
I am a good swimmer (though without pretending to rival
|
|
Byron or Edgar Poe, who were masters of the art),
|
|
and in that plunge I did not lose my presence of mind.
|
|
Two vigorous strokes brought me to the surface of the water.
|
|
My first care was to look for the frigate. Had the crew
|
|
seen me disappear? Had the Abraham Lincoln veered round?
|
|
Would the captain put out a boat? Might I hope to be saved?
|
|
|
|
The darkness was intense. I caught a glimpse of a black mass disappearing in
|
|
the east, its beacon lights dying out in the distance. It was the frigate!
|
|
I was lost.
|
|
|
|
"Help, help!" I shouted, swimming towards the Abraham Lincoln in desperation.
|
|
|
|
My clothes encumbered me; they seemed glued to my body,
|
|
and paralysed my movements.
|
|
|
|
I was sinking! I was suffocating!
|
|
|
|
"Help!"
|
|
|
|
This was my last cry. My mouth filled with water;
|
|
I struggled against being drawn down the abyss.
|
|
Suddenly my clothes were seized by a strong hand, and I
|
|
felt myself quickly drawn up to the surface of the sea;
|
|
and I heard, yes, I heard these words pronounced in my ear:
|
|
|
|
"If master would be so good as to lean on my shoulder,
|
|
master would swim with much greater ease."
|
|
|
|
I seized with one hand my faithful Conseil's arm.
|
|
|
|
"Is it you?" said I, "you?"
|
|
|
|
"Myself," answered Conseil; "and waiting master's orders."
|
|
|
|
"That shock threw you as well as me into the sea?"
|
|
|
|
"No; but, being in my master's service, I followed him."
|
|
|
|
The worthy fellow thought that was but natural.
|
|
|
|
"And the frigate?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"The frigate?" replied Conseil, turning on his back;
|
|
"I think that master had better not count too much on her."
|
|
|
|
"You think so?"
|
|
|
|
"I say that, at the time I threw myself into the sea, I heard the men
|
|
at the wheel say, `The screw and the rudder are broken.'
|
|
|
|
"Broken?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, broken by the monster's teeth. It is the only injury
|
|
the Abraham Lincoln has sustained. But it is a bad look-out for us--
|
|
she no longer answers her helm."
|
|
|
|
"Then we are lost!"
|
|
|
|
"Perhaps so," calmly answered Conseil. "However, we have still several
|
|
hours before us, and one can do a good deal in some hours."
|
|
|
|
Conseil's imperturbable coolness set me up again.
|
|
I swam more vigorously; but, cramped by my clothes, which stuck
|
|
to me like a leaden weight, I felt great difficulty in bearing up.
|
|
Conseil saw this.
|
|
|
|
"Will master let me make a slit?" said he; and, slipping an open knife
|
|
under my clothes, he ripped them up from top to bottom very rapidly.
|
|
Then he cleverly slipped them off me, while I swam for both of us.
|
|
|
|
Then I did the same for Conseil, and we continued to swim near
|
|
to each other.
|
|
|
|
Nevertheless, our situation was no less terrible.
|
|
Perhaps our disappearance had not been noticed; and, if it
|
|
had been, the frigate could not tack, being without its helm.
|
|
Conseil argued on this supposition, and laid his plans accordingly.
|
|
This quiet boy was perfectly self-possessed. We then decided that,
|
|
as our only chance of safety was being picked up by the Abraham
|
|
Lincoln's boats, we ought to manage so as to wait for them
|
|
as long as possible. I resolved then to husband our strength,
|
|
so that both should not be exhausted at the same time;
|
|
and this is how we managed: while one of us lay on our back,
|
|
quite still, with arms crossed, and legs stretched out,
|
|
the other would swim and push the other on in front.
|
|
This towing business did not last more than ten minutes each;
|
|
and relieving each other thus, we could swim on for some hours,
|
|
perhaps till day-break. Poor chance! but hope is so firmly
|
|
rooted in the heart of man! Moreover, there were two of us.
|
|
Indeed I declare (though it may seem improbable)
|
|
if I sought to destroy all hope--if I wished to despair,
|
|
I could not.
|
|
|
|
The collision of the frigate with the cetacean had
|
|
occurred about eleven o'clock in the evening before.
|
|
I reckoned then we should have eight hours to swim before sunrise,
|
|
an operation quite practicable if we relieved each other.
|
|
The sea, very calm, was in our favour. Sometimes I tried
|
|
to pierce the intense darkness that was only dispelled
|
|
by the phosphorescence caused by our movements.
|
|
I watched the luminous waves that broke over my hand,
|
|
whose mirror-like surface was spotted with silvery rings.
|
|
One might have said that we were in a bath of quicksilver.
|
|
|
|
Near one o'clock in the morning, I was seized with dreadful fatigue.
|
|
My limbs stiffened under the strain of violent cramp. Conseil was
|
|
obliged to keep me up, and our preservation devolved on him alone.
|
|
I heard the poor boy pant; his breathing became short and hurried.
|
|
I found that he could not keep up much longer.
|
|
|
|
"Leave me! leave me!" I said to him.
|
|
|
|
"Leave my master? Never!" replied he. "I would drown first."
|
|
|
|
Just then the moon appeared through the fringes of a
|
|
thick cloud that the wind was driving to the east.
|
|
The surface of the sea glittered with its rays.
|
|
This kindly light reanimated us. My head got better again.
|
|
I looked at all points of the horizon. I saw the frigate!
|
|
She was five miles from us, and looked like a dark mass,
|
|
hardly discernible. But no boats!
|
|
|
|
I would have cried out. But what good would it have been at such a distance!
|
|
My swollen lips could utter no sounds. Conseil could articulate some words,
|
|
and I heard him repeat at intervals, "Help! help!"
|
|
|
|
Our movements were suspended for an instant; we listened.
|
|
It might be only a singing in the ear, but it seemed to me
|
|
as if a cry answered the cry from Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Did you hear?" I murmured.
|
|
|
|
"Yes! Yes!"
|
|
|
|
And Conseil gave one more despairing cry.
|
|
|
|
This time there was no mistake! A human voice responded to ours!
|
|
Was it the voice of another unfortunate creature, abandoned in the middle
|
|
of the ocean, some other victim of the shock sustained by the vessel?
|
|
Or rather was it a boat from the frigate, that was hailing us in the darkness?
|
|
|
|
Conseil made a last effort, and, leaning on my shoulder, while I struck
|
|
out in a desperate effort, he raised himself half out of the water,
|
|
then fell back exhausted.
|
|
|
|
"What did you see?"
|
|
|
|
"I saw----" murmured he; "I saw--but do not talk--reserve all your strength!"
|
|
|
|
What had he seen? Then, I know not why, the thought
|
|
of the monster came into my head for the first time!
|
|
But that voice! The time is past for Jonahs to take refuge
|
|
in whales' bellies! However, Conseil was towing me again.
|
|
He raised his head sometimes, looked before us, and uttered a cry
|
|
of recognition, which was responded to by a voice that came nearer
|
|
and nearer. I scarcely heard it. My strength was exhausted;
|
|
my fingers stiffened; my hand afforded me support no longer;
|
|
my mouth, convulsively opening, filled with salt water.
|
|
Cold crept over me. I raised my head for the last time,
|
|
then I sank.
|
|
|
|
At this moment a hard body struck me. I clung to it:
|
|
then I felt that I was being drawn up, that I was brought to
|
|
the surface of the water, that my chest collapsed--I fainted.
|
|
|
|
It is certain that I soon came to, thanks to the vigorous rubbings
|
|
that I received. I half opened my eyes.
|
|
|
|
"Conseil!" I murmured.
|
|
|
|
"Does master call me?" asked Conseil.
|
|
|
|
Just then, by the waning light of the moon which was sinking
|
|
down to the horizon, I saw a face which was not Conseil's
|
|
and which I immediately recognised.
|
|
|
|
"Ned!" I cried.
|
|
|
|
"The same, sir, who is seeking his prize!" replied the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Were you thrown into the sea by the shock to the frigate?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Professor; but more fortunate than you, I was able to find
|
|
a footing almost directly upon a floating island."
|
|
|
|
"An island?"
|
|
|
|
"Or, more correctly speaking, on our gigantic narwhal."
|
|
|
|
"Explain yourself, Ned!"
|
|
|
|
"Only I soon found out why my harpoon had not entered its skin
|
|
and was blunted."
|
|
|
|
"Why, Ned, why?"
|
|
|
|
"Because, Professor, that beast is made of sheet iron."
|
|
|
|
The Canadian's last words produced a sudden revolution in my brain.
|
|
I wriggled myself quickly to the top of the being, or object,
|
|
half out of the water, which served us for a refuge. I kicked it.
|
|
It was evidently a hard, impenetrable body, and not the soft substance
|
|
that forms the bodies of the great marine mammalia. But this hard
|
|
body might be a bony covering, like that of the antediluvian animals;
|
|
and I should be free to class this monster among amphibious reptiles,
|
|
such as tortoises or alligators.
|
|
|
|
Well, no! the blackish back that supported me was smooth,
|
|
polished, without scales. The blow produced a metallic sound;
|
|
and, incredible though it may be, it seemed, I might say,
|
|
as if it was made of riveted plates.
|
|
|
|
There was no doubt about it! This monster, this natural
|
|
phenomenon that had puzzled the learned world, and over thrown
|
|
and misled the imagination of seamen of both hemispheres,
|
|
it must be owned was a still more astonishing phenomenon,
|
|
inasmuch as it was a simply human construction.
|
|
|
|
We had no time to lose, however. We were lying upon the back of a
|
|
sort of submarine boat, which appeared (as far as I could judge)
|
|
like a huge fish of steel. Ned Land's mind was made up on this point.
|
|
Conseil and I could only agree with him.
|
|
|
|
Just then a bubbling began at the back of this strange thing
|
|
(which was evidently propelled by a screw), and it began to move.
|
|
We had only just time to seize hold of the upper part,
|
|
which rose about seven feet out of the water, and happily its speed
|
|
was not great.
|
|
|
|
"As long as it sails horizontally," muttered Ned Land,
|
|
"I do not mind; but, if it takes a fancy to dive, I would
|
|
not give two straws for my life."
|
|
|
|
The Canadian might have said still less. It became really necessary to
|
|
communicate with the beings, whatever they were, shut up inside the machine.
|
|
I searched all over the outside for an aperture, a panel, or a manhole,
|
|
to use a technical expression; but the lines of the iron rivets,
|
|
solidly driven into the joints of the iron plates, were clear and uniform.
|
|
Besides, the moon disappeared then, and left us in total darkness.
|
|
|
|
At last this long night passed. My indistinct remembrance
|
|
prevents my describing all the impressions it made.
|
|
I can only recall one circumstance. During some lulls of
|
|
the wind and sea, I fancied I heard several times vague sounds,
|
|
a sort of fugitive harmony produced by words of command.
|
|
What was, then, the mystery of this submarine craft,
|
|
of which the whole world vainly sought an explanation?
|
|
What kind of beings existed in this strange boat?
|
|
What mechanical agent caused its prodigious speed?
|
|
|
|
Daybreak appeared. The morning mists surrounded us,
|
|
but they soon cleared off. I was about to examine the hull,
|
|
which formed on deck a kind of horizontal platform, when I felt
|
|
it gradually sinking.
|
|
|
|
"Oh! confound it!" cried Ned Land, kicking the resounding plate.
|
|
"Open, you inhospitable rascals!"
|
|
|
|
Happily the sinking movement ceased. Suddenly a noise, like iron
|
|
works violently pushed aside, came from the interior of the boat.
|
|
One iron plate was moved, a man appeared, uttered an odd cry,
|
|
and disappeared immediately.
|
|
|
|
Some moments after, eight strong men, with masked faces, appeared noiselessly,
|
|
and drew us down into their formidable machine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER VIII
|
|
|
|
MOBILIS IN MOBILI
|
|
|
|
This forcible abduction, so roughly carried out, was accomplished with
|
|
the rapidity of lightning. I shivered all over. Whom had we to deal with?
|
|
No doubt some new sort of pirates, who explored the sea in their own way.
|
|
Hardly had the narrow panel closed upon me, when I was enveloped in darkness.
|
|
My eyes, dazzled with the outer light, could distinguish nothing.
|
|
I felt my naked feet cling to the rungs of an iron ladder. Ned Land
|
|
and Conseil, firmly seized, followed me. At the bottom of the ladder,
|
|
a door opened, and shut after us immediately with a bang.
|
|
|
|
We were alone. Where, I could not say, hardly imagine.
|
|
All was black, and such a dense black that, after some minutes,
|
|
my eyes had not been able to discern even the faintest glimmer.
|
|
|
|
Meanwhile, Ned Land, furious at these proceedings, gave free
|
|
vent to his indignation.
|
|
|
|
"Confound it!" cried he, "here are people who come up to the
|
|
Scotch for hospitality. They only just miss being cannibals.
|
|
I should not be surprised at it, but I declare that they shall
|
|
not eat me without my protesting."
|
|
|
|
"Calm yourself, friend Ned, calm yourself," replied Conseil, quietly.
|
|
"Do not cry out before you are hurt. We are not quite done for yet."
|
|
|
|
"Not quite," sharply replied the Canadian, "but pretty near,
|
|
at all events. Things look black. Happily, my bowie knife
|
|
I have still, and I can always see well enough to use it.
|
|
The first of these pirates who lays a hand on me----"
|
|
|
|
"Do not excite yourself, Ned," I said to the harpooner, "and do not compromise
|
|
us by useless violence. Who knows that they will not listen to us?
|
|
Let us rather try to find out where we are."
|
|
|
|
I groped about. In five steps I came to an iron wall,
|
|
made of plates bolted together. Then turning back I struck
|
|
against a wooden table, near which were ranged several stools.
|
|
The boards of this prison were concealed under a thick mat,
|
|
which deadened the noise of the feet. The bare walls
|
|
revealed no trace of window or door. Conseil, going round
|
|
the reverse way, met me, and we went back to the middle
|
|
of the cabin, which measured about twenty feet by ten.
|
|
As to its height, Ned Land, in spite of his own great height,
|
|
could not measure it.
|
|
|
|
Half an hour had already passed without our situation being bettered,
|
|
when the dense darkness suddenly gave way to extreme light.
|
|
Our prison was suddenly lighted, that is to say, it became filled
|
|
with a luminous matter, so strong that I could not bear it at first.
|
|
In its whiteness and intensity I recognised that electric light which played
|
|
round the submarine boat like a magnificent phenomenon of phosphorescence.
|
|
After shutting my eyes involuntarily, I opened them, and saw that this
|
|
luminous agent came from a half globe, unpolished, placed in the roof
|
|
of the cabin.
|
|
|
|
"At last one can see," cried Ned Land, who, knife in hand,
|
|
stood on the defensive.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," said I; "but we are still in the dark about ourselves."
|
|
|
|
"Let master have patience," said the imperturbable Conseil.
|
|
|
|
The sudden lighting of the cabin enabled me to examine it minutely.
|
|
It only contained a table and five stools. The invisible
|
|
door might be hermetically sealed. No noise was heard.
|
|
All seemed dead in the interior of this boat. Did it move, did it
|
|
float on the surface of the ocean, or did it dive into its depths?
|
|
I could not guess.
|
|
|
|
A noise of bolts was now heard, the door opened, and two men appeared.
|
|
|
|
One was short, very muscular, broad-shouldered, with robust limbs,
|
|
strong head, an abundance of black hair, thick moustache,
|
|
a quick penetrating look, and the vivacity which characterises
|
|
the population of Southern France.
|
|
|
|
The second stranger merits a more detailed description. I made out
|
|
his prevailing qualities directly: self-confidence--because his head
|
|
was well set on his shoulders, and his black eyes looked around with
|
|
cold assurance; calmness--for his skin, rather pale, showed his coolness
|
|
of blood; energy--evinced by the rapid contraction of his lofty brows;
|
|
and courage--because his deep breathing denoted great power of lungs.
|
|
|
|
Whether this person was thirty-five or fifty years of age,
|
|
I could not say. He was tall, had a large forehead,
|
|
straight nose, a clearly cut mouth, beautiful teeth, with fine
|
|
taper hands, indicative of a highly nervous temperament.
|
|
This man was certainly the most admirable specimen I had ever met.
|
|
One particular feature was his eyes, rather far from each other,
|
|
and which could take in nearly a quarter of the horizon at once.
|
|
|
|
This faculty--(I verified it later)--gave him a range of vision far superior
|
|
to Ned Land's. When this stranger fixed upon an object, his eyebrows met,
|
|
his large eyelids closed around so as to contract the range of his vision,
|
|
and he looked as if he magnified the objects lessened by distance, as if
|
|
he pierced those sheets of water so opaque to our eyes, and as if he read
|
|
the very depths of the seas.
|
|
|
|
The two strangers, with caps made from the fur of the sea otter,
|
|
and shod with sea boots of seal's skin, were dressed in clothes
|
|
of a particular texture, which allowed free movement of the limbs.
|
|
The taller of the two, evidently the chief on board, examined us
|
|
with great attention, without saying a word; then, turning to
|
|
his companion, talked with him in an unknown tongue.
|
|
It was a sonorous, harmonious, and flexible dialect, the vowels
|
|
seeming to admit of very varied accentuation.
|
|
|
|
The other replied by a shake of the head, and added two or three perfectly
|
|
incomprehensible words. Then he seemed to question me by a look.
|
|
|
|
I replied in good French that I did not know his language;
|
|
but he seemed not to understand me, and my situation
|
|
became more embarrassing.
|
|
|
|
"If master were to tell our story," said Conseil, "perhaps these gentlemen
|
|
may understand some words."
|
|
|
|
I began to tell our adventures, articulating each syllable clearly,
|
|
and without omitting one single detail. I announced our names and rank,
|
|
introducing in person Professor Aronnax, his servant Conseil,
|
|
and master Ned Land, the harpooner.
|
|
|
|
The man with the soft calm eyes listened to me quietly,
|
|
even politely, and with extreme attention; but nothing in
|
|
his countenance indicated that he had understood my story.
|
|
When I finished, he said not a word.
|
|
|
|
There remained one resource, to speak English.
|
|
Perhaps they would know this almost universal language.
|
|
I knew it--as well as the German language--well enough to read
|
|
it fluently, but not to speak it correctly. But, anyhow, we must
|
|
make ourselves understood.
|
|
|
|
"Go on in your turn," I said to the harpooner; "speak your best
|
|
Anglo-Saxon, and try to do better than I."
|
|
|
|
Ned did not beg off, and recommenced our story.
|
|
|
|
To his great disgust, the harpooner did not seem to have made
|
|
himself more intelligible than I had. Our visitors did not stir.
|
|
They evidently understood neither the language of England
|
|
nor of France.
|
|
|
|
Very much embarrassed, after having vainly exhausted our speaking resources,
|
|
I knew not what part to take, when Conseil said:
|
|
|
|
"If master will permit me, I will relate it in German."
|
|
|
|
But in spite of the elegant terms and good accent
|
|
of the narrator, the German language had no success.
|
|
At last, nonplussed, I tried to remember my first lessons,
|
|
and to narrate our adventures in Latin, but with no better success.
|
|
This last attempt being of no avail, the two strangers exchanged
|
|
some words in their unknown language, and retired.
|
|
|
|
The door shut.
|
|
|
|
"It is an infamous shame," cried Ned Land, who broke out for the
|
|
twentieth time. "We speak to those rogues in French, English, German,
|
|
and Latin, and not one of them has the politeness to answer!"
|
|
|
|
"Calm yourself," I said to the impetuous Ned; "anger will do no good."
|
|
|
|
"But do you see, Professor," replied our irascible companion,
|
|
"that we shall absolutely die of hunger in this iron cage?"
|
|
|
|
"Bah!" said Conseil, philosophically; "we can hold out some time yet."
|
|
|
|
"My friends," I said, "we must not despair. We have been worse
|
|
off than this. Do me the favour to wait a little before forming
|
|
an opinion upon the commander and crew of this boat."
|
|
|
|
"My opinion is formed," replied Ned Land, sharply. "They are rascals."
|
|
|
|
"Good! and from what country?"
|
|
|
|
"From the land of rogues!"
|
|
|
|
"My brave Ned, that country is not clearly indicated on the map of the world;
|
|
but I admit that the nationality of the two strangers is hard to determine.
|
|
Neither English, French, nor German, that is quite certain. However, I am
|
|
inclined to think that the commander and his companion were born in
|
|
low latitudes. There is southern blood in them. But I cannot decide by
|
|
their appearance whether they are Spaniards, Turks, Arabians, or Indians.
|
|
As to their language, it is quite incomprehensible."
|
|
|
|
"There is the disadvantage of not knowing all languages," said Conseil,
|
|
"or the disadvantage of not having one universal language."
|
|
|
|
As he said these words, the door opened. A steward entered.
|
|
He brought us clothes, coats and trousers, made of a stuff I did not know.
|
|
I hastened to dress myself, and my companions followed my example.
|
|
During that time, the steward--dumb, perhaps deaf--had arranged the table,
|
|
and laid three plates.
|
|
|
|
"This is something like!" said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Bah!" said the angry harpooner, "what do you suppose they eat here?
|
|
Tortoise liver, filleted shark, and beef steaks from seadogs."
|
|
|
|
"We shall see," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
The dishes, of bell metal, were placed on the table, and we took
|
|
our places. Undoubtedly we had to do with civilised people,
|
|
and, had it not been for the electric light which flooded us,
|
|
I could have fancied I was in the dining-room of the Adelphi
|
|
Hotel at Liverpool, or at the Grand Hotel in Paris.
|
|
I must say, however, that there was neither bread nor wine.
|
|
The water was fresh and clear, but it was water and did not suit
|
|
Ned Land's taste. Amongst the dishes which were brought to us,
|
|
I recognised several fish delicately dressed; but of some,
|
|
although excellent, I could give no opinion, neither could I tell
|
|
to what kingdom they belonged, whether animal or vegetable.
|
|
As to the dinner-service, it was elegant, and in perfect taste.
|
|
Each utensil--spoon, fork, knife, plate--had a letter engraved on it,
|
|
with a motto above it, of which this is an exact facsimile:
|
|
|
|
|
|
MOBILIS IN MOBILI N
|
|
|
|
The letter N was no doubt the initial of the name of the enigmatical
|
|
person who commanded at the bottom of the seas.
|
|
|
|
Ned and Conseil did not reflect much. They devoured the food,
|
|
and I did likewise. I was, besides, reassured as to our fate;
|
|
and it seemed evident that our hosts would not let us die of want.
|
|
|
|
However, everything has an end, everything passes away,
|
|
even the hunger of people who have not eaten for fifteen hours.
|
|
Our appetites satisfied, we felt overcome with sleep.
|
|
|
|
"Faith! I shall sleep well," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"So shall I," replied Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
My two companions stretched themselves on the cabin carpet,
|
|
and were soon sound asleep. For my own part, too many thoughts
|
|
crowded my brain, too many insoluble questions pressed upon me,
|
|
too many fancies kept my eyes half open. Where were we?
|
|
What strange power carried us on? I felt--or rather fancied I felt--
|
|
the machine sinking down to the lowest beds of the sea.
|
|
Dreadful nightmares beset me; I saw in these mysterious asylums
|
|
a world of unknown animals, amongst which this submarine boat seemed
|
|
to be of the same kind, living, moving, and formidable as they.
|
|
Then my brain grew calmer, my imagination wandered into
|
|
vague unconsciousness, and I soon fell into a deep sleep.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER IX
|
|
|
|
NED LAND'S TEMPERS
|
|
|
|
How long we slept I do not know; but our sleep must have lasted long,
|
|
for it rested us completely from our fatigues. I woke first.
|
|
My companions had not moved, and were still stretched in their corner.
|
|
|
|
Hardly roused from my somewhat hard couch, I felt my brain freed,
|
|
my mind clear. I then began an attentive examination of our cell.
|
|
Nothing was changed inside. The prison was still a prison--
|
|
the prisoners, prisoners. However, the steward, during our sleep,
|
|
had cleared the table. I breathed with difficulty. The heavy air
|
|
seemed to oppress my lungs. Although the cell was large, we had
|
|
evidently consumed a great part of the oxygen that it contained.
|
|
Indeed, each man consumes, in one hour, the oxygen contained in more
|
|
than 176 pints of air, and this air, charged (as then) with a nearly
|
|
equal quantity of carbonic acid, becomes unbreathable.
|
|
|
|
It became necessary to renew the atmosphere of our prison, and no doubt
|
|
the whole in the submarine boat. That gave rise to a question in my mind.
|
|
How would the commander of this floating dwelling-place proceed?
|
|
Would he obtain air by chemical means, in getting by heat the oxygen contained
|
|
in chlorate of potash, and in absorbing carbonic acid by caustic potash?
|
|
Or--a more convenient, economical, and consequently more probable alternative--
|
|
would he be satisfied to rise and take breath at the surface of the water,
|
|
like a whale, and so renew for twenty-four hours the atmospheric provision?
|
|
|
|
In fact, I was already obliged to increase my respirations to eke
|
|
out of this cell the little oxygen it contained, when suddenly I was
|
|
refreshed by a current of pure air, and perfumed with saline emanations.
|
|
It was an invigorating sea breeze, charged with iodine. I opened my
|
|
mouth wide, and my lungs saturated themselves with fresh particles.
|
|
|
|
At the same time I felt the boat rolling. The iron-plated monster
|
|
had evidently just risen to the surface of the ocean to breathe,
|
|
after the fashion of whales. I found out from that the mode
|
|
of ventilating the boat.
|
|
|
|
When I had inhaled this air freely, I sought the conduit pipe,
|
|
which conveyed to us the beneficial whiff, and I was not long in finding it.
|
|
Above the door was a ventilator, through which volumes of fresh air
|
|
renewed the impoverished atmosphere of the cell.
|
|
|
|
I was making my observations, when Ned and Conseil awoke almost
|
|
at the same time, under the influence of this reviving air.
|
|
They rubbed their eyes, stretched themselves, and were on their feet
|
|
in an instant.
|
|
|
|
"Did master sleep well?" asked Conseil, with his usual politeness.
|
|
|
|
"Very well, my brave boy. And you, Mr. Land?"
|
|
|
|
"Soundly, Professor. But, I don't know if I am right or not,
|
|
there seems to be a sea breeze!"
|
|
|
|
A seaman could not be mistaken, and I told the Canadian all that had passed
|
|
during his sleep.
|
|
|
|
"Good!" said he. "That accounts for those roarings we heard,
|
|
when the supposed narwhal sighted the Abraham Lincoln."
|
|
|
|
"Quite so, Master Land; it was taking breath."
|
|
|
|
"Only, Mr. Aronnax, I have no idea what o'clock it is,
|
|
unless it is dinner-time."
|
|
|
|
"Dinner-time! my good fellow? Say rather breakfast-time, for we
|
|
certainly have begun another day."
|
|
|
|
"So," said Conseil, "we have slept twenty-four hours?"
|
|
|
|
"That is my opinion."
|
|
|
|
"I will not contradict you," replied Ned Land. "But, dinner or breakfast,
|
|
the steward will be welcome, whichever he brings."
|
|
|
|
"Master Land, we must conform to the rules on board, and I suppose
|
|
our appetites are in advance of the dinner hour."
|
|
|
|
"That is just like you, friend Conseil," said Ned, impatiently.
|
|
"You are never out of temper, always calm; you would return thanks
|
|
before grace, and die of hunger rather than complain!"
|
|
|
|
Time was getting on, and we were fearfully hungry; and this
|
|
time the steward did not appear. It was rather too long
|
|
to leave us, if they really had good intentions towards us.
|
|
Ned Land, tormented by the cravings of hunger, got still
|
|
more angry; and, notwithstanding his promise, I dreaded an
|
|
explosion when he found himself with one of the crew.
|
|
|
|
For two hours more Ned Land's temper increased; he cried, he shouted,
|
|
but in vain. The walls were deaf. There was no sound to be heard
|
|
in the boat; all was still as death. It did not move, for I should have
|
|
felt the trembling motion of the hull under the influence of the screw.
|
|
Plunged in the depths of the waters, it belonged no longer to earth:
|
|
this silence was dreadful.
|
|
|
|
I felt terrified, Conseil was calm, Ned Land roared.
|
|
|
|
Just then a noise was heard outside. Steps sounded on the metal flags.
|
|
The locks were turned, the door opened, and the steward appeared.
|
|
|
|
Before I could rush forward to stop him, the Canadian had thrown him down,
|
|
and held him by the throat. The steward was choking under the grip
|
|
of his powerful hand.
|
|
|
|
Conseil was already trying to unclasp the harpooner's hand from
|
|
his half-suffocated victim, and I was going to fly to the rescue,
|
|
when suddenly I was nailed to the spot by hearing these words in French:
|
|
|
|
"Be quiet, Master Land; and you, Professor, will you be so good
|
|
as to listen to me?"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER X
|
|
|
|
THE MAN OF THE SEAS
|
|
|
|
It was the commander of the vessel who thus spoke.
|
|
|
|
At these words, Ned Land rose suddenly. The steward,
|
|
nearly strangled, tottered out on a sign from his master.
|
|
But such was the power of the commander on board, that not
|
|
a gesture betrayed the resentment which this man must have felt
|
|
towards the Canadian. Conseil interested in spite of himself,
|
|
I stupefied, awaited in silence the result of this scene.
|
|
|
|
The commander, leaning against the corner of a table with his arms folded,
|
|
scanned us with profound attention. Did he hesitate to speak?
|
|
Did he regret the words which he had just spoken in French?
|
|
One might almost think so.
|
|
|
|
After some moments of silence, which not one of us dreamed
|
|
of breaking, "Gentlemen," said he, in a calm and penetrating voice,
|
|
"I speak French, English, German, and Latin equally well.
|
|
I could, therefore, have answered you at our first interview, but I
|
|
wished to know you first, then to reflect. The story told by each one,
|
|
entirely agreeing in the main points, convinced me of your identity.
|
|
I know now that chance has brought before me M. Pierre Aronnax,
|
|
Professor of Natural History at the Museum of Paris, entrusted with
|
|
a scientific mission abroad, Conseil, his servant, and Ned Land,
|
|
of Canadian origin, harpooner on board the frigate Abraham Lincoln
|
|
of the navy of the United States of America."
|
|
|
|
I bowed assent. It was not a question that the commander put to me.
|
|
Therefore there was no answer to be made. This man expressed himself
|
|
with perfect ease, without any accent. His sentences were well turned,
|
|
his words clear, and his fluency of speech remarkable. Yet, I did not
|
|
recognise in him a fellow-countryman.
|
|
|
|
He continued the conversation in these terms:
|
|
|
|
"You have doubtless thought, sir, that I have delayed long in paying
|
|
you this second visit. The reason is that, your identity recognised,
|
|
I wished to weigh maturely what part to act towards you.
|
|
I have hesitated much. Most annoying circumstances have brought you
|
|
into the presence of a man who has broken all the ties of humanity.
|
|
You have come to trouble my existence."
|
|
|
|
"Unintentionally!" said I.
|
|
|
|
"Unintentionally?" replied the stranger, raising his voice a little.
|
|
"Was it unintentionally that the Abraham Lincoln pursued me all over
|
|
the seas? Was it unintentionally that you took passage in this frigate?
|
|
Was it unintentionally that your cannon-balls rebounded off the plating
|
|
of my vessel? Was it unintentionally that Mr. Ned Land struck me
|
|
with his harpoon?"
|
|
|
|
I detected a restrained irritation in these words.
|
|
But to these recriminations I had a very natural answer to make,
|
|
and I made it.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said I, "no doubt you are ignorant of the discussions
|
|
which have taken place concerning you in America and Europe.
|
|
You do not know that divers accidents, caused by collisions with your
|
|
submarine machine, have excited public feeling in the two continents.
|
|
I omit the theories without number by which it was sought
|
|
to explain that of which you alone possess the secret.
|
|
But you must understand that, in pursuing you over the high
|
|
seas of the Pacific, the Abraham Lincoln believed itself to be
|
|
chasing some powerful sea-monster, of which it was necessary
|
|
to rid the ocean at any price."
|
|
|
|
A half-smile curled the lips of the commander: then, in a calmer tone:
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax," he replied, "dare you affirm that your frigate
|
|
would not as soon have pursued and cannonaded a submarine boat
|
|
as a monster?"
|
|
|
|
This question embarrassed me, for certainly Captain Farragut might
|
|
not have hesitated. He might have thought it his duty to destroy
|
|
a contrivance of this kind, as he would a gigantic narwhal.
|
|
|
|
"You understand then, sir," continued the stranger, "that I
|
|
have the right to treat you as enemies?"
|
|
|
|
I answered nothing, purposely. For what good would it be to discuss
|
|
such a proposition, when force could destroy the best arguments?
|
|
|
|
"I have hesitated some time," continued the commander; "nothing obliged
|
|
me to show you hospitality. If I chose to separate myself from you,
|
|
I should have no interest in seeing you again; I could place you
|
|
upon the deck of this vessel which has served you as a refuge,
|
|
I could sink beneath the waters, and forget that you had ever existed.
|
|
Would not that be my right?"
|
|
|
|
"It might be the right of a savage," I answered, "but not
|
|
that of a civilised man."
|
|
|
|
"Professor," replied the commander, quickly, "I am not what you
|
|
call a civilised man! I have done with society entirely,
|
|
for reasons which I alone have the right of appreciating.
|
|
I do not, therefore, obey its laws, and I desire you never to allude
|
|
to them before me again!"
|
|
|
|
This was said plainly. A flash of anger and disdain kindled in the eyes of
|
|
the Unknown, and I had a glimpse of a terrible past in the life of this man.
|
|
Not only had he put himself beyond the pale of human laws, but he had made
|
|
himself independent of them, free in the strictest acceptation of the word,
|
|
quite beyond their reach! Who then would dare to pursue him at the bottom of
|
|
the sea, when, on its surface, he defied all attempts made against him?
|
|
|
|
What vessel could resist the shock of his submarine monitor?
|
|
What cuirass, however thick, could withstand the blows of his spur?
|
|
No man could demand from him an account of his actions;
|
|
God, if he believed in one--his conscience, if he had one--
|
|
were the sole judges to whom he was answerable.
|
|
|
|
These reflections crossed my mind rapidly, whilst the stranger
|
|
personage was silent, absorbed, and as if wrapped up in himself.
|
|
I regarded him with fear mingled with interest, as, doubtless,
|
|
OEdiphus regarded the Sphinx.
|
|
|
|
After rather a long silence, the commander resumed the conversation.
|
|
|
|
"I have hesitated," said he, "but I have thought that my interest might
|
|
be reconciled with that pity to which every human being has a right.
|
|
You will remain on board my vessel, since fate has cast you there.
|
|
You will be free; and, in exchange for this liberty, I shall only impose one
|
|
single condition. Your word of honour to submit to it will suffice."
|
|
|
|
"Speak, sir," I answered. "I suppose this condition is one which a man
|
|
of honour may accept?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir; it is this: It is possible that certain events,
|
|
unforeseen, may oblige me to consign you to your cabins for some hours
|
|
or some days, as the case may be. As I desire never to use violence,
|
|
I expect from you, more than all the others, a passive obedience.
|
|
In thus acting, I take all the responsibility: I acquit you entirely,
|
|
for I make it an impossibility for you to see what ought not to be seen.
|
|
Do you accept this condition?"
|
|
|
|
Then things took place on board which, to say the least,
|
|
were singular, and which ought not to be seen by people
|
|
who were not placed beyond the pale of social laws.
|
|
Amongst the surprises which the future was preparing for me,
|
|
this might not be the least.
|
|
|
|
"We accept," I answered; "only I will ask your permission, sir, to address
|
|
one question to you--one only."
|
|
|
|
"Speak, sir."
|
|
|
|
"You said that we should be free on board."
|
|
|
|
"Entirely."
|
|
|
|
"I ask you, then, what you mean by this liberty?"
|
|
|
|
"Just the liberty to go, to come, to see, to observe even all
|
|
that passes here save under rare circumstances--the liberty,
|
|
in short, which we enjoy ourselves, my companions and I."
|
|
|
|
It was evident that we did not understand one another.
|
|
|
|
"Pardon me, sir," I resumed, "but this liberty is only what every
|
|
prisoner has of pacing his prison. It cannot suffice us."
|
|
|
|
"It must suffice you, however."
|
|
|
|
"What! we must renounce for ever seeing our country, our friends,
|
|
our relations again?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir. But to renounce that unendurable worldly yoke which men
|
|
believe to be liberty is not perhaps so painful as you think."
|
|
|
|
"Well," exclaimed Ned Land, "never will I give my word of honour
|
|
not to try to escape."
|
|
|
|
"I did not ask you for your word of honour, Master Land,"
|
|
answered the commander, coldly.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," I replied, beginning to get angry in spite of my self,
|
|
"you abuse your situation towards us; it is cruelty."
|
|
|
|
"No, sir, it is clemency. You are my prisoners of war. I keep you,
|
|
when I could, by a word, plunge you into the depths of the ocean.
|
|
You attacked me. You came to surprise a secret which no man
|
|
in the world must penetrate--the secret of my whole existence.
|
|
And you think that I am going to send you back to that world which must
|
|
know me no more? Never! In retaining you, it is not you whom I guard--
|
|
it is myself."
|
|
|
|
These words indicated a resolution taken on the part of the commander,
|
|
against which no arguments would prevail.
|
|
|
|
"So, sir," I rejoined, "you give us simply the choice between life and death?"
|
|
|
|
"Simply."
|
|
|
|
"My friends," said I, "to a question thus put, there is nothing to answer.
|
|
But no word of honour binds us to the master of this vessel."
|
|
|
|
"None, sir," answered the Unknown.
|
|
|
|
Then, in a gentler tone, he continued:
|
|
|
|
"Now, permit me to finish what I have to say to you. I know you,
|
|
M. Aronnax. You and your companions will not, perhaps, have so much
|
|
to complain of in the chance which has bound you to my fate.
|
|
You will find amongst the books which are my favourite study the work
|
|
which you have published on `the depths of the sea.' I have often read it.
|
|
You have carried out your work as far as terrestrial science permitted you.
|
|
But you do not know all--you have not seen all. Let me tell you then,
|
|
Professor, that you will not regret the time passed on board my vessel.
|
|
You are going to visit the land of marvels."
|
|
|
|
These words of the commander had a great effect upon me. I cannot deny it.
|
|
My weak point was touched; and I forgot, for a moment, that the contemplation
|
|
of these sublime subjects was not worth the loss of liberty.
|
|
Besides, I trusted to the future to decide this grave question.
|
|
So I contented myself with saying:
|
|
|
|
"By what name ought I to address you?"
|
|
|
|
"Sir," replied the commander, "I am nothing to you but Captain Nemo;
|
|
and you and your companions are nothing to me but the passengers
|
|
of the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo called. A steward appeared. The captain gave him
|
|
his orders in that strange language which I did not understand.
|
|
Then, turning towards the Canadian and Conseil:
|
|
|
|
"A repast awaits you in your cabin," said he. "Be so good
|
|
as to follow this man.
|
|
|
|
"And now, M. Aronnax, our breakfast is ready. Permit me to lead the way."
|
|
|
|
"I am at your service, Captain."
|
|
|
|
I followed Captain Nemo; and as soon as I had passed through the door,
|
|
I found myself in a kind of passage lighted by electricity,
|
|
similar to the waist of a ship. After we had proceeded a dozen yards,
|
|
a second door opened before me.
|
|
|
|
I then entered a dining-room, decorated and furnished
|
|
in severe taste. High oaken sideboards, inlaid with ebony,
|
|
stood at the two extremities of the room, and upon their shelves
|
|
glittered china, porcelain, and glass of inestimable value.
|
|
The plate on the table sparkled in the rays which the luminous
|
|
ceiling shed around, while the light was tempered and softened
|
|
by exquisite paintings.
|
|
|
|
In the centre of the room was a table richly laid out.
|
|
Captain Nemo indicated the place I was to occupy.
|
|
|
|
The breakfast consisted of a certain number of dishes,
|
|
the contents of which were furnished by the sea alone;
|
|
and I was ignorant of the nature and mode of preparation
|
|
of some of them. I acknowledged that they were good, but they
|
|
had a peculiar flavour, which I easily became accustomed to.
|
|
These different aliments appeared to me to be rich in phosphorus,
|
|
and I thought they must have a marine origin.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo looked at me. I asked him no questions, but he guessed
|
|
my thoughts, and answered of his own accord the questions which I
|
|
was burning to address to him.
|
|
|
|
"The greater part of these dishes are unknown to you,"
|
|
he said to me. "However, you may partake of them without fear.
|
|
They are wholesome and nourishing. For a long time I have
|
|
renounced the food of the earth, and I am never ill now.
|
|
My crew, who are healthy, are fed on the same food."
|
|
|
|
"So," said I, "all these eatables are the produce of the sea?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Professor, the sea supplies all my wants. Sometimes I cast
|
|
my nets in tow, and I draw them in ready to break. Sometimes I
|
|
hunt in the midst of this element, which appears to be inaccessible
|
|
to man, and quarry the game which dwells in my submarine forests.
|
|
My flocks, like those of Neptune's old shepherds, graze fearlessly
|
|
in the immense prairies of the ocean. I have a vast property there,
|
|
which I cultivate myself, and which is always sown by the hand
|
|
of the Creator of all things."
|
|
|
|
"I can understand perfectly, sir, that your nets furnish excellent fish
|
|
for your table; I can understand also that you hunt aquatic game in your
|
|
submarine forests; but I cannot understand at all how a particle of meat,
|
|
no matter how small, can figure in your bill of fare."
|
|
|
|
"This, which you believe to be meat, Professor, is nothing else than
|
|
fillet of turtle. Here are also some dolphins' livers, which you
|
|
take to be ragout of pork. My cook is a clever fellow,
|
|
who excels in dressing these various products of the ocean.
|
|
Taste all these dishes. Here is a preserve of sea-cucumber,
|
|
which a Malay would declare to be unrivalled in the world;
|
|
here is a cream, of which the milk has been furnished by
|
|
the cetacea, and the sugar by the great fucus of the North Sea;
|
|
and, lastly, permit me to offer you some preserve of anemones,
|
|
which is equal to that of the most delicious fruits."
|
|
|
|
I tasted, more from curiosity than as a connoisseur, whilst Captain
|
|
Nemo enchanted me with his extraordinary stories.
|
|
|
|
"You like the sea, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes; I love it! The sea is everything. It covers seven tenths
|
|
of the terrestrial globe. Its breath is pure and healthy.
|
|
It is an immense desert, where man is never lonely,
|
|
for he feels life stirring on all sides. The sea is only
|
|
the embodiment of a supernatural and wonderful existence.
|
|
It is nothing but love and emotion; it is the `Living Infinite,'
|
|
as one of your poets has said. In fact, Professor, Nature manifests
|
|
herself in it by her three kingdoms--mineral, vegetable, and animal.
|
|
The sea is the vast reservoir of Nature. The globe began with sea,
|
|
so to speak; and who knows if it will not end with it?
|
|
In it is supreme tranquillity. The sea does not belong to despots.
|
|
Upon its surface men can still exercise unjust laws, fight, tear one
|
|
another to pieces, and be carried away with terrestrial horrors.
|
|
But at thirty feet below its level, their reign ceases,
|
|
their influence is quenched, and their power disappears.
|
|
Ah! sir, live--live in the bosom of the waters!
|
|
There only is independence! There I recognise no masters!
|
|
There I am free!"
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo suddenly became silent in the midst of
|
|
this enthusiasm, by which he was quite carried away.
|
|
For a few moments he paced up and down, much agitated.
|
|
Then he became more calm, regained his accustomed coldness
|
|
of expression, and turning towards me:
|
|
|
|
"Now, Professor," said he, "if you wish to go over the Nautilus,
|
|
I am at your service."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo rose. I followed him. A double door, contrived at the back
|
|
of the dining-room, opened, and I entered a room equal in dimensions
|
|
to that which I had just quitted.
|
|
|
|
It was a library. High pieces of furniture, of black violet
|
|
ebony inlaid with brass, supported upon their wide shelves
|
|
a great number of books uniformly bound. They followed the shape
|
|
of the room, terminating at the lower part in huge divans,
|
|
covered with brown leather, which were curved, to afford
|
|
the greatest comfort. Light movable desks, made to slide in
|
|
and out at will, allowed one to rest one's book while reading.
|
|
In the centre stood an immense table, covered with pamphlets,
|
|
amongst which were some newspapers, already of old date.
|
|
The electric light flooded everything; it was shed from four
|
|
unpolished globes half sunk in the volutes of the ceiling.
|
|
I looked with real admiration at this room, so ingeniously fitted up,
|
|
and I could scarcely believe my eyes.
|
|
|
|
"Captain Nemo," said I to my host, who had just thrown himself
|
|
on one of the divans, "this is a library which would do honour
|
|
to more than one of the continental palaces, and I am absolutely
|
|
astounded when I consider that it can follow you to the bottom
|
|
of the seas."
|
|
|
|
"Where could one find greater solitude or silence, Professor?"
|
|
replied Captain Nemo. "Did your study in the Museum afford you
|
|
such perfect quiet?"
|
|
|
|
"No, sir; and I must confess that it is a very poor one after yours.
|
|
You must have six or seven thousand volumes here."
|
|
|
|
"Twelve thousand, M. Aronnax. These are the only ties which bind
|
|
me to the earth. But I had done with the world on the day
|
|
when my Nautilus plunged for the first time beneath the waters.
|
|
That day I bought my last volumes, my last pamphlets, my last papers,
|
|
and from that time I wish to think that men no longer think or write.
|
|
These books, Professor, are at your service besides, and you can make use
|
|
of them freely."
|
|
|
|
I thanked Captain Nemo, and went up to the shelves of the library.
|
|
Works on science, morals, and literature abounded in every language;
|
|
but I did not see one single work on political economy; that subject
|
|
appeared to be strictly proscribed. Strange to say, all these books
|
|
were irregularly arranged, in whatever language they were written;
|
|
and this medley proved that the Captain of the Nautilus must have read
|
|
indiscriminately the books which he took up by chance.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said I to the Captain, "I thank you for having placed
|
|
this library at my disposal. It contains treasures of science,
|
|
and I shall profit by them."
|
|
|
|
"This room is not only a library," said Captain Nemo,
|
|
"it is also a smoking-room."
|
|
|
|
"A smoking-room!" I cried. "Then one may smoke on board?"
|
|
|
|
"Certainly."
|
|
|
|
"Then, sir, I am forced to believe that you have kept up
|
|
a communication with Havannah."
|
|
|
|
"Not any," answered the Captain. "Accept this cigar,
|
|
M. Aronnax; and, though it does not come from Havannah,
|
|
you will be pleased with it, if you are a connoisseur."
|
|
|
|
I took the cigar which was offered me; its shape recalled
|
|
the London ones, but it seemed to be made of leaves of gold.
|
|
I lighted it at a little brazier, which was supported upon an
|
|
elegant bronze stem, and drew the first whiffs with the delight
|
|
of a lover of smoking who has not smoked for two days.
|
|
|
|
"It is excellent, but it is not tobacco."
|
|
|
|
"No!" answered the Captain, "this tobacco comes neither from Havannah
|
|
nor from the East. It is a kind of sea-weed, rich in nicotine,
|
|
with which the sea provides me, but somewhat sparingly."
|
|
|
|
At that moment Captain Nemo opened a door which stood opposite
|
|
to that by which I had entered the library, and I passed into
|
|
an immense drawing-room splendidly lighted.
|
|
|
|
It was a vast, four-sided room, thirty feet long, eighteen wide,
|
|
and fifteen high. A luminous ceiling, decorated with light arabesques,
|
|
shed a soft clear light over all the marvels accumulated in this museum.
|
|
For it was in fact a museum, in which an intelligent and prodigal hand
|
|
had gathered all the treasures of nature and art, with the artistic
|
|
confusion which distinguishes a painter's studio.
|
|
|
|
{several sentences are missing here in the omnibus edition}
|
|
|
|
Thirty first-rate pictures, uniformly framed, separated by bright drapery,
|
|
ornamented the walls, which were hung with tapestry of severe design.
|
|
I saw works of great value, the greater part of which I had admired in the
|
|
special collections of Europe, and in the exhibitions of paintings.
|
|
|
|
Some admirable statues in marble and bronze, after the finest antique models,
|
|
stood upon pedestals in the corners of this magnificent museum.
|
|
Amazement, as the Captain of the Nautilus had predicted, had already
|
|
begun to take possession of me.
|
|
|
|
"Professor," said this strange man, "you must excuse the unceremonious
|
|
way in which I receive you, and the disorder of this room."
|
|
|
|
"Sir," I answered, "without seeking to know who you are,
|
|
I recognise in you an artist."
|
|
|
|
"An amateur, nothing more, sir. Formerly I loved to collect
|
|
these beautiful works created by the hand of man.
|
|
I sought them greedily, and ferreted them out indefatigably,
|
|
and I have been able to bring together some objects of great value.
|
|
These are my last souvenirs of that world which is dead to me.
|
|
In my eyes, your modern artists are already old; they have two or
|
|
three thousand years of existence; I confound them in my own mind.
|
|
Masters have no age."
|
|
|
|
{4 paragraphs seem to be missing from this omnibus text here they
|
|
have to do with musical composers, a piano, and a brief revery
|
|
on the part of Nemo}
|
|
|
|
Under elegant glass cases, fixed by copper rivets, were classed
|
|
and labelled the most precious productions of the sea
|
|
which had ever been presented to the eye of a naturalist.
|
|
My delight as a professor may be conceived.
|
|
|
|
{2 long paragraphs seem to be missing from this omnibus here}
|
|
|
|
Apart, in separate compartments, were spread out chaplets of pearls
|
|
of the greatest beauty, which reflected the electric light in little
|
|
sparks of fire; pink pearls, torn from the pinna-marina of the Red Sea;
|
|
green pearls, yellow, blue, and black pearls, the curious productions
|
|
of the divers molluscs of every ocean, and certain mussels of the water
|
|
courses of the North; lastly, several specimens of inestimable value.
|
|
Some of these pearls were larger than a pigeon's egg, and were worth millions.
|
|
|
|
{this para has been altered the last sentence reworded}
|
|
|
|
Therefore, to estimate the value of this collection was simply impossible.
|
|
Captain Nemo must have expended millions in the acquirement of these
|
|
various specimens, and I was thinking what source he could have drawn from,
|
|
to have been able thus to gratify his fancy for collecting, when I was
|
|
interrupted by these words:
|
|
|
|
"You are examining my shells, Professor? Unquestionably they must be
|
|
interesting to a naturalist; but for me they have a far greater charm,
|
|
for I have collected them all with my own hand, and there is not a sea
|
|
on the face of the globe which has escaped my researches."
|
|
|
|
"I can understand, Captain, the delight of wandering about in the midst
|
|
of such riches. You are one of those who have collected their
|
|
treasures themselves. No museum in Europe possesses such a collection
|
|
of the produce of the ocean. But if I exhaust all my admiration
|
|
upon it, I shall have none left for the vessel which carries it.
|
|
I do not wish to pry into your secrets: but I must confess
|
|
that this Nautilus, with the motive power which is confined in it,
|
|
the contrivances which enable it to be worked, the powerful agent
|
|
which propels it, all excite my curiosity to the highest pitch.
|
|
I see suspended on the walls of this room instruments of whose use
|
|
I am ignorant."
|
|
|
|
"You will find these same instruments in my own room, Professor,
|
|
where I shall have much pleasure in explaining their use to you.
|
|
But first come and inspect the cabin which is set apart for your own use.
|
|
You must see how you will be accommodated on board the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
I followed Captain Nemo who, by one of the doors opening
|
|
from each panel of the drawing-room, regained the waist.
|
|
He conducted me towards the bow, and there I found, not a cabin,
|
|
but an elegant room, with a bed, dressing-table, and several other
|
|
pieces of excellent furniture.
|
|
|
|
I could only thank my host.
|
|
|
|
"Your room adjoins mine," said he, opening a door, "and mine
|
|
opens into the drawing-room that we have just quitted."
|
|
|
|
I entered the Captain's room: it had a severe, almost a monkish aspect.
|
|
A small iron bedstead, a table, some articles for the toilet; the whole
|
|
lighted by a skylight. No comforts, the strictest necessaries only.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo pointed to a seat.
|
|
|
|
"Be so good as to sit down," he said. I seated myself,
|
|
and he began thus:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XI
|
|
|
|
ALL BY ELECTRICITY
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said Captain Nemo, showing me the instruments hanging on the walls
|
|
of his room, "here are the contrivances required for the navigation of
|
|
the Nautilus. Here, as in the drawing-room, I have them always under my eyes,
|
|
and they indicate my position and exact direction in the middle of the ocean.
|
|
Some are known to you, such as the thermometer, which gives the internal
|
|
temperature of the Nautilus; the barometer, which indicates the weight
|
|
of the air and foretells the changes of the weather; the hygrometer,
|
|
which marks the dryness of the atmosphere; the storm-glass, the contents
|
|
of which, by decomposing, announce the approach of tempests; the compass,
|
|
which guides my course; the sextant, which shows the latitude by the altitude
|
|
of the sun; chronometers, by which I calculate the longitude; and glasses
|
|
for day and night, which I use to examine the points of the horizon,
|
|
when the Nautilus rises to the surface of the waves."
|
|
|
|
"These are the usual nautical instruments," I replied,
|
|
"and I know the use of them. But these others, no doubt,
|
|
answer to the particular requirements of the Nautilus.
|
|
This dial with movable needle is a manometer, is it not?"
|
|
|
|
"It is actually a manometer. But by communication with the water,
|
|
whose external pressure it indicates, it gives our depth at the same time."
|
|
|
|
"And these other instruments, the use of which I cannot guess?"
|
|
|
|
"Here, Professor, I ought to give you some explanations.
|
|
Will you be kind enough to listen to me?"
|
|
|
|
He was silent for a few moments, then he said:
|
|
|
|
"There is a powerful agent, obedient, rapid, easy, which conforms to
|
|
every use, and reigns supreme on board my vessel. Everything is done by means
|
|
of it. It lights, warms it, and is the soul of my mechanical apparatus.
|
|
This agent is electricity."
|
|
|
|
"Electricity?" I cried in surprise.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir."
|
|
|
|
"Nevertheless, Captain, you possess an extreme rapidity of movement,
|
|
which does not agree well with the power of electricity.
|
|
Until now, its dynamic force has remained under restraint, and has
|
|
only been able to produce a small amount of power."
|
|
|
|
"Professor," said Captain Nemo, "my electricity is not everybody's.
|
|
You know what sea-water is composed of. In a thousand grammes
|
|
are found 96 1/2 per cent. of water, and about 2 2/3 per cent.
|
|
of chloride of sodium; then, in a smaller quantity, chlorides of
|
|
magnesium and of potassium, bromide of magnesium, sulphate of magnesia,
|
|
sulphate and carbonate of lime. You see, then, that chloride
|
|
of sodium forms a large part of it. So it is this sodium that I
|
|
extract from the sea-water, and of which I compose my ingredients.
|
|
I owe all to the ocean; it produces electricity, and electricity
|
|
gives heat, light, motion, and, in a word, life to the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"But not the air you breathe?"
|
|
|
|
"Oh! I could manufacture the air necessary for my consumption, but it
|
|
is useless, because I go up to the surface of the water when I please.
|
|
However, if electricity does not furnish me with air to breathe, it works
|
|
at least the powerful pumps that are stored in spacious reservoirs,
|
|
and which enable me to prolong at need, and as long as I will, my stay
|
|
in the depths of the sea. It gives a uniform and unintermittent light,
|
|
which the sun does not. Now look at this clock; it is electrical,
|
|
and goes with a regularity that defies the best chronometers.
|
|
I have divided it into twenty-four hours, like the Italian clocks,
|
|
because for me there is neither night nor day, sun nor moon, but only
|
|
that factitious light that I take with me to the bottom of the sea.
|
|
Look! just now, it is ten o'clock in the morning."
|
|
|
|
"Exactly."
|
|
|
|
"Another application of electricity. This dial hanging in front of us
|
|
indicates the speed of the Nautilus. An electric thread puts it in
|
|
communication with the screw, and the needle indicates the real speed.
|
|
Look! now we are spinning along with a uniform speed of fifteen
|
|
miles an hour."
|
|
|
|
"It is marvelous! And I see, Captain, you were right to make use
|
|
of this agent that takes the place of wind, water, and steam."
|
|
|
|
"We have not finished, M. Aronnax," said Captain Nemo, rising.
|
|
"If you will allow me, we will examine the stern of the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
Really, I knew already the anterior part of this submarine boat,
|
|
of which this is the exact division, starting from the ship's head:
|
|
the dining-room, five yards long, separated from the library
|
|
by a water-tight partition; the library, five yards long;
|
|
the large drawing-room, ten yards long, separated from the Captain's
|
|
room by a second water-tight partition; the said room, five yards
|
|
in length; mine, two and a half yards; and, lastly a reservoir
|
|
of air, seven and a half yards, that extended to the bows.
|
|
Total length thirty five yards, or one hundred and five feet.
|
|
The partitions had doors that were shut hermetically by means of
|
|
india-rubber instruments, and they ensured the safety of the Nautilus
|
|
in case of a leak.
|
|
|
|
I followed Captain Nemo through the waist, and arrived at the centre
|
|
of the boat. There was a sort of well that opened between two partitions.
|
|
An iron ladder, fastened with an iron hook to the partition, led to
|
|
the upper end. I asked the Captain what the ladder was used for.
|
|
|
|
"It leads to the small boat," he said.
|
|
|
|
"What! have you a boat?" I exclaimed, in surprise.
|
|
|
|
"Of course; an excellent vessel, light and insubmersible,
|
|
that serves either as a fishing or as a pleasure boat."
|
|
|
|
"But then, when you wish to embark, you are obliged to come to the surface
|
|
of the water?"
|
|
|
|
"Not at all. This boat is attached to the upper part of
|
|
the hull of the Nautilus, and occupies a cavity made for it.
|
|
It is decked, quite water-tight, and held together by solid bolts.
|
|
This ladder leads to a man-hole made in the hull of the Nautilus,
|
|
that corresponds with a similar hole made in the side of the boat.
|
|
By this double opening I get into the small vessel. They shut the one
|
|
belonging to the Nautilus; I shut the other by means of screw pressure.
|
|
I undo the bolts, and the little boat goes up to the surface of the sea
|
|
with prodigious rapidity. I then open the panel of the bridge,
|
|
carefully shut till then; I mast it, hoist my sail, take my oars,
|
|
and I'm off."
|
|
|
|
"But how do you get back on board?"
|
|
|
|
"I do not come back, M. Aronnax; the Nautilus comes to me."
|
|
|
|
"By your orders?"
|
|
|
|
"By my orders. An electric thread connects us. I telegraph to it,
|
|
and that is enough."
|
|
|
|
"Really," I said, astonished at these marvels, "nothing can
|
|
be more simple."
|
|
|
|
After having passed by the cage of the staircase that led to the platform,
|
|
I saw a cabin six feet long, in which Conseil and Ned Land,
|
|
enchanted with their repast, were devouring it with avidity.
|
|
Then a door opened into a kitchen nine feet long, situated between
|
|
the large store-rooms. There electricity, better than gas itself,
|
|
did all the cooking. The streams under the furnaces gave out to the
|
|
sponges of platina a heat which was regularly kept up and distributed.
|
|
They also heated a distilling apparatus, which, by evaporation,
|
|
furnished excellent drinkable water. Near this kitchen was a bathroom
|
|
comfortably furnished, with hot and cold water taps.
|
|
|
|
Next to the kitchen was the berth-room of the vessel, sixteen feet long.
|
|
But the door was shut, and I could not see the management of it,
|
|
which might have given me an idea of the number of men employed on
|
|
board the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
At the bottom was a fourth partition that separated this
|
|
office from the engine-room. A door opened, and I found myself
|
|
in the compartment where Captain Nemo--certainly an engineer
|
|
of a very high order--had arranged his locomotive machinery.
|
|
This engine-room, clearly lighted, did not measure less than
|
|
sixty-five feet in length. It was divided into two parts;
|
|
the first contained the materials for producing electricity,
|
|
and the second the machinery that connected it with the screw.
|
|
I examined it with great interest, in order to understand the
|
|
machinery of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
"You see," said the Captain, "I use Bunsen's contrivances,
|
|
not Ruhmkorff's. Those would not have been powerful enough.
|
|
Bunsen's are fewer in number, but strong and large, which experience
|
|
proves to be the best. The electricity produced passes forward,
|
|
where it works, by electro-magnets of great size, on a system of levers
|
|
and cog-wheels that transmit the movement to the axle of the screw.
|
|
This one, the diameter of which is nineteen feet, and the thread
|
|
twenty-three feet, performs about 120 revolutions in a second."
|
|
|
|
"And you get then?"
|
|
|
|
"A speed of fifty miles an hour."
|
|
|
|
"I have seen the Nautilus manoeuvre before the Abraham Lincoln,
|
|
and I have my own ideas as to its speed. But this is not enough.
|
|
We must see where we go. We must be able to direct it to the right,
|
|
to the left, above, below. How do you get to the great depths,
|
|
where you find an increasing resistance, which is rated by hundreds
|
|
of atmospheres? How do you return to the surface of the ocean?
|
|
And how do you maintain yourselves in the requisite medium?
|
|
Am I asking too much?"
|
|
|
|
"Not at all, Professor," replied the Captain, with some hesitation;
|
|
"since you may never leave this submarine boat. Come into the saloon,
|
|
it is our usual study, and there you will learn all you want to know
|
|
about the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XII
|
|
|
|
SOME FIGURES
|
|
|
|
A moment after we were seated on a divan in the saloon smoking.
|
|
The Captain showed me a sketch that gave the plan, section, and elevation
|
|
of the Nautilus. Then he began his description in these words:
|
|
|
|
"Here, M. Aronnax, are the several dimensions of the boat
|
|
you are in. It is an elongated cylinder with conical ends.
|
|
It is very like a cigar in shape, a shape already adopted
|
|
in London in several constructions of the same sort.
|
|
The length of this cylinder, from stem to stern, is exactly
|
|
232 feet, and its maximum breadth is twenty-six feet.
|
|
It is not built quite like your long-voyage steamers,
|
|
but its lines are sufficiently long, and its curves
|
|
prolonged enough, to allow the water to slide off easily,
|
|
and oppose no obstacle to its passage. These two dimensions
|
|
enable you to obtain by a simple calculation the surface and
|
|
cubic contents of the Nautilus. Its area measures 6,032 feet;
|
|
and its contents about 1,500 cubic yards; that is to say,
|
|
when completely immersed it displaces 50,000 feet of water,
|
|
or weighs 1,500 tons.
|
|
|
|
"When I made the plans for this submarine vessel, I meant that nine-tenths
|
|
should be submerged: consequently it ought only to displace nine-tenths
|
|
of its bulk, that is to say, only to weigh that number of tons.
|
|
I ought not, therefore, to have exceeded that weight, constructing it on
|
|
the aforesaid dimensions.
|
|
|
|
"The Nautilus is composed of two hulls, one inside, the other outside,
|
|
joined by T-shaped irons, which render it very strong. Indeed, owing to
|
|
this cellular arrangement it resists like a block, as if it were solid.
|
|
Its sides cannot yield; it coheres spontaneously, and not by the closeness
|
|
of its rivets; and its perfect union of the materials enables it to defy
|
|
the roughest seas.
|
|
|
|
"These two hulls are composed of steel plates, whose density is
|
|
from .7 to .8 that of water. The first is not less than two inches
|
|
and a half thick and weighs 394 tons. The second envelope, the keel,
|
|
twenty inches high and ten thick, weighs only sixty-two tons.
|
|
The engine, the ballast, the several accessories and apparatus
|
|
appendages, the partitions and bulkheads, weigh 961.62 tons.
|
|
Do you follow all this?"
|
|
|
|
"I do."
|
|
|
|
"Then, when the Nautilus is afloat under these circumstances,
|
|
one-tenth is out of the water. Now, if I have made reservoirs
|
|
of a size equal to this tenth, or capable of holding 150 tons,
|
|
and if I fill them with water, the boat, weighing then 1,507 tons,
|
|
will be completely immersed. That would happen, Professor.
|
|
These reservoirs are in the lower part of the Nautilus.
|
|
I turn on taps and they fill, and the vessel sinks that had just
|
|
been level with the surface."
|
|
|
|
"Well, Captain, but now we come to the real difficulty.
|
|
I can understand your rising to the surface; but, diving below
|
|
the surface, does not your submarine contrivance encounter a pressure,
|
|
and consequently undergo an upward thrust of one atmosphere
|
|
for every thirty feet of water, just about fifteen pounds
|
|
per square inch?"
|
|
|
|
"Just so, sir."
|
|
|
|
"Then, unless you quite fill the Nautilus, I do not see how you
|
|
can draw it down to those depths."
|
|
|
|
"Professor, you must not confound statics with dynamics or you will be
|
|
exposed to grave errors. There is very little labour spent in attaining
|
|
the lower regions of the ocean, for all bodies have a tendency to sink.
|
|
When I wanted to find out the necessary increase of weight required
|
|
to sink the Nautilus, I had only to calculate the reduction of volume
|
|
that sea-water acquires according to the depth."
|
|
|
|
"That is evident."
|
|
|
|
"Now, if water is not absolutely incompressible, it is at least capable
|
|
of very slight compression. Indeed, after the most recent calculations this
|
|
reduction is only .000436 of an atmosphere for each thirty feet of depth.
|
|
If we want to sink 3,000 feet, I should keep account of the reduction of bulk
|
|
under a pressure equal to that of a column of water of a thousand feet.
|
|
The calculation is easily verified. Now, I have supplementary
|
|
reservoirs capable of holding a hundred tons. Therefore I can sink
|
|
to a considerable depth. When I wish to rise to the level of the sea,
|
|
I only let off the water, and empty all the reservoirs if I want the Nautilus
|
|
to emerge from the tenth part of her total capacity."
|
|
|
|
I had nothing to object to these reasonings.
|
|
|
|
"I admit your calculations, Captain," I replied; "I should be
|
|
wrong to dispute them since daily experience confirms them;
|
|
but I foresee a real difficulty in the way."
|
|
|
|
"What, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"When you are about 1,000 feet deep, the walls of the Nautilus
|
|
bear a pressure of 100 atmospheres. If, then, just now you were
|
|
to empty the supplementary reservoirs, to lighten the vessel,
|
|
and to go up to the surface, the pumps must overcome the pressure
|
|
of 100 atmospheres, which is 1,500 lbs. per square inch.
|
|
From that a power----"
|
|
|
|
"That electricity alone can give," said the Captain, hastily.
|
|
"I repeat, sir, that the dynamic power of my engines is almost infinite.
|
|
The pumps of the Nautilus have an enormous power, as you must have observed
|
|
when their jets of water burst like a torrent upon the Abraham Lincoln.
|
|
Besides, I use subsidiary reservoirs only to attain a mean depth of 750
|
|
to 1,000 fathoms, and that with a view of managing my machines.
|
|
Also, when I have a mind to visit the depths of the ocean five or six mlles
|
|
below the surface, I make use of slower but not less infallible means."
|
|
|
|
"What are they, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"That involves my telling you how the Nautilus is worked."
|
|
|
|
"I am impatient to learn."
|
|
|
|
"To steer this boat to starboard or port, to turn, in a word,
|
|
following a horizontal plan, I use an ordinary rudder fixed on the back
|
|
of the stern-post, and with one wheel and some tackle to steer by.
|
|
But I can also make the Nautilus rise and sink, and sink and rise,
|
|
by a vertical movement by means of two inclined planes fastened to its sides,
|
|
opposite the centre of flotation, planes that move in every direction,
|
|
and that are worked by powerful levers from the interior.
|
|
If the planes are kept parallel with the boat, it moves horizontally.
|
|
If slanted, the Nautilus, according to this inclination, and under
|
|
the influence of the screw, either sinks diagonally or rises diagonally
|
|
as it suits me. And even if I wish to rise more quickly to the surface,
|
|
I ship the screw, and the pressure of the water causes the Nautilus
|
|
to rise vertically like a balloon filled with hydrogen."
|
|
|
|
"Bravo, Captain! But how can the steersman follow the route
|
|
in the middle of the waters?"
|
|
|
|
"The steersman is placed in a glazed box, that is raised about the hull
|
|
of the Nautilus, and furnished with lenses."
|
|
|
|
"Are these lenses capable of resisting such pressure?"
|
|
|
|
"Perfectly. Glass, which breaks at a blow, is, nevertheless, capable of
|
|
offering considerable resistance. During some experiments of fishing
|
|
by electric light in 1864 in the Northern Seas, we saw plates less
|
|
than a third of an inch thick resist a pressure of sixteen atmospheres.
|
|
Now, the glass that I use is not less than thirty times thicker."
|
|
|
|
"Granted. But, after all, in order to see, the light must exceed
|
|
the darkness, and in the midst of the darkness in the water,
|
|
how can you see?"
|
|
|
|
"Behind the steersman's cage is placed a powerful electric reflector,
|
|
the rays from which light up the sea for half a mile in front."
|
|
|
|
"Ah! bravo, bravo, Captain! Now I can account for this
|
|
phosphorescence in the supposed narwhal that puzzled us so.
|
|
I now ask you if the boarding of the Nautilus and of the Scotia,
|
|
that has made such a noise, has been the result of a chance rencontre?"
|
|
|
|
"Quite accidental, sir. I was sailing only one fathom
|
|
below the surface of the water when the shock came.
|
|
It had no bad result."
|
|
|
|
"None, sir. But now, about your rencontre with the Abraham Lincoln?"
|
|
|
|
"Professor, I am sorry for one of the best vessels in the American navy;
|
|
but they attacked me, and I was bound to defend myself.
|
|
I contented myself, however, with putting the frigate hors de combat;
|
|
she will not have any difficulty in getting repaired at the next port."
|
|
|
|
"Ah, Commander! your Nautilus is certainly a marvellous boat."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Professor; and I love it as if it were part of myself.
|
|
If danger threatens one of your vessels on the ocean,
|
|
the first impression is the feeling of an abyss above and below.
|
|
On the Nautilus men's hearts never fail them. No defects
|
|
to be afraid of, for the double shell is as firm as iron;
|
|
no rigging to attend to; no sails for the wind to carry away;
|
|
no boilers to burst; no fire to fear, for the vessel is made
|
|
of iron, not of wood; no coal to run short, for electricity
|
|
is the only mechanical agent; no collision to fear, for it
|
|
alone swims in deep water; no tempest to brave, for when it
|
|
dives below the water it reaches absolute tranquillity.
|
|
There, sir! that is the perfection of vessels! And if it is true
|
|
that the engineer has more confidence in the vessel than the builder,
|
|
and the builder than the captain himself, you understand
|
|
the trust I repose in my Nautilus; for I am at once captain,
|
|
builder, and engineer."
|
|
|
|
"But how could you construct this wonderful Nautilus in secret?"
|
|
|
|
"Each separate portion, M. Aronnax, was brought from different
|
|
parts of the globe."
|
|
|
|
"But these parts had to be put together and arranged?"
|
|
|
|
"Professor, I had set up my workshops upon a desert island in the ocean.
|
|
There my workmen, that is to say, the brave men that I instructed
|
|
and educated, and myself have put together our Nautilus. Then, when the work
|
|
was finished, fire destroyed all trace of our proceedings on this island,
|
|
that I could have jumped over if I had liked."
|
|
|
|
"Then the cost of this vessel is great?"
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax, an iron vessel costs L145 per ton. Now the Nautilus weighed
|
|
1,500. It came therefore to L67,500, and L80,000 more for fitting it up,
|
|
and about L200,000, with the works of art and the collections it contains."
|
|
|
|
"One last question, Captain Nemo."
|
|
|
|
"Ask it, Professor."
|
|
|
|
"You are rich?"
|
|
|
|
"Immensely rich, sir; and I could, without missing it,
|
|
pay the national debt of France."
|
|
|
|
I stared at the singular person who spoke thus. Was he playing
|
|
upon my credulity? The future would decide that.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XIII
|
|
|
|
THE BLACK RIVER
|
|
|
|
The portion of the terrestrial globe which is covered by
|
|
water is estimated at upwards of eighty millions of acres.
|
|
This fluid mass comprises two billions two hundred and fifty
|
|
millions of cubic miles, forming a spherical body of a diameter
|
|
of sixty leagues, the weight of which would be three quintillions
|
|
of tons. To comprehend the meaning of these figures,
|
|
it is necessary to observe that a quintillion is to a billion
|
|
as a billion is to unity; in other words, there are as many
|
|
billions in a quintillion as there are units in a billion.
|
|
This mass of fluid is equal to about the quantity of water
|
|
which would be discharged by all the rivers of the earth in
|
|
forty thousand years.
|
|
|
|
During the geological epochs the ocean originally prevailed everywhere.
|
|
Then by degrees, in the silurian period, the tops of the mountains began
|
|
to appear, the islands emerged, then disappeared in partial deluges,
|
|
reappeared, became settled, formed continents, till at length the earth
|
|
became geographically arranged, as we see in the present day.
|
|
The solid had wrested from the liquid thirty-seven million six hundred
|
|
and fifty-seven square miles, equal to twelve billions nine hundred
|
|
and sixty millions of acres.
|
|
|
|
The shape of continents allows us to divide the waters into five
|
|
great portions: the Arctic or Frozen Ocean, the Antarctic,
|
|
or Frozen Ocean, the Indian, the Atlantic, and the Pacific Oceans.
|
|
|
|
The Pacific Ocean extends from north to south between the two
|
|
Polar Circles, and from east to west between Asia and America,
|
|
over an extent of 145 degrees of longitude. It is the quietest of seas;
|
|
its currents are broad and slow, it has medium tides, and abundant rain.
|
|
Such was the ocean that my fate destined me first to travel over under
|
|
these strange conditions.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said Captain Nemo, "we will, if you please,
|
|
take our bearings and fix the starting-point of this voyage.
|
|
It is a quarter to twelve; I will go up again to the surface."
|
|
|
|
The Captain pressed an electric clock three times.
|
|
The pumps began to drive the water from the tanks; the needle
|
|
of the manometer marked by a different pressure the ascent
|
|
of the Nautilus, then it stopped.
|
|
|
|
"We have arrived," said the Captain.
|
|
|
|
I went to the central staircase which opened on to the platform,
|
|
clambered up the iron steps, and found myself on the upper part
|
|
of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
The platform was only three feet out of water. The front
|
|
and back of the Nautilus was of that spindle-shape which caused
|
|
it justly to be compared to a cigar. I noticed that its
|
|
iron plates, slightly overlaying each other, resembled the shell
|
|
which clothes the bodies of our large terrestrial reptiles.
|
|
It explained to me how natural it was, in spite of all glasses,
|
|
that this boat should have been taken for a marine animal.
|
|
|
|
Toward the middle of the platform the longboat, half buried
|
|
in the hull of the vessel, formed a slight excrescence.
|
|
Fore and aft rose two cages of medium height with inclined sides,
|
|
and partly closed by thick lenticular glasses; one destined for
|
|
the steersman who directed the Nautilus, the other containing a
|
|
brilliant lantern to give light on the road.
|
|
|
|
The sea was beautiful, the sky pure. Scarcely could
|
|
the long vehicle feel the broad undulations of the ocean.
|
|
A light breeze from the east rippled the surface of the waters.
|
|
The horizon, free from fog, made observation easy.
|
|
Nothing was in sight. Not a quicksand, not an island.
|
|
A vast desert.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo, by the help of his sextant, took the altitude
|
|
of the sun, which ought also to give the latitude.
|
|
He waited for some moments till its disc touched the horizon.
|
|
Whilst taking observations not a muscle moved, the instrument
|
|
could not have been more motionless in a hand of marble.
|
|
|
|
"Twelve o'clock, sir," said he. "When you like----"
|
|
|
|
I cast a last look upon the sea, slightly yellowed by the Japanese coast,
|
|
and descended to the saloon.
|
|
|
|
"And now, sir, I leave you to your studies," added the Captain;
|
|
"our course is E.N.E., our depth is twenty-six fathoms.
|
|
Here are maps on a large scale by which you may follow it.
|
|
The saloon is at your disposal, and, with your permission,
|
|
I will retire." Captain Nemo bowed, and I remained alone,
|
|
lost in thoughts all bearing on the commander of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
For a whole hour was I deep in these reflections,
|
|
seeking to pierce this mystery so interesting to me.
|
|
Then my eyes fell upon the vast planisphere spread upon the table,
|
|
and I placed my finger on the very spot where the given latitude
|
|
and longitude crossed.
|
|
|
|
The sea has its large rivers like the continents. They are
|
|
special currents known by their temperature and their colour.
|
|
The most remarkable of these is known by the name of the Gulf Stream.
|
|
Science has decided on the globe the direction of five principal currents:
|
|
one in the North Atlantic, a second in the South, a third in the North
|
|
Pacific, a fourth in the South, and a fifth in the Southern Indian Ocean.
|
|
It is even probable that a sixth current existed at one time or another
|
|
in the Northern Indian Ocean, when the Caspian and Aral Seas formed but
|
|
one vast sheet of water.
|
|
|
|
At this point indicated on the planisphere one of these currents
|
|
was rolling, the Kuro-Scivo of the Japanese, the Black River, which,
|
|
leaving the Gulf of Bengal, where it is warmed by the perpendicular
|
|
rays of a tropical sun, crosses the Straits of Malacca along the coast
|
|
of Asia, turns into the North Pacific to the Aleutian Islands,
|
|
carrying with it trunks of camphor-trees and other indigenous productions,
|
|
and edging the waves of the ocean with the pure indigo of its warm water.
|
|
It was this current that the Nautilus was to follow. I followed
|
|
it with my eye; saw it lose itself in the vastness of the Pacific,
|
|
and felt myself drawn with it, when Ned Land and Conseil appeared at
|
|
the door of the saloon.
|
|
|
|
My two brave companions remained petrified at the sight of the wonders
|
|
spread before them.
|
|
|
|
"Where are we, where are we?" exclaimed the Canadian.
|
|
"In the museum at Quebec?"
|
|
|
|
"My friends," I answered, making a sign for them to enter,
|
|
"you are not in Canada, but on board the Nautilus, fifty yards
|
|
below the level of the sea."
|
|
|
|
"But, M. Aronnax," said Ned Land, "can you tell me how many men
|
|
there are on board? Ten, twenty, fifty, a hundred?"
|
|
|
|
"I cannot answer you, Mr. Land; it is better to abandon for a
|
|
time all idea of seizing the Nautilus or escaping from it.
|
|
This ship is a masterpiece of modern industry, and I should be
|
|
sorry not to have seen it. Many people would accept the situation
|
|
forced upon us, if only to move amongst such wonders.
|
|
So be quiet and let us try and see what passes around us."
|
|
|
|
"See!" exclaimed the harpooner, "but we can see nothing in this iron prison!
|
|
We are walking--we are sailing--blindly."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land had scarcely pronounced these words when all was suddenly darkness.
|
|
The luminous ceiling was gone, and so rapidly that my eyes received
|
|
a painful impression.
|
|
|
|
We remained mute, not stirring, and not knowing what surprise awaited us,
|
|
whether agreeable or disagreeable. A sliding noise was heard:
|
|
one would have said that panels were working at the sides of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
"It is the end of the end!" said Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
Suddenly light broke at each side of the saloon, through two oblong openings.
|
|
The liquid mass appeared vividly lit up by the electric gleam. Two crystal
|
|
plates separated us from the sea. At first I trembled at the thought that
|
|
this frail partition might break, but strong bands of copper bound them,
|
|
giving an almost infinite power of resistance.
|
|
|
|
The sea was distinctly visible for a mile all round the Nautilus.
|
|
What a spectacle! What pen can describe it? Who could paint
|
|
the effects of the light through those transparent sheets of water,
|
|
and the softness of the successive gradations from the lower
|
|
to the superior strata of the ocean?
|
|
|
|
We know the transparency of the sea and that its clearness is far
|
|
beyond that of rock-water. The mineral and organic substances
|
|
which it holds in suspension heightens its transparency.
|
|
In certain parts of the ocean at the Antilles, under seventy-five
|
|
fathoms of water, can be seen with surprising clearness a bed
|
|
of sand. The penetrating power of the solar rays does not
|
|
seem to cease for a depth of one hundred and fifty fathoms.
|
|
But in this middle fluid travelled over by the Nautilus,
|
|
the electric brightness was produced even in the bosom of the waves.
|
|
It was no longer luminous water, but liquid light.
|
|
|
|
On each side a window opened into this unexplored abyss.
|
|
The obscurity of the saloon showed to advantage the brightness outside,
|
|
and we looked out as if this pure crystal had been the glass of
|
|
an immense aquarium.
|
|
|
|
"You wished to see, friend Ned; well, you see now."
|
|
|
|
"Curious! curious!" muttered the Canadian, who, forgetting his
|
|
ill-temper, seemed to submit to some irresistible attraction;
|
|
"and one would come further than this to admire such a sight!"
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" thought I to myself, "I understand the life of this man;
|
|
he has made a world apart for himself, in which he treasures all
|
|
his greatest wonders."
|
|
|
|
For two whole hours an aquatic army escorted the Nautilus.
|
|
During their games, their bounds, while rivalling each other
|
|
in beauty, brightness, and velocity, I distinguished the green labre;
|
|
the banded mullet, marked by a double line of black; the round-tailed goby,
|
|
of a white colour, with violet spots on the back; the Japanese scombrus,
|
|
a beautiful mackerel of these seas, with a blue body and silvery head;
|
|
the brilliant azurors, whose name alone defies description;
|
|
some banded spares, with variegated fins of blue and yellow;
|
|
the woodcocks of the seas, some specimens of which attain a yard in length;
|
|
Japanese salamanders, spider lampreys, serpents six feet long,
|
|
with eyes small and lively, and a huge mouth bristling with teeth;
|
|
with many other species.
|
|
|
|
Our imagination was kept at its height, interjections followed quickly
|
|
on each other. Ned named the fish, and Conseil classed them.
|
|
I was in ecstasies with the vivacity of their movements and the
|
|
beauty of their forms. Never had it been given to me to surprise
|
|
these animals, alive and at liberty, in their natural element.
|
|
I will not mention all the varieties which passed before my dazzled eyes,
|
|
all the collection of the seas of China and Japan. These fish,
|
|
more numerous than the birds of the air, came, attracted, no doubt,
|
|
by the brilliant focus of the electric light.
|
|
|
|
Suddenly there was daylight in the saloon, the iron panels closed again,
|
|
and the enchanting vision disappeared. But for a long time I dreamt on,
|
|
till my eyes fell on the instruments hanging on the partition.
|
|
The compass still showed the course to be E.N.E., the manometer
|
|
indicated a pressure of five atmospheres, equivalent to a depth
|
|
of twenty five fathoms, and the electric log gave a speed of fifteen
|
|
miles an hour. I expected Captain Nemo, but he did not appear.
|
|
The clock marked the hour of five.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land and Conseil returned to their cabin, and I retired to my chamber.
|
|
My dinner was ready. It was composed of turtle soup made of the
|
|
most delicate hawks bills, of a surmullet served with puff paste
|
|
(the liver of which, prepared by itself, was most delicious), and fillets
|
|
of the emperor-holocanthus, the savour of which seemed to me superior
|
|
even to salmon.
|
|
|
|
I passed the evening reading, writing, and thinking.
|
|
Then sleep overpowered me, and I stretched myself on my couch
|
|
of zostera, and slept profoundly, whilst the Nautilus was gliding
|
|
rapidly through the current of the Black River.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XIV
|
|
|
|
A NOTE OF INVITATION
|
|
|
|
The next day was the 9th of November. I awoke after a long
|
|
sleep of twelve hours. Conseil came, according to custom,
|
|
to know "how I passed the night," and to offer his services.
|
|
He had left his friend the Canadian sleeping like a man who
|
|
had never done anything else all his life. I let the worthy
|
|
fellow chatter as he pleased, without caring to answer him.
|
|
I was preoccupied by the absence of the Captain during our sitting
|
|
of the day before, and hoping to see him to-day.
|
|
|
|
As soon as I was dressed I went into the saloon. It was deserted.
|
|
I plunged into the study of the shell treasures hidden behind the glasses.
|
|
|
|
The whole day passed without my being honoured by a visit from Captain Nemo.
|
|
The panels of the saloon did not open. Perhaps they did not wish us to tire
|
|
of these beautiful things.
|
|
|
|
The course of the Nautilus was E.N.E., her speed twelve knots,
|
|
the depth below the surface between twenty-five and thirty fathoms.
|
|
|
|
The next day, 10th of November, the same desertion,
|
|
the same solitude. I did not see one of the ship's crew:
|
|
Ned and Conseil spent the greater part of the day with me.
|
|
They were astonished at the puzzling absence of the Captain.
|
|
Was this singular man ill?--had he altered his intentions with
|
|
regard to us?
|
|
|
|
After all, as Conseil said, we enjoyed perfect liberty, we were delicately
|
|
and abundantly fed. Our host kept to his terms of the treaty.
|
|
We could not complain, and, indeed, the singularity of our fate reserved
|
|
such wonderful compensation for us that we had no right to accuse
|
|
it as yet.
|
|
|
|
That day I commenced the journal of these adventures which has enabled
|
|
me to relate them with more scrupulous exactitude and minute detail.
|
|
|
|
11th November, early in the morning. The fresh air spreading
|
|
over the interior of the Nautilus told me that we had come
|
|
to the surface of the ocean to renew our supply of oxygen.
|
|
I directed my steps to the central staircase, and mounted the platform.
|
|
|
|
It was six o'clock, the weather was cloudy, the sea grey, but calm.
|
|
Scarcely a billow. Captain Nemo, whom I hoped to meet, would he be there?
|
|
I saw no one but the steersman imprisoned in his glass cage.
|
|
Seated upon the projection formed by the hull of the pinnace,
|
|
I inhaled the salt breeze with delight.
|
|
|
|
By degrees the fog disappeared under the action of the sun's rays,
|
|
the radiant orb rose from behind the eastern horizon.
|
|
The sea flamed under its glance like a train of gunpowder.
|
|
The clouds scattered in the heights were coloured with lively tints
|
|
of beautiful shades, and numerous "mare's tails," which betokened
|
|
wind for that day. But what was wind to this Nautilus,
|
|
which tempests could not frighten!
|
|
|
|
I was admiring this joyous rising of the sun, so gay,
|
|
and so life-giving, when I heard steps approaching the platform.
|
|
I was prepared to salute Captain Nemo, but it was his second
|
|
(whom I had already seen on the Captain's first visit) who appeared.
|
|
He advanced on the platform, not seeming to see me.
|
|
With his powerful glass to his eye, he scanned every point
|
|
of the horizon with great attention. This examination over,
|
|
he approached the panel and pronounced a sentence in exactly
|
|
these terms. I have remembered it, for every morning
|
|
it was repeated under exactly the same conditions.
|
|
It was thus worded:
|
|
|
|
"Nautron respoc lorni virch."
|
|
|
|
What it meant I could not say.
|
|
|
|
These words pronounced, the second descended. I thought that
|
|
the Nautilus was about to return to its submarine navigation.
|
|
I regained the panel and returned to my chamber.
|
|
|
|
Five days sped thus, without any change in our situation. Every morning I
|
|
mounted the platform. The same phrase was pronounced by the same individual.
|
|
But Captain Nemo did not appear.
|
|
|
|
I had made up my mind that I should never see him again,
|
|
when, on the 16th November, on returning to my room with Ned
|
|
and Conseil, I found upon my table a note addressed to me.
|
|
I opened it impatiently. It was written in a bold, clear hand,
|
|
the characters rather pointed, recalling the German type.
|
|
The note was worded as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
TO PROFESSOR ARONNAX, On board the Nautilus. 16th of November, 1867.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo invites Professor Aronnax to a hunting-party, which will
|
|
take place to-morrow morning in the forests of the Island of Crespo.
|
|
He hopes that nothing will prevent the Professor from being present,
|
|
and he will with pleasure see him joined by his companions.
|
|
|
|
CAPTAIN NEMO, Commander of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
"A hunt!" exclaimed Ned.
|
|
|
|
"And in the forests of the Island of Crespo!" added Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Oh! then the gentleman is going on terra firma?" replied Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"That seems to me to be clearly indicated," said I,
|
|
reading the letter once more.
|
|
|
|
"Well, we must accept," said the Canadian. "But once more on dry ground,
|
|
we shall know what to do. Indeed, I shall not be sorry to eat a piece
|
|
of fresh venison."
|
|
|
|
Without seeking to reconcile what was contradictory between Captain
|
|
Nemo's manifest aversion to islands and continents, and his invitation
|
|
to hunt in a forest, I contented myself with replying:
|
|
|
|
"Let us first see where the Island of Crespo is."
|
|
|
|
I consulted the planisphere, and in 32@ 40' N. lat.
|
|
and 157@ 50' W. long., I found a small island, recognised in 1801
|
|
by Captain Crespo, and marked in the ancient Spanish maps
|
|
as Rocca de la Plata, the meaning of which is The Silver Rock.
|
|
We were then about eighteen hundred miles from our starting-point,
|
|
and the course of the Nautilus, a little changed, was bringing
|
|
it back towards the southeast.
|
|
|
|
I showed this little rock, lost in the midst of the North Pacific,
|
|
to my companions.
|
|
|
|
"If Captain Nemo does sometimes go on dry ground," said I,
|
|
"he at least chooses desert islands."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land shrugged his shoulders without speaking, and Conseil
|
|
and he left me.
|
|
|
|
After supper, which was served by the steward, mute and impassive,
|
|
I went to bed, not without some anxiety.
|
|
|
|
The next morning, the 17th of November, on awakening, I felt
|
|
that the Nautilus was perfectly still. I dressed quickly
|
|
and entered the saloon.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo was there, waiting for me. He rose, bowed,
|
|
and asked me if it was convenient for me to accompany him.
|
|
As he made no allusion to his absence during the last eight days,
|
|
I did not mention it, and simply answered that my companions and
|
|
myself were ready to follow him.
|
|
|
|
We entered the dining-room, where breakfast was served.
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax," said the Captain, "pray, share my breakfast without ceremony;
|
|
we will chat as we eat. For, though I promised you a walk in the forest,
|
|
I did not undertake to find hotels there. So breakfast as a man who will most
|
|
likely not have his dinner till very late."
|
|
|
|
I did honour to the repast. It was composed of several kinds of fish,
|
|
and slices of sea-cucumber, and different sorts of seaweed.
|
|
Our drink consisted of pure water, to which the Captain added
|
|
some drops of a fermented liquor, extracted by the Kamschatcha
|
|
method from a seaweed known under the name of Rhodomenia palmata.
|
|
Captain Nemo ate at first without saying a word. Then he began:
|
|
|
|
"Sir, when I proposed to you to hunt in my submarine forest of Crespo,
|
|
you evidently thought me mad. Sir, you should never judge lightly
|
|
of any man."
|
|
|
|
"But Captain, believe me----"
|
|
|
|
"Be kind enough to listen, and you will then see whether you
|
|
have any cause to accuse me of folly and contradiction."
|
|
|
|
"I listen."
|
|
|
|
"You know as well as I do, Professor, that man can live under water,
|
|
providing he carries with him a sufficient supply of breathable air.
|
|
In submarine works, the workman, clad in an impervious dress,
|
|
with his head in a metal helmet, receives air from above by means
|
|
of forcing pumps and regulators."
|
|
|
|
"That is a diving apparatus," said I.
|
|
|
|
"Just so, but under these conditions the man is not at liberty;
|
|
he is attached to the pump which sends him air through an
|
|
india-rubber tube, and if we were obliged to be thus held
|
|
to the Nautilus, we could not go far."
|
|
|
|
"And the means of getting free?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"It is to use the Rouquayrol apparatus, invented by two of your
|
|
own countrymen, which I have brought to perfection for my own use,
|
|
and which will allow you to risk yourself under these new
|
|
physiological conditions without any organ whatever suffering.
|
|
It consists of a reservoir of thick iron plates, in which I store
|
|
the air under a pressure of fifty atmospheres. This reservoir is
|
|
fixed on the back by means of braces, like a soldier's knapsack.
|
|
Its upper part forms a box in which the air is kept by means of
|
|
a bellows, and therefore cannot escape unless at its normal tension.
|
|
In the Rouquayrol apparatus such as we use, two india rubber pipes
|
|
leave this box and join a sort of tent which holds the nose and mouth;
|
|
one is to introduce fresh air, the other to let out the foul, and the tongue
|
|
closes one or the other according to the wants of the respirator.
|
|
But I, in encountering great pressures at the bottom of the sea,
|
|
was obliged to shut my head, like that of a diver in a ball of copper;
|
|
and it is to this ball of copper that the two pipes, the inspirator and
|
|
the expirator, open."
|
|
|
|
"Perfectly, Captain Nemo; but the air that you carry with you
|
|
must soon be used; when it only contains fifteen per cent.
|
|
of oxygen it is no longer fit to breathe."
|
|
|
|
"Right! But I told you, M. Aronnax, that the pumps of the Nautilus allow
|
|
me to store the air under considerable pressure, and on those conditions
|
|
the reservoir of the apparatus can furnish breathable air for nine
|
|
or ten hours."
|
|
|
|
"I have no further objections to make," I answered.
|
|
"I will only ask you one thing, Captain--how can you light your
|
|
road at the bottom of the sea?"
|
|
|
|
"With the Ruhmkorff apparatus, M. Aronnax; one is carried on the back,
|
|
the other is fastened to the waist. It is composed of a Bunsen pile,
|
|
which I do not work with bichromate of potash, but with sodium.
|
|
A wire is introduced which collects the electricity produced, and directs
|
|
it towards a particularly made lantern. In this lantern is a spiral glass
|
|
which contains a small quantity of carbonic gas. When the apparatus is at
|
|
work this gas becomes luminous, giving out a white and continuous light.
|
|
Thus provided, I can breathe and I can see."
|
|
|
|
"Captain Nemo, to all my objections you make such crushing answers that I
|
|
dare no longer doubt. But, if I am forced to admit the Rouquayrol
|
|
and Ruhmkorff apparatus, I must be allowed some reservations with regard
|
|
to the gun I am to carry."
|
|
|
|
"But it is not a gun for powder," answered the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"Then it is an air-gun."
|
|
|
|
"Doubtless! How would you have me manufacture gun powder on board,
|
|
without either saltpetre, sulphur, or charcoal?"
|
|
|
|
"Besides," I added, "to fire under water in a medium eight
|
|
hundred and fifty-five times denser than the air, we must
|
|
conquer very considerable resistance."
|
|
|
|
"That would be no difficulty. There exist guns, according to Fulton,
|
|
perfected in England by Philip Coles and Burley, in France by Furcy,
|
|
and in Italy by Landi, which are furnished with a peculiar
|
|
system of closing, which can fire under these conditions.
|
|
But I repeat, having no powder, I use air under great pressure,
|
|
which the pumps of the Nautilus furnish abundantly."
|
|
|
|
"But this air must be rapidly used?"
|
|
|
|
"Well, have I not my Rouquayrol reservoir, which can furnish it at need?
|
|
A tap is all that is required. Besides M. Aronnax, you must see
|
|
yourself that, during our submarine hunt, we can spend but little air
|
|
and but few balls."
|
|
|
|
"But it seems to me that in this twilight, and in the midst of this fluid,
|
|
which is very dense compared with the atmosphere, shots could not go far,
|
|
nor easily prove mortal."
|
|
|
|
"Sir, on the contrary, with this gun every blow is mortal;
|
|
and, however lightly the animal is touched, it falls as if struck
|
|
by a thunderbolt."
|
|
|
|
"Why?"
|
|
|
|
"Because the balls sent by this gun are not ordinary balls, but little
|
|
cases of glass. These glass cases are covered with a case of steel,
|
|
and weighted with a pellet of lead; they are real Leyden bottles,
|
|
into which the electricity is forced to a very high tension.
|
|
With the slightest shock they are discharged, and the animal,
|
|
however strong it may be, falls dead. I must tell you that these
|
|
cases are size number four, and that the charge for an ordinary gun
|
|
would be ten."
|
|
|
|
"I will argue no longer," I replied, rising from the table.
|
|
"I have nothing left me but to take my gun. At all events,
|
|
I will go where you go."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo then led me aft; and in passing before Ned's and
|
|
Conseil's cabin, I called my two companions, who followed promptly.
|
|
We then came to a cell near the machinery-room, in which we put
|
|
on our walking-dress.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XV
|
|
|
|
A WALK ON THE BOTTOM OF THE SEA
|
|
|
|
This cell was, to speak correctly, the arsenal and wardrobe of the Nautilus.
|
|
A dozen diving apparatuses hung from the partition waiting our use.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land, on seeing them, showed evident repugnance to dress
|
|
himself in one.
|
|
|
|
"But, my worthy Ned, the forests of the Island of Crespo are nothing
|
|
but submarine forests."
|
|
|
|
"Good!" said the disappointed harpooner, who saw his dreams
|
|
of fresh meat fade away. "And you, M. Aronnax, are you going
|
|
to dress yourself in those clothes?"
|
|
|
|
"There is no alternative, Master Ned."
|
|
|
|
"As you please, sir," replied the harpooner, shrugging his shoulders;
|
|
"but, as for me, unless I am forced, I will never get into one."
|
|
|
|
"No one will force you, Master Ned," said Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"Is Conseil going to risk it?" asked Ned.
|
|
|
|
"I follow my master wherever he goes," replied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
At the Captain's call two of the ship's crew came to help us dress
|
|
in these heavy and impervious clothes, made of india-rubber without seam,
|
|
and constructed expressly to resist considerable pressure.
|
|
One would have thought it a suit of armour, both supple and resisting.
|
|
This suit formed trousers and waistcoat. The trousers were
|
|
finished off with thick boots, weighted with heavy leaden soles.
|
|
The texture of the waistcoat was held together by bands of copper,
|
|
which crossed the chest, protecting it from the great pressure
|
|
of the water, and leaving the lungs free to act; the sleeves ended
|
|
in gloves, which in no way restrained the movement of the hands.
|
|
There was a vast difference noticeable between these consummate
|
|
apparatuses and the old cork breastplates, jackets, and other
|
|
contrivances in vogue during the eighteenth century.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo and one of his companions (a sort of Hercules,
|
|
who must have possessed great strength), Conseil and myself
|
|
were soon enveloped in the dresses. There remained nothing
|
|
more to be done but to enclose our heads in the metal box.
|
|
But, before proceeding to this operation, I asked the Captain's
|
|
permission to examine the guns.
|
|
|
|
One of the Nautilus men gave me a simple gun, the butt end
|
|
of which, made of steel, hollow in the centre, was rather large.
|
|
It served as a reservoir for compressed air, which a valve,
|
|
worked by a spring, allowed to escape into a metal tube.
|
|
A box of projectiles in a groove in the thickness of the butt
|
|
end contained about twenty of these electric balls, which,
|
|
by means of a spring, were forced into the barrel of the gun.
|
|
As soon as one shot was fired, another was ready.
|
|
|
|
"Captain Nemo," said I, "this arm is perfect, and easily handled:
|
|
I only ask to be allowed to try it. But how shall we gain the bottom
|
|
of the sea?"
|
|
|
|
"At this moment, Professor, the Nautilus is stranded in five fathoms,
|
|
and we have nothing to do but to start."
|
|
|
|
"But how shall we get off?"
|
|
|
|
"You shall see."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo thrust his head into the helmet, Conseil and I did the same,
|
|
not without hearing an ironical "Good sport!" from the Canadian.
|
|
The upper part of our dress terminated in a copper collar upon which
|
|
was screwed the metal helmet. Three holes, protected by thick glass,
|
|
allowed us to see in all directions, by simply turning our head
|
|
in the interior of the head-dress. As soon as it was in position,
|
|
the Rouquayrol apparatus on our backs began to act; and, for my part,
|
|
I could breathe with ease.
|
|
|
|
With the Ruhmkorff lamp hanging from my belt, and the gun in my hand,
|
|
I was ready to set out. But to speak the truth, imprisoned in
|
|
these heavy garments, and glued to the deck by my leaden soles,
|
|
it was impossible for me to take a step.
|
|
|
|
But this state of things was provided for. I felt myself being
|
|
pushed into a little room contiguous to the wardrobe room.
|
|
My companions followed, towed along in the same way. I heard
|
|
a water-tight door, furnished with stopper plates, close upon us,
|
|
and we were wrapped in profound darkness.
|
|
|
|
After some minutes, a loud hissing was heard. I felt the cold
|
|
mount from my feet to my chest. Evidently from some part of the
|
|
vessel they had, by means of a tap, given entrance to the water,
|
|
which was invading us, and with which the room was soon filled.
|
|
A second door cut in the side of the Nautilus then opened.
|
|
We saw a faint light. In another instant our feet trod the bottom
|
|
of the sea.
|
|
|
|
And now, how can I retrace the impression left upon me by that walk
|
|
under the waters? Words are impotent to relate such wonders!
|
|
Captain Nemo walked in front, his companion followed some steps behind.
|
|
Conseil and I remained near each other, as if an exchange of words
|
|
had been possible through our metallic cases. I no longer felt
|
|
the weight of my clothing, or of my shoes, of my reservoir of air,
|
|
or my thick helmet, in the midst of which my head rattled like an almond
|
|
in its shell.
|
|
|
|
The light, which lit the soil thirty feet below the surface of
|
|
the ocean, astonished me by its power. The solar rays shone through
|
|
the watery mass easily, and dissipated all colour, and I clearly
|
|
distinguished objects at a distance of a hundred and fifty yards.
|
|
Beyond that the tints darkened into fine gradations of ultramarine,
|
|
and faded into vague obscurity. Truly this water which surrounded
|
|
me was but another air denser than the terrestrial atmosphere,
|
|
but almost as transparent. Above me was the calm surface of the sea.
|
|
We were walking on fine, even sand, not wrinkled, as on a flat shore,
|
|
which retains the impression of the billows. This dazzling carpet,
|
|
really a reflector, repelled the rays of the sun with wonderful intensity,
|
|
which accounted for the vibration which penetrated every atom of liquid.
|
|
Shall I be believed when I say that, at the depth of thirty feet,
|
|
I could see as if I was in broad daylight?
|
|
|
|
For a quarter of an hour I trod on this sand, sown with the impalpable
|
|
dust of shells. The hull of the Nautilus, resembling a long shoal,
|
|
disappeared by degrees; but its lantern, when darkness should overtake us
|
|
in the waters, would help to guide us on board by its distinct rays.
|
|
|
|
Soon forms of objects outlined in the distance were discernible.
|
|
I recognised magnificent rocks, hung with a tapestry of zoophytes
|
|
of the most beautiful kind, and I was at first struck by the peculiar
|
|
effect of this medium.
|
|
|
|
It was then ten in the morning; the rays of the sun struck the surface
|
|
of the waves at rather an oblique angle, and at the touch of their light,
|
|
decomposed by refraction as through a prism, flowers, rocks, plants, shells,
|
|
and polypi were shaded at the edges by the seven solar colours.
|
|
It was marvellous, a feast for the eyes, this complication of coloured tints,
|
|
a perfect kaleidoscope of green, yellow, orange, violet, indigo, and blue;
|
|
in one word, the whole palette of an enthusiastic colourist!
|
|
Why could I not communicate to Conseil the lively sensations which were
|
|
mounting to my brain, and rival him in expressions of admiration?
|
|
For aught I knew, Captain Nemo and his companion might be able to exchange
|
|
thoughts by means of signs previously agreed upon. So, for want of better,
|
|
I talked to myself; I declaimed in the copper box which covered my head,
|
|
thereby expending more air in vain words than was perhaps wise.
|
|
|
|
Various kinds of isis, clusters of pure tuft-coral, prickly fungi,
|
|
and anemones formed a brilliant garden of flowers, decked with their
|
|
collarettes of blue tentacles, sea-stars studding the sandy bottom.
|
|
It was a real grief to me to crush under my feet the brilliant
|
|
specimens of molluscs which strewed the ground by thousands,
|
|
of hammerheads, donaciae (veritable bounding shells), of staircases,
|
|
and red helmet-shells, angel-wings, and many others produced by this
|
|
inexhaustible ocean. But we were bound to walk, so we went on,
|
|
whilst above our heads waved medusae whose umbrellas of opal
|
|
or rose-pink, escalloped with a band of blue, sheltered us from
|
|
the rays of the sun and fiery pelagiae, which, in the darkness,
|
|
would have strewn our path with phosphorescent light.
|
|
|
|
All these wonders I saw in the space of a quarter of a mile,
|
|
scarcely stopping, and following Captain Nemo, who beckoned me on
|
|
by signs. Soon the nature of the soil changed; to the sandy plain
|
|
succeeded an extent of slimy mud which the Americans call "ooze,"
|
|
composed of equal parts of silicious and calcareous shells. We then
|
|
travelled over a plain of seaweed of wild and luxuriant vegetation.
|
|
This sward was of close texture, and soft to the feet,
|
|
and rivalled the softest carpet woven by the hand of man.
|
|
But whilst verdure was spread at our feet, it did not abandon our heads.
|
|
A light network of marine plants, of that inexhaustible family
|
|
of seaweeds of which more than two thousand kinds are known,
|
|
grew on the surface of the water.
|
|
|
|
I noticed that the green plants kept nearer the top of the sea,
|
|
whilst the red were at a greater depth, leaving to the black
|
|
or brown the care of forming gardens and parterres in the remote
|
|
beds of the ocean.
|
|
|
|
We had quitted the Nautilus about an hour and a half.
|
|
It was near noon; I knew by the perpendicularity of the sun's rays,
|
|
which were no longer refracted. The magical colours disappeared
|
|
by degrees, and the shades of emerald and sapphire were effaced.
|
|
We walked with a regular step, which rang upon the ground with
|
|
astonishing intensity; the slightest noise was transmitted with a
|
|
quickness to which the ear is unaccustomed on the earth; indeed, water is
|
|
a better conductor of sound than air, in the ratio of four to one.
|
|
At this period the earth sloped downwards; the light took a uniform tint.
|
|
We were at a depth of a hundred and five yards and twenty inches,
|
|
undergoing a pressure of six atmospheres.
|
|
|
|
At this depth I could still see the rays of the sun, though feebly;
|
|
to their intense brilliancy had succeeded a reddish twilight, the lowest
|
|
state between day and night; but we could still see well enough;
|
|
it was not necessary to resort to the Ruhmkorff apparatus as yet.
|
|
At this moment Captain Nemo stopped; he waited till I joined him,
|
|
and then pointed to an obscure mass, looming in the shadow,
|
|
at a short distance.
|
|
|
|
"It is the forest of the Island of Crespo," thought I;
|
|
and I was not mistaken.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XVI
|
|
|
|
A SUBMARINE FOREST
|
|
|
|
We had at last arrived on the borders of this forest,
|
|
doubtless one of the finest of Captain Nemo's immense domains.
|
|
He looked upon it as his own, and considered he had the same right
|
|
over it that the first men had in the first days of the world.
|
|
And, indeed, who would have disputed with him the possession
|
|
of this submarine property? What other hardier pioneer would come,
|
|
hatchet in hand, to cut down the dark copses?
|
|
|
|
This forest was composed of large tree-plants; and the moment we
|
|
penetrated under its vast arcades, I was struck by the singular
|
|
position of their branches--a position I had not yet observed.
|
|
|
|
Not an herb which carpeted the ground, not a branch which clothed
|
|
the trees, was either broken or bent, nor did they extend horizontally;
|
|
all stretched up to the surface of the ocean. Not a filament, not a ribbon,
|
|
however thin they might be, but kept as straight as a rod of iron.
|
|
The fuci and llianas grew in rigid perpendicular lines, due to the density
|
|
of the element which had produced them. Motionless yet, when bent
|
|
to one side by the hand, they directly resumed their former position.
|
|
Truly it was the region of perpendicularity!
|
|
|
|
I soon accustomed myself to this fantastic position,
|
|
as well as to the comparative darkness which surrounded us.
|
|
The soil of the forest seemed covered with sharp blocks,
|
|
difficult to avoid. The submarine flora struck me as being
|
|
very perfect, and richer even than it would have been in the arctic
|
|
or tropical zones, where these productions are not so plentiful.
|
|
But for some minutes I involuntarily confounded the genera,
|
|
taking animals for plants; and who would not have been mistaken?
|
|
The fauna and the flora are too closely allied in this submarine world.
|
|
|
|
These plants are self-propagated, and the principle of their
|
|
existence is in the water, which upholds and nourishes them.
|
|
The greater number, instead of leaves, shoot forth blades
|
|
of capricious shapes, comprised within a scale of colours pink,
|
|
carmine, green, olive, fawn, and brown.
|
|
|
|
"Curious anomaly, fantastic element!" said an ingenious naturalist,
|
|
"in which the animal kingdom blossoms, and the vegetable does not!"
|
|
|
|
In about an hour Captain Nemo gave the signal to halt; I, for my part,
|
|
was not sorry, and we stretched ourselves under an arbour of alariae,
|
|
the long thin blades of which stood up like arrows.
|
|
|
|
This short rest seemed delicious to me; there was nothing
|
|
wanting but the charm of conversation; but, impossible to speak,
|
|
impossible to answer, I only put my great copper head to Conseil's.
|
|
I saw the worthy fellow's eyes glistening with delight, and, to show
|
|
his satisfaction, he shook himself in his breastplate of air,
|
|
in the most comical way in the world.
|
|
|
|
After four hours of this walking, I was surprised not to find
|
|
myself dreadfully hungry. How to account for this state
|
|
of the stomach I could not tell. But instead I felt an
|
|
insurmountable desire to sleep, which happens to all divers.
|
|
And my eyes soon closed behind the thick glasses, and I fell into
|
|
a heavy slumber, which the movement alone had prevented before.
|
|
Captain Nemo and his robust companion, stretched in the clear crystal,
|
|
set us the example.
|
|
|
|
How long I remained buried in this drowsiness I cannot judge,
|
|
but, when I woke, the sun seemed sinking towards the horizon.
|
|
Captain Nemo had already risen, and I was beginning to stretch
|
|
my limbs, when an unexpected apparition brought me briskly
|
|
to my feet.
|
|
|
|
A few steps off, a monstrous sea-spider, about thirty-eight inches
|
|
high, was watching me with squinting eyes, ready to spring upon me.
|
|
Though my diver's dress was thick enough to defend me from
|
|
the bite of this animal, I could not help shuddering with horror.
|
|
Conseil and the sailor of the Nautilus awoke at this moment.
|
|
Captain Nemo pointed out the hideous crustacean, which a blow
|
|
from the butt end of the gun knocked over, and I saw the horrible
|
|
claws of the monster writhe in terrible convulsions.
|
|
This incident reminded me that other animals more to be feared
|
|
might haunt these obscure depths, against whose attacks my
|
|
diving-dress would not protect me. I had never thought of it before,
|
|
but I now resolved to be upon my guard. Indeed, I thought
|
|
that this halt would mark the termination of our walk;
|
|
but I was mistaken, for, instead of returning to the Nautilus,
|
|
Captain Nemo continued his bold excursion. The ground was still
|
|
on the incline, its declivity seemed to be getting greater,
|
|
and to be leading us to greater depths. It must have been
|
|
about three o'clock when we reached a narrow valley, between high
|
|
perpendicular walls, situated about seventy-five fathoms deep.
|
|
Thanks to the perfection of our apparatus, we were forty-five
|
|
fathoms below the limit which nature seems to have imposed on man
|
|
as to his submarine excursions.
|
|
|
|
I say seventy-five fathoms, though I had no instrument by which to
|
|
judge the distance. But I knew that even in the clearest waters
|
|
the solar rays could not penetrate further. And accordingly
|
|
the darkness deepened. At ten paces not an object was visible.
|
|
I was groping my way, when I suddenly saw a brilliant white light.
|
|
Captain Nemo had just put his electric apparatus into use;
|
|
his companion did the same, and Conseil and I followed their example.
|
|
By turning a screw I established a communication between the wire
|
|
and the spiral glass, and the sea, lit by our four lanterns,
|
|
was illuminated for a circle of thirty-six yards.
|
|
|
|
As we walked I thought the light of our Ruhmkorff apparatus
|
|
could not fail to draw some inhabitant from its dark couch.
|
|
But if they did approach us, they at least kept at
|
|
a respectful distance from the hunters. Several times
|
|
I saw Captain Nemo stop, put his gun to his shoulder,
|
|
and after some moments drop it and walk on. At last,
|
|
after about four hours, this marvellous excursion came to an end.
|
|
A wall of superb rocks, in an imposing mass, rose before us,
|
|
a heap of gigantic blocks, an enormous, steep granite shore,
|
|
forming dark grottos, but which presented no practicable slope;
|
|
it was the prop of the Island of Crespo. It was the earth!
|
|
Captain Nemo stopped suddenly. A gesture of his brought us all
|
|
to a halt; and, however desirous I might be to scale the wall,
|
|
I was obliged to stop. Here ended Captain Nemo's domains.
|
|
And he would not go beyond them. Further on was a portion of the
|
|
globe he might not trample upon.
|
|
|
|
The return began. Captain Nemo had returned to the head of his little band,
|
|
directing their course without hesitation. I thought we were not following
|
|
the same road to return to the Nautilus. The new road was very steep,
|
|
and consequently very painful. We approached the surface of the sea rapidly.
|
|
But this return to the upper strata was not so sudden as to cause relief
|
|
from the pressure too rapidly, which might have produced serious disorder
|
|
in our organisation, and brought on internal lesions, so fatal to divers.
|
|
Very soon light reappeared and grew, and, the sun being low on the horizon,
|
|
the refraction edged the different objects with a spectral ring.
|
|
At ten yards and a half deep, we walked amidst a shoal of little fishes
|
|
of all kinds, more numerous than the birds of the air, and also more agile;
|
|
but no aquatic game worthy of a shot had as yet met our gaze, when at
|
|
that moment I saw the Captain shoulder his gun quickly, and follow
|
|
a moving object into the shrubs. He fired; I heard a slight hissing,
|
|
and a creature fell stunned at some distance from us. It was a magnificent
|
|
sea-otter, an enhydrus, the only exclusively marine quadruped.
|
|
This otter was five feet long, and must have been very valuable.
|
|
Its skin, chestnut-brown above and silvery underneath, would have made one
|
|
of those beautiful furs so sought after in the Russian and Chinese markets:
|
|
the fineness and the lustre of its coat would certainly fetch L80.
|
|
I admired this curious mammal, with its rounded head ornamented with
|
|
short ears, its round eyes, and white whiskers like those of a cat,
|
|
with webbed feet and nails, and tufted tail. This precious animal,
|
|
hunted and tracked by fishermen, has now become very rare, and taken refuge
|
|
chiefly in the northern parts of the Pacific, or probably its race would
|
|
soon become extinct.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo's companion took the beast, threw it over his shoulder, and we
|
|
continued our journey. For one hour a plain of sand lay stretched before us.
|
|
Sometimes it rose to within two yards and some inches of the surface of
|
|
the water. I then saw our image clearly reflected, drawn inversely, and above
|
|
us appeared an identical group reflecting our movements and our actions;
|
|
in a word, like us in every point, except that they walked with their heads
|
|
downward and their feet in the air.
|
|
|
|
Another effect I noticed, which was the passage of thick clouds which formed
|
|
and vanished rapidly; but on reflection I understood that these seeming
|
|
clouds were due to the varying thickness of the reeds at the bottom,
|
|
and I could even see the fleecy foam which their broken tops multiplied
|
|
on the water, and the shadows of large birds passing above our heads,
|
|
whose rapid flight I could discern on the surface of the sea.
|
|
|
|
On this occasion I was witness to one of the finest gun
|
|
shots which ever made the nerves of a hunter thrill.
|
|
A large bird of great breadth of wing, clearly visible, approached,
|
|
hovering over us. Captain Nemo's companion shouldered his gun
|
|
and fired, when it was only a few yards above the waves.
|
|
The creature fell stunned, and the force of its fall
|
|
brought it within the reach of dexterous hunter's grasp.
|
|
It was an albatross of the finest kind.
|
|
|
|
Our march had not been interrupted by this incident.
|
|
For two hours we followed these sandy plains, then fields of algae
|
|
very disagreeable to cross. Candidly, I could do no more when I
|
|
saw a glimmer of light, which, for a half mile, broke the
|
|
darkness of the waters. It was the lantern of the Nautilus.
|
|
Before twenty minutes were over we should be on board,
|
|
and I should be able to breathe with ease, for it seemed
|
|
that my reservoir supplied air very deficient in oxygen.
|
|
But I did not reckon on an accidental meeting which delayed our
|
|
arrival for some time.
|
|
|
|
I had remained some steps behind, when I presently saw Captain
|
|
Nemo coming hurriedly towards me. With his strong hand he bent
|
|
me to the ground, his companion doing the same to Conseil.
|
|
At first I knew not what to think of this sudden attack, but I
|
|
was soon reassured by seeing the Captain lie down beside me,
|
|
and remain immovable.
|
|
|
|
I was stretched on the ground, just under the shelter of a bush
|
|
of algae, when, raising my head, I saw some enormous mass,
|
|
casting phosphorescent gleams, pass blusteringly by.
|
|
|
|
My blood froze in my veins as I recognised two formidable
|
|
sharks which threatened us. It was a couple of tintoreas,
|
|
terrible creatures, with enormous tails and a dull glassy stare,
|
|
the phosphorescent matter ejected from holes pierced around the muzzle.
|
|
Monstrous brutes! which would crush a whole man in their iron jaws.
|
|
I did not know whether Conseil stopped to classify them; for my part,
|
|
I noticed their silver bellies, and their huge mouths bristling
|
|
with teeth, from a very unscientific point of view, and more as a
|
|
possible victim than as a naturalist.
|
|
|
|
Happily the voracious creatures do not see well. They passed without
|
|
seeing us, brushing us with their brownish fins, and we escaped by a miracle
|
|
from a danger certainly greater than meeting a tiger full-face in the forest.
|
|
Half an hour after, guided by the electric light we reached the Nautilus.
|
|
The outside door had been left open, and Captain Nemo closed it
|
|
as soon as we had entered the first cell. He then pressed a knob.
|
|
I heard the pumps working in the midst of the vessel, I felt the water
|
|
sinking from around me, and in a few moments the cell was entirely empty.
|
|
The inside door then opened, and we entered the vestry.
|
|
|
|
There our diving-dress was taken off, not without some trouble, and,
|
|
fairly worn out from want of food and sleep, I returned to my room,
|
|
in great wonder at this surprising excursion at the bottom of the sea.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XVII
|
|
|
|
FOUR THOUSAND LEAGUES UNDER THE PACIFIC
|
|
|
|
The next morning, the 18th of November, I had quite recovered from
|
|
my fatigues of the day before, and I went up on to the platform,
|
|
just as the second lieutenant was uttering his daily phrase.
|
|
|
|
I was admiring the magnificent aspect of the ocean when Captain
|
|
Nemo appeared. He did not seem to be aware of my presence,
|
|
and began a series of astronomical observations.
|
|
Then, when he had finished, he went and leant on the cage
|
|
of the watch-light, and gazed abstractedly on the ocean.
|
|
In the meantime, a number of the sailors of the Nautilus,
|
|
all strong and healthy men, had come up onto the platform.
|
|
They came to draw up the nets that had been laid all night.
|
|
These sailors were evidently of different nations,
|
|
although the European type was visible in all of them.
|
|
I recognised some unmistakable Irishmen, Frenchmen, some Sclaves,
|
|
and a Greek, or a Candiote. They were civil, and only used that odd
|
|
language among themselves, the origin of which I could not guess,
|
|
neither could I question them.
|
|
|
|
The nets were hauled in. They were a large kind of "chaluts," like those
|
|
on the Normandy coasts, great pockets that the waves and a chain fixed
|
|
in the smaller meshes kept open. These pockets, drawn by iron poles,
|
|
swept through the water, and gathered in everything in their way.
|
|
That day they brought up curious specimens from those productive coasts.
|
|
|
|
I reckoned that the haul had brought in more than nine hundredweight of fish.
|
|
It was a fine haul, but not to be wondered at. Indeed, the nets are let
|
|
down for several hours, and enclose in their meshes an infinite variety.
|
|
We had no lack of excellent food, and the rapidity of the Nautilus
|
|
and the attraction of the electric light could always renew our supply.
|
|
These several productions of the sea were immediately lowered through the
|
|
panel to the steward's room, some to be eaten fresh, and others pickled.
|
|
|
|
The fishing ended, the provision of air renewed, I thought
|
|
that the Nautilus was about to continue its submarine excursion,
|
|
and was preparing to return to my room, when, without further preamble,
|
|
the Captain turned to me, saying:
|
|
|
|
"Professor, is not this ocean gifted with real life? It has its
|
|
tempers and its gentle moods. Yesterday it slept as we did, and now it
|
|
has woke after a quiet night. Look!" he continued, "it wakes under
|
|
the caresses of the sun. It is going to renew its diurnal existence.
|
|
It is an interesting study to watch the play of its organisation.
|
|
It has a pulse, arteries, spasms; and I agree with the learned Maury,
|
|
who discovered in it a circulation as real as the circulation of
|
|
blood in animals.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, the ocean has indeed circulation, and to promote it, the Creator
|
|
has caused things to multiply in it--caloric, salt, and animalculae."
|
|
|
|
When Captain Nemo spoke thus, he seemed altogether changed,
|
|
and aroused an extraordinary emotion in me.
|
|
|
|
"Also," he added, "true existence is there; and I can imagine
|
|
the foundations of nautical towns, clusters of submarine houses,
|
|
which, like the Nautilus, would ascend every morning to breathe
|
|
at the surface of the water, free towns, independent cities.
|
|
Yet who knows whether some despot----"
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo finished his sentence with a violent gesture.
|
|
Then, addressing me as if to chase away some sorrowful thought:
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax," he asked. "do you know the depth of the ocean?"
|
|
|
|
"I only know, Captain, what the principal soundings have taught us."
|
|
|
|
"Could you tell me them, so that I can suit them to my purpose?"
|
|
|
|
"These are some," I replied, "that I remember. If I am not mistaken,
|
|
a depth of 8,000 yards has been found in the North Atlantic,
|
|
and 2,500 yards in the Mediterranean. The most remarkable soundings
|
|
have been made in the South Atlantic, near the thirty-fifth parallel,
|
|
and they gave 12,000 yards, 14,000 yards, and 15,000 yards.
|
|
To sum up all, it is reckoned that if the bottom of the sea were levelled,
|
|
its mean depth would be about one and three-quarter leagues."
|
|
|
|
"Well, Professor," replied the Captain, "we shall show you better
|
|
than that I hope. As to the mean depth of this part of the Pacific,
|
|
I tell you it is only 4,000 yards."
|
|
|
|
Having said this, Captain Nemo went towards the panel,
|
|
and disappeared down the ladder. I followed him, and went into
|
|
the large drawing-room. The screw was immediately put in motion,
|
|
and the log gave twenty miles an hour.
|
|
|
|
During the days and weeks that passed, Captain Nemo
|
|
was very sparing of his visits. I seldom saw him.
|
|
The lieutenant pricked the ship's course regularly on the chart,
|
|
so I could always tell exactly the route of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
Nearly every day, for some time, the panels of the drawing-room were opened,
|
|
and we were never tired of penetrating the mysteries of the submarine world.
|
|
|
|
The general direction of the Nautilus was south-east, and it kept between 100
|
|
and 150 yards of depth. One day, however, I do not know why, being drawn
|
|
diagonally by means of the inclined planes, it touched the bed of the sea.
|
|
The thermometer indicated a temperature of 4.25 (cent.): a temperature that at
|
|
this depth seemed common to all latitudes.
|
|
|
|
At three o'clock in the morning of the 26th of November the Nautilus
|
|
crossed the tropic of Cancer at 172@ long. On 27th instant it
|
|
sighted the Sandwich Islands, where Cook died, February 14, 1779.
|
|
We had then gone 4,860 leagues from our starting-point. In the morning,
|
|
when I went on the platform, I saw two miles to windward,
|
|
Hawaii, the largest of the seven islands that form the group.
|
|
I saw clearly the cultivated ranges, and the several mountain-chains
|
|
that run parallel with the side, and the volcanoes that overtop
|
|
Mouna-Rea, which rise 5,000 yards above the level of the sea.
|
|
Besides other things the nets brought up, were several flabellariae
|
|
and graceful polypi, that are peculiar to that part of the ocean.
|
|
The direction of the Nautilus was still to the south-east. It crossed
|
|
the equator December 1, in 142@ long.; and on the 4th of the same month,
|
|
after crossing rapidly and without anything in particular occurring,
|
|
we sighted the Marquesas group. I saw, three miles off, Martin's peak
|
|
in Nouka-Hiva, the largest of the group that belongs to France.
|
|
I only saw the woody mountains against the horizon, because Captain Nemo
|
|
did not wish to bring the ship to the wind. There the nets brought up
|
|
beautiful specimens of fish: some with azure fins and tails like gold,
|
|
the flesh of which is unrivalled; some nearly destitute of scales,
|
|
but of exquisite flavour; others, with bony jaws, and yellow-tinged
|
|
gills, as good as bonitos; all fish that would be of use to us.
|
|
After leaving these charming islands protected by the French flag,
|
|
from the 4th to the 11th of December the Nautilus sailed over about
|
|
2,000 miles.
|
|
|
|
During the daytime of the 11th of December I was busy reading
|
|
in the large drawing-room. Ned Land and Conseil watched the luminous
|
|
water through the half-open panels. The Nautilus was immovable.
|
|
While its reservoirs were filled, it kept at a depth of 1,000 yards,
|
|
a region rarely visited in the ocean, and in which large fish
|
|
were seldom seen.
|
|
|
|
I was then reading a charming book by Jean Mace, The Slaves of the Stomach,
|
|
and I was learning some valuable lessons from it, when Conseil interrupted me.
|
|
|
|
"Will master come here a moment?" he said, in a curious voice.
|
|
|
|
"What is the matter, Conseil?"
|
|
|
|
"I want master to look."
|
|
|
|
I rose, went, and leaned on my elbows before the panes and watched.
|
|
|
|
In a full electric light, an enormous black mass, quite immovable,
|
|
was suspended in the midst of the waters. I watched it attentively,
|
|
seeking to find out the nature of this gigantic cetacean.
|
|
But a sudden thought crossed my mind. "A vessel!"
|
|
I said, half aloud.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," replied the Canadian, "a disabled ship that has sunk perpendicularly."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land was right; we were close to a vessel of which the tattered
|
|
shrouds still hung from their chains. The keel seemed to be
|
|
in good order, and it had been wrecked at most some few hours.
|
|
Three stumps of masts, broken off about two feet above the bridge,
|
|
showed that the vessel had had to sacrifice its masts. But, lying on
|
|
its side, it had filled, and it was heeling over to port.
|
|
This skeleton of what it had once been was a sad spectacle as it lay
|
|
lost under the waves, but sadder still was the sight of the bridge,
|
|
where some corpses, bound with ropes, were still lying.
|
|
I counted five--four men, one of whom was standing at the helm,
|
|
and a woman standing by the poop, holding an infant in her arms.
|
|
She was quite young. I could distinguish her features, which the water
|
|
had not decomposed, by the brilliant light from the Nautilus.
|
|
In one despairing effort, she had raised her infant above her head--
|
|
poor little thing!--whose arms encircled its mother's neck.
|
|
The attitude of the four sailors was frightful, distorted as they
|
|
were by their convulsive movements, whilst making a last effort
|
|
to free themselves from the cords that bound them to the vessel.
|
|
The steersman alone, calm, with a grave, clear face, his grey hair
|
|
glued to his forehead, and his hand clutching the wheel of the helm,
|
|
seemed even then to be guiding the three broken masts through the depths
|
|
of the ocean.
|
|
|
|
What a scene! We were dumb; our hearts beat fast before this shipwreck,
|
|
taken as it were from life and photographed in its last moments.
|
|
And I saw already, coming towards it with hungry eyes, enormous sharks,
|
|
attracted by the human flesh.
|
|
|
|
However, the Nautilus, turning, went round the submerged vessel,
|
|
and in one instant I read on the stern--"The Florida, Sunderland."
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XVIII
|
|
|
|
VANIKORO
|
|
|
|
This terrible spectacle was the forerunner of the series of maritime
|
|
catastrophes that the Nautilus was destined to meet with in its route.
|
|
As long as it went through more frequented waters, we often saw
|
|
the hulls of shipwrecked vessels that were rotting in the depths,
|
|
and deeper down cannons, bullets, anchors, chains, and a thousand
|
|
other iron materials eaten up by rust. However, on the 11th of
|
|
December we sighted the Pomotou Islands, the old "dangerous group"
|
|
of Bougainville, that extend over a space of 500 leagues at
|
|
E.S.E. to W.N.W., from the Island Ducie to that of Lazareff.
|
|
This group covers an area of 370 square leagues, and it is formed
|
|
of sixty groups of islands, among which the Gambier group is remarkable,
|
|
over which France exercises sway. These are coral islands,
|
|
slowly raised, but continuous, created by the daily work of polypi.
|
|
Then this new island will be joined later on to the neighboring groups,
|
|
and a fifth continent will stretch from New Zealand and New Caledonia,
|
|
and from thence to the Marquesas.
|
|
|
|
One day, when I was suggesting this theory to Captain Nemo,
|
|
he replied coldly:
|
|
|
|
"The earth does not want new continents, but new men."
|
|
|
|
{5 paragraphs have been stripped from this edition}
|
|
|
|
On 15th of December, we left to the east the bewitching group
|
|
of the Societies and the graceful Tahiti, queen of the Pacific.
|
|
I saw in the morning, some miles to the windward, the elevated
|
|
summits of the island. These waters furnished our table
|
|
with excellent fish, mackerel, bonitos, and some varieties
|
|
of a sea-serpent.
|
|
|
|
On the 25th of December the Nautilus sailed into the midst of the
|
|
New Hebrides, discovered by Quiros in 1606, and that Bougainville
|
|
explored in 1768, and to which Cook gave its present name in 1773.
|
|
This group is composed principally of nine large islands, that form
|
|
a band of 120 leagues N.N.S. to S.S.W., between 15@ and 2@ S. lat.,
|
|
and 164@ and 168@ long. We passed tolerably near to the Island of Aurou,
|
|
that at noon looked like a mass of green woods, surmounted by a peak
|
|
of great height.
|
|
|
|
That day being Christmas Day, Ned Land seemed to regret sorely
|
|
the non-celebration of "Christmas," the family fete of which
|
|
Protestants are so fond. I had not seen Captain Nemo for a week,
|
|
when, on the morning of the 27th, he came into the large drawing-room,
|
|
always seeming as if he had seen you five minutes before.
|
|
I was busily tracing the route of the Nautilus on the planisphere.
|
|
The Captain came up to me, put his finger on one spot on the chart,
|
|
and said this single word.
|
|
|
|
"Vanikoro."
|
|
|
|
The effect was magical! It was the name of the islands on which La
|
|
Perouse had been lost! I rose suddenly.
|
|
|
|
"The Nautilus has brought us to Vanikoro?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Professor," said the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"And I can visit the celebrated islands where the Boussole
|
|
and the Astrolabe struck?"
|
|
|
|
"If you like, Professor."
|
|
|
|
"When shall we be there?"
|
|
|
|
"We are there now."
|
|
|
|
Followed by Captain Nemo, I went up on to the platform,
|
|
and greedily scanned the horizon.
|
|
|
|
To the N.E. two volcanic islands emerged of unequal size,
|
|
surrounded by a coral reef that measured forty miles in circumference.
|
|
We were close to Vanikoro, really the one to which Dumont d'Urville
|
|
gave the name of Isle de la Recherche, and exactly facing the little
|
|
harbour of Vanou, situated in 16@ 4' S. lat., and 164@ 32' E. long.
|
|
The earth seemed covered with verdure from the shore to the summits
|
|
in the interior, that were crowned by Mount Kapogo, 476 feet high.
|
|
The Nautilus, having passed the outer belt of rocks by a narrow strait,
|
|
found itself among breakers where the sea was from thirty to forty
|
|
fathoms deep. Under the verdant shade of some mangroves I perceived
|
|
some savages, who appeared greatly surprised at our approach.
|
|
In the long black body, moving between wind and water, did they not see
|
|
some formidable cetacean that they regarded with suspicion?
|
|
|
|
Just then Captain Nemo asked me what I knew about the wreck of La Perouse.
|
|
|
|
"Only what everyone knows, Captain," I replied.
|
|
|
|
"And could you tell me what everyone knows about it?"
|
|
he inquired, ironically.
|
|
|
|
"Easily."
|
|
|
|
I related to him all that the last works of Dumont d'Urville had made known--
|
|
works from which the following is a brief account.
|
|
|
|
La Perouse, and his second, Captain de Langle, were sent
|
|
by Louis XVI, in 1785, on a voyage of circumnavigation.
|
|
They embarked in the corvettes Boussole and the Astrolabe,
|
|
neither of which were again heard of. In 1791, the French
|
|
Government, justly uneasy as to the fate of these two sloops,
|
|
manned two large merchantmen, the Recherche and the Esperance,
|
|
which left Brest the 28th of September under the command
|
|
of Bruni d'Entrecasteaux.
|
|
|
|
Two months after, they learned from Bowen, commander of the Albemarle,
|
|
that the debris of shipwrecked vessels had been seen on the coasts
|
|
of New Georgia. But D'Entrecasteaux, ignoring this communication--
|
|
rather uncertain, besides--directed his course towards the Admiralty Islands,
|
|
mentioned in a report of Captain Hunter's as being the place where La
|
|
Perouse was wrecked.
|
|
|
|
They sought in vain. The Esperance and the Recherche passed before Vanikoro
|
|
without stopping there, and, in fact, this voyage was most disastrous,
|
|
as it cost D'Entrecasteaux his life, and those of two of his lieutenants,
|
|
besides several of his crew.
|
|
|
|
Captain Dillon, a shrewd old Pacific sailor, was the first to find
|
|
unmistakable traces of the wrecks. On the 15th of May, 1824, his vessel,
|
|
the St. Patrick, passed close to Tikopia, one of the New Hebrides.
|
|
There a Lascar came alongside in a canoe, sold him the handle of a sword
|
|
in silver that bore the print of characters engraved on the hilt.
|
|
The Lascar pretended that six years before, during a stay at Vanikoro,
|
|
he had seen two Europeans that belonged to some vessels that had run
|
|
aground on the reefs some years ago.
|
|
|
|
Dillon guessed that he meant La Perouse, whose disappearance had
|
|
troubled the whole world. He tried to get on to Vanikoro, where,
|
|
according to the Lascar, he would find numerous debris of the wreck,
|
|
but winds and tides prevented him.
|
|
|
|
Dillon returned to Calcutta. There he interested the Asiatic Society
|
|
and the Indian Company in his discovery. A vessel, to which was given
|
|
the name of the Recherche, was put at his disposal, and he set out,
|
|
23rd January, 1827, accompanied by a French agent.
|
|
|
|
The Recherche, after touching at several points in the Pacific,
|
|
cast anchor before Vanikoro, 7th July, 1827, in that same harbour
|
|
of Vanou where the Nautilus was at this time.
|
|
|
|
There it collected numerous relics of the wreck--
|
|
iron utensils, anchors, pulley-strops, swivel-guns, an 18 lb.
|
|
shot, fragments of astronomical instruments, a piece of crown work,
|
|
and a bronze clock, bearing this inscription--"Bazin m'a fait,"
|
|
the mark of the foundry of the arsenal at Brest about 1785.
|
|
There could be no further doubt.
|
|
|
|
Dillon, having made all inquiries, stayed in the unlucky place till October.
|
|
Then he quitted Vanikoro, and directed his course towards New Zealand;
|
|
put into Calcutta, 7th April, 1828, and returned to France, where he was
|
|
warmly welcomed by Charles X.
|
|
|
|
But at the same time, without knowing Dillon's movements,
|
|
Dumont d'Urville had already set out to find the scene of the wreck.
|
|
And they had learned from a whaler that some medals and a cross of St. Louis
|
|
had been found in the hands of some savages of Louisiade and New Caledonia.
|
|
Dumont d'Urville, commander of the Astrolabe, had then sailed,
|
|
and two months after Dillon had left Vanikoro he put into Hobart Town.
|
|
There he learned the results of Dillon's inquiries, and found that a certain
|
|
James Hobbs, second lieutenant of the Union of Calcutta, after landing
|
|
on an island situated 8@ 18' S. lat., and 156@ 30' E. long., had seen
|
|
some iron bars and red stuffs used by the natives of these parts.
|
|
Dumont d'Urville, much perplexed, and not knowing how to credit the reports
|
|
of low-class journals, decided to follow Dillon's track.
|
|
|
|
On the 10th of February, 1828, the Astrolabe appeared off Tikopia,
|
|
and took as guide and interpreter a deserter found on the island;
|
|
made his way to Vanikoro, sighted it on the 12th inst., lay among
|
|
the reefs until the 14th, and not until the 20th did he cast anchor
|
|
within the barrier in the harbour of Vanou.
|
|
|
|
On the 23rd, several officers went round the island and brought
|
|
back some unimportant trifles. The natives, adopting a system
|
|
of denials and evasions, refused to take them to the unlucky place.
|
|
This ambiguous conduct led them to believe that the natives had
|
|
ill-treated the castaways, and indeed they seemed to fear that Dumont
|
|
d'Urville had come to avenge La Perouse and his unfortunate crew.
|
|
|
|
However, on the 26th, appeased by some presents, and understanding that they
|
|
had no reprisals to fear, they led M. Jacquireot to the scene of the wreck.
|
|
|
|
There, in three or four fathoms of water, between the reefs
|
|
of Pacou and Vanou, lay anchors, cannons, pigs of lead and iron,
|
|
embedded in the limy concretions. The large boat and the whaler
|
|
belonging to the Astrolabe were sent to this place, and, not without
|
|
some difficulty, their crews hauled up an anchor weighing 1,800
|
|
lbs., a brass gun, some pigs of iron, and two copper swivel-guns.
|
|
|
|
Dumont d'Urville, questioning the natives, learned too that La Perouse,
|
|
after losing both his vessels on the reefs of this island,
|
|
had constructed a smaller boat, only to be lost a second time.
|
|
Where, no one knew.
|
|
|
|
But the French Government, fearing that Dumont d'Urville was
|
|
not acquainted with Dillon's movements, had sent the sloop
|
|
Bayonnaise, commanded by Legoarant de Tromelin, to Vanikoro,
|
|
which had been stationed on the west coast of America.
|
|
The Bayonnaise cast her anchor before Vanikoro some months
|
|
after the departure of the Astrolabe, but found no new document;
|
|
but stated that the savages had respected the monument to La Perouse.
|
|
That is the substance of what I told Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"So," he said, "no one knows now where the third vessel perished
|
|
that was constructed by the castaways on the island of Vanikoro?"
|
|
|
|
"No one knows."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo said nothing, but signed to me to follow him into
|
|
the large saloon. The Nautilus sank several yards below the waves,
|
|
and the panels were opened.
|
|
|
|
I hastened to the aperture, and under the crustations of coral,
|
|
covered with fungi, I recognised certain debris that the drags had
|
|
not been able to tear up--iron stirrups, anchors, cannons, bullets,
|
|
capstan fittings, the stem of a ship, all objects clearly proving
|
|
the wreck of some vessel, and now carpeted with living flowers.
|
|
While I was looking on this desolate scene, Captain Nemo said,
|
|
in a sad voice:
|
|
|
|
{this above para was edited}
|
|
|
|
"Commander La Perouse set out 7th December, 1785, with his vessels
|
|
La Boussole and the Astrolabe. He first cast anchor at Botany Bay,
|
|
visited the Friendly Isles, New Caledonia, then directed his course
|
|
towards Santa Cruz, and put into Namouka, one of the Hapai group.
|
|
Then his vessels struck on the unknown reefs of Vanikoro.
|
|
The Boussole, which went first, ran aground on the southerly coast.
|
|
The Astrolabe went to its help, and ran aground too. The first vessel
|
|
was destroyed almost immediately. The second, stranded under the wind,
|
|
resisted some days. The natives made the castaways welcome.
|
|
They installed themselves in the island, and constructed a smaller boat
|
|
with the debris of the two large ones. Some sailors stayed willingly
|
|
at Vanikoro; the others, weak and ill, set out with La Perouse.
|
|
They directed their course towards the Solomon Islands, and there perished,
|
|
with everything, on the westerly coast of the chief island of the group,
|
|
between Capes Deception and Satisfaction."
|
|
|
|
"How do you know that?"
|
|
|
|
"By this, that I found on the spot where was the last wreck."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo showed me a tin-plate box, stamped with the French arms,
|
|
and corroded by the salt water. He opened it, and I saw a bundle of papers,
|
|
yellow but still readable.
|
|
|
|
They were the instructions of the naval minister to Commander La Perouse,
|
|
annotated in the margin in Louis XVI's handwriting.
|
|
|
|
"Ah! it is a fine death for a sailor!" said Captain Nemo, at last.
|
|
"A coral tomb makes a quiet grave; and I trust that I and my comrades
|
|
will find no other."
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XIX
|
|
|
|
TORRES STRAITS
|
|
|
|
During the night of the 27th or 28th of December,
|
|
the Nautilus left the shores of Vanikoro with great speed.
|
|
Her course was south-westerly, and in three days she had gone
|
|
over the 750 leagues that separated it from La Perouse's group
|
|
and the south-east point of Papua.
|
|
|
|
Early on the 1st of January, 1863, Conseil joined me on the platform.
|
|
|
|
"Master, will you permit me to wish you a happy New Year?"
|
|
|
|
"What! Conseil; exactly as if I was at Paris in my study
|
|
at the Jardin des Plantes? Well, I accept your good wishes,
|
|
and thank you for them. Only, I will ask you what you mean
|
|
by a `Happy New Year' under our circumstances? Do you mean
|
|
the year that will bring us to the end of our imprisonment,
|
|
or the year that sees us continue this strange voyage?"
|
|
|
|
"Really, I do not know how to answer, master. We are sure to see
|
|
curious things, and for the last two months we have not had time
|
|
for dullness. The last marvel is always the most astonishing;
|
|
and, if we continue this progression, I do not know how it will end.
|
|
It is my opinion that we shall never again see the like.
|
|
I think then, with no offence to master, that a happy year would be
|
|
one in which we could see everything."
|
|
|
|
On 2nd January we had made 11,340 miles, or 5,250
|
|
French leagues, since our starting-point in the Japan Seas.
|
|
Before the ship's head stretched the dangerous shores
|
|
of the coral sea, on the north-east coast of Australia.
|
|
Our boat lay along some miles from the redoubtable bank
|
|
on which Cook's vessel was lost, 10th June, 1770. The boat
|
|
in which Cook was struck on a rock, and, if it did not sink,
|
|
it was owing to a piece of coral that was broken by the shock,
|
|
and fixed itself in the broken keel.
|
|
|
|
I had wished to visit the reef, 360 leagues long, against which the sea,
|
|
always rough, broke with great violence, with a noise like thunder.
|
|
But just then the inclined planes drew the Nautilus down to a great depth,
|
|
and I could see nothing of the high coral walls. I had to content
|
|
myself with the different specimens of fish brought up by the nets.
|
|
I remarked, among others, some germons, a species of mackerel as large
|
|
as a tunny, with bluish sides, and striped with transverse bands,
|
|
that disappear with the animal's life. These fish followed us in shoals,
|
|
and furnished us with very delicate food. We took also a large number
|
|
of giltheads, about one and a half inches long, tasting like dorys;
|
|
and flying fire-fish like submarine swallows, which, in dark nights,
|
|
light alternately the air and water with their phosphorescent light.{2
|
|
sentences missing here}
|
|
|
|
Two days after crossing the coral sea, 4th January, we sighted
|
|
the Papuan coasts. On this occasion, Captain Nemo informed me that his
|
|
intention was to get into the Indian Ocean by the Strait of Torres.
|
|
His communication ended there.
|
|
|
|
The Torres Straits are nearly thirty-four leagues wide; but they are
|
|
obstructed by an innumerable quantity of islands, islets, breakers,
|
|
and rocks, that make its navigation almost impracticable;
|
|
so that Captain Nemo took all needful precautions to cross them.
|
|
The Nautilus, floating betwixt wind and water, went at a moderate pace.
|
|
Her screw, like a cetacean's tail, beat the waves slowly.
|
|
|
|
Profiting by this, I and my two companions went up on to the
|
|
deserted platform. Before us was the steersman's cage, and I expected
|
|
that Captain Nemo was there directing the course of the Nautilus.
|
|
I had before me the excellent charts of the Straits of Torres, and I
|
|
consulted them attentively. Round the Nautilus the sea dashed furiously.
|
|
The course of the waves, that went from south-east to north-west at
|
|
the rate of two and a half miles, broke on the coral that showed itself
|
|
here and there.
|
|
|
|
"This is a bad sea!" remarked Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"Detestable indeed, and one that does not suit a boat like the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"The Captain must be very sure of his route, for I see there pieces of coral
|
|
that would do for its keel if it only touched them slightly."
|
|
|
|
Indeed the situation was dangerous, but the Nautilus seemed to slide
|
|
like magic off these rocks. It did not follow the routes of the
|
|
Astrolabe and the Zelee exactly, for they proved fatal to Dumont
|
|
d'Urville. It bore more northwards, coasted the Islands of Murray,
|
|
and came back to the south-west towards Cumberland Passage.
|
|
I thought it was going to pass it by, when, going back to north-west,
|
|
it went through a large quantity of islands and islets little known,
|
|
towards the Island Sound and Canal Mauvais.
|
|
|
|
I wondered if Captain Nemo, foolishly imprudent, would steer his
|
|
vessel into that pass where Dumont d'Urville's two corvettes touched;
|
|
when, swerving again, and cutting straight through to the west,
|
|
he steered for the Island of Gilboa.
|
|
|
|
It was then three in the afternoon. The tide began to recede,
|
|
being quite full. The Nautilus approached the island, that I
|
|
still saw, with its remarkable border of screw-pines. He stood off
|
|
it at about two miles distant. Suddenly a shock overthrew me.
|
|
The Nautilus just touched a rock, and stayed immovable,
|
|
laying lightly to port side.
|
|
|
|
When I rose, I perceived Captain Nemo and his lieutenant on the platform.
|
|
They were examining the situation of the vessel, and exchanging words in
|
|
their incomprehensible dialect.
|
|
|
|
She was situated thus: Two miles, on the starboard side,
|
|
appeared Gilboa, stretching from north to west like an immense arm.
|
|
Towards the south and east some coral showed itself, left by the ebb.
|
|
We had run aground, and in one of those seas where the tides
|
|
are middling--a sorry matter for the floating of the Nautilus.
|
|
However, the vessel had not suffered, for her keel was solidly joined.
|
|
But, if she could neither glide off nor move, she ran the risk
|
|
of being for ever fastened to these rocks, and then Captain Nemo's
|
|
submarine vessel would be done for.
|
|
|
|
I was reflecting thus, when the Captain, cool and calm,
|
|
always master of himself, approached me.
|
|
|
|
"An accident?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"No; an incident."
|
|
|
|
"But an incident that will oblige you perhaps to become an inhabitant
|
|
of this land from which you flee?"
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo looked at me curiously, and made a negative gesture, as much
|
|
as to say that nothing would force him to set foot on terra firma again.
|
|
Then he said:
|
|
|
|
"Besides, M. Aronnax, the Nautilus is not lost; it will
|
|
carry you yet into the midst of the marvels of the ocean.
|
|
Our voyage is only begun, and I do not wish to be deprived so soon
|
|
of the honour of your company."
|
|
|
|
"However, Captain Nemo," I replied, without noticing the ironical
|
|
turn of his phrase, "the Nautilus ran aground in open sea.
|
|
Now the tides are not strong in the Pacific; and, if you cannot
|
|
lighten the Nautilus, I do not see how it will be reinflated."
|
|
|
|
"The tides are not strong in the Pacific: you are right there,
|
|
Professor; but in Torres Straits one finds still a difference
|
|
of a yard and a half between the level of high and low seas.
|
|
To-day is 4th January, and in five days the moon will be full.
|
|
Now, I shall be very much astonished if that satellite does
|
|
not raise these masses of water sufficiently, and render me
|
|
a service that I should be indebted to her for."
|
|
|
|
Having said this, Captain Nemo, followed by his lieutenant,
|
|
redescended to the interior of the Nautilus. As to the vessel,
|
|
it moved not, and was immovable, as if the coralline polypi had
|
|
already walled it up with their in destructible cement.
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir?" said Ned Land, who came up to me after the departure
|
|
of the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"Well, friend Ned, we will wait patiently for the tide on the 9th instant;
|
|
for it appears that the moon will have the goodness to put it off again."
|
|
|
|
"Really?"
|
|
|
|
"Really."
|
|
|
|
"And this Captain is not going to cast anchor at all since the tide
|
|
will suffice?" said Conseil, simply.
|
|
|
|
The Canadian looked at Conseil, then shrugged his shoulders.
|
|
|
|
"Sir, you may believe me when I tell you that this piece of iron will navigate
|
|
neither on nor under the sea again; it is only fit to be sold for its weight.
|
|
I think, therefore, that the time has come to part company with Captain Nemo."
|
|
|
|
"Friend Ned, I do not despair of this stout Nautilus, as you do;
|
|
and in four days we shall know what to hold to on the Pacific tides.
|
|
Besides, flight might be possible if we were in sight of the English
|
|
or Provencal coast; but on the Papuan shores, it is another thing;
|
|
and it will be time enough to come to that extremity if the Nautilus
|
|
does not recover itself again, which I look upon as a grave event."
|
|
|
|
"But do they know, at least, how to act circumspectly? There is an island;
|
|
on that island there are trees; under those trees, terrestrial animals,
|
|
bearers of cutlets and roast beef, to which I would willingly give a trial."
|
|
|
|
"In this, friend Ned is right," said Conseil, "and I agree with him.
|
|
Could not master obtain permission from his friend Captain Nemo to put us
|
|
on land, if only so as not to lose the habit of treading on the solid parts
|
|
of our planet?"
|
|
|
|
"I can ask him, but he will refuse."
|
|
|
|
"Will master risk it?" asked Conseil, "and we shall know how to rely
|
|
upon the Captain's amiability."
|
|
|
|
To my great surprise, Captain Nemo gave me the permission I asked for,
|
|
and he gave it very agreeably, without even exacting from me a promise
|
|
to return to the vessel; but flight across New Guinea might be
|
|
very perilous, and I should not have counselled Ned Land to attempt it.
|
|
Better to be a prisoner on board the Nautilus than to fall into the hands
|
|
of the natives.
|
|
|
|
At eight o'clock, armed with guns and hatchets, we got off the Nautilus.
|
|
The sea was pretty calm; a slight breeze blew on land.
|
|
Conseil and I rowing, we sped along quickly, and Ned steered
|
|
in the straight passage that the breakers left between them.
|
|
The boat was well handled, and moved rapidly.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land could not restrain his joy. He was like a prisoner that had escaped
|
|
from prison, and knew not that it was necessary to re-enter it.
|
|
|
|
"Meat! We are going to eat some meat; and what meat!" he replied.
|
|
"Real game! no, bread, indeed."
|
|
|
|
"I do not say that fish is not good; we must not abuse it;
|
|
but a piece of fresh venison, grilled on live coals,
|
|
will agreeably vary our ordinary course."
|
|
|
|
"Glutton!" said Conseil, "he makes my mouth water."
|
|
|
|
"It remains to be seen," I said, "if these forests are full of game,
|
|
and if the game is not such as will hunt the hunter himself."
|
|
|
|
"Well said, M. Aronnax," replied the Canadian, whose teeth seemed
|
|
sharpened like the edge of a hatchet; "but I will eat tiger--
|
|
loin of tiger--if there is no other quadruped on this island."
|
|
|
|
"Friend Ned is uneasy about it," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Whatever it may be," continued Ned Land, "every animal with four
|
|
paws without feathers, or with two paws without feathers,
|
|
will be saluted by my first shot."
|
|
|
|
"Very well! Master Land's imprudences are beginning."
|
|
|
|
"Never fear, M. Aronnax," replied the Canadian; "I do not want
|
|
twenty-five minutes to offer you a dish, of my sort."
|
|
|
|
At half-past eight the Nautilus boat ran softly aground
|
|
on a heavy sand, after having happily passed the coral reef
|
|
that surrounds the Island of Gilboa.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XX
|
|
|
|
A FEW DAYS ON LAND
|
|
|
|
I was much impressed on touching land. Ned Land tried
|
|
the soil with his feet, as if to take possession of it.
|
|
However, it was only two months before that we had become,
|
|
according to Captain Nemo, "passengers on board the Nautilus,"
|
|
but, in reality, prisoners of its commander.
|
|
|
|
In a few minutes we were within musket-shot of the coast.
|
|
The whole horizon was hidden behind a beautiful curtain of forests.
|
|
Enormous trees, the trunks of which attained a height of 200 feet,
|
|
were tied to each other by garlands of bindweed, real natural
|
|
hammocks, which a light breeze rocked. They were mimosas,
|
|
figs, hibisci, and palm trees, mingled together in profusion;
|
|
and under the shelter of their verdant vault grew orchids,
|
|
leguminous plants, and ferns.
|
|
|
|
But, without noticing all these beautiful specimens of Papuan flora,
|
|
the Canadian abandoned the agreeable for the useful.
|
|
He discovered a coco-tree, beat down some of the fruit, broke them,
|
|
and we drunk the milk and ate the nut with a satisfaction that
|
|
protested against the ordinary food on the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
"Excellent!" said Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"Exquisite!" replied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"And I do not think," said the Canadian, "that he would object
|
|
to our introducing a cargo of coco-nuts on board."
|
|
|
|
"I do not think he would, but he would not taste them."
|
|
|
|
"So much the worse for him," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"And so much the better for us," replied Ned Land.
|
|
"There will be more for us."
|
|
|
|
"One word only, Master Land," I said to the harpooner, who was
|
|
beginning to ravage another coco-nut tree. "Coco-nuts are good things,
|
|
but before filling the canoe with them it would be wise to reconnoitre
|
|
and see if the island does not produce some substance not less useful.
|
|
Fresh vegetables would be welcome on board the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"Master is right," replied Conseil; "and I propose to reserve three places
|
|
in our vessel, one for fruits, the other for vegetables, and the third
|
|
for the venison, of which I have not yet seen the smallest specimen."
|
|
|
|
"Conseil, we must not despair," said the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Let us continue," I returned, "and lie in wait. Although the island
|
|
seems uninhabited, it might still contain some individuals that would
|
|
be less hard than we on the nature of game."
|
|
|
|
"Ho! ho!" said Ned Land, moving his jaws significantly.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Ned!" said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"My word!" returned the Canadian, "I begin to understand
|
|
the charms of anthropophagy."
|
|
|
|
"Ned! Ned! what are you saying? You, a man-eater? I should
|
|
not feel safe with you, especially as I share your cabin.
|
|
I might perhaps wake one day to find myself half devoured."
|
|
|
|
"Friend Conseil, I like you much, but not enough to eat you unnecessarily."
|
|
|
|
"I would not trust you," replied Conseil. "But enough.
|
|
We must absolutely bring down some game to satisfy this cannibal,
|
|
or else one of these fine mornings, master will find only pieces
|
|
of his servant to serve him."
|
|
|
|
While we were talking thus, we were penetrating the sombre arches
|
|
of the forest, and for two hours we surveyed it in all directions.
|
|
|
|
Chance rewarded our search for eatable vegetables,
|
|
and one of the most useful products of the tropical zones
|
|
furnished us with precious food that we missed on board.
|
|
I would speak of the bread-fruit tree, very abundant in the island
|
|
of Gilboa; and I remarked chiefly the variety destitute of seeds,
|
|
which bears in Malaya the name of "rima."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land knew these fruits well. He had already eaten many during his
|
|
numerous voyages, and he knew how to prepare the eatable substance.
|
|
Moreover, the sight of them excited him, and he could contain
|
|
himself no longer.
|
|
|
|
"Master," he said, "I shall die if I do not taste a little
|
|
of this bread-fruit pie."
|
|
|
|
"Taste it, friend Ned--taste it as you want. We are here
|
|
to make experiments--make them."
|
|
|
|
"It won't take long," said the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
And, provided with a lentil, he lighted a fire of dead wood that
|
|
crackled joyously. During this time, Conseil and I chose the best
|
|
fruits of the bread-fruit. Some had not then attained a sufficient
|
|
degree of maturity; and their thick skin covered a white but rather
|
|
fibrous pulp. Others, the greater number yellow and gelatinous,
|
|
waited only to be picked.
|
|
|
|
These fruits enclosed no kernel. Conseil brought a dozen to Ned Land,
|
|
who placed them on a coal fire, after having cut them in thick slices,
|
|
and while doing this repeating:
|
|
|
|
"You will see, master, how good this bread is.
|
|
More so when one has been deprived of it so long.
|
|
It is not even bread," added he, "but a delicate pastry.
|
|
You have eaten none, master?"
|
|
|
|
"No, Ned."
|
|
|
|
"Very well, prepare yourself for a juicy thing. If you do not come for more,
|
|
I am no longer the king of harpooners."
|
|
|
|
After some minutes, the part of the fruits that was exposed to the fire
|
|
was completely roasted. The interior looked like a white pasty,
|
|
a sort of soft crumb, the flavour of which was like that of an artichoke.
|
|
|
|
It must be confessed this bread was excellent, and I ate of it
|
|
with great relish.
|
|
|
|
"What time is it now?" asked the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Two o'clock at least," replied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"How time flies on firm ground!" sighed Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"Let us be off," replied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
We returned through the forest, and completed our collection by a raid
|
|
upon the cabbage-palms, that we gathered from the tops of the trees,
|
|
little beans that I recognised as the "abrou" of the Malays, and yams
|
|
of a superior quality.
|
|
|
|
We were loaded when we reached the boat. But Ned Land did not
|
|
find his provisions sufficient. Fate, however, favoured us.
|
|
Just as we were pushing off, he perceived several trees,
|
|
from twenty-five to thirty feet high, a species of palm-tree.
|
|
|
|
At last, at five o'clock in the evening, loaded with our riches,
|
|
we quitted the shore, and half an hour after we hailed the Nautilus.
|
|
No one appeared on our arrival. The enormous iron-plated cylinder
|
|
seemed deserted. The provisions embarked, I descended to my chamber,
|
|
and after supper slept soundly.
|
|
|
|
The next day, 6th January, nothing new on board.
|
|
Not a sound inside, not a sign of life. The boat rested
|
|
along the edge, in the same place in which we had left it.
|
|
We resolved to return to the island. Ned Land hoped to be
|
|
more fortunate than on the day before with regard to the hunt,
|
|
and wished to visit another part of the forest.
|
|
|
|
At dawn we set off. The boat, carried on by the waves that flowed to shore,
|
|
reached the island in a few minutes.
|
|
|
|
We landed, and, thinking that it was better to give in to the Canadian,
|
|
we followed Ned Land, whose long limbs threatened to distance us.
|
|
He wound up the coast towards the west: then, fording some torrents,
|
|
he gained the high plain that was bordered with admirable forests.
|
|
Some kingfishers were rambling along the water-courses, but they would
|
|
not let themselves be approached. Their circumspection proved to me
|
|
that these birds knew what to expect from bipeds of our species, and I
|
|
concluded that, if the island was not inhabited, at least human beings
|
|
occasionally frequented it.
|
|
|
|
After crossing a rather large prairie, we arrived at the skirts of a little
|
|
wood that was enlivened by the songs and flight of a large number of birds.
|
|
|
|
"There are only birds," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"But they are eatable," replied the harpooner.
|
|
|
|
"I do not agree with you, friend Ned, for I see only parrots there."
|
|
|
|
"Friend Conseil," said Ned, gravely, "the parrot is like pheasant
|
|
to those who have nothing else."
|
|
|
|
"And," I added, "this bird, suitably prepared, is worth knife and fork."
|
|
|
|
Indeed, under the thick foliage of this wood, a world of parrots
|
|
were flying from branch to branch, only needing a careful
|
|
education to speak the human language. For the moment, they were
|
|
chattering with parrots of all colours, and grave cockatoos,
|
|
who seemed to meditate upon some philosophical problem,
|
|
whilst brilliant red lories passed like a piece of bunting carried
|
|
away by the breeze, papuans, with the finest azure colours,
|
|
and in all a variety of winged things most charming to behold,
|
|
but few eatable.
|
|
|
|
However, a bird peculiar to these lands, and which has never passed
|
|
the limits of the Arrow and Papuan islands, was wanting in this collection.
|
|
But fortune reserved it for me before long.
|
|
|
|
After passing through a moderately thick copse, we found a plain
|
|
obstructed with bushes. I saw then those magnificent birds,
|
|
the disposition of whose long feathers obliges them to fly against
|
|
the wind. Their undulating flight, graceful aerial curves,
|
|
and the shading of their colours, attracted and charmed one's looks.
|
|
I had no trouble in recognising them.
|
|
|
|
"Birds of paradise!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
The Malays, who carry on a great trade in these birds with the Chinese,
|
|
have several means that we could not employ for taking them.
|
|
Sometimes they put snares on the top of high trees that the birds
|
|
of paradise prefer to frequent. Sometimes they catch them with a
|
|
viscous birdlime that paralyses their movements. They even go so far
|
|
as to poison the fountains that the birds generally drink from.
|
|
But we were obliged to fire at them during flight, which gave us few
|
|
chances to bring them down; and, indeed, we vainly exhausted one
|
|
half our ammunition.
|
|
|
|
About eleven o'clock in the morning, the first range of mountains that form
|
|
the centre of the island was traversed, and we had killed nothing.
|
|
Hunger drove us on. The hunters had relied on the products of the chase,
|
|
and they were wrong. Happily Conseil, to his great surprise,
|
|
made a double shot and secured breakfast. He brought down a white pigeon
|
|
and a wood-pigeon, which, cleverly plucked and suspended from a skewer,
|
|
was roasted before a red fire of dead wood. While these interesting
|
|
birds were cooking, Ned prepared the fruit of the bread-tree. Then
|
|
the wood-pigeons were devoured to the bones, and declared excellent.
|
|
The nutmeg, with which they are in the habit of stuffing their crops,
|
|
flavours their flesh and renders it delicious eating.
|
|
|
|
"Now, Ned, what do you miss now?"
|
|
|
|
"Some four-footed game, M. Aronnax. All these pigeons are only
|
|
side-dishes and trifles; and until I have killed an animal
|
|
with cutlets I shall not be content."
|
|
|
|
"Nor I, Ned, if I do not catch a bird of paradise."
|
|
|
|
"Let us continue hunting," replied Conseil. "Let us go towards the sea.
|
|
We have arrived at the first declivities of the mountains, and I think we had
|
|
better regain the region of forests."
|
|
|
|
That was sensible advice, and was followed out.
|
|
After walking for one hour we had attained a forest of
|
|
sago-trees. Some inoffensive serpents glided away from us.
|
|
The birds of paradise fled at our approach, and truly I despaired
|
|
of getting near one when Conseil, who was walking in front,
|
|
suddenly bent down, uttered a triumphal cry, and came back to me
|
|
bringing a magnificent specimen.
|
|
|
|
"Ah! bravo, Conseil!"
|
|
|
|
"Master is very good."
|
|
|
|
"No, my boy; you have made an excellent stroke.
|
|
Take one of these living birds, and carry it in your hand."
|
|
|
|
"If master will examine it, he will see that I have not deserved great merit."
|
|
|
|
"Why, Conseil?"
|
|
|
|
"Because this bird is as drunk as a quail."
|
|
|
|
"Drunk!"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir; drunk with the nutmegs that it devoured under
|
|
the nutmeg-tree, under which I found it. See, friend Ned,
|
|
see the monstrous effects of intemperance!"
|
|
|
|
"By Jove!" exclaimed the Canadian, "because I have drunk gin for two months,
|
|
you must needs reproach me!"
|
|
|
|
However, I examined the curious bird. Conseil was right.
|
|
The bird, drunk with the juice, was quite powerless. It could
|
|
not fly; it could hardly walk.
|
|
|
|
This bird belonged to the most beautiful of the eight species
|
|
that are found in Papua and in the neighbouring islands.
|
|
It was the "large emerald bird, the most rare kind."
|
|
It measured three feet in length. Its head was comparatively small,
|
|
its eyes placed near the opening of the beak, and also small.
|
|
But the shades of colour were beautiful, having a yellow beak,
|
|
brown feet and claws, nut-coloured wings with purple tips,
|
|
pale yellow at the back of the neck and head, and emerald
|
|
colour at the throat, chestnut on the breast and belly.
|
|
Two horned, downy nets rose from below the tail, that prolonged
|
|
the long light feathers of admirable fineness, and they
|
|
completed the whole of this marvellous bird, that the natives
|
|
have poetically named the "bird of the sun."
|
|
|
|
But if my wishes were satisfied by the possession of the bird
|
|
of paradise, the Canadian's were not yet. Happily, about two
|
|
o'clock, Ned Land brought down a magnificent hog; from the brood
|
|
of those the natives call "bari-outang." The animal came in time
|
|
for us to procure real quadruped meat, and he was well received.
|
|
Ned Land was very proud of his shot. The hog, hit by the electric ball,
|
|
fell stone dead. The Canadian skinned and cleaned it properly,
|
|
after having taken half a dozen cutlets, destined to furnish us
|
|
with a grilled repast in the evening. Then the hunt was resumed,
|
|
which was still more marked by Ned and Conseil's exploits.
|
|
|
|
Indeed, the two friends, beating the bushes, roused a herd
|
|
of kangaroos that fled and bounded along on their elastic paws.
|
|
But these animals did not take to flight so rapidly but what
|
|
the electric capsule could stop their course.
|
|
|
|
"Ah, Professor!" cried Ned Land, who was carried away by the
|
|
delights of the chase, "what excellent game, and stewed, too!
|
|
What a supply for the Nautilus! Two! three! five down!
|
|
And to think that we shall eat that flesh, and that the idiots on
|
|
board shall not have a crumb!"
|
|
|
|
I think that, in the excess of his joy, the Canadian,
|
|
if he had not talked so much, would have killed them all.
|
|
But he contented himself with a single dozen of these
|
|
interesting marsupians. These animals were small.
|
|
They were a species of those "kangaroo rabbits" that live
|
|
habitually in the hollows of trees, and whose speed is extreme;
|
|
but they are moderately fat, and furnish, at least, estimable food.
|
|
We were very satisfied with the results of the hunt.
|
|
Happy Ned proposed to return to this enchanting island the next day,
|
|
for he wished to depopulate it of all the eatable quadrupeds.
|
|
But he had reckoned without his host.
|
|
|
|
At six o'clock in the evening we had regained the shore;
|
|
our boat was moored to the usual place. The Nautilus, like a
|
|
long rock, emerged from the waves two miles from the beach.
|
|
Ned Land, without waiting, occupied himself about the important
|
|
dinner business. He understood all about cooking well.
|
|
The "bari-outang," grilled on the coals, soon scented the air with
|
|
a delicious odour.
|
|
|
|
Indeed, the dinner was excellent. Two wood-pigeons
|
|
completed this extraordinary menu. The sago pasty,
|
|
the artocarpus bread, some mangoes, half a dozen pineapples,
|
|
and the liquor fermented from some coco-nuts, overjoyed us.
|
|
I even think that my worthy companions' ideas had not all
|
|
the plainness desirable.
|
|
|
|
"Suppose we do not return to the Nautilus this evening?" said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Suppose we never return?" added Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
Just then a stone fell at our feet and cut short the harpooner's proposition.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XXI
|
|
|
|
CAPTAIN NEMO'S THUNDERBOLT
|
|
|
|
We looked at the edge of the forest without rising,
|
|
my hand stopping in the action of putting it to my mouth,
|
|
Ned Land's completing its office.
|
|
|
|
"Stones do not fall from the sky," remarked Conseil, "or they
|
|
would merit the name aerolites."
|
|
|
|
A second stone, carefully aimed, that made a savoury pigeon's leg
|
|
fall from Conseil's hand, gave still more weight to his observation.
|
|
We all three arose, shouldered our guns, and were ready to reply
|
|
to any attack.
|
|
|
|
"Are they apes?" cried Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"Very nearly--they are savages."
|
|
|
|
"To the boat!" I said, hurrying to the sea.
|
|
|
|
It was indeed necessary to beat a retreat, for about twenty natives
|
|
armed with bows and slings appeared on the skirts of a copse that masked
|
|
the horizon to the right, hardly a hundred steps from us.
|
|
|
|
Our boat was moored about sixty feet from us. The savages
|
|
approached us, not running, but making hostile demonstrations.
|
|
Stones and arrows fell thickly.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land had not wished to leave his provisions; and, in spite of his
|
|
imminent danger, his pig on one side and kangaroos on the other,
|
|
he went tolerably fast. In two minutes we were on the shore.
|
|
To load the boat with provisions and arms, to push it out
|
|
to sea, and ship the oars, was the work of an instant.
|
|
We had not gone two cable-lengths, when a hundred savages,
|
|
howling and gesticulating, entered the water up to their waists.
|
|
I watched to see if their apparition would attract some men from
|
|
the Nautilus on to the platform. But no. The enormous machine,
|
|
lying off, was absolutely deserted.
|
|
|
|
Twenty minutes later we were on board. The panels were open.
|
|
After making the boat fast, we entered into the interior
|
|
of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
I descended to the drawing-room, from whence I heard some chords.
|
|
Captain Nemo was there, bending over his organ, and plunged in
|
|
a musical ecstasy.
|
|
|
|
"Captain!"
|
|
|
|
He did not hear me.
|
|
|
|
"Captain!" I said, touching his hand.
|
|
|
|
He shuddered, and, turning round, said, "Ah! it is you, Professor?
|
|
Well, have you had a good hunt, have you botanised successfully?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes Captain; but we have unfortunately brought a troop of bipeds,
|
|
whose vicinity troubles me."
|
|
|
|
"What bipeds?"
|
|
|
|
"Savages."
|
|
|
|
"Savages!" he echoed, ironically. "So you are astonished, Professor,
|
|
at having set foot on a strange land and finding savages?
|
|
Savages! where are there not any? Besides, are they worse than others,
|
|
these whom you call savages?"
|
|
|
|
"But Captain----"
|
|
|
|
"How many have you counted?"
|
|
|
|
"A hundred at least."
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax," replied Captain Nemo, placing his fingers on the organ stops,
|
|
"when all the natives of Papua are assembled on this shore, the Nautilus
|
|
will have nothing to fear from their attacks."
|
|
|
|
The Captain's fingers were then running over the keys of
|
|
the instrument, and I remarked that he touched only the black keys,
|
|
which gave his melodies an essentially Scotch character.
|
|
Soon he had forgotten my presence, and had plunged into a reverie
|
|
that I did not disturb. I went up again on to the platform:
|
|
night had already fallen; for, in this low latitude,
|
|
the sun sets rapidly and without twilight. I could only see
|
|
the island indistinctly; but the numerous fires, lighted on
|
|
the beach, showed that the natives did not think of leaving it.
|
|
I was alone for several hours, sometimes thinking of the natives--
|
|
but without any dread of them, for the imperturbable
|
|
confidence of the Captain was catching--sometimes forgetting
|
|
them to admire the splendours of the night in the tropics.
|
|
My remembrances went to France in the train of those zodiacal
|
|
stars that would shine in some hours' time. The moon shone in
|
|
the midst of the constellations of the zenith.
|
|
|
|
The night slipped away without any mischance, the islanders
|
|
frightened no doubt at the sight of a monster aground in the bay.
|
|
The panels were open, and would have offered an easy access
|
|
to the interior of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
At six o'clock in the morning of the 8th January I went up
|
|
on to the platform. The dawn was breaking. The island soon
|
|
showed itself through the dissipating fogs, first the shore,
|
|
then the summits.
|
|
|
|
The natives were there, more numerous than on the day before--
|
|
five or six hundred perhaps--some of them, profiting by the low water,
|
|
had come on to the coral, at less than two cable-lengths from the Nautilus.
|
|
I distinguished them easily; they were true Papuans, with athletic figures,
|
|
men of good race, large high foreheads, large, but not broad and flat,
|
|
and white teeth. Their woolly hair, with a reddish tinge, showed off on their
|
|
black shining bodies like those of the Nubians. From the lobes of their ears,
|
|
cut and distended, hung chaplets of bones. Most of these savages were naked.
|
|
Amongst them, I remarked some women, dressed from the hips to knees
|
|
in quite a crinoline of herbs, that sustained a vegetable waistband.
|
|
Some chiefs had ornamented their necks with a crescent and collars
|
|
of glass beads, red and white; nearly all were armed with bows, arrows,
|
|
and shields and carried on their shoulders a sort of net containing
|
|
those round stones which they cast from their slings with great skill.
|
|
One of these chiefs, rather near to the Nautilus, examined it attentively.
|
|
He was, perhaps, a "mado" of high rank, for he was draped in a mat of
|
|
banana-leaves, notched round the edges, and set off with brilliant colours.
|
|
|
|
I could easily have knocked down this native, who was within a short length;
|
|
but I thought that it was better to wait for real hostile demonstrations.
|
|
Between Europeans and savages, it is proper for the Europeans to parry
|
|
sharply, not to attack.
|
|
|
|
During low water the natives roamed about near the Nautilus,
|
|
but were not troublesome; I heard them frequently repeat the word
|
|
"Assai," and by their gestures I understood that they invited me
|
|
to go on land, an invitation that I declined.
|
|
|
|
So that, on that day, the boat did not push off, to the great displeasure
|
|
of Master Land, who could not complete his provisions.
|
|
|
|
This adroit Canadian employed his time in preparing the viands
|
|
and meat that he had brought off the island. As for the savages,
|
|
they returned to the shore about eleven o'clock in the morning,
|
|
as soon as the coral tops began to disappear under the rising tide;
|
|
but I saw their numbers had increased considerably on the shore.
|
|
Probably they came from the neighbouring islands, or very likely
|
|
from Papua. However, I had not seen a single native canoe.
|
|
Having nothing better to do, I thought of dragging these beautiful
|
|
limpid waters, under which I saw a profusion of shells, zoophytes,
|
|
and marine plants. Moreover, it was the last day that the Nautilus
|
|
would pass in these parts, if it float in open sea the next day,
|
|
according to Captain Nemo's promise.
|
|
|
|
I therefore called Conseil, who brought me a little light drag,
|
|
very like those for the oyster fishery. Now to work!
|
|
For two hours we fished unceasingly, but without bringing up
|
|
any rarities. The drag was filled with midas-ears, harps, melames,
|
|
and particularly the most beautiful hammers I have ever seen.
|
|
We also brought up some sea-slugs, pearl-oysters, and a dozen little
|
|
turtles that were reserved for the pantry on board.
|
|
|
|
But just when I expected it least, I put my hand on a wonder,
|
|
I might say a natural deformity, very rarely met with.
|
|
Conseil was just dragging, and his net came up filled with
|
|
divers ordinary shells, when, all at once, he saw me plunge
|
|
my arm quickly into the net, to draw out a shell, and heard me
|
|
utter a cry.
|
|
|
|
"What is the matter, sir?" he asked in surprise.
|
|
"Has master been bitten?"
|
|
|
|
"No, my boy; but I would willingly have given a finger for my discovery."
|
|
|
|
"What discovery?"
|
|
|
|
"This shell," I said, holding up the object of my triumph.
|
|
|
|
"It is simply an olive porphyry." {genus species missing}
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Conseil; but, instead of being rolled from right to left,
|
|
this olive turns from left to right."
|
|
|
|
"Is it possible?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, my boy; it is a left shell."
|
|
|
|
Shells are all right-handed, with rare exceptions; and, when by chance
|
|
their spiral is left, amateurs are ready to pay their weight in gold.
|
|
|
|
Conseil and I were absorbed in the contemplation of our treasure,
|
|
and I was promising myself to enrich the museum with it,
|
|
when a stone unfortunately thrown by a native struck against,
|
|
and broke, the precious object in Conseil's hand.
|
|
I uttered a cry of despair! Conseil took up his gun, and aimed
|
|
at a savage who was poising his sling at ten yards from him.
|
|
I would have stopped him, but his blow took effect and broke
|
|
the bracelet of amulets which encircled the arm of the savage.
|
|
|
|
"Conseil!" cried I. "Conseil!"
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir! do you not see that the cannibal has commenced the attack?"
|
|
|
|
"A shell is not worth the life of a man," said I.
|
|
|
|
"Ah! the scoundrel!" cried Conseil; "I would rather he had
|
|
broken my shoulder!"
|
|
|
|
Conseil was in earnest, but I was not of his opinion. However, the situation
|
|
had changed some minutes before, and we had not perceived. A score of canoes
|
|
surrounded the Nautilus. These canoes, scooped out of the trunk of a tree,
|
|
long, narrow, well adapted for speed, were balanced by means of a long
|
|
bamboo pole, which floated on the water. They were managed by skilful,
|
|
half-naked paddlers, and I watched their advance with some uneasiness.
|
|
It was evident that these Papuans had already had dealings with the Europeans
|
|
and knew their ships. But this long iron cylinder anchored in the bay,
|
|
without masts or chimneys, what could they think of it? Nothing good, for at
|
|
first they kept at a respectful distance. However, seeing it motionless,
|
|
by degrees they took courage, and sought to familiarise themselves with it.
|
|
Now this familiarity was precisely what it was necessary to avoid.
|
|
Our arms, which were noiseless, could only produce a moderate effect
|
|
on the savages, who have little respect for aught but blustering things.
|
|
The thunderbolt without the reverberations of thunder would frighten man
|
|
but little, though the danger lies in the lightning, not in the noise.
|
|
|
|
At this moment the canoes approached the Nautilus, and a shower
|
|
of arrows alighted on her.
|
|
|
|
I went down to the saloon, but found no one there. I ventured
|
|
to knock at the door that opened into the Captain's room.
|
|
"Come in," was the answer.
|
|
|
|
I entered, and found Captain Nemo deep in algebraical calculations
|
|
of _x_ and other quantities.
|
|
|
|
"I am disturbing you," said I, for courtesy's sake.
|
|
|
|
"That is true, M. Aronnax," replied the Captain; "but I think
|
|
you have serious reasons for wishing to see me?"
|
|
|
|
"Very grave ones; the natives are surrounding us in their canoes,
|
|
and in a few minutes we shall certainly be attacked by many
|
|
hundreds of savages."
|
|
|
|
"Ah!," said Captain Nemo quietly, "they are come with their canoes?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir."
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir, we must close the hatches."
|
|
|
|
"Exactly, and I came to say to you----"
|
|
|
|
"Nothing can be more simple," said Captain Nemo. And, pressing an
|
|
electric button, he transmitted an order to the ship's crew.
|
|
|
|
"It is all done, sir," said he, after some moments.
|
|
"The pinnace is ready, and the hatches are closed.
|
|
You do not fear, I imagine, that these gentlemen could stave in
|
|
walls on which the balls of your frigate have had no effect?"
|
|
|
|
"No, Captain; but a danger still exists."
|
|
|
|
"What is that, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"It is that to-morrow, at about this hour, we must open the hatches
|
|
to renew the air of the Nautilus. Now, if, at this moment,
|
|
the Papuans should occupy the platform, I do not see how you
|
|
could prevent them from entering."
|
|
|
|
"Then, sir, you suppose that they will board us?"
|
|
|
|
"I am certain of it."
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir, let them come. I see no reason for hindering them.
|
|
After all, these Papuans are poor creatures, and I am unwilling
|
|
that my visit to the island should cost the life of a single one
|
|
of these wretches."
|
|
|
|
Upon that I was going away; But Captain Nemo detained me,
|
|
and asked me to sit down by him. He questioned me with interest
|
|
about our excursions on shore, and our hunting; and seemed not
|
|
to understand the craving for meat that possessed the Canadian.
|
|
Then the conversation turned on various subjects, and, without being
|
|
more communicative, Captain Nemo showed himself more amiable.
|
|
|
|
Amongst other things, we happened to speak of the situation
|
|
of the Nautilus, run aground in exactly the same spot
|
|
in this strait where Dumont d'Urville was nearly lost.
|
|
Apropos of this:
|
|
|
|
"This D'Urville was one of your great sailors," said the Captain
|
|
to me, "one of your most intelligent navigators. He is the Captain
|
|
Cook of you Frenchmen. Unfortunate man of science, after having
|
|
braved the icebergs of the South Pole, the coral reefs of Oceania,
|
|
the cannibals of the Pacific, to perish miserably in a railway train!
|
|
If this energetic man could have reflected during the last moments
|
|
of his life, what must have been uppermost in his last thoughts,
|
|
do you suppose?"
|
|
|
|
So speaking, Captain Nemo seemed moved, and his emotion
|
|
gave me a better opinion of him. Then, chart in hand,
|
|
we reviewed the travels of the French navigator, his voyages
|
|
of circumnavigation, his double detention at the South Pole,
|
|
which led to the discovery of Adelaide and Louis Philippe,
|
|
and fixing the hydrographical bearings of the principal
|
|
islands of Oceania.
|
|
|
|
"That which your D'Urville has done on the surface of the seas," said Captain
|
|
Nemo, "that have I done under them, and more easily, more completely than he.
|
|
The Astrolabe and the Zelee, incessantly tossed about by the hurricane,
|
|
could not be worth the Nautilus, quiet repository of labour that she is,
|
|
truly motionless in the midst of the waters.
|
|
|
|
"To-morrow," added the Captain, rising, "to-morrow, at twenty
|
|
minutes to three p.m., the Nautilus shall float, and leave
|
|
the Strait of Torres uninjured."
|
|
|
|
Having curtly pronounced these words, Captain Nemo bowed slightly.
|
|
This was to dismiss me, and I went back to my room.
|
|
|
|
There I found Conseil, who wished to know the result of my interview
|
|
with the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"My boy," said I, "when I feigned to believe that his Nautilus
|
|
was threatened by the natives of Papua, the Captain answered
|
|
me very sarcastically. I have but one thing to say to you:
|
|
Have confidence in him, and go to sleep in peace."
|
|
|
|
"Have you no need of my services, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"No, my friend. What is Ned Land doing?"
|
|
|
|
"If you will excuse me, sir," answered Conseil, "friend Ned is busy
|
|
making a kangaroo-pie which will be a marvel."
|
|
|
|
I remained alone and went to bed, but slept indifferently. I heard the noise
|
|
of the savages, who stamped on the platform, uttering deafening cries.
|
|
The night passed thus, without disturbing the ordinary repose of the crew.
|
|
The presence of these cannibals affected them no more than the soldiers of a
|
|
masked battery care for the ants that crawl over its front.
|
|
|
|
At six in the morning I rose. The hatches had not been opened.
|
|
The inner air was not renewed, but the reservoirs, filled ready
|
|
for any emergency, were now resorted to, and discharged several
|
|
cubic feet of oxygen into the exhausted atmosphere of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
I worked in my room till noon, without having seen Captain Nemo,
|
|
even for an instant. On board no preparations for departure were visible.
|
|
|
|
I waited still some time, then went into the large saloon.
|
|
The clock marked half-past two. In ten minutes it would be
|
|
high-tide: and, if Captain Nemo had not made a rash promise,
|
|
the Nautilus would be immediately detached. If not, many months
|
|
would pass ere she could leave her bed of coral.
|
|
|
|
However, some warning vibrations began to be felt in the vessel.
|
|
I heard the keel grating against the rough calcareous bottom of
|
|
the coral reef.
|
|
|
|
At five-and-twenty minutes to three, Captain Nemo appeared in the saloon.
|
|
|
|
"We are going to start," said he.
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" replied I.
|
|
|
|
"I have given the order to open the hatches."
|
|
|
|
"And the Papuans?"
|
|
|
|
"The Papuans?" answered Captain Nemo, slightly shrugging his shoulders.
|
|
|
|
"Will they not come inside the Nautilus?"
|
|
|
|
"How?"
|
|
|
|
"Only by leaping over the hatches you have opened."
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax," quietly answered Captain Nemo, "they will not enter
|
|
the hatches of the Nautilus in that way, even if they were open."
|
|
|
|
I looked at the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"You do not understand?" said he.
|
|
|
|
"Hardly."
|
|
|
|
"Well, come and you will see."
|
|
|
|
I directed my steps towards the central staircase. There Ned
|
|
Land and Conseil were slyly watching some of the ship's crew,
|
|
who were opening the hatches, while cries of rage and fearful
|
|
vociferations resounded outside.
|
|
|
|
The port lids were pulled down outside. Twenty horrible faces appeared.
|
|
But the first native who placed his hand on the stair-rail, struck from behind
|
|
by some invisible force, I know not what, fled, uttering the most fearful
|
|
cries and making the wildest contortions.
|
|
|
|
Ten of his companions followed him. They met with the same fate.
|
|
|
|
Conseil was in ecstasy. Ned Land, carried away by his violent instincts,
|
|
rushed on to the staircase. But the moment he seized the rail with
|
|
both hands, he, in his turn, was overthrown.
|
|
|
|
"I am struck by a thunderbolt," cried he, with an oath.
|
|
|
|
This explained all. It was no rail; but a metallic cable
|
|
charged with electricity from the deck communicating with
|
|
the platform. Whoever touched it felt a powerful shock--
|
|
and this shock would have been mortal if Captain Nemo had
|
|
discharged into the conductor the whole force of the current.
|
|
It might truly be said that between his assailants and himself
|
|
he had stretched a network of electricity which none could
|
|
pass with impunity.
|
|
|
|
Meanwhile, the exasperated Papuans had beaten a retreat paralysed
|
|
with terror. As for us, half laughing, we consoled and rubbed
|
|
the unfortunate Ned Land, who swore like one possessed.
|
|
|
|
But at this moment the Nautilus, raised by the last waves of the tide,
|
|
quitted her coral bed exactly at the fortieth minute fixed by
|
|
the Captain. Her screw swept the waters slowly and majestically.
|
|
Her speed increased gradually, and, sailing on the surface of the ocean,
|
|
she quitted safe and sound the dangerous passes of the Straits of Torres.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XXII
|
|
|
|
"AEGRI SOMNIA"
|
|
|
|
The following day 10th January, the Nautilus continued her
|
|
course between two seas, but with such remarkable speed that I
|
|
could not estimate it at less than thirty-five miles an hour.
|
|
The rapidity of her screw was such that I could neither follow
|
|
nor count its revolutions. When I reflected that this marvellous
|
|
electric agent, after having afforded motion, heat, and light
|
|
to the Nautilus, still protected her from outward attack,
|
|
and transformed her into an ark of safety which no profane
|
|
hand might touch without being thunderstricken, my admiration
|
|
was unbounded, and from the structure it extended to the engineer
|
|
who had called it into existence.
|
|
|
|
Our course was directed to the west, and on the 11th of January we doubled
|
|
Cape Wessel, situation in 135@ long. and 10@ S. lat., which forms
|
|
the east point of the Gulf of Carpentaria. The reefs were still numerous,
|
|
but more equalised, and marked on the chart with extreme precision.
|
|
The Nautilus easily avoided the breakers of Money to port and the Victoria
|
|
reefs to starboard, placed at 130@ long. and on the 10th parallel,
|
|
which we strictly followed.
|
|
|
|
On the 13th of January, Captain Nemo arrived in the Sea of Timor,
|
|
and recognised the island of that name in 122@ long.
|
|
|
|
From this point the direction of the Nautilus inclined towards
|
|
the south-west. Her head was set for the Indian Ocean.
|
|
Where would the fancy of Captain Nemo carry us next?
|
|
Would he return to the coast of Asia or would he approach
|
|
again the shores of Europe? Improbable conjectures both,
|
|
to a man who fled from inhabited continents. Then would
|
|
he descend to the south? Was he going to double the Cape
|
|
of Good Hope, then Cape Horn, and finally go as far as the
|
|
Antarctic pole? Would he come back at last to the Pacific,
|
|
where his Nautilus could sail free and independently?
|
|
Time would show.
|
|
|
|
After having skirted the sands of Cartier, of Hibernia, Seringapatam,
|
|
and Scott, last efforts of the solid against the liquid element,
|
|
on the 14th of January we lost sight of land altogether.
|
|
The speed of the Nautilus was considerably abated, and with
|
|
irregular course she sometimes swam in the bosom of the waters,
|
|
sometimes floated on their surface.
|
|
|
|
During this period of the voyage, Captain Nemo made some interesting
|
|
experiments on the varied temperature of the sea, in different beds.
|
|
Under ordinary conditions these observations are made by means of
|
|
rather complicated instruments, and with somewhat doubtful results,
|
|
by means of thermometrical sounding-leads, the glasses often breaking
|
|
under the pressure of the water, or an apparatus grounded on
|
|
the variations of the resistance of metals to the electric currents.
|
|
Results so obtained could not be correctly calculated. On the contrary,
|
|
Captain Nemo went himself to test the temperature in the depths of the sea,
|
|
and his thermometer, placed in communication with the different sheets
|
|
of water, gave him the required degree immediately and accurately.
|
|
|
|
It was thus that, either by overloading her reservoirs or by descending
|
|
obliquely by means of her inclined planes, the Nautilus successively attained
|
|
the depth of three, four, five, seven, nine, and ten thousand yards,
|
|
and the definite result of this experience was that the sea preserved
|
|
an average temperature of four degrees and a half at a depth of five
|
|
thousand fathoms under all latitudes.
|
|
|
|
On the 16th of January, the Nautilus seemed becalmed
|
|
only a few yards beneath the surface of the waves.
|
|
Her electric apparatus remained inactive and her motionless
|
|
screw left her to drift at the mercy of the currents.
|
|
I supposed that the crew was occupied with interior repairs,
|
|
rendered necessary by the violence of the mechanical movements
|
|
of the machine.
|
|
|
|
My companions and I then witnessed a curious spectacle.
|
|
The hatches of the saloon were open, and, as the beacon light
|
|
of the Nautilus was not in action, a dim obscurity reigned
|
|
in the midst of the waters. I observed the state of the sea,
|
|
under these conditions, and the largest fish appeared to me
|
|
no more than scarcely defined shadows, when the Nautilus
|
|
found herself suddenly transported into full light.
|
|
I thought at first that the beacon had been lighted,
|
|
and was casting its electric radiance into the liquid mass.
|
|
I was mistaken, and after a rapid survey perceived my error.
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus floated in the midst of a phosphorescent bed which,
|
|
in this obscurity, became quite dazzling. It was produced
|
|
by myriads of luminous animalculae, whose brilliancy was
|
|
increased as they glided over the metallic hull of the vessel.
|
|
I was surprised by lightning in the midst of these luminous sheets,
|
|
as though they bad been rivulets of lead melted in an ardent
|
|
furnace or metallic masses brought to a white heat, so that,
|
|
by force of contrast, certain portions of light appeared to cast
|
|
a shade in the midst of the general ignition, from which all
|
|
shade seemed banished. No; this was not the calm irradiation
|
|
of our ordinary lightning. There was unusual life and vigour:
|
|
this was truly living light!
|
|
|
|
In reality, it was an infinite agglomeration of coloured infusoria,
|
|
of veritable globules of jelly, provided with a threadlike tentacle,
|
|
and of which as many as twenty-five thousand have been counted in less
|
|
than two cubic half-inches of water.
|
|
|
|
During several hours the Nautilus floated in these brilliant waves,
|
|
and our admiration increased as we watched the marine monsters
|
|
disporting themselves like salamanders. I saw there in the midst
|
|
of this fire that burns not the swift and elegant porpoise
|
|
(the indefatigable clown of the ocean), and some swordfish
|
|
ten feet long, those prophetic heralds of the hurricane whose
|
|
formidable sword would now and then strike the glass of the saloon.
|
|
Then appeared the smaller fish, the balista, the leaping mackerel,
|
|
wolf-thorn-tails, and a hundred others which striped the luminous
|
|
atmosphere as they swam. This dazzling spectacle was enchanting!
|
|
Perhaps some atmospheric condition increased the intensity of
|
|
this phenomenon. Perhaps some storm agitated the surface of the waves.
|
|
But at this depth of some yards, the Nautilus was unmoved by its fury
|
|
and reposed peacefully in still water.
|
|
|
|
So we progressed, incessantly charmed by some new marvel.
|
|
The days passed rapidly away, and I took no account of them.
|
|
Ned, according to habit, tried to vary the diet on board.
|
|
Like snails, we were fixed to our shells, and I declare it is easy
|
|
to lead a snail's life.
|
|
|
|
Thus this life seemed easy and natural, and we thought no longer
|
|
of the life we led on land; but something happened to recall us
|
|
to the strangeness of our situation.
|
|
|
|
On the 18th of January, the Nautilus was in 105@ long.
|
|
and 15@ S. lat. The weather was threatening, the sea rough
|
|
and rolling. There was a strong east wind. The barometer,
|
|
which had been going down for some days, foreboded a coming storm.
|
|
I went up on to the platform just as the second lieutenant
|
|
was taking the measure of the horary angles, and waited,
|
|
according to habit till the daily phrase was said. But on this day
|
|
it was exchanged for another phrase not less incomprehensible.
|
|
Almost directly, I saw Captain Nemo appear with a glass, looking
|
|
towards the horizon.
|
|
|
|
For some minutes he was immovable, without taking his eye off
|
|
the point of observation. Then he lowered his glass and exchanged
|
|
a few words with his lieutenant. The latter seemed to be
|
|
a victim to some emotion that he tried in vain to repress.
|
|
Captain Nemo, having more command over himself, was cool.
|
|
He seemed, too, to be making some objections to which the lieutenant
|
|
replied by formal assurances. At least I concluded so by the
|
|
difference of their tones and gestures. For myself, I had looked
|
|
carefully in the direction indicated without seeing anything.
|
|
The sky and water were lost in the clear line of the horizon.
|
|
|
|
However, Captain Nemo walked from one end of the platform
|
|
to the other, without looking at me, perhaps without seeing me.
|
|
His step was firm, but less regular than usual.
|
|
He stopped sometimes, crossed his arms, and observed the sea.
|
|
What could he be looking for on that immense expanse?
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus was then some hundreds of miles from the nearest coast.
|
|
|
|
The lieutenant had taken up the glass and examined the horizon steadfastly,
|
|
going and coming, stamping his foot and showing more nervous agitation than
|
|
his superior officer. Besides, this mystery must necessarily be solved,
|
|
and before long; for, upon an order from Captain Nemo, the engine,
|
|
increasing its propelling power, made the screw turn more rapidly.
|
|
|
|
Just then the lieutenant drew the Captain's attention again.
|
|
The latter stopped walking and directed his glass towards
|
|
the place indicated. He looked long. I felt very much puzzled,
|
|
and descended to the drawing-room, and took out an excellent
|
|
telescope that I generally used. Then, leaning on the cage
|
|
of the watch-light that jutted out from the front of the platform,
|
|
set myself to look over all the line of the sky and sea.
|
|
|
|
But my eye was no sooner applied to the glass than it was quickly
|
|
snatched out of my hands.
|
|
|
|
I turned round. Captain Nemo was before me, but I did not know him.
|
|
His face was transfigured. His eyes flashed sullenly; his teeth were set;
|
|
his stiff body, clenched fists, and head shrunk between his shoulders,
|
|
betrayed the violent agitation that pervaded his whole frame.
|
|
He did not move. My glass, fallen from his hands, had rolled at his feet.
|
|
|
|
Had I unwittingly provoked this fit of anger? Did this incomprehensible
|
|
person imagine that I had discovered some forbidden secret?
|
|
No; I was not the object of this hatred, for he was not looking at me;
|
|
his eye was steadily fixed upon the impenetrable point of the horizon.
|
|
At last Captain Nemo recovered himself. His agitation subsided.
|
|
He addressed some words in a foreign language to his lieutenant,
|
|
then turned to me. "M. Aronnax," he said, in rather an imperious tone,
|
|
"I require you to keep one of the conditions that bind you to me."
|
|
|
|
"What is it, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"You must be confined, with your companions, until I think fit
|
|
to release you."
|
|
|
|
"You are the master," I replied, looking steadily at him.
|
|
"But may I ask you one question?"
|
|
|
|
"None, sir."
|
|
|
|
There was no resisting this imperious command, it would have been useless.
|
|
I went down to the cabin occupied by Ned Land and Conseil, and told them
|
|
the Captain's determination. You may judge how this communication was
|
|
received by the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
But there was not time for altercation. Four of the crew waited
|
|
at the door, and conducted us to that cell where we had passed
|
|
our first night on board the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land would have remonstrated, but the door was shut upon him.
|
|
|
|
"Will master tell me what this means?" asked Conseil.
|
|
|
|
I told my companions what had passed. They were as much astonished as I,
|
|
and equally at a loss how to account for it.
|
|
|
|
Meanwhile, I was absorbed in my own reflections, and could think
|
|
of nothing but the strange fear depicted in the Captain's countenance.
|
|
I was utterly at a loss to account for it, when my cogitations were
|
|
disturbed by these words from Ned Land:
|
|
|
|
"Hallo! breakfast is ready."
|
|
|
|
And indeed the table was laid. Evidently Captain Nemo had given this order
|
|
at the same time that he had hastened the speed of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
"Will master permit me to make a recommendation?" asked Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, my boy."
|
|
|
|
"Well, it is that master breakfasts. It is prudent, for we do not know
|
|
what may happen."
|
|
|
|
"You are right, Conseil."
|
|
|
|
"Unfortunately," said Ned Land, "they have only given us the ship's fare."
|
|
|
|
"Friend Ned," asked Conseil, "what would you have said if the breakfast
|
|
had been entirely forgotten?"
|
|
|
|
This argument cut short the harpooner's recriminations.
|
|
|
|
We sat down to table. The meal was eaten in silence.
|
|
|
|
Just then the luminous globe that lighted the cell went out, and left us
|
|
in total darkness. Ned Land was soon asleep, and what astonished me was
|
|
that Conseil went off into a heavy slumber. I was thinking what could have
|
|
caused his irresistible drowsiness, when I felt my brain becoming stupefied.
|
|
In spite of my efforts to keep my eyes open, they would close.
|
|
A painful suspicion seized me. Evidently soporific substances had been
|
|
mixed with the food we had just taken. Imprisonment was not enough
|
|
to conceal Captain Nemo's projects from us, sleep was more necessary.
|
|
I then heard the panels shut. The undulations of the sea, which caused
|
|
a slight rolling motion, ceased. Had the Nautilus quitted the surface
|
|
of the ocean? Had it gone back to the motionless bed of water?
|
|
I tried to resist sleep. It was impossible. My breathing grew weak.
|
|
I felt a mortal cold freeze my stiffened and half-paralysed limbs.
|
|
My eye lids, like leaden caps, fell over my eyes. I could not raise them;
|
|
a morbid sleep, full of hallucinations, bereft me of my being.
|
|
Then the visions disappeared, and left me in complete insensibility.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XXIII
|
|
|
|
THE CORAL KINGDOM
|
|
|
|
The next day I woke with my head singularly clear.
|
|
To my great surprise, I was in my own room. My companions,
|
|
no doubt, had been reinstated in their cabin, without having
|
|
perceived it any more than I. Of what had passed during the night
|
|
they were as ignorant as I was, and to penetrate this mystery I
|
|
only reckoned upon the chances of the future.
|
|
|
|
I then thought of quitting my room. Was I free again or a prisoner?
|
|
Quite free. I opened the door, went to the half-deck, went up
|
|
the central stairs. The panels, shut the evening before, were open.
|
|
I went on to the platform.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land and Conseil waited there for me. I questioned them;
|
|
they knew nothing. Lost in a heavy sleep in which they had
|
|
been totally unconscious, they had been astonished at finding
|
|
themselves in their cabin.
|
|
|
|
As for the Nautilus, it seemed quiet and mysterious as ever.
|
|
It floated on the surface of the waves at a moderate pace.
|
|
Nothing seemed changed on board.
|
|
|
|
The second lieutenant then came on to the platform, and gave
|
|
the usual order below.
|
|
|
|
As for Captain Nemo, he did not appear.
|
|
|
|
Of the people on board, I only saw the impassive steward,
|
|
who served me with his usual dumb regularity.
|
|
|
|
About two o'clock, I was in the drawing-room, busied in arranging
|
|
my notes, when the Captain opened the door and appeared. I bowed.
|
|
He made a slight inclination in return, without speaking.
|
|
I resumed my work, hoping that he would perhaps give me some
|
|
explanation of the events of the preceding night. He made none.
|
|
I looked at him. He seemed fatigued; his heavy eyes had not
|
|
been refreshed by sleep; his face looked very sorrowful.
|
|
He walked to and fro, sat down and got up again, took a
|
|
chance book, put it down, consulted his instruments without
|
|
taking his habitual notes, and seemed restless and uneasy.
|
|
At last, he came up to me, and said:
|
|
|
|
"Are you a doctor, M. Aronnax?"
|
|
|
|
I so little expected such a question that I stared some time
|
|
at him without answering.
|
|
|
|
"Are you a doctor?" he repeated. "Several of your colleagues
|
|
have studied medicine."
|
|
|
|
"Well," said I, "I am a doctor and resident surgeon to the hospital.
|
|
I practised several years before entering the museum."
|
|
|
|
"Very well, sir."
|
|
|
|
My answer had evidently satisfied the Captain. But, not knowing
|
|
what he would say next, I waited for other questions, reserving my
|
|
answers according to circumstances.
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax, will you consent to prescribe for one of my men?" be asked.
|
|
|
|
"Is he ill?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes."
|
|
|
|
"I am ready to follow you."
|
|
|
|
"Come, then."
|
|
|
|
I own my heart beat, I do not know why. I saw certain connection
|
|
between the illness of one of the crew and the events of the day before;
|
|
and this mystery interested me at least as much as the sick man.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo conducted me to the poop of the Nautilus,
|
|
and took me into a cabin situated near the sailors' quarters.
|
|
|
|
There, on a bed, lay a man about forty years of age, with a resolute
|
|
expression of countenance, a true type of an Anglo-Saxon.
|
|
|
|
I leant over him. He was not only ill, he was wounded.
|
|
His head, swathed in bandages covered with blood, lay on a pillow.
|
|
I undid the bandages, and the wounded man looked at me with his large
|
|
eyes and gave no sign of pain as I did it. It was a horrible wound.
|
|
The skull, shattered by some deadly weapon, left the brain exposed,
|
|
which was much injured. Clots of blood had formed in the bruised
|
|
and broken mass, in colour like the dregs of wine.
|
|
|
|
There was both contusion and suffusion of the brain. His breathing
|
|
was slow, and some spasmodic movements of the muscles agitated his face.
|
|
I felt his pulse. It was intermittent. The extremities of the body
|
|
were growing cold already, and I saw death must inevitably ensue.
|
|
After dressing the unfortunate man's wounds, I readjusted the bandages
|
|
on his head, and turned to Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"What caused this wound?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"What does it signify?" he replied, evasively. "A shock has
|
|
broken one of the levers of the engine, which struck myself.
|
|
But your opinion as to his state?"
|
|
|
|
I hesitated before giving it.
|
|
|
|
"You may speak," said the Captain. "This man does not understand French."
|
|
|
|
I gave a last look at the wounded man.
|
|
|
|
"He will be dead in two hours."
|
|
|
|
"Can nothing save him?"
|
|
|
|
"Nothing."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo's hand contracted, and some tears glistened in his eyes,
|
|
which I thought incapable of shedding any.
|
|
|
|
For some moments I still watched the dying man, whose life ebbed slowly.
|
|
His pallor increased under the electric light that was shed over
|
|
his death-bed. I looked at his intelligent forehead, furrowed with
|
|
premature wrinkles, produced probably by misfortune and sorrow.
|
|
I tried to learn the secret of his life from the last words that
|
|
escaped his lips.
|
|
|
|
"You can go now, M. Aronnax," said the Captain.
|
|
|
|
I left him in the dying man's cabin, and returned to my
|
|
room much affected by this scene. During the whole day,
|
|
I was haunted by uncomfortable suspicions, and at night
|
|
I slept badly, and between my broken dreams I fancied I
|
|
heard distant sighs like the notes of a funeral psalm.
|
|
Were they the prayers of the dead, murmured in that language
|
|
that I could not understand?
|
|
|
|
The next morning I went on to the bridge. Captain Nemo was there before me.
|
|
As soon as he perceived me he came to me.
|
|
|
|
"Professor, will it be convenient to you to make a submarine excursion to-day?"
|
|
|
|
"With my companions?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"If they like."
|
|
|
|
"We obey your orders, Captain."
|
|
|
|
"Will you be so good then as to put on your cork jackets?"
|
|
|
|
It was not a question of dead or dying. I rejoined Ned Land
|
|
and Conseil, and told them of Captain Nemo's proposition.
|
|
Conseil hastened to accept it, and this time the Canadian seemed
|
|
quite willing to follow our example.
|
|
|
|
It was eight o'clock in the morning. At half-past eight we were equipped
|
|
for this new excursion, and provided with two contrivances for light
|
|
and breathing. The double door was open; and, accompanied by Captain Nemo,
|
|
who was followed by a dozen of the crew, we set foot, at a depth of about
|
|
thirty feet, on the solid bottom on which the Nautilus rested.
|
|
|
|
A slight declivity ended in an uneven bottom, at fifteen fathoms depth.
|
|
This bottom differed entirely from the one I had visited on my first excursion
|
|
under the waters of the Pacific Ocean. Here, there was no fine sand,
|
|
no submarine prairies, no sea-forest. I immediately recognised that
|
|
marvellous region in which, on that day, the Captain did the honours to us.
|
|
It was the coral kingdom.
|
|
|
|
The light produced a thousand charming varieties, playing in
|
|
the midst of the branches that were so vividly coloured.
|
|
I seemed to see the membraneous and cylindrical tubes tremble
|
|
beneath the undulation of the waters. I was tempted to gather
|
|
their fresh petals, ornamented with delicate tentacles,
|
|
some just blown, the others budding, while a small fish,
|
|
swimming swiftly, touched them slightly, like flights of birds.
|
|
But if my hand approached these living flowers, these animated,
|
|
sensitive plants, the whole colony took alarm. The white petals
|
|
re-entered their red cases, the flowers faded as I looked,
|
|
and the bush changed into a block of stony knobs.
|
|
|
|
Chance had thrown me just by the most precious specimens of the zoophyte.
|
|
This coral was more valuable than that found in the Mediterranean,
|
|
on the coasts of France, Italy and Barbary. Its tints justified
|
|
the poetical names of "Flower of Blood," and "Froth of Blood,"
|
|
that trade has given to its most beautiful productions.
|
|
Coral is sold for L20 per ounce; and in this place the watery beds would
|
|
make the fortunes of a company of coral-divers. This precious matter,
|
|
often confused with other polypi, formed then the inextricable plots
|
|
called "macciota," and on which I noticed several beautiful specimens
|
|
of pink coral.
|
|
|
|
{opening sentence missing} Real petrified thickets, long joints
|
|
of fantastic architecture, were disclosed before us.
|
|
Captain Nemo placed himself under a dark gallery, where by
|
|
a slight declivity we reached a depth of a hundred yards.
|
|
The light from our lamps produced sometimes magical effects,
|
|
following the rough outlines of the natural arches and pendants
|
|
disposed like lustres, that were tipped with points of fire.
|
|
|
|
At last, after walking two hours, we had attained a depth
|
|
of about three hundred yards, that is to say, the extreme limit
|
|
on which coral begins to form. But there was no isolated bush,
|
|
nor modest brushwood, at the bottom of lofty trees.
|
|
It was an immense forest of large mineral vegetations,
|
|
enormous petrified trees, united by garlands of elegant
|
|
sea-bindweed, all adorned with clouds and reflections.
|
|
We passed freely under their high branches, lost in the shade
|
|
of the waves.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo had stopped. I and my companions halted, and, turning round,
|
|
I saw his men were forming a semi-circle round their chief.
|
|
Watching attentively, I observed that four of them carried on their
|
|
shoulders an object of an oblong shape.
|
|
|
|
We occupied, in this place, the centre of a vast glade
|
|
surrounded by the lofty foliage of the submarine forest.
|
|
Our lamps threw over this place a sort of clear twilight
|
|
that singularly elongated the shadows on the ground.
|
|
At the end of the glade the darkness increased, and was only relieved
|
|
by little sparks reflected by the points of coral.
|
|
|
|
Ned Land and Conseil were near me. We watched,
|
|
and I thought I was going to witness a strange scene.
|
|
On observing the ground, I saw that it was raised in certain
|
|
places by slight excrescences encrusted with limy deposits,
|
|
and disposed with a regularity that betrayed the hand of man.
|
|
|
|
In the midst of the glade, on a pedestal of rocks roughly
|
|
piled up, stood a cross of coral that extended its long arms
|
|
that one might have thought were made of petrified blood.
|
|
Upon a sign from Captain Nemo one of the men advanced;
|
|
and at some feet from the cross he began to dig a hole with
|
|
a pickaxe that he took from his belt. I understood all!
|
|
This glade was a cemetery, this hole a tomb, this oblong
|
|
object the body of the man who had died in the night!
|
|
The Captain and his men had come to bury their companion in this
|
|
general resting-place, at the bottom of this inaccessible ocean!
|
|
|
|
The grave was being dug slowly; the fish fled on all sides while their
|
|
retreat was being thus disturbed; I heard the strokes of the pickaxe,
|
|
which sparkled when it hit upon some flint lost at the bottom of the waters.
|
|
The hole was soon large and deep enough to receive the body.
|
|
Then the bearers approached; the body, enveloped in a tissue of white linen,
|
|
was lowered into the damp grave. Captain Nemo, with his arms crossed
|
|
on his breast, and all the friends of him who had loved them,
|
|
knelt in prayer.
|
|
|
|
The grave was then filled in with the rubbish taken from the ground,
|
|
which formed a slight mound. When this was done, Captain Nemo
|
|
and his men rose; then, approaching the grave, they knelt again,
|
|
and all extended their hands in sign of a last adieu.
|
|
Then the funeral procession returned to the Nautilus,
|
|
passing under the arches of the forest, in the midst
|
|
of thickets, along the coral bushes, and still on the ascent.
|
|
At last the light of the ship appeared, and its luminous track
|
|
guided us to the Nautilus. At one o'clock we had returned.
|
|
|
|
As soon as I had changed my clothes I went up on to the platform,
|
|
and, a prey to conflicting emotions, I sat down near the binnacle.
|
|
Captain Nemo joined me. I rose and said to him:
|
|
|
|
"So, as I said he would, this man died in the night?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, M. Aronnax."
|
|
|
|
"And he rests now, near his companions, in the coral cemetery?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, forgotten by all else, but not by us. We dug the grave,
|
|
and the polypi undertake to seal our dead for eternity."
|
|
And, burying his face quickly in his hands, he tried in vain to
|
|
suppress a sob. Then he added: "Our peaceful cemetery is there,
|
|
some hundred feet below the surface of the waves."
|
|
|
|
"Your dead sleep quietly, at least, Captain, out of the reach of sharks."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir, of sharks and men," gravely replied the Captain.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
PART TWO
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER I
|
|
|
|
THE INDIAN OCEAN
|
|
|
|
We now come to the second part of our journey under the sea.
|
|
The first ended with the moving scene in the coral cemetery which left
|
|
such a deep impression on my mind. Thus, in the midst of this great sea,
|
|
Captain Nemo's life was passing, even to his grave, which he had
|
|
prepared in one of its deepest abysses. There, not one of the ocean's
|
|
monsters could trouble the last sleep of the crew of the Nautilus,
|
|
of those friends riveted to each other in death as in life.
|
|
"Nor any man, either," had added the Captain. Still the same fierce,
|
|
implacable defiance towards human society!
|
|
|
|
I could no longer content myself with the theory which satisfied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
That worthy fellow persisted in seeing in the Commander of
|
|
the Nautilus one of those unknown servants who return mankind
|
|
contempt for indifference. For him, he was a misunderstood
|
|
genius who, tired of earth's deceptions, had taken refuge in this
|
|
inaccessible medium, where he might follow his instincts freely.
|
|
To my mind, this explains but one side of Captain Nemo's character.
|
|
Indeed, the mystery of that last night during which we had been
|
|
chained in prison, the sleep, and the precaution so violently
|
|
taken by the Captain of snatching from my eyes the glass I
|
|
had raised to sweep the horizon, the mortal wound of the man,
|
|
due to an unaccountable shock of the Nautilus, all put me on a
|
|
new track. No; Captain Nemo was not satisfied with shunning man.
|
|
His formidable apparatus not only suited his instinct of freedom,
|
|
but perhaps also the design of some terrible retaliation.
|
|
|
|
At this moment nothing is clear to me; I catch but a glimpse
|
|
of light amidst all the darkness, and I must confine myself
|
|
to writing as events shall dictate.
|
|
|
|
That day, the 24th of January, 1868, at noon, the second officer came to take
|
|
the altitude of the sun. I mounted the platform, lit a cigar, and watched
|
|
the operation. It seemed to me that the man did not understand French;
|
|
for several times I made remarks in a loud voice, which must have drawn
|
|
from him some involuntary sign of attention, if he had understood them;
|
|
but he remained undisturbed and dumb.
|
|
|
|
As he was taking observations with the sextant, one of the
|
|
sailors of the Nautilus (the strong man who had accompanied
|
|
us on our first submarine excursion to the Island of Crespo)
|
|
came to clean the glasses of the lantern. I examined the fittings
|
|
of the apparatus, the strength of which was increased a hundredfold
|
|
by lenticular rings, placed similar to those in a lighthouse,
|
|
and which projected their brilliance in a horizontal plane.
|
|
The electric lamp was combined in such a way as to give
|
|
its most powerful light. Indeed, it was produced in vacuo,
|
|
which insured both its steadiness and its intensity.
|
|
This vacuum economised the graphite points between which
|
|
the luminous arc was developed--an important point of economy
|
|
for Captain Nemo, who could not easily have replaced them;
|
|
and under these conditions their waste was imperceptible.
|
|
When the Nautilus was ready to continue its submarine journey,
|
|
I went down to the saloon. The panel was closed, and the course
|
|
marked direct west.
|
|
|
|
We were furrowing the waters of the Indian Ocean, a vast liquid plain,
|
|
with a surface of 1,200,000,000 of acres, and whose waters are so clear
|
|
and transparent that any one leaning over them would turn giddy.
|
|
The Nautilus usually floated between fifty and a hundred fathoms deep.
|
|
We went on so for some days. To anyone but myself, who had a great
|
|
love for the sea, the hours would have seemed long and monotonous;
|
|
but the daily walks on the platform, when I steeped myself in the reviving
|
|
air of the ocean, the sight of the rich waters through the windows
|
|
of the saloon, the books in the library, the compiling of my memoirs,
|
|
took up all my time, and left me not a moment of ennui or weariness.
|
|
|
|
For some days we saw a great number of aquatic birds, sea-mews or gulls.
|
|
Some were cleverly killed and, prepared in a certain way, made very acceptable
|
|
water-game. Amongst large-winged birds, carried a long distance from all lands
|
|
and resting upon the waves from the fatigue of their flight, I saw some
|
|
magnificent albatrosses, uttering discordant cries like the braying of an ass,
|
|
and birds belonging to the family of the long-wings.
|
|
|
|
As to the fish, they always provoked our admiration when we surprised
|
|
the secrets of their aquatic life through the open panels.
|
|
I saw many kinds which I never before had a chance of observing.
|
|
|
|
{3 paragraphs are missing}
|
|
|
|
From the 21st to the 23rd of January the Nautilus went at
|
|
the rate of two hundred and fifty leagues in twenty-four hours,
|
|
being five hundred and forty miles, or twenty-two miles an hour.
|
|
If we recognised so many different varieties of fish, it was because,
|
|
attracted by the electric light, they tried to follow us;
|
|
the greater part, however, were soon distanced by our speed,
|
|
though some kept their place in the waters of the Nautilus for a time.
|
|
The morning of the 24th, in 12@ 5' S. lat., and 94@ 33'
|
|
long., we observed Keeling Island, a coral formation,
|
|
planted with magnificent cocos, and which had been visited by
|
|
Mr. Darwin and Captain Fitzroy. The Nautilus skirted the shores
|
|
of this desert island for a little distance. Its nets brought
|
|
up numerous specimens of polypi and curious shells of mollusca.
|
|
{one sentence stripped here}
|
|
|
|
Soon Keeling Island disappeared from the horizon, and our course was directed
|
|
to the north-west in the direction of the Indian Peninsula.
|
|
|
|
From Keeling Island our course was slower and more variable,
|
|
often taking us into great depths. Several times they made use
|
|
of the inclined planes, which certain internal levers placed
|
|
obliquely to the waterline. In that way we went about two miles,
|
|
but without ever obtaining the greatest depths of the Indian Sea,
|
|
which soundings of seven thousand fathoms have never reached.
|
|
As to the temperature of the lower strata, the thermometer invariably
|
|
indicated 4@ above zero. I only observed that in the upper regions
|
|
the water was always colder in the high levels than at the surface
|
|
of the sea.
|
|
|
|
On the 25th of January the ocean was entirely deserted; the Nautilus
|
|
passed the day on the surface, beating the waves with its powerful
|
|
screw and making them rebound to a great height. Who under such
|
|
circumstances would not have taken it for a gigantic cetacean?
|
|
Three parts of this day I spent on the platform. I watched the sea.
|
|
Nothing on the horizon, till about four o'clock a steamer running
|
|
west on our counter. Her masts were visible for an instant,
|
|
but she could not see the Nautilus, being too low in the water.
|
|
I fancied this steamboat belonged to the P.O. Company, which runs
|
|
from Ceylon to Sydney, touching at King George's Point and Melbourne.
|
|
|
|
At five o'clock in the evening, before that fleeting twilight
|
|
which binds night to day in tropical zones, Conseil and I
|
|
were astonished by a curious spectacle.
|
|
|
|
It was a shoal of argonauts travelling along on the surface of the ocean.
|
|
We could count several hundreds. They belonged to the tubercle kind
|
|
which are peculiar to the Indian seas.
|
|
|
|
These graceful molluscs moved backwards by means of their
|
|
locomotive tube, through which they propelled the water already
|
|
drawn in. Of their eight tentacles, six were elongated,
|
|
and stretched out floating on the water, whilst the other two,
|
|
rolled up flat, were spread to the wing like a light sail.
|
|
I saw their spiral-shaped and fluted shells, which Cuvier
|
|
justly compares to an elegant skiff. A boat indeed!
|
|
It bears the creature which secretes it without its adhering to it.
|
|
|
|
For nearly an hour the Nautilus floated in the midst of this shoal
|
|
of molluscs. Then I know not what sudden fright they took.
|
|
But as if at a signal every sail was furled, the arms folded,
|
|
the body drawn in, the shells turned over, changing their centre
|
|
of gravity, and the whole fleet disappeared under the waves.
|
|
Never did the ships of a squadron manoeuvre with more unity.
|
|
|
|
At that moment night fell suddenly, and the reeds, scarcely raised
|
|
by the breeze, lay peaceably under the sides of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
The next day, 26th of January, we cut the equator at the
|
|
eighty-second meridian and entered the northern hemisphere.
|
|
During the day a formidable troop of sharks accompanied us,
|
|
terrible creatures, which multiply in these seas and make them
|
|
very dangerous. They were "cestracio philippi" sharks, with brown
|
|
backs and whitish bellies, armed with eleven rows of teeth--
|
|
eyed sharks--their throat being marked with a large black
|
|
spot surrounded with white like an eye. There were also some
|
|
Isabella sharks, with rounded snouts marked with dark spots.
|
|
These powerful creatures often hurled themselves at the windows
|
|
of the saloon with such violence as to make us feel very insecure.
|
|
At such times Ned Land was no longer master of himself.
|
|
He wanted to go to the surface and harpoon the monsters,
|
|
particularly certain smooth-hound sharks, whose mouth is studded with
|
|
teeth like a mosaic; and large tiger-sharks nearly six yards long,
|
|
the last named of which seemed to excite him more particularly.
|
|
But the Nautilus, accelerating her speed, easily left the most rapid
|
|
of them behind.
|
|
|
|
The 27th of January, at the entrance of the vast Bay of Bengal,
|
|
we met repeatedly a forbidding spectacle, dead bodies floating on
|
|
the surface of the water. They were the dead of the Indian villages,
|
|
carried by the Ganges to the level of the sea, and which the vultures,
|
|
the only undertakers of the country, had not been able to devour.
|
|
But the sharks did not fail to help them at their funeral work.
|
|
|
|
About seven o'clock in the evening, the Nautilus, half-immersed, was
|
|
sailing in a sea of milk. At first sight the ocean seemed lactified.
|
|
Was it the effect of the lunar rays? No; for the moon, scarcely two
|
|
days old, was still lying hidden under the horizon in the rays of the sun.
|
|
The whole sky, though lit by the sidereal rays, seemed black by contrast
|
|
with the whiteness of the waters.
|
|
|
|
Conseil could not believe his eyes, and questioned me as to the cause
|
|
of this strange phenomenon. Happily I was able to answer him.
|
|
|
|
"It is called a milk sea," I explained. "A large extent
|
|
of white wavelets often to be seen on the coasts of Amboyna,
|
|
and in these parts of the sea."
|
|
|
|
"But, sir," said Conseil, "can you tell me what causes such an effect?
|
|
for I suppose the water is not really turned into milk."
|
|
|
|
"No, my boy; and the whiteness which surprises you is caused only by
|
|
the presence of myriads of infusoria, a sort of luminous little worm,
|
|
gelatinous and without colour, of the thickness of a hair,
|
|
and whose length is not more than seven-thousandths of an inch.
|
|
These insects adhere to one another sometimes for several leagues."
|
|
|
|
"Several leagues!" exclaimed Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, my boy; and you need not try to compute the number of these infusoria.
|
|
You will not be able, for, if I am not mistaken, ships have floated on these
|
|
milk seas for more than forty miles."
|
|
|
|
Towards midnight the sea suddenly resumed its usual colour;
|
|
but behind us, even to the limits of the horizon, the sky
|
|
reflected the whitened waves, and for a long time seemed
|
|
impregnated with the vague glimmerings of an aurora borealis.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER II
|
|
|
|
A NOVEL PROPOSAL OF CAPTAIN NEMO'S
|
|
|
|
On the 28th of February, when at noon the Nautilus came to the surface
|
|
of the sea, in 9@ 4' N. lat., there was land in sight about eight
|
|
miles to westward. The first thing I noticed was a range of mountains
|
|
about two thousand feet high, the shapes of which were most capricious.
|
|
On taking the bearings, I knew that we were nearing the island of Ceylon,
|
|
the pearl which hangs from the lobe of the Indian Peninsula.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo and his second appeared at this moment.
|
|
The Captain glanced at the map. Then turning to me, said:
|
|
|
|
"The Island of Ceylon, noted for its pearl-fisheries. Would you
|
|
like to visit one of them, M. Aronnax?"
|
|
|
|
"Certainly, Captain."
|
|
|
|
"Well, the thing is easy. Though, if we see the fisheries, we shall
|
|
not see the fishermen. The annual exportation has not yet begun.
|
|
Never mind, I will give orders to make for the Gulf of Manaar,
|
|
where we shall arrive in the night."
|
|
|
|
The Captain said something to his second, who immediately went out.
|
|
Soon the Nautilus returned to her native element, and the manometer
|
|
showed that she was about thirty feet deep.
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir," said Captain Nemo, "you and your companions shall visit
|
|
the Bank of Manaar, and if by chance some fisherman should be there,
|
|
we shall see him at work."
|
|
|
|
"Agreed, Captain!"
|
|
|
|
"By the bye, M. Aronnax you are not afraid of sharks?"
|
|
|
|
"Sharks!" exclaimed I.
|
|
|
|
This question seemed a very hard one.
|
|
|
|
"Well?" continued Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"I admit, Captain, that I am not yet very familiar with that kind of fish."
|
|
|
|
"We are accustomed to them," replied Captain Nemo,
|
|
"and in time you will be too. However, we shall be armed,
|
|
and on the road we may be able to hunt some of the tribe.
|
|
It is interesting. So, till to-morrow, sir, and early."
|
|
|
|
This said in a careless tone, Captain Nemo left the saloon.
|
|
Now, if you were invited to hunt the bear in the mountains
|
|
of Switzerland, what would you say?
|
|
|
|
"Very well! to-morrow we will go and hunt the bear."
|
|
If you were asked to hunt the lion in the plains of Atlas,
|
|
or the tiger in the Indian jungles, what would you say?
|
|
|
|
"Ha! ha! it seems we are going to hunt the tiger or the lion!"
|
|
But when you are invited to hunt the shark in its natural element,
|
|
you would perhaps reflect before accepting the invitation.
|
|
As for myself, I passed my hand over my forehead, on which stood large
|
|
drops of cold perspiration. "Let us reflect," said I, "and take our time.
|
|
Hunting otters in submarine forests, as we did in the Island of Crespo,
|
|
will pass; but going up and down at the bottom of the sea,
|
|
where one is almost certain to meet sharks, is quite another thing!
|
|
I know well that in certain countries, particularly in the Andaman Islands,
|
|
the negroes never hesitate to attack them with a dagger in one hand
|
|
and a running noose in the other; but I also know that few who affront
|
|
those creatures ever return alive. However, I am not a negro,
|
|
and if I were I think a little hesitation in this case would
|
|
not be ill-timed."
|
|
|
|
At this moment Conseil and the Canadian entered, quite composed,
|
|
and even joyous. They knew not what awaited them.
|
|
|
|
"Faith, sir," said Ned Land, "your Captain Nemo--the devil take him!--
|
|
has just made us a very pleasant offer."
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" said I, "you know?"
|
|
|
|
"If agreeable to you, sir," interrupted Conseil, "the commander
|
|
of the Nautilus has invited us to visit the magnificent Ceylon
|
|
fisheries to-morrow, in your company; he did it kindly,
|
|
and behaved like a real gentleman."
|
|
|
|
"He said nothing more?"
|
|
|
|
"Nothing more, sir, except that he had already spoken to you
|
|
of this little walk."
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said Conseil, "would you give us some details of the pearl fishery?"
|
|
|
|
"As to the fishing itself," I asked, "or the incidents, which?"
|
|
|
|
"On the fishing," replied the Canadian; "before entering upon the ground,
|
|
it is as well to know something about it."
|
|
|
|
"Very well; sit down, my friends, and I will teach you."
|
|
|
|
Ned and Conseil seated themselves on an ottoman, and the first thing
|
|
the Canadian asked was:
|
|
|
|
"Sir, what is a pearl?"
|
|
|
|
"My worthy Ned," I answered, "to the poet, a pearl is a tear of the sea;
|
|
to the Orientals, it is a drop of dew solidified; to the ladies, it is
|
|
a jewel of an oblong shape, of a brilliancy of mother-of-pearl substance,
|
|
which they wear on their fingers, their necks, or their ears; for the chemist
|
|
it is a mixture of phosphate and carbonate of lime, with a little gelatine;
|
|
and lastly, for naturalists, it is simply a morbid secretion of the organ
|
|
that produces the mother-of-pearl amongst certain bivalves."
|
|
|
|
"Branch of molluscs," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Precisely so, my learned Conseil; and, amongst these testacea
|
|
the earshell, the tridacnae, the turbots, in a word, all those
|
|
which secrete mother-of-pearl, that is, the blue, bluish, violet,
|
|
or white substance which lines the interior of their shells,
|
|
are capable of producing pearls."
|
|
|
|
"Mussels too?" asked the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, mussels of certain waters in Scotland, Wales, Ireland,
|
|
Saxony, Bohemia, and France."
|
|
|
|
"Good! For the future I shall pay attention," replied the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"But," I continued, "the particular mollusc which secretes
|
|
the pearl is the pearl-oyster. The pearl is nothing but a
|
|
formation deposited in a globular form, either adhering
|
|
to the oyster-shell or buried in the folds of the creature.
|
|
On the shell it is fast: in the flesh it is loose; but always
|
|
has for a kernel a small hard substance, maybe a barren egg,
|
|
maybe a grain of sand, around which the pearly matter deposits itself
|
|
year after year successively, and by thin concentric layers."
|
|
{this paragraph is edited}
|
|
|
|
"Are many pearls found in the same oyster?" asked Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, my boy. Some are a perfect casket. One oyster has been mentioned,
|
|
though I allow myself to doubt it, as having contained no less than a hundred
|
|
and fifty sharks."
|
|
|
|
"A hundred and fifty sharks!" exclaimed Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"Did I say sharks?" said I hurriedly. "I meant to say a hundred
|
|
and fifty pearls. Sharks would not be sense."
|
|
|
|
"Certainly not," said Conseil; "but will you tell us now by what means
|
|
they extract these pearls?"
|
|
|
|
"They proceed in various ways. When they adhere to the shell,
|
|
the fishermen often pull them off with pincers; but the most common
|
|
way is to lay the oysters on mats of the seaweed which covers
|
|
the banks. Thus they die in the open air; and at the end
|
|
of ten days they are in a forward state of decomposition.
|
|
They are then plunged into large reservoirs of sea-water;
|
|
then they are opened and washed."
|
|
|
|
"The price of these pearls varies according to their size?" asked Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Not only according to their size," I answered, "but also according
|
|
to their shape, their water (that is, their colour), and their lustre:
|
|
that is, that bright and diapered sparkle which makes them so charming
|
|
to the eye. The most beautiful are called virgin pearls, or paragons.
|
|
They are formed alone in the tissue of the mollusc, are white,
|
|
often opaque, and sometimes have the transparency of an opal;
|
|
they are generally round or oval. The round are made into bracelets,
|
|
the oval into pendants, and, being more precious, are sold singly.
|
|
Those adhering to the shell of the oyster are more irregular in shape,
|
|
and are sold by weight. Lastly, in a lower order are classed those small
|
|
pearls known under the name of seed-pearls; they are sold by measure,
|
|
and are especially used in embroidery for church ornaments."
|
|
|
|
"But," said Conseil, "is this pearl-fishery dangerous?"
|
|
|
|
"No," I answered, quickly; "particularly if certain precautions are taken."
|
|
|
|
"What does one risk in such a calling?" said Ned Land,
|
|
"the swallowing of some mouthfuls of sea-water?"
|
|
|
|
"As you say, Ned. By the bye," said I, trying to take Captain
|
|
Nemo's careless tone, "are you afraid of sharks, brave Ned?"
|
|
|
|
"I!" replied the Canadian; "a harpooner by profession?
|
|
It is my trade to make light of them."
|
|
|
|
"But," said I, "it is not a question of fishing for them
|
|
with an iron-swivel, hoisting them into the vessel, cutting off
|
|
their tails with a blow of a chopper, ripping them up,
|
|
and throwing their heart into the sea!"
|
|
|
|
"Then, it is a question of----"
|
|
|
|
"Precisely."
|
|
|
|
"In the water?"
|
|
|
|
"In the water."
|
|
|
|
"Faith, with a good harpoon! You know, sir, these sharks are
|
|
ill-fashioned beasts. They turn on their bellies to seize you,
|
|
and in that time----"
|
|
|
|
Ned Land had a way of saying "seize" which made my blood run cold.
|
|
|
|
"Well, and you, Conseil, what do you think of sharks?"
|
|
|
|
"Me!" said Conseil. "I will be frank, sir."
|
|
|
|
"So much the better," thought I.
|
|
|
|
"If you, sir, mean to face the sharks, I do not see why your faithful
|
|
servant should not face them with you."
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER III
|
|
|
|
A PEARL OF TEN MILLIONS
|
|
|
|
The next morning at four o'clock I was awakened by
|
|
the steward whom Captain Nemo had placed at my service.
|
|
I rose hurriedly, dressed, and went into the saloon.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo was awaiting me.
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax," said he, "are you ready to start?"
|
|
|
|
"I am ready."
|
|
|
|
"Then please to follow me."
|
|
|
|
"And my companions, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"They have been told and are waiting."
|
|
|
|
"Are we not to put on our diver's dresses?" asked I.
|
|
|
|
"Not yet. I have not allowed the Nautilus to come too near this coast,
|
|
and we are some distance from the Manaar Bank; but the boat is ready, and will
|
|
take us to the exact point of disembarking, which will save us a long way.
|
|
It carries our diving apparatus, which we will put on when we begin
|
|
our submarine journey."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo conducted me to the central staircase,
|
|
which led on the platform. Ned and Conseil were already there,
|
|
delighted at the idea of the "pleasure party" which was preparing.
|
|
Five sailors from the Nautilus, with their oars, waited in the boat,
|
|
which had been made fast against the side.
|
|
|
|
The night was still dark. Layers of clouds covered the sky,
|
|
allowing but few stars to be seen. I looked on the side
|
|
where the land lay, and saw nothing but a dark line enclosing
|
|
three parts of the horizon, from south-west to north west.
|
|
The Nautilus, having returned during the night up the western
|
|
coast of Ceylon, was now west of the bay, or rather gulf,
|
|
formed by the mainland and the Island of Manaar.
|
|
There, under the dark waters, stretched the pintadine bank,
|
|
an inexhaustible field of pearls, the length of which is more
|
|
than twenty miles.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo, Ned Land, Conseil, and I took our places
|
|
in the stern of the boat. The master went to the tiller;
|
|
his four companions leaned on their oars, the painter was cast off,
|
|
and we sheered off.
|
|
|
|
The boat went towards the south; the oarsmen did not hurry. I noticed
|
|
that their strokes, strong in the water, only followed each other every
|
|
ten seconds, according to the method generally adopted in the navy.
|
|
Whilst the craft was running by its own velocity, the liquid drops
|
|
struck the dark depths of the waves crisply like spats of melted lead.
|
|
A little billow, spreading wide, gave a slight roll to the boat, and some
|
|
samphire reeds flapped before it.
|
|
|
|
We were silent. What was Captain Nemo thinking of? Perhaps of
|
|
the land he was approaching, and which he found too near to him,
|
|
contrary to the Canadian's opinion, who thought it too far off.
|
|
As to Conseil, he was merely there from curiosity.
|
|
|
|
About half-past five the first tints on the horizon showed
|
|
the upper line of coast more distinctly. Flat enough in the east,
|
|
it rose a little to the south. Five miles still lay between us,
|
|
and it was indistinct owing to the mist on the water.
|
|
At six o'clock it became suddenly daylight, with that rapidity
|
|
peculiar to tropical regions, which know neither dawn nor twilight.
|
|
The solar rays pierced the curtain of clouds, piled up
|
|
on the eastern horizon, and the radiant orb rose rapidly.
|
|
I saw land distinctly, with a few trees scattered here and there.
|
|
The boat neared Manaar Island, which was rounded to the south.
|
|
Captain Nemo rose from his seat and watched the sea.
|
|
|
|
At a sign from him the anchor was dropped, but the chain scarcely ran,
|
|
for it was little more than a yard deep, and this spot was one of the highest
|
|
points of the bank of pintadines.
|
|
|
|
"Here we are, M. Aronnax," said Captain Nemo.
|
|
"You see that enclosed bay? Here, in a month will be
|
|
assembled the numerous fishing boats of the exporters,
|
|
and these are the waters their divers will ransack so boldly.
|
|
Happily, this bay is well situated for that kind of fishing.
|
|
It is sheltered from the strongest winds; the sea is never very
|
|
rough here, which makes it favourable for the diver's work.
|
|
We will now put on our dresses, and begin our walk."
|
|
|
|
I did not answer, and, while watching the suspected waves,
|
|
began with the help of the sailors to put on my heavy
|
|
sea-dress. Captain Nemo and my companions were also dressing.
|
|
None of the Nautilus men were to accompany us on this new excursion.
|
|
|
|
Soon we were enveloped to the throat in india-rubber clothing;
|
|
the air apparatus fixed to our backs by braces.
|
|
As to the Ruhmkorff apparatus, there was no necessity for it.
|
|
Before putting my head into the copper cap, I had asked the question
|
|
of the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"They would be useless," he replied. "We are going to no great depth,
|
|
and the solar rays will be enough to light our walk. Besides, it would
|
|
not be prudent to carry the electric light in these waters;
|
|
its brilliancy might attract some of the dangerous inhabitants
|
|
of the coast most inopportunely."
|
|
|
|
As Captain Nemo pronounced these words, I turned to Conseil and Ned Land.
|
|
But my two friends had already encased their heads in the metal cap,
|
|
and they could neither hear nor answer.
|
|
|
|
One last question remained to ask of Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"And our arms?" asked I; "our guns?"
|
|
|
|
"Guns! What for? Do not mountaineers attack the bear with
|
|
a dagger in their hand, and is not steel surer than lead?
|
|
Here is a strong blade; put it in your belt, and we start."
|
|
|
|
I looked at my companions; they were armed like us, and, more than that,
|
|
Ned Land was brandishing an enormous harpoon, which he had placed in the boat
|
|
before leaving the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
Then, following the Captain's example, I allowed myself to be
|
|
dressed in the heavy copper helmet, and our reservoirs of air
|
|
were at once in activity. An instant after we were landed,
|
|
one after the other, in about two yards of water upon an even sand.
|
|
Captain Nemo made a sign with his hand, and we followed him
|
|
by a gentle declivity till we disappeared under the waves.
|
|
|
|
{3 paragraphs missing}
|
|
|
|
At about seven o'clock we found ourselves at last surveying the oyster-banks
|
|
on which the pearl-oysters are reproduced by millions.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo pointed with his hand to the enormous heap of oysters;
|
|
and I could well understand that this mine was inexhaustible, for
|
|
Nature's creative power is far beyond man's instinct of destruction.
|
|
Ned Land, faithful to his instinct, hastened to fill a net
|
|
which he carried by his side with some of the finest specimens.
|
|
But we could not stop. We must follow the Captain,
|
|
who seemed to guide him self by paths known only to himself.
|
|
The ground was sensibly rising, and sometimes,
|
|
on holding up my arm, it was above the surface of the sea.
|
|
Then the level of the bank would sink capriciously.
|
|
Often we rounded high rocks scarped into pyramids.
|
|
In their dark fractures huge crustacea, perched upon their
|
|
high claws like some war-machine, watched us with fixed eyes,
|
|
and under our feet crawled various kinds of annelides.
|
|
|
|
At this moment there opened before us a large grotto dug in a picturesque
|
|
heap of rocks and carpeted with all the thick warp of the submarine flora.
|
|
At first it seemed very dark to me. The solar rays seemed to be
|
|
extinguished by successive gradations, until its vague transparency became
|
|
nothing more than drowned light. Captain Nemo entered; we followed.
|
|
My eyes soon accustomed themselves to this relative state of darkness.
|
|
I could distinguish the arches springing capriciously from natural pillars,
|
|
standing broad upon their granite base, like the heavy columns of
|
|
Tuscan architecture. Why had our incomprehensible guide led us to the bottom
|
|
of this submarine crypt? I was soon to know. After descending a rather
|
|
sharp declivity, our feet trod the bottom of a kind of circular pit.
|
|
There Captain Nemo stopped, and with his hand indicated an object I
|
|
had not yet perceived. It was an oyster of extraordinary dimensions,
|
|
a gigantic tridacne, a goblet which could have contained a whole lake of
|
|
holy-water, a basin the breadth of which was more than two yards and a half,
|
|
and consequently larger than that ornamenting the saloon of the Nautilus.
|
|
I approached this extraordinary mollusc. It adhered by its filaments
|
|
to a table of granite, and there, isolated, it developed itself in the calm
|
|
waters of the grotto. I estimated the weight of this tridacne at 600 lb.
|
|
Such an oyster would contain 30 lb. of meat; and one must have the stomach of
|
|
a Gargantua to demolish some dozens of them.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo was evidently acquainted with the existence of this bivalve,
|
|
and seemed to have a particular motive in verifying the actual state
|
|
of this tridacne. The shells were a little open; the Captain came near
|
|
and put his dagger between to prevent them from closing; then with his
|
|
hand he raised the membrane with its fringed edges, which formed a cloak
|
|
for the creature. There, between the folded plaits, I saw a loose pearl,
|
|
whose size equalled that of a coco-nut. Its globular shape, perfect clearness,
|
|
and admirable lustre made it altogether a jewel of inestimable value.
|
|
Carried away by my curiosity, I stretched out my hand to seize it,
|
|
weigh it, and touch it; but the Captain stopped me, made a sign of refusal,
|
|
and quickly withdrew his dagger, and the two shells closed suddenly.
|
|
I then understood Captain Nemo's intention. In leaving this pearl
|
|
hidden in the mantle of the tridacne he was allowing it to grow slowly.
|
|
Each year the secretions of the mollusc would add new concentric circles.
|
|
I estimated its value at L500,000 at least.
|
|
|
|
After ten minutes Captain Nemo stopped suddenly.
|
|
I thought he had halted previously to returning. No; by a
|
|
gesture he bade us crouch beside him in a deep fracture
|
|
of the rock, his hand pointed to one part of the liquid mass,
|
|
which I watched attentively.
|
|
|
|
About five yards from me a shadow appeared, and sank to the ground.
|
|
The disquieting idea of sharks shot through my mind, but I was mistaken;
|
|
and once again it was not a monster of the ocean that we had anything
|
|
to do with.
|
|
|
|
It was a man, a living man, an Indian, a fisherman, a poor
|
|
devil who, I suppose, had come to glean before the harvest.
|
|
I could see the bottom of his canoe anchored some feet above his head.
|
|
He dived and went up successively. A stone held between his feet,
|
|
cut in the shape of a sugar loaf, whilst a rope fastened him to his boat,
|
|
helped him to descend more rapidly. This was all his apparatus.
|
|
Reaching the bottom, about five yards deep, he went on his knees
|
|
and filled his bag with oysters picked up at random. Then he went up,
|
|
emptied it, pulled up his stone, and began the operation once more,
|
|
which lasted thirty seconds.
|
|
|
|
The diver did not see us. The shadow of the rock hid us from sight.
|
|
And how should this poor Indian ever dream that men, beings like himself,
|
|
should be there under the water watching his movements and losing no detail
|
|
of the fishing? Several times he went up in this way, and dived again.
|
|
He did not carry away more than ten at each plunge, for he was obliged to pull
|
|
them from the bank to which they adhered by means of their strong byssus.
|
|
And how many of those oysters for which he risked his life had no pearl
|
|
in them! I watched him closely; his manoeuvres were regular; and for the
|
|
space of half an hour no danger appeared to threaten him.
|
|
|
|
I was beginning to accustom myself to the sight of this interesting fishing,
|
|
when suddenly, as the Indian was on the ground, I saw him make a gesture
|
|
of terror, rise, and make a spring to return to the surface of the sea.
|
|
|
|
I understood his dread. A gigantic shadow appeared just above
|
|
the unfortunate diver. It was a shark of enormous size
|
|
advancing diagonally, his eyes on fire, and his jaws open.
|
|
I was mute with horror and unable to move.
|
|
|
|
The voracious creature shot towards the Indian, who threw
|
|
himself on one side to avoid the shark's fins; but not its tail,
|
|
for it struck his chest and stretched him on the ground.
|
|
|
|
This scene lasted but a few seconds: the shark returned, and,
|
|
turning on his back, prepared himself for cutting the Indian in two,
|
|
when I saw Captain Nemo rise suddenly, and then, dagger in hand,
|
|
walk straight to the monster, ready to fight face to face with him.
|
|
The very moment the shark was going to snap the unhappy fisherman
|
|
in two, he perceived his new adversary, and, turning over,
|
|
made straight towards him.
|
|
|
|
I can still see Captain Nemo's position. Holding himself well together,
|
|
he waited for the shark with admirable coolness; and, when it rushed at him,
|
|
threw himself on one side with wonderful quickness, avoiding the shock,
|
|
and burying his dagger deep into its side. But it was not all over.
|
|
A terrible combat ensued.
|
|
|
|
The shark had seemed to roar, if I might say so. The blood
|
|
rushed in torrents from its wound. The sea was dyed red,
|
|
and through the opaque liquid I could distinguish nothing more.
|
|
Nothing more until the moment when, like lightning, I saw
|
|
the undaunted Captain hanging on to one of the creature's fins,
|
|
struggling, as it were, hand to hand with the monster,
|
|
and dealing successive blows at his enemy, yet still unable to give
|
|
a decisive one.
|
|
|
|
The shark's struggles agitated the water with such fury that the rocking
|
|
threatened to upset me.
|
|
|
|
I wanted to go to the Captain's assistance, but, nailed to the spot
|
|
with horror, I could not stir.
|
|
|
|
I saw the haggard eye; I saw the different phases of the fight.
|
|
The Captain fell to the earth, upset by the enormous mass which leant
|
|
upon him. The shark's jaws opened wide, like a pair of factory shears,
|
|
and it would have been all over with the Captain; but, quick as thought,
|
|
harpoon in hand, Ned Land rushed towards the shark and struck it with
|
|
its sharp point.
|
|
|
|
The waves were impregnated with a mass of blood. They rocked under
|
|
the shark's movements, which beat them with indescribable fury.
|
|
Ned Land had not missed his aim. It was the monster's death-rattle.
|
|
Struck to the heart, it struggled in dreadful convulsions, the shock
|
|
of which overthrew Conseil.
|
|
|
|
But Ned Land had disentangled the Captain, who, getting up without any wound,
|
|
went straight to the Indian, quickly cut the cord which held him
|
|
to his stone, took him in his arms, and, with a sharp blow of his heel,
|
|
mounted to the surface.
|
|
|
|
We all three followed in a few seconds, saved by a miracle,
|
|
and reached the fisherman's boat.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo's first care was to recall the unfortunate
|
|
man to life again. I did not think he could succeed.
|
|
I hoped so, for the poor creature's immersion was not long;
|
|
but the blow from the shark's tail might have been his death-blow.
|
|
|
|
Happily, with the Captain's and Conseil's sharp friction,
|
|
I saw consciousness return by degrees. He opened his eyes.
|
|
What was his surprise, his terror even, at seeing four great
|
|
copper heads leaning over him! And, above all, what must
|
|
he have thought when Captain Nemo, drawing from the pocket
|
|
of his dress a bag of pearls, placed it in his hand!
|
|
This munificent charity from the man of the waters to the poor
|
|
Cingalese was accepted with a trembling hand. His wondering eyes
|
|
showed that he knew not to what super-human beings he owed both
|
|
fortune and life.
|
|
|
|
At a sign from the Captain we regained the bank, and, following the road
|
|
already traversed, came in about half an hour to the anchor which held
|
|
the canoe of the Nautilus to the earth.
|
|
|
|
Once on board, we each, with the help of the sailors, got rid
|
|
of the heavy copper helmet.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo's first word was to the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Thank you, Master Land," said he.
|
|
|
|
"It was in revenge, Captain," replied Ned Land.
|
|
"I owed you that."
|
|
|
|
A ghastly smile passed across the Captain's lips, and that was all.
|
|
|
|
"To the Nautilus," said he.
|
|
|
|
The boat flew over the waves. Some minutes after we met the shark's
|
|
dead body floating. By the black marking of the extremity of its fins,
|
|
I recognised the terrible melanopteron of the Indian Seas, of the species
|
|
of shark so properly called. It was more than twenty-five feet long;
|
|
its enormous mouth occupied one-third of its body. It was an adult,
|
|
as was known by its six rows of teeth placed in an isosceles triangle in
|
|
the upper jaw.
|
|
|
|
Whilst I was contemplating this inert mass, a dozen of these voracious
|
|
beasts appeared round the boat; and, without noticing us, threw themselves
|
|
upon the dead body and fought with one another for the pieces.
|
|
|
|
At half-past eight we were again on board the Nautilus.
|
|
There I reflected on the incidents which had taken place in our
|
|
excursion to the Manaar Bank.
|
|
|
|
Two conclusions I must inevitably draw from it--one bearing
|
|
upon the unparalleled courage of Captain Nemo, the other upon
|
|
his devotion to a human being, a representative of that race
|
|
from which he fled beneath the sea. Whatever he might say,
|
|
this strange man had not yet succeeded in entirely crushing his heart.
|
|
|
|
When I made this observation to him, he answered in a slightly moved tone:
|
|
|
|
"That Indian, sir, is an inhabitant of an oppressed country;
|
|
and I am still, and shall be, to my last breath, one of them!"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER IV
|
|
|
|
THE RED SEA
|
|
|
|
In the course of the day of the 29th of January, the island
|
|
of Ceylon disappeared under the horizon, and the Nautilus,
|
|
at a speed of twenty miles an hour, slid into the labyrinth
|
|
of canals which separate the Maldives from the Laccadives.
|
|
It coasted even the Island of Kiltan, a land originally coraline,
|
|
discovered by Vasco da Gama in 1499, and one of the nineteen
|
|
principal islands of the Laccadive Archipelago, situated between
|
|
10@ and 14@ 30' N. lat., and 69@ 50' 72" E. long.
|
|
|
|
We had made 16,220 miles, or 7,500 (French) leagues from our starting-point
|
|
in the Japanese Seas.
|
|
|
|
The next day (30th January), when the Nautilus went
|
|
to the surface of the ocean there was no land in sight.
|
|
Its course was N.N.E., in the direction of the Sea of Oman,
|
|
between Arabia and the Indian Peninsula, which serves as an
|
|
outlet to the Persian Gulf. It was evidently a block without
|
|
any possible egress. Where was Captain Nemo taking us to?
|
|
I could not say. This, however, did not satisfy the Canadian,
|
|
who that day came to me asking where we were going.
|
|
|
|
"We are going where our Captain's fancy takes us, Master Ned."
|
|
|
|
"His fancy cannot take us far, then," said the Canadian.
|
|
"The Persian Gulf has no outlet: and, if we do go in, it will
|
|
not be long before we are out again."
|
|
|
|
"Very well, then, we will come out again, Master Land; and if,
|
|
after the Persian Gulf, the Nautilus would like to visit the Red Sea,
|
|
the Straits of Bab-el-mandeb are there to give us entrance."
|
|
|
|
"I need not tell you, sir," said Ned Land, "that the Red Sea is as much closed
|
|
as the Gulf, as the Isthmus of Suez is not yet cut; and, if it was, a boat
|
|
as mysterious as ours would not risk itself in a canal cut with sluices.
|
|
And again, the Red Sea is not the road to take us back to Europe."
|
|
|
|
"But I never said we were going back to Europe."
|
|
|
|
"What do you suppose, then?"
|
|
|
|
"I suppose that, after visiting the curious coasts of Arabia
|
|
and Egypt, the Nautilus will go down the Indian Ocean again,
|
|
perhaps cross the Channel of Mozambique, perhaps off the Mascarenhas,
|
|
so as to gain the Cape of Good Hope."
|
|
|
|
"And once at the Cape of Good Hope?" asked the Canadian,
|
|
with peculiar emphasis.
|
|
|
|
"Well, we shall penetrate into that Atlantic which we do not yet know.
|
|
Ah! friend Ned, you are getting tired of this journey under the sea; you are
|
|
surfeited with the incessantly varying spectacle of submarine wonders.
|
|
For my part, I shall be sorry to see the end of a voyage which it is given to
|
|
so few men to make."
|
|
|
|
For four days, till the 3rd of February, the Nautilus scoured
|
|
the Sea of Oman, at various speeds and at various depths.
|
|
It seemed to go at random, as if hesitating as to which road it
|
|
should follow, but we never passed the Tropic of Cancer.
|
|
|
|
In quitting this sea we sighted Muscat for an instant,
|
|
one of the most important towns of the country of Oman.
|
|
I admired its strange aspect, surrounded by black rocks
|
|
upon which its white houses and forts stood in relief.
|
|
I saw the rounded domes of its mosques, the elegant points
|
|
of its minarets, its fresh and verdant terraces. But it was only
|
|
a vision! The Nautilus soon sank under the waves of that part
|
|
of the sea.
|
|
|
|
We passed along the Arabian coast of Mahrah and Hadramaut,
|
|
for a distance of six miles, its undulating line of mountains
|
|
being occasionally relieved by some ancient ruin.
|
|
The 5th of February we at last entered the Gulf of Aden,
|
|
a perfect funnel introduced into the neck of Bab-el-mandeb,
|
|
through which the Indian waters entered the Red Sea.
|
|
|
|
The 6th of February, the Nautilus floated in sight of Aden,
|
|
perched upon a promontory which a narrow isthmus joins to the mainland,
|
|
a kind of inaccessible Gibraltar, the fortifications of which
|
|
were rebuilt by the English after taking possession in 1839.
|
|
I caught a glimpse of the octagon minarets of this town, which was at
|
|
one time the richest commercial magazine on the coast.
|
|
|
|
I certainly thought that Captain Nemo, arrived at this point,
|
|
would back out again; but I was mistaken, for he did no such thing,
|
|
much to my surprise.
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 7th of February, we entered the Straits
|
|
of Bab-el-mandeb, the name of which, in the Arab tongue,
|
|
means The Gate of Tears.
|
|
|
|
To twenty miles in breadth, it is only thirty-two in length.
|
|
And for the Nautilus, starting at full speed, the crossing was scarcely
|
|
the work of an hour. But I saw nothing, not even the Island of Perim,
|
|
with which the British Government has fortified the position of Aden.
|
|
There were too many English or French steamers of the line of Suez
|
|
to Bombay, Calcutta to Melbourne, and from Bourbon to the Mauritius,
|
|
furrowing this narrow passage, for the Nautilus to venture to show itself.
|
|
So it remained prudently below. At last about noon, we were in the waters of
|
|
the Red Sea.
|
|
|
|
I would not even seek to understand the caprice which had decided Captain Nemo
|
|
upon entering the gulf. But I quite approved of the Nautilus entering it.
|
|
Its speed was lessened: sometimes it kept on the surface, sometimes it dived
|
|
to avoid a vessel, and thus I was able to observe the upper and lower parts
|
|
of this curious sea.
|
|
|
|
The 8th of February, from the first dawn of day, Mocha came
|
|
in sight, now a ruined town, whose walls would fall at a gunshot,
|
|
yet which shelters here and there some verdant date-trees;
|
|
once an important city, containing six public markets,
|
|
and twenty-six mosques, and whose walls, defended by fourteen forts,
|
|
formed a girdle of two miles in circumference.
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus then approached the African shore, where the depth of the sea
|
|
was greater. There, between two waters clear as crystal, through the open
|
|
panels we were allowed to contemplate the beautiful bushes of brilliant
|
|
coral and large blocks of rock clothed with a splendid fur of green
|
|
variety of sites and landscapes along these sandbanks and algae and fuci.
|
|
What an indescribable spectacle, and what variety of sites and landscapes
|
|
along these sandbanks and volcanic islands which bound the Libyan coast!
|
|
But where these shrubs appeared in all their beauty was on the eastern coast,
|
|
which the Nautilus soon gained. It was on the coast of Tehama, for there
|
|
not only did this display of zoophytes flourish beneath the level of the sea,
|
|
but they also formed picturesque interlacings which unfolded themselves about
|
|
sixty feet above the surface, more capricious but less highly coloured than
|
|
those whose freshness was kept up by the vital power of the waters.
|
|
|
|
What charming hours I passed thus at the window of the saloon!
|
|
What new specimens of submarine flora and fauna did I admire under
|
|
the brightness of our electric lantern!
|
|
|
|
The 9th of February the Nautilus floated in the broadest part of the Red Sea,
|
|
which is comprised between Souakin, on the west coast, and Komfidah,
|
|
on the east coast, with a diameter of ninety miles.
|
|
|
|
That day at noon, after the bearings were taken, Captain Nemo mounted
|
|
the platform, where I happened to be, and I was determined not to let him go
|
|
down again without at least pressing him regarding his ulterior projects.
|
|
As soon as he saw me he approached and graciously offered me a cigar.
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir, does this Red Sea please you? Have you sufficiently
|
|
observed the wonders it covers, its fishes, its zoophytes,
|
|
its parterres of sponges, and its forests of coral?
|
|
Did you catch a glimpse of the towns on its borders?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Captain Nemo," I replied; "and the Nautilus is wonderfully
|
|
fitted for such a study. Ah! it is an intelligent boat!"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir, intelligent and invulnerable. It fears neither
|
|
the terrible tempests of the Red Sea, nor its currents,
|
|
nor its sandbanks."
|
|
|
|
"Certainly," said I, "this sea is quoted as one of the worst,
|
|
and in the time of the ancients, if I am not mistaken,
|
|
its reputation was detestable."
|
|
|
|
"Detestable, M. Aronnax. The Greek and Latin historians
|
|
do not speak favourably of it, and Strabo says it is very
|
|
dangerous during the Etesian winds and in the rainy season.
|
|
The Arabian Edrisi portrays it under the name of the Gulf of Colzoum,
|
|
and relates that vessels perished there in great numbers on
|
|
the sandbanks and that no one would risk sailing in the night.
|
|
It is, he pretends, a sea subject to fearful hurricanes,
|
|
strewn with inhospitable islands, and `which offers nothing good
|
|
either on its surface or in its depths.'"
|
|
|
|
"One may see," I replied, "that these historians never sailed
|
|
on board the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"Just so," replied the Captain, smiling; "and in that respect
|
|
moderns are not more advanced than the ancients. It required
|
|
many ages to find out the mechanical power of steam. Who knows if,
|
|
in another hundred years, we may not see a second Nautilus?
|
|
Progress is slow, M. Aronnax."
|
|
|
|
"It is true," I answered; "your boat is at least a century before its time,
|
|
perhaps an era. What a misfortune that the secret of such an invention
|
|
should die with its inventor!"
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo did not reply. After some minutes' silence he continued:
|
|
|
|
"You were speaking of the opinions of ancient historians upon
|
|
the dangerous navigation of the Red Sea."
|
|
|
|
"It is true," said I; "but were not their fears exaggerated?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes and no, M. Aronnax," replied Captain Nemo, who seemed to know the Red
|
|
Sea by heart. "That which is no longer dangerous for a modern vessel,
|
|
well rigged, strongly built, and master of its own course, thanks to
|
|
obedient steam, offered all sorts of perils to the ships of the ancients.
|
|
Picture to yourself those first navigators venturing in ships made
|
|
of planks sewn with the cords of the palmtree, saturated with
|
|
the grease of the seadog, and covered with powdered resin!
|
|
They had not even instruments wherewith to take their bearings, and they
|
|
went by guess amongst currents of which they scarcely knew anything.
|
|
Under such conditions shipwrecks were, and must have been, numerous.
|
|
But in our time, steamers running between Suez and the South Seas have
|
|
nothing more to fear from the fury of this gulf, in spite of contrary
|
|
trade-winds. The captain and passengers do not prepare for their
|
|
departure by offering propitiatory sacrifices; and, on their return,
|
|
they no longer go ornamented with wreaths and gilt fillets to thank
|
|
the gods in the neighbouring temple."
|
|
|
|
"I agree with you," said I; "and steam seems to have killed all gratitude
|
|
in the hearts of sailors. But, Captain, since you seem to have especially
|
|
studied this sea, can you tell me the origin of its name?"
|
|
|
|
"There exist several explanations on the subject, M. Aronnax.
|
|
Would you like to know the opinion of a chronicler of
|
|
the fourteenth century?"
|
|
|
|
"Willingly."
|
|
|
|
"This fanciful writer pretends that its name was given to it
|
|
after the passage of the Israelites, when Pharaoh perished
|
|
in the waves which closed at the voice of Moses."
|
|
|
|
"A poet's explanation, Captain Nemo," I replied; "but I cannot content
|
|
myself with that. I ask you for your personal opinion."
|
|
|
|
"Here it is, M. Aronnax. According to my idea, we must see
|
|
in this appellation of the Red Sea a translation of the Hebrew
|
|
word `Edom'; and if the ancients gave it that name, it was
|
|
on account of the particular colour of its waters."
|
|
|
|
"But up to this time I have seen nothing but transparent waves
|
|
and without any particular colour."
|
|
|
|
"Very likely; but as we advance to the bottom of the gulf, you will see
|
|
this singular appearance. I remember seeing the Bay of Tor entirely red,
|
|
like a sea of blood."
|
|
|
|
"And you attribute this colour to the presence of a microscopic seaweed?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes."
|
|
|
|
"So, Captain Nemo, it is not the first time you have overrun
|
|
the Red Sea on board the Nautilus?"
|
|
|
|
"No, sir."
|
|
|
|
"As you spoke a while ago of the passage of the Israelites and of
|
|
the catastrophe to the Egyptians, I will ask whether you have met
|
|
with the traces under the water of this great historical fact?"
|
|
|
|
"No, sir; and for a good reason."
|
|
|
|
"What is it?"
|
|
|
|
"It is that the spot where Moses and his people passed is now so blocked
|
|
up with sand that the camels can barely bathe their legs there.
|
|
You can well understand that there would not be water enough
|
|
for my Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"And the spot?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"The spot is situated a little above the Isthmus of Suez, in the arm
|
|
which formerly made a deep estuary, when the Red Sea extended to
|
|
the Salt Lakes. Now, whether this passage were miraculous or not,
|
|
the Israelites, nevertheless, crossed there to reach the Promised Land,
|
|
and Pharaoh's army perished precisely on that spot; and I think
|
|
that excavations made in the middle of the sand would bring to light
|
|
a large number of arms and instruments of Egyptian origin."
|
|
|
|
"That is evident," I replied; "and for the sake of archaeologists let us
|
|
hope that these excavations will be made sooner or later, when new towns
|
|
are established on the isthmus, after the construction of the Suez Canal;
|
|
a canal, however, very useless to a vessel like the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"Very likely; but useful to the whole world," said Captain Nemo.
|
|
"The ancients well understood the utility of a communication between
|
|
the Red Sea and the Mediterranean for their commercial affairs:
|
|
but they did not think of digging a canal direct, and took the Nile
|
|
as an intermediate. Very probably the canal which united the Nile
|
|
to the Red Sea was begun by Sesostris, if we may believe tradition.
|
|
One thing is certain, that in the year 615 before Jesus Christ,
|
|
Necos undertook the works of an alimentary canal to the waters
|
|
of the Nile across the plain of Egypt, looking towards Arabia.
|
|
It took four days to go up this canal, and it was so wide that
|
|
two triremes could go abreast. It was carried on by Darius,
|
|
the son of Hystaspes, and probably finished by Ptolemy II.
|
|
Strabo saw it navigated: but its decline from the point
|
|
of departure, near Bubastes, to the Red Sea was so slight
|
|
that it was only navigable for a few months in the year.
|
|
This canal answered all commercial purposes to the age
|
|
of Antonius, when it was abandoned and blocked up with sand.
|
|
Restored by order of the Caliph Omar, it was definitely destroyed
|
|
in 761 or 762 by Caliph Al-Mansor, who wished to prevent the arrival
|
|
of provisions to Mohammed-ben-Abdallah, who had revolted against him.
|
|
During the expedition into Egypt, your General Bonaparte discovered
|
|
traces of the works in the Desert of Suez; and, surprised by
|
|
the tide, he nearly perished before regaining Hadjaroth,
|
|
at the very place where Moses had encamped three thousand
|
|
years before him."
|
|
|
|
"Well, Captain, what the ancients dared not undertake, this junction
|
|
between the two seas, which will shorten the road from Cadiz to India,
|
|
M. Lesseps has succeeded in doing; and before long he will have changed
|
|
Africa into an immense island."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, M. Aronnax; you have the right to be proud of your countryman.
|
|
Such a man brings more honour to a nation than great captains.
|
|
He began, like so many others, with disgust and rebuffs;
|
|
but he has triumphed, for he has the genius of will.
|
|
And it is sad to think that a work like that, which ought to have
|
|
been an international work and which would have sufficed to make
|
|
a reign illustrious, should have succeeded by the energy of one man.
|
|
All honour to M. Lesseps!"
|
|
|
|
"Yes! honour to the great citizen," I replied, surprised by the manner
|
|
in which Captain Nemo had just spoken.
|
|
|
|
"Unfortunately," he continued, "I cannot take you through the Suez Canal;
|
|
but you will be able to see the long jetty of Port Said after to-morrow,
|
|
when we shall be in the Mediterranean."
|
|
|
|
"The Mediterranean!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir; does that astonish you?"
|
|
|
|
"What astonishes me is to think that we shall be there
|
|
the day after to-morrow."
|
|
|
|
"Indeed?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Captain, although by this time I ought to have accustomed myself
|
|
to be surprised at nothing since I have been on board your boat."
|
|
|
|
"But the cause of this surprise?"
|
|
|
|
"Well! it is the fearful speed you will have to put on the Nautilus,
|
|
if the day after to-morrow she is to be in the Mediterranean,
|
|
having made the round of Africa, and doubled the Cape of Good Hope!"
|
|
|
|
"Who told you that she would make the round of Africa and double
|
|
the Cape of Good Hope, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"Well, unless the Nautilus sails on dry land, and passes above the isthmus----"
|
|
|
|
"Or beneath it, M. Aronnax."
|
|
|
|
"Beneath it?"
|
|
|
|
"Certainly," replied Captain Nemo quietly. "A long time ago Nature made
|
|
under this tongue of land what man has this day made on its surface."
|
|
|
|
"What! such a passage exists?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes; a subterranean passage, which I have named the Arabian Tunnel.
|
|
It takes us beneath Suez and opens into the Gulf of Pelusium."
|
|
|
|
"But this isthmus is composed of nothing but quick sands?"
|
|
|
|
"To a certain depth. But at fifty-five yards only there is a solid
|
|
layer of rock."
|
|
|
|
"Did you discover this passage by chance?" I asked more and more surprised.
|
|
|
|
"Chance and reasoning, sir; and by reasoning even more than by chance.
|
|
Not only does this passage exist, but I have profited by it several times.
|
|
Without that I should not have ventured this day into the impassable Red Sea.
|
|
I noticed that in the Red Sea and in the Mediterranean there existed a certain
|
|
number of fishes of a kind perfectly identical. Certain of the fact, I asked
|
|
myself was it possible that there was no communication between the two seas?
|
|
If there was, the subterranean current must necessarily run from the Red
|
|
Sea to the Mediterranean, from the sole cause of difference of level.
|
|
I caught a large number of fishes in the neighbourhood of Suez.
|
|
I passed a copper ring through their tails, and threw them back into the sea.
|
|
Some months later, on the coast of Syria, I caught some of my fish ornamented
|
|
with the ring. Thus the communication between the two was proved.
|
|
I then sought for it with my Nautilus; I discovered it, ventured into it,
|
|
and before long, sir, you too will have passed through my Arabian tunnel!"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER V
|
|
|
|
THE ARABIAN TUNNEL
|
|
|
|
That same evening, in 21@ 30' N. lat., the Nautilus floated
|
|
on the surface of the sea, approaching the Arabian coast.
|
|
I saw Djeddah, the most important counting-house of Egypt,
|
|
Syria, Turkey, and India. I distinguished clearly enough
|
|
its buildings, the vessels anchored at the quays, and those whose
|
|
draught of water obliged them to anchor in the roads. The sun,
|
|
rather low on the horizon, struck full on the houses of the town,
|
|
bringing out their whiteness. Outside, some wooden cabins,
|
|
and some made of reeds, showed the quarter inhabited by the Bedouins.
|
|
Soon Djeddah was shut out from view by the shadows of night,
|
|
and the Nautilus found herself under water slightly phosphorescent.
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 10th of February, we sighted several ships running
|
|
to windward. The Nautilus returned to its submarine navigation;
|
|
but at noon, when her bearings were taken, the sea being deserted,
|
|
she rose again to her waterline.
|
|
|
|
Accompanied by Ned and Conseil, I seated myself on the platform.
|
|
The coast on the eastern side looked like a mass faintly printed upon
|
|
a damp fog.
|
|
|
|
We were leaning on the sides of the pinnace, talking of one thing and another,
|
|
when Ned Land, stretching out his hand towards a spot on the sea, said:
|
|
|
|
"Do you see anything there, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"No, Ned," I replied; "but I have not your eyes, you know."
|
|
|
|
"Look well," said Ned, "there, on the starboard beam, about the height
|
|
of the lantern! Do you not see a mass which seems to move?"
|
|
|
|
"Certainly," said I, after close attention; "I see something
|
|
like a long black body on the top of the water."
|
|
|
|
And certainly before long the black object was not more than a mile
|
|
from us. It looked like a great sandbank deposited in the open sea.
|
|
It was a gigantic dugong!
|
|
|
|
Ned Land looked eagerly. His eyes shone with covetousness at
|
|
the sight of the animal. His hand seemed ready to harpoon it.
|
|
One would have thought he was awaiting the moment to throw himself
|
|
into the sea and attack it in its element.
|
|
|
|
At this instant Captain Nemo appeared on the platform.
|
|
He saw the dugong, understood the Canadian's attitude, and,
|
|
addressing him, said:
|
|
|
|
"If you held a harpoon just now, Master Land, would it not burn your hand?"
|
|
|
|
"Just so, sir."
|
|
|
|
"And you would not be sorry to go back, for one day, to your trade
|
|
of a fisherman and to add this cetacean to the list of those you
|
|
have already killed?"
|
|
|
|
"I should not, sir."
|
|
|
|
"Well, you can try."
|
|
|
|
"Thank you, sir," said Ned Land, his eyes flaming.
|
|
|
|
"Only," continued the Captain, "I advise you for your own sake
|
|
not to miss the creature."
|
|
|
|
"Is the dugong dangerous to attack?" I asked, in spite of the Canadian's
|
|
shrug of the shoulders.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," replied the Captain; "sometimes the animal
|
|
turns upon its assailants and overturns their boat.
|
|
But for Master Land this danger is not to be feared.
|
|
His eye is prompt, his arm sure."
|
|
|
|
At this moment seven men of the crew, mute and immovable as ever,
|
|
mounted the platform. One carried a harpoon and a line similar
|
|
to those employed in catching whales. The pinnace was lifted from
|
|
the bridge, pulled from its socket, and let down into the sea.
|
|
Six oarsmen took their seats, and the coxswain went to the tiller.
|
|
Ned, Conseil, and I went to the back of the boat.
|
|
|
|
"You are not coming, Captain?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"No, sir; but I wish you good sport."
|
|
|
|
The boat put off, and, lifted by the six rowers, drew rapidly towards
|
|
the dugong, which floated about two miles from the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
Arrived some cables-length from the cetacean, the speed slackened,
|
|
and the oars dipped noiselessly into the quiet waters.
|
|
Ned Land, harpoon in hand, stood in the fore part of the boat.
|
|
The harpoon used for striking the whale is generally attached to a
|
|
very long cord which runs out rapidly as the wounded creature draws
|
|
it after him. But here the cord was not more than ten fathoms long,
|
|
and the extremity was attached to a small barrel which, by floating,
|
|
was to show the course the dugong took under the water.
|
|
|
|
I stood and carefully watched the Canadian's adversary.
|
|
This dugong, which also bears the name of the halicore,
|
|
closely resembles the manatee; its oblong body terminated
|
|
in a lengthened tail, and its lateral fins in perfect fingers.
|
|
Its difference from the manatee consisted in its upper jaw,
|
|
which was armed with two long and pointed teeth which formed on each
|
|
side diverging tusks.
|
|
|
|
This dugong which Ned Land was preparing to attack was
|
|
of colossal dimensions; it was more than seven yards long.
|
|
It did not move, and seemed to be sleeping on the waves,
|
|
which circumstance made it easier to capture.
|
|
|
|
The boat approached within six yards of the animal.
|
|
The oars rested on the rowlocks. I half rose. Ned Land,
|
|
his body thrown a little back, brandished the harpoon in
|
|
his experienced hand.
|
|
|
|
Suddenly a hissing noise was heard, and the dugong disappeared.
|
|
The harpoon, although thrown with great force; had apparently only
|
|
struck the water.
|
|
|
|
"Curse it!" exclaimed the Canadian furiously; "I have missed it!"
|
|
|
|
"No," said I; "the creature is wounded--look at the blood;
|
|
but your weapon has not stuck in his body."
|
|
|
|
"My harpoon! my harpoon!" cried Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
The sailors rowed on, and the coxswain made for the floating barrel.
|
|
The harpoon regained, we followed in pursuit of the animal.
|
|
|
|
The latter came now and then to the surface to breathe.
|
|
Its wound had not weakened it, for it shot onwards with great rapidity.
|
|
|
|
The boat, rowed by strong arms, flew on its track. Several times it
|
|
approached within some few yards, and the Canadian was ready to strike,
|
|
but the dugong made off with a sudden plunge, and it was impossible
|
|
to reach it.
|
|
|
|
Imagine the passion which excited impatient Ned Land! He hurled at the
|
|
unfortunate creature the most energetic expletives in the English tongue.
|
|
For my part, I was only vexed to see the dugong escape all our attacks.
|
|
|
|
We pursued it without relaxation for an hour, and I began to think
|
|
it would prove difficult to capture, when the animal, possessed with
|
|
the perverse idea of vengeance of which he had cause to repent,
|
|
turned upon the pinnace and assailed us in its turn.
|
|
|
|
This manoeuvre did not escape the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Look out!" he cried.
|
|
|
|
The coxswain said some words in his outlandish tongue,
|
|
doubtless warning the men to keep on their guard.
|
|
|
|
The dugong came within twenty feet of the boat, stopped, sniffed the air
|
|
briskly with its large nostrils (not pierced at the extremity,
|
|
but in the upper part of its muzzle). Then, taking a spring,
|
|
he threw himself upon us.
|
|
|
|
The pinnace could not avoid the shock, and half upset, shipped at least
|
|
two tons of water, which had to be emptied; but, thanks to the coxswain,
|
|
we caught it sideways, not full front, so we were not quite overturned.
|
|
While Ned Land, clinging to the bows, belaboured the gigantic animal with
|
|
blows from his harpoon, the creature's teeth were buried in the gunwale,
|
|
and it lifted the whole thing out of the water, as a lion does a roebuck.
|
|
We were upset over one another, and I know not how the adventure would
|
|
have ended, if the Canadian, still enraged with the beast, had not struck it
|
|
to the heart.
|
|
|
|
I heard its teeth grind on the iron plate, and the dugong disappeared,
|
|
carrying the harpoon with him. But the barrel soon returned to the surface,
|
|
and shortly after the body of the animal, turned on its back.
|
|
The boat came up with it, took it in tow, and made straight for the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
It required tackle of enormous strength to hoist the dugong
|
|
on to the platform. It weighed 10,000 lb.
|
|
|
|
The next day, 11th February, the larder of the Nautilus was enriched by some
|
|
more delicate game. A flight of sea-swallows rested on the Nautilus.
|
|
It was a species of the Sterna nilotica, peculiar to Egypt; its beak is black,
|
|
head grey and pointed, the eye surrounded by white spots, the back, wings,
|
|
and tail of a greyish colour, the belly and throat white, and claws red.
|
|
They also took some dozen of Nile ducks, a wild bird of high flavour,
|
|
its throat and upper part of the head white with black spots.
|
|
|
|
About five o'clock in the evening we sighted to the north the Cape
|
|
of Ras-Mohammed. This cape forms the extremity of Arabia Petraea,
|
|
comprised between the Gulf of Suez and the Gulf of Acabah.
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus penetrated into the Straits of Jubal, which leads
|
|
to the Gulf of Suez. I distinctly saw a high mountain,
|
|
towering between the two gulfs of Ras-Mohammed. It was Mount Horeb,
|
|
that Sinai at the top of which Moses saw God face to face.
|
|
|
|
At six o'clock the Nautilus, sometimes floating, sometimes immersed,
|
|
passed some distance from Tor, situated at the end of the bay, the waters
|
|
of which seemed tinted with red, an observation already made by Captain Nemo.
|
|
Then night fell in the midst of a heavy silence, sometimes broken by the cries
|
|
of the pelican and other night-birds, and the noise of the waves breaking upon
|
|
the shore, chafing against the rocks, or the panting of some far-off steamer
|
|
beating the waters of the Gulf with its noisy paddles.
|
|
|
|
From eight to nine o'clock the Nautilus remained some fathoms
|
|
under the water. According to my calculation we must have
|
|
been very near Suez. Through the panel of the saloon I saw
|
|
the bottom of the rocks brilliantly lit up by our electric lamp.
|
|
We seemed to be leaving the Straits behind us more and more.
|
|
|
|
At a quarter-past nine, the vessel having returned to the surface,
|
|
I mounted the platform. Most impatient to pass through Captain
|
|
Nemo's tunnel, I could not stay in one place, so came to breathe
|
|
the fresh night air.
|
|
|
|
Soon in the shadow I saw a pale light, half discoloured by the fog,
|
|
shining about a mile from us.
|
|
|
|
"A floating lighthouse!" said someone near me.
|
|
|
|
I turned, and saw the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"It is the floating light of Suez," he continued.
|
|
"It will not be long before we gain the entrance of the tunnel."
|
|
|
|
"The entrance cannot be easy?"
|
|
|
|
"No, sir; for that reason I am accustomed to go into the steersman's cage
|
|
and myself direct our course. And now, if you will go down, M. Aronnax,
|
|
the Nautilus is going under the waves, and will not return to the surface
|
|
until we have passed through the Arabian Tunnel."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo led me towards the central staircase; half way down he opened
|
|
a door, traversed the upper deck, and landed in the pilot's cage,
|
|
which it may be remembered rose at the extremity of the platform.
|
|
It was a cabin measuring six feet square, very much like that occupied
|
|
by the pilot on the steamboats of the Mississippi or Hudson.
|
|
In the midst worked a wheel, placed vertically, and caught
|
|
to the tiller-rope, which ran to the back of the Nautilus.
|
|
Four light-ports with lenticular glasses, let in a groove in
|
|
the partition of the cabin, allowed the man at the wheel to see
|
|
in all directions.
|
|
|
|
This cabin was dark; but soon my eyes accustomed themselves to the obscurity,
|
|
and I perceived the pilot, a strong man, with his hands resting on the spokes
|
|
of the wheel. Outside, the sea appeared vividly lit up by the lantern,
|
|
which shed its rays from the back of the cabin to the other extremity
|
|
of the platform.
|
|
|
|
"Now," said Captain Nemo, "let us try to make our passage."
|
|
|
|
Electric wires connected the pilot's cage with the machinery room,
|
|
and from there the Captain could communicate simultaneously to his
|
|
Nautilus the direction and the speed. He pressed a metal knob,
|
|
and at once the speed of the screw diminished.
|
|
|
|
I looked in silence at the high straight wall we were running
|
|
by at this moment, the immovable base of a massive sandy coast.
|
|
We followed it thus for an hour only some few yards off.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo did not take his eye from the knob, suspended by
|
|
its two concentric circles in the cabin. At a simple gesture,
|
|
the pilot modified the course of the Nautilus every instant.
|
|
|
|
I had placed myself at the port-scuttle, and saw some magnificent
|
|
substructures of coral, zoophytes, seaweed, and fucus, agitating their
|
|
enormous claws, which stretched out from the fissures of the rock.
|
|
|
|
At a quarter-past ten, the Captain himself took the helm.
|
|
A large gallery, black and deep, opened before us. The Nautilus
|
|
went boldly into it. A strange roaring was heard round its sides.
|
|
It was the waters of the Red Sea, which the incline of
|
|
the tunnel precipitated violently towards the Mediterranean.
|
|
The Nautilus went with the torrent, rapid as an arrow, in spite
|
|
of the efforts of the machinery, which, in order to offer more
|
|
effective resistance, beat the waves with reversed screw.
|
|
|
|
On the walls of the narrow passage I could see nothing
|
|
but brilliant rays, straight lines, furrows of fire,
|
|
traced by the great speed, under the brilliant electric light.
|
|
My heart beat fast.
|
|
|
|
At thirty-five minutes past ten, Captain Nemo quitted the helm,
|
|
and, turning to me, said:
|
|
|
|
"The Mediterranean!"
|
|
|
|
In less than twenty minutes, the Nautilus, carried along by the torrent,
|
|
had passed through the Isthmus of Suez.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER VI
|
|
|
|
THE GRECIAN ARCHIPELAGO
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 12th of February, at the dawn of day,
|
|
the Nautilus rose to the surface. I hastened on to the platform.
|
|
Three miles to the south the dim outline of Pelusium was to be seen.
|
|
A torrent had carried us from one sea to another.
|
|
About seven o'clock Ned and Conseil joined me.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Sir Naturalist," said the Canadian, in a slightly jovial tone,
|
|
"and the Mediterranean?"
|
|
|
|
"We are floating on its surface, friend Ned."
|
|
|
|
"What!" said Conseil, "this very night."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, this very night; in a few minutes we have passed
|
|
this impassable isthmus."
|
|
|
|
"I do not believe it," replied the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Then you are wrong, Master Land," I continued; "this low
|
|
coast which rounds off to the south is the Egyptian coast.
|
|
And you who have such good eyes, Ned, you can see the jetty of Port
|
|
Said stretching into the sea."
|
|
|
|
The Canadian looked attentively.
|
|
|
|
"Certainly you are right, sir, and your Captain is a first-rate man.
|
|
We are in the Mediterranean. Good! Now, if you please, let us talk
|
|
of our own little affair, but so that no one hears us."
|
|
|
|
I saw what the Canadian wanted, and, in any case, I thought it better to let
|
|
him talk, as he wished it; so we all three went and sat down near the lantern,
|
|
where we were less exposed to the spray of the blades.
|
|
|
|
"Now, Ned, we listen; what have you to tell us?"
|
|
|
|
"What I have to tell you is very simple. We are in Europe; and before
|
|
Captain Nemo's caprices drag us once more to the bottom of the Polar Seas,
|
|
or lead us into Oceania, I ask to leave the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
I wished in no way to shackle the liberty of my companions,
|
|
but I certainly felt no desire to leave Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
Thanks to him, and thanks to his apparatus, I was each day
|
|
nearer the completion of my submarine studies; and I was
|
|
rewriting my book of submarine depths in its very element.
|
|
Should I ever again have such an opportunity of observing
|
|
the wonders of the ocean? No, certainly not! And I could
|
|
not bring myself to the idea of abandoning the Nautilus before
|
|
the cycle of investigation was accomplished.
|
|
|
|
"Friend Ned, answer me frankly, are you tired of being on board?
|
|
Are you sorry that destiny has thrown us into Captain Nemo's hands?"
|
|
|
|
The Canadian remained some moments without answering.
|
|
Then, crossing his arms, he said:
|
|
|
|
"Frankly, I do not regret this journey under the seas. I shall be glad
|
|
to have made it; but, now that it is made, let us have done with it.
|
|
That is my idea."
|
|
|
|
"It will come to an end, Ned."
|
|
|
|
"Where and when?"
|
|
|
|
"Where I do not know--when I cannot say; or, rather, I suppose
|
|
it will end when these seas have nothing more to teach us."
|
|
|
|
"Then what do you hope for?" demanded the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"That circumstances may occur as well six months hence as now by which we
|
|
may and ought to profit."
|
|
|
|
"Oh!" said Ned Land, "and where shall we be in six months,
|
|
if you please, Sir Naturalist?"
|
|
|
|
"Perhaps in China; you know the Nautilus is a rapid traveller.
|
|
It goes through water as swallows through the air, or as an express
|
|
on the land. It does not fear frequented seas; who can say
|
|
that it may not beat the coasts of France, England, or America,
|
|
on which flight may be attempted as advantageously as here."
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax," replied the Canadian, "your arguments are rotten
|
|
at the foundation. You speak in the future, `We shall be there!
|
|
we shall be here!' I speak in the present, `We are here,
|
|
and we must profit by it.'"
|
|
|
|
Ned Land's logic pressed me hard, and I felt myself beaten on that ground.
|
|
I knew not what argument would now tell in my favour.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," continued Ned, "let us suppose an impossibility:
|
|
if Captain Nemo should this day offer you your liberty;
|
|
would you accept it?"
|
|
|
|
"I do not know," I answered.
|
|
|
|
"And if," he added, "the offer made you this day was never to be renewed,
|
|
would you accept it?"
|
|
|
|
"Friend Ned, this is my answer. Your reasoning is against me.
|
|
We must not rely on Captain Nemo's good-will. Common prudence
|
|
forbids him to set us at liberty. On the other side, prudence bids
|
|
us profit by the first opportunity to leave the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"Well, M. Aronnax, that is wisely said."
|
|
|
|
"Only one observation--just one. The occasion must be serious,
|
|
and our first attempt must succeed; if it fails, we shall never
|
|
find another, and Captain Nemo will never forgive us."
|
|
|
|
"All that is true," replied the Canadian. "But your observation
|
|
applies equally to all attempts at flight, whether in two years'
|
|
time, or in two days'. But the question is still this:
|
|
If a favourable opportunity presents itself, it must be seized."
|
|
|
|
"Agreed! And now, Ned, will you tell me what you mean
|
|
by a favourable opportunity?"
|
|
|
|
"It will be that which, on a dark night, will bring the Nautilus
|
|
a short distance from some European coast."
|
|
|
|
"And you will try and save yourself by swimming?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, if we were near enough to the bank, and if the vessel
|
|
was floating at the time. Not if the bank was far away,
|
|
and the boat was under the water."
|
|
|
|
"And in that case?"
|
|
|
|
"In that case, I should seek to make myself master of the pinnace.
|
|
I know how it is worked. We must get inside, and the bolts once drawn,
|
|
we shall come to the surface of the water, without even the pilot,
|
|
who is in the bows, perceiving our flight."
|
|
|
|
"Well, Ned, watch for the opportunity; but do not forget that a hitch
|
|
will ruin us."
|
|
|
|
"I will not forget, sir."
|
|
|
|
"And now, Ned, would you like to know what I think of your project?"
|
|
|
|
"Certainly, M. Aronnax."
|
|
|
|
"Well, I think--I do not say I hope--I think that this favourable
|
|
opportunity will never present itself."
|
|
|
|
"Why not?"
|
|
|
|
"Because Captain Nemo cannot hide from himself that we have not given up
|
|
all hope of regaining our liberty, and he will be on his guard, above all,
|
|
in the seas and in the sight of European coasts."
|
|
|
|
"We shall see," replied Ned Land, shaking his head determinedly.
|
|
|
|
"And now, Ned Land," I added, "let us stop here.
|
|
Not another word on the subject. The day that you
|
|
are ready, come and let us know, and we will follow you.
|
|
I rely entirely upon you."
|
|
|
|
Thus ended a conversation which, at no very distant time,
|
|
led to such grave results. I must say here that facts seemed
|
|
to confirm my foresight, to the Canadian's great despair.
|
|
Did Captain Nemo distrust us in these frequented seas? or did
|
|
he only wish to hide himself from the numerous vessels,
|
|
of all nations, which ploughed the Mediterranean?
|
|
I could not tell; but we were oftener between waters
|
|
and far from the coast. Or, if the Nautilus did emerge,
|
|
nothing was to be seen but the pilot's cage; and sometimes it
|
|
went to great depths, for, between the Grecian Archipelago
|
|
and Asia Minor we could not touch the bottom by more than
|
|
a thousand fathoms.
|
|
|
|
Thus I only knew we were near the Island of Carpathos, one of the Sporades,
|
|
by Captain Nemo reciting these lines from Virgil:
|
|
|
|
"Est Carpathio Neptuni gurgite vates, Caeruleus Proteus,"
|
|
|
|
as he pointed to a spot on the planisphere.
|
|
|
|
It was indeed the ancient abode of Proteus, the old shepherd of Neptune's
|
|
flocks, now the Island of Scarpanto, situated between Rhodes and Crete.
|
|
I saw nothing but the granite base through the glass panels of the saloon.
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 14th of February, I resolved to employ some hours in
|
|
studying the fishes of the Archipelago; but for some reason or other the
|
|
panels remained hermetically sealed. Upon taking the course of the Nautilus,
|
|
I found that we were going towards Candia, the ancient Isle of Crete.
|
|
At the time I embarked on the Abraham Lincoln, the whole of this
|
|
island had risen in insurrection against the despotism of the Turks.
|
|
But how the insurgents had fared since that time I was absolutely ignorant,
|
|
and it was not Captain Nemo, deprived of all land communications,
|
|
who could tell me.
|
|
|
|
I made no allusion to this event when that night I found myself alone
|
|
with him in the saloon. Besides, he seemed to be taciturn and preoccupied.
|
|
Then, contrary to his custom, he ordered both panels to be opened, and,
|
|
going from one to the other, observed the mass of waters attentively.
|
|
To what end I could not guess; so, on my side, I employed my time in studying
|
|
the fish passing before my eyes.
|
|
|
|
In the midst of the waters a man appeared, a diver, carrying at his
|
|
belt a leathern purse. It was not a body abandoned to the waves;
|
|
it was a living man, swimming with a strong hand, disappearing occasionally
|
|
to take breath at the surface.
|
|
|
|
I turned towards Captain Nemo, and in an agitated voice exclaimed:
|
|
|
|
"A man shipwrecked! He must be saved at any price!"
|
|
|
|
The Captain did not answer me, but came and leaned against the panel.
|
|
|
|
The man had approached, and, with his face flattened against the glass,
|
|
was looking at us.
|
|
|
|
To my great amazement, Captain Nemo signed to him.
|
|
The diver answered with his hand, mounted immediately to
|
|
the surface of the water, and did not appear again.
|
|
|
|
"Do not be uncomfortable," said Captain Nemo. "It is Nicholas of
|
|
Cape Matapan, surnamed Pesca. He is well known in all the Cyclades.
|
|
A bold diver! water is his element, and he lives more in it than on land,
|
|
going continually from one island to another, even as far as Crete."
|
|
|
|
"You know him, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"Why not, M. Aronnax?"
|
|
|
|
Saying which, Captain Nemo went towards a piece of furniture standing
|
|
near the left panel of the saloon. Near this piece of furniture,
|
|
I saw a chest bound with iron, on the cover of which was a copper plate,
|
|
bearing the cypher of the Nautilus with its device.
|
|
|
|
At that moment, the Captain, without noticing my presence,
|
|
opened the piece of furniture, a sort of strong box, which held
|
|
a great many ingots.
|
|
|
|
They were ingots of gold. From whence came this precious metal,
|
|
which represented an enormous sum? Where did the Captain gather
|
|
this gold from? and what was he going to do with it?
|
|
|
|
I did not say one word. I looked. Captain Nemo took the ingots one by one,
|
|
and arranged them methodically in the chest, which he filled entirely.
|
|
I estimated the contents at more than 4,000 lb. weight of gold, that is
|
|
to say, nearly L200,000.
|
|
|
|
The chest was securely fastened, and the Captain wrote an address on the lid,
|
|
in characters which must have belonged to Modern Greece.
|
|
|
|
This done, Captain Nemo pressed a knob, the wire of which communicated with
|
|
the quarters of the crew. Four men appeared, and, not without some trouble,
|
|
pushed the chest out of the saloon. Then I heard them hoisting it up the iron
|
|
staircase by means of pulleys.
|
|
|
|
At that moment, Captain Nemo turned to me.
|
|
|
|
"And you were saying, sir?" said he.
|
|
|
|
"I was saying nothing, Captain."
|
|
|
|
"Then, sir, if you will allow me, I will wish you good night."
|
|
|
|
Whereupon he turned and left the saloon.
|
|
|
|
I returned to my room much troubled, as one may believe.
|
|
I vainly tried to sleep--I sought the connecting link between
|
|
the apparition of the diver and the chest filled with gold.
|
|
Soon, I felt by certain movements of pitching and tossing
|
|
that the Nautilus was leaving the depths and returning
|
|
to the surface.
|
|
|
|
Then I heard steps upon the platform; and I knew they were
|
|
unfastening the pinnace and launching it upon the waves.
|
|
For one instant it struck the side of the Nautilus,
|
|
then all noise ceased.
|
|
|
|
Two hours after, the same noise, the same going and coming was renewed;
|
|
the boat was hoisted on board, replaced in its socket, and the Nautilus
|
|
again plunged under the waves.
|
|
|
|
So these millions had been transported to their address.
|
|
To what point of the continent? Who was Captain Nemo's correspondent?
|
|
|
|
The next day I related to Conseil and the Canadian the events
|
|
of the night, which had excited my curiosity to the highest degree.
|
|
My companions were not less surprised than myself.
|
|
|
|
"But where does he take his millions to?" asked Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
To that there was no possible answer. I returned to the saloon
|
|
after having breakfast and set to work. Till five o'clock
|
|
in the evening I employed myself in arranging my notes.
|
|
At that moment--(ought I to attribute it to some peculiar idiosyncrasy)--
|
|
I felt so great a heat that I was obliged to take off my coat.
|
|
It was strange, for we were under low latitudes; and even then the Nautilus,
|
|
submerged as it was, ought to experience no change of temperature.
|
|
I looked at the manometer; it showed a depth of sixty feet, to which
|
|
atmospheric heat could never attain.
|
|
|
|
I continued my work, but the temperature rose to such a pitch
|
|
as to be intolerable.
|
|
|
|
"Could there be fire on board?" I asked myself.
|
|
|
|
I was leaving the saloon, when Captain Nemo entered; he approached
|
|
the thermometer, consulted it, and, turning to me, said:
|
|
|
|
"Forty-two degrees."
|
|
|
|
"I have noticed it, Captain," I replied; "and if it gets much
|
|
hotter we cannot bear it."
|
|
|
|
"Oh, sir, it will not get better if we do not wish it."
|
|
|
|
"You can reduce it as you please, then?"
|
|
|
|
"No; but I can go farther from the stove which produces it."
|
|
|
|
"It is outward, then!"
|
|
|
|
"Certainly; we are floating in a current of boiling water."
|
|
|
|
"Is it possible!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"Look."
|
|
|
|
The panels opened, and I saw the sea entirely white all round.
|
|
A sulphurous smoke was curling amid the waves, which boiled like
|
|
water in a copper. I placed my hand on one of the panes of glass,
|
|
but the heat was so great that I quickly took it off again.
|
|
|
|
"Where are we?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"Near the Island of Santorin, sir," replied the Captain.
|
|
"I wished to give you a sight of the curious spectacle of
|
|
a submarine eruption."
|
|
|
|
"I thought," said I, "that the formation of these new islands was ended."
|
|
|
|
"Nothing is ever ended in the volcanic parts of the sea,"
|
|
replied Captain Nemo; "and the globe is always being worked by
|
|
subterranean fires. Already, in the nineteenth year of our era,
|
|
according to Cassiodorus and Pliny, a new island, Theia
|
|
(the divine), appeared in the very place where these islets
|
|
have recently been formed. Then they sank under the waves,
|
|
to rise again in the year 69, when they again subsided.
|
|
Since that time to our days the Plutonian work has been suspended.
|
|
But on the 3rd of February, 1866, a new island, which they named
|
|
George Island, emerged from the midst of the sulphurous vapour
|
|
near Nea Kamenni, and settled again the 6th of the same month.
|
|
Seven days after, the 13th of February, the Island of Aphroessa
|
|
appeared, leaving between Nea Kamenni and itself a canal ten
|
|
yards broad. I was in these seas when the phenomenon occurred,
|
|
and I was able therefore to observe all the different phases.
|
|
The Island of Aphroessa, of round form, measured 300 feet
|
|
in diameter, and 30 feet in height. It was composed of
|
|
black and vitreous lava, mixed with fragments of felspar.
|
|
And lastly, on the 10th of March, a smaller island, called Reka,
|
|
showed itself near Nea Kamenni, and since then these three have
|
|
joined together, forming but one and the same island."
|
|
|
|
"And the canal in which we are at this moment?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"Here it is," replied Captain Nemo, showing me a map of the Archipelago.
|
|
"You see, I have marked the new islands."
|
|
|
|
I returned to the glass. The Nautilus was no longer moving,
|
|
the heat was becoming unbearable. The sea, which till now had
|
|
been white, was red, owing to the presence of salts of iron.
|
|
In spite of the ship's being hermetically sealed, an insupportable
|
|
smell of sulphur filled the saloon, and the brilliancy of the
|
|
electricity was entirely extinguished by bright scarlet flames.
|
|
I was in a bath, I was choking, I was broiled.
|
|
|
|
"We can remain no longer in this boiling water," said I to the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"It would not be prudent," replied the impassive Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
An order was given; the Nautilus tacked about and left
|
|
the furnace it could not brave with impunity. A quarter
|
|
of an hour after we were breathing fresh air on the surface.
|
|
The thought then struck me that, if Ned Land had chosen this part
|
|
of the sea for our flight, we should never have come alive out
|
|
of this sea of fire.
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 16th of February, we left the basin which,
|
|
between Rhodes and Alexandria, is reckoned about 1,500 fathoms
|
|
in depth, and the Nautilus, passing some distance from Cerigo,
|
|
quitted the Grecian Archipelago after having doubled Cape Matapan.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER VII
|
|
|
|
THE MEDITERRANEAN IN FORTY-EIGHT HOURS
|
|
|
|
The Mediterranean, the blue sea par excellence, "the great sea"
|
|
of the Hebrews, "the sea" of the Greeks, the "mare nostrum"
|
|
of the Romans, bordered by orange-trees, aloes, cacti, and sea-pines;
|
|
embalmed with the perfume of the myrtle, surrounded by rude mountains,
|
|
saturated with pure and transparent air, but incessantly worked
|
|
by underground fires; a perfect battlefield in which Neptune and Pluto
|
|
still dispute the empire of the world!
|
|
|
|
It is upon these banks, and on these waters, says Michelet, that man
|
|
is renewed in one of the most powerful climates of the globe.
|
|
But, beautiful as it was, I could only take a rapid glance at
|
|
the basin whose superficial area is two million of square yards.
|
|
Even Captain Nemo's knowledge was lost to me, for this puzzling
|
|
person did not appear once during our passage at full speed.
|
|
I estimated the course which the Nautilus took under the waves
|
|
of the sea at about six hundred leagues, and it was accomplished
|
|
in forty-eight hours. Starting on the morning of the 16th
|
|
of February from the shores of Greece, we had crossed the Straits
|
|
of Gibraltar by sunrise on the 18th.
|
|
|
|
It was plain to me that this Mediterranean, enclosed in the midst of those
|
|
countries which he wished to avoid, was distasteful to Captain Nemo.
|
|
Those waves and those breezes brought back too many remembrances, if not
|
|
too many regrets. Here he had no longer that independence and that liberty
|
|
of gait which he had when in the open seas, and his Nautilus felt itself
|
|
cramped between the close shores of Africa and Europe.
|
|
|
|
Our speed was now twenty-five miles an hour. It may be well
|
|
understood that Ned Land, to his great disgust, was obliged
|
|
to renounce his intended flight. He could not launch the pinnace,
|
|
going at the rate of twelve or thirteen yards every second.
|
|
To quit the Nautilus under such conditions would be as bad
|
|
as jumping from a train going at full speed--an imprudent thing,
|
|
to say the least of it. Besides, our vessel only mounted
|
|
to the surface of the waves at night to renew its stock of air;
|
|
it was steered entirely by the compass and the log.
|
|
|
|
I saw no more of the interior of this Mediterranean than a traveller
|
|
by express train perceives of the landscape which flies before his eyes;
|
|
that is to say, the distant horizon, and not the nearer objects which pass
|
|
like a flash of lightning.
|
|
|
|
We were then passing between Sicily and the coast of Tunis.
|
|
In the narrow space between Cape Bon and the Straits
|
|
of Messina the bottom of the sea rose almost suddenly.
|
|
There was a perfect bank, on which there was not more than
|
|
nine fathoms of water, whilst on either side the depth
|
|
was ninety fathoms.
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus had to manoeuvre very carefully so as not to strike
|
|
against this submarine barrier.
|
|
|
|
I showed Conseil, on the map of the Mediterranean, the spot occupied
|
|
by this reef.
|
|
|
|
"But if you please, sir," observed Conseil, "it is like a real
|
|
isthmus joining Europe to Africa."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, my boy, it forms a perfect bar to the Straits of Lybia,
|
|
and the soundings of Smith have proved that in former times
|
|
the continents between Cape Boco and Cape Furina were joined."
|
|
|
|
"I can well believe it," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"I will add," I continued, "that a similar barrier exists between Gibraltar
|
|
and Ceuta, which in geological times formed the entire Mediterranean."
|
|
|
|
"What if some volcanic burst should one day raise these two barriers
|
|
above the waves?"
|
|
|
|
"It is not probable, Conseil."
|
|
|
|
"Well, but allow me to finish, please, sir; if this phenomenon
|
|
should take place, it will be troublesome for M. Lesseps,
|
|
who has taken so much pains to pierce the isthmus."
|
|
|
|
"I agree with you; but I repeat, Conseil, this phenomenon will
|
|
never happen. The violence of subterranean force is ever diminishing.
|
|
Volcanoes, so plentiful in the first days of the world,
|
|
are being extinguished by degrees; the internal heat is weakened,
|
|
the temperature of the lower strata of the globe is lowered by a
|
|
perceptible quantity every century to the detriment of our globe,
|
|
for its heat is its life."
|
|
|
|
"But the sun?"
|
|
|
|
"The sun is not sufficient, Conseil. Can it give heat to a dead body?"
|
|
|
|
"Not that I know of."
|
|
|
|
"Well, my friend, this earth will one day be that cold corpse;
|
|
it will become uninhabitable and uninhabited like the moon,
|
|
which has long since lost all its vital heat."
|
|
|
|
"In how many centuries?"
|
|
|
|
"In some hundreds of thousands of years, my boy."
|
|
|
|
"Then," said Conseil, "we shall have time to finish our journey--
|
|
that is, if Ned Land does not interfere with it."
|
|
|
|
And Conseil, reassured, returned to the study of the bank,
|
|
which the Nautilus was skirting at a moderate speed.
|
|
|
|
During the night of the 16th and 17th February we had entered the second
|
|
Mediterranean basin, the greatest depth of which was 1,450 fathoms.
|
|
The Nautilus, by the action of its crew, slid down the inclined planes
|
|
and buried itself in the lowest depths of the sea.
|
|
|
|
On the 18th of February, about three o'clock in the morning, we were at
|
|
the entrance of the Straits of Gibraltar. There once existed two currents:
|
|
an upper one, long since recognised, which conveys the waters of the ocean
|
|
into the basin of the Mediterranean; and a lower counter-current,
|
|
which reasoning has now shown to exist. Indeed, the volume of water
|
|
in the Mediterranean, incessantly added to by the waves of the Atlantic
|
|
and by rivers falling into it, would each year raise the level of this sea,
|
|
for its evaporation is not sufficient to restore the equilibrium.
|
|
As it is not so, we must necessarily admit the existence of an under-current,
|
|
which empties into the basin of the Atlantic through the Straits
|
|
of Gibraltar the surplus waters of the Mediterranean. A fact indeed;
|
|
and it was this counter-current by which the Nautilus profited.
|
|
It advanced rapidly by the narrow pass. For one instant I caught a glimpse
|
|
of the beautiful ruins of the temple of Hercules, buried in the ground,
|
|
according to Pliny, and with the low island which supports it; and a few
|
|
minutes later we were floating on the Atlantic.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER VIII
|
|
|
|
VIGO BAY
|
|
|
|
The Atlantic! a vast sheet of water whose superficial area covers
|
|
twenty-five millions of square miles, the length of which is nine
|
|
thousand miles, with a mean breadth of two thousand seven hundred--
|
|
an ocean whose parallel winding shores embrace an immense circumference,
|
|
watered by the largest rivers of the world, the St. Lawrence,
|
|
the Mississippi, the Amazon, the Plata, the Orinoco, the Niger,
|
|
the Senegal, the Elbe, the Loire, and the Rhine, which carry water
|
|
from the most civilised, as well as from the most savage, countries!
|
|
Magnificent field of water, incessantly ploughed by vessels
|
|
of every nation, sheltered by the flags of every nation, and which
|
|
terminates in those two terrible points so dreaded by mariners,
|
|
Cape Horn and the Cape of Tempests.
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus was piercing the water with its sharp spur,
|
|
after having accomplished nearly ten thousand leagues in three months
|
|
and a half, a distance greater than the great circle of the earth.
|
|
Where were we going now, and what was reserved for the future?
|
|
The Nautilus, leaving the Straits of Gibraltar, had gone far out.
|
|
It returned to the surface of the waves, and our daily walks on the
|
|
platform were restored to us.
|
|
|
|
I mounted at once, accompanied by Ned Land and Conseil.
|
|
At a distance of about twelve miles, Cape St. Vincent
|
|
was dimly to be seen, forming the south-western point of
|
|
the Spanish peninsula. A strong southerly gale was blowing.
|
|
The sea was swollen and billowy; it made the Nautilus rock violently.
|
|
It was almost impossible to keep one's foot on the platform,
|
|
which the heavy rolls of the sea beat over every instant.
|
|
So we descended after inhaling some mouthfuls of fresh air.
|
|
|
|
I returned to my room, Conseil to his cabin; but the Canadian,
|
|
with a preoccupied air, followed me. Our rapid passage across
|
|
the Mediterranean had not allowed him to put his project
|
|
into execution, and he could not help showing his disappointment.
|
|
When the door of my room was shut, he sat down and looked
|
|
at me silently.
|
|
|
|
"Friend Ned," said I, "I understand you; but you cannot reproach yourself.
|
|
To have attempted to leave the Nautilus under the circumstances would
|
|
have been folly."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land did not answer; his compressed lips and frowning brow showed
|
|
with him the violent possession this fixed idea had taken of his mind.
|
|
|
|
"Let us see," I continued; "we need not despair yet.
|
|
We are going up the coast of Portugal again; France and
|
|
England are not far off, where we can easily find refuge.
|
|
Now if the Nautilus, on leaving the Straits of Gibraltar,
|
|
had gone to the south, if it had carried us towards regions
|
|
where there were no continents, I should share your uneasiness.
|
|
But we know now that Captain Nemo does not fly from civilised seas,
|
|
and in some days I think you can act with security."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land still looked at me fixedly; at length his fixed lips parted,
|
|
and he said, "It is for to-night."
|
|
|
|
I drew myself up suddenly. I was, I admit, little prepared
|
|
for this communication. I wanted to answer the Canadian,
|
|
but words would not come.
|
|
|
|
"We agreed to wait for an opportunity," continued Ned Land,
|
|
"and the opportunity has arrived. This night we shall
|
|
be but a few miles from the Spanish coast. It is cloudy.
|
|
The wind blows freely. I have your word, M. Aronnax, and I
|
|
rely upon you."
|
|
|
|
As I was silent, the Canadian approached me.
|
|
|
|
"To-night, at nine o'clock," said he. "I have warned Conseil.
|
|
At that moment Captain Nemo will be shut up in his room, probably in bed.
|
|
Neither the engineers nor the ship's crew can see us.
|
|
Conseil and I will gain the central staircase, and you, M. Aronnax,
|
|
will remain in the library, two steps from us, waiting my signal.
|
|
The oars, the mast, and the sail are in the canoe. I have even succeeded
|
|
in getting some provisions. I have procured an English wrench,
|
|
to unfasten the bolts which attach it to the shell of the Nautilus.
|
|
So all is ready, till to-night."
|
|
|
|
"The sea is bad."
|
|
|
|
"That I allow," replied the Canadian; "but we must risk that.
|
|
Liberty is worth paying for; besides, the boat is strong,
|
|
and a few miles with a fair wind to carry us is no great thing.
|
|
Who knows but by to-morrow we may be a hundred leagues away?
|
|
Let circumstances only favour us, and by ten or eleven o'clock we
|
|
shall have landed on some spot of terra firma, alive or dead.
|
|
But adieu now till to-night."
|
|
|
|
With these words the Canadian withdrew, leaving me almost dumb.
|
|
I had imagined that, the chance gone, I should have time to
|
|
reflect and discuss the matter. My obstinate companion had given
|
|
me no time; and, after all, what could I have said to him?
|
|
Ned Land was perfectly right. There was almost the opportunity
|
|
to profit by. Could I retract my word, and take upon myself
|
|
the responsibility of compromising the future of my companions?
|
|
To-morrow Captain Nemo might take us far from all land.
|
|
|
|
At that moment a rather loud hissing noise told me that the reservoirs
|
|
were filling, and that the Nautilus was sinking under the waves
|
|
of the Atlantic.
|
|
|
|
A sad day I passed, between the desire of regaining my liberty
|
|
of action and of abandoning the wonderful Nautilus, and leaving
|
|
my submarine studies incomplete.
|
|
|
|
What dreadful hours I passed thus! Sometimes seeing myself and
|
|
companions safely landed, sometimes wishing, in spite of my reason,
|
|
that some unforeseen circumstance, would prevent the realisation
|
|
of Ned Land's project.
|
|
|
|
Twice I went to the saloon. I wished to consult the compass.
|
|
I wished to see if the direction the Nautilus was taking
|
|
was bringing us nearer or taking us farther from the coast.
|
|
But no; the Nautilus kept in Portuguese waters.
|
|
|
|
I must therefore take my part and prepare for flight.
|
|
My luggage was not heavy; my notes, nothing more.
|
|
|
|
As to Captain Nemo, I asked myself what he would think of our escape;
|
|
what trouble, what wrong it might cause him and what he might do in case
|
|
of its discovery or failure. Certainly I had no cause to complain of him;
|
|
on the contrary, never was hospitality freer than his. In leaving
|
|
him I could not be taxed with ingratitude. No oath bound us to him.
|
|
It was on the strength of circumstances he relied, and not upon our word,
|
|
to fix us for ever.
|
|
|
|
I had not seen the Captain since our visit to the Island of Santorin.
|
|
Would chance bring me to his presence before our departure?
|
|
I wished it, and I feared it at the same time. I listened if I could
|
|
hear him walking the room contiguous to mine. No sound reached my ear.
|
|
I felt an unbearable uneasiness. This day of waiting seemed eternal.
|
|
Hours struck too slowly to keep pace with my impatience.
|
|
|
|
My dinner was served in my room as usual. I ate but little;
|
|
I was too preoccupied. I left the table at seven o'clock. A
|
|
hundred and twenty minutes (I counted them) still separated
|
|
me from the moment in which I was to join Ned Land.
|
|
My agitation redoubled. My pulse beat violently.
|
|
I could not remain quiet. I went and came, hoping to calm
|
|
my troubled spirit by constant movement. The idea of failure
|
|
in our bold enterprise was the least painful of my anxieties;
|
|
but the thought of seeing our project discovered before
|
|
leaving the Nautilus, of being brought before Captain Nemo,
|
|
irritated, or (what was worse) saddened, at my desertion,
|
|
made my heart beat.
|
|
|
|
I wanted to see the saloon for the last time. I descended the stairs and
|
|
arrived in the museum, where I had passed so many useful and agreeable hours.
|
|
I looked at all its riches, all its treasures, like a man on the eve of an
|
|
eternal exile, who was leaving never to return.
|
|
|
|
These wonders of Nature, these masterpieces of art, amongst which for so many
|
|
days my life had been concentrated, I was going to abandon them for ever!
|
|
I should like to have taken a last look through the windows of the saloon into
|
|
the waters of the Atlantic: but the panels were hermetically closed, and a
|
|
cloak of steel separated me from that ocean which I had not yet explored.
|
|
|
|
In passing through the saloon, I came near the door let
|
|
into the angle which opened into the Captain's room.
|
|
To my great surprise, this door was ajar. I drew back involuntarily.
|
|
If Captain Nemo should be in his room, he could see me.
|
|
But, hearing no sound, I drew nearer. The room was deserted.
|
|
I pushed open the door and took some steps forward. Still the same
|
|
monklike severity of aspect.
|
|
|
|
Suddenly the clock struck eight. The first beat of the hammer on the bell
|
|
awoke me from my dreams. I trembled as if an invisible eye had plunged
|
|
into my most secret thoughts, and I hurried from the room.
|
|
|
|
There my eye fell upon the compass. Our course was still north.
|
|
The log indicated moderate speed, the manometer a depth of about sixty feet.
|
|
|
|
I returned to my room, clothed myself warmly--sea boots,
|
|
an otterskin cap, a great coat of byssus, lined with sealskin;
|
|
I was ready, I was waiting. The vibration of the screw
|
|
alone broke the deep silence which reigned on board.
|
|
I listened attentively. Would no loud voice suddenly inform
|
|
me that Ned Land had been surprised in his projected flight.
|
|
A mortal dread hung over me, and I vainly tried to regain
|
|
my accustomed coolness.
|
|
|
|
At a few minutes to nine, I put my ear to the Captain's door.
|
|
No noise. I left my room and returned to the saloon, which was half
|
|
in obscurity, but deserted.
|
|
|
|
I opened the door communicating with the library.
|
|
The same insufficient light, the same solitude.
|
|
I placed myself near the door leading to the central staircase,
|
|
and there waited for Ned Land's signal.
|
|
|
|
At that moment the trembling of the screw sensibly diminished,
|
|
then it stopped entirely. The silence was now only disturbed
|
|
by the beatings of my own heart. Suddenly a slight shock was felt;
|
|
and I knew that the Nautilus had stopped at the bottom of the ocean.
|
|
My uneasiness increased. The Canadian's signal did not come.
|
|
I felt inclined to join Ned Land and beg of him to put off his attempt.
|
|
I felt that we were not sailing under our usual conditions.
|
|
|
|
At this moment the door of the large saloon opened, and Captain
|
|
Nemo appeared. He saw me, and without further preamble began
|
|
in an amiable tone of voice:
|
|
|
|
"Ah, sir! I have been looking for you. Do you know the history of Spain?"
|
|
|
|
Now, one might know the history of one's own country by heart;
|
|
but in the condition I was at the time, with troubled mind
|
|
and head quite lost, I could not have said a word of it.
|
|
|
|
"Well," continued Captain Nemo, "you heard my question!
|
|
Do you know the history of Spain?"
|
|
|
|
"Very slightly," I answered.
|
|
|
|
"Well, here are learned men having to learn," said the Captain.
|
|
"Come, sit down, and I will tell you a curious episode in this history.
|
|
Sir, listen well," said he; "this history will interest you on one side,
|
|
for it will answer a question which doubtless you have not been
|
|
able to solve."
|
|
|
|
"I listen, Captain," said I, not knowing what my interlocutor was driving at,
|
|
and asking myself if this incident was bearing on our projected flight.
|
|
|
|
"Sir, if you have no objection, we will go back to 1702. You cannot
|
|
be ignorant that your king, Louis XIV, thinking that the gesture
|
|
of a potentate was sufficient to bring the Pyrenees under his yoke,
|
|
had imposed the Duke of Anjou, his grandson, on the Spaniards.
|
|
This prince reigned more or less badly under the name of Philip V,
|
|
and had a strong party against him abroad. Indeed, the preceding year,
|
|
the royal houses of Holland, Austria, and England had concluded
|
|
a treaty of alliance at the Hague, with the intention of plucking
|
|
the crown of Spain from the head of Philip V, and placing it
|
|
on that of an archduke to whom they prematurely gave the title
|
|
of Charles III.
|
|
|
|
"Spain must resist this coalition; but she was almost entirely unprovided
|
|
with either soldiers or sailors. However, money would not fail them,
|
|
provided that their galleons, laden with gold and silver from America,
|
|
once entered their ports. And about the end of 1702 they expected a rich
|
|
convoy which France was escorting with a fleet of twenty-three vessels,
|
|
commanded by Admiral Chateau-Renaud, for the ships of the coalition
|
|
were already beating the Atlantic. This convoy was to go to Cadiz,
|
|
but the Admiral, hearing that an English fleet was cruising in those waters,
|
|
resolved to make for a French port.
|
|
|
|
"The Spanish commanders of the convoy objected to this decision.
|
|
They wanted to be taken to a Spanish port, and, if not to Cadiz,
|
|
into Vigo Bay, situated on the northwest coast of Spain,
|
|
and which was not blocked.
|
|
|
|
"Admiral Chateau-Renaud had the rashness to obey this injunction,
|
|
and the galleons entered Vigo Bay.
|
|
|
|
"Unfortunately, it formed an open road which could not be
|
|
defended in any way. They must therefore hasten to unload
|
|
the galleons before the arrival of the combined fleet;
|
|
and time would not have failed them had not a miserable question
|
|
of rivalry suddenly arisen.
|
|
|
|
"You are following the chain of events?" asked Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"Perfectly," said I, not knowing the end proposed by this historical lesson.
|
|
|
|
"I will continue. This is what passed. The merchants of Cadiz had
|
|
a privilege by which they had the right of receiving all merchandise
|
|
coming from the West Indies. Now, to disembark these ingots at the port
|
|
of Vigo was depriving them of their rights. They complained at Madrid,
|
|
and obtained the consent of the weak-minded Philip that the convoy,
|
|
without discharging its cargo, should remain sequestered in the roads
|
|
of Vigo until the enemy had disappeared.
|
|
|
|
"But whilst coming to this decision, on the 22nd of October,
|
|
1702, the English vessels arrived in Vigo Bay, when Admiral
|
|
Chateau-Renaud, in spite of inferior forces, fought bravely.
|
|
But, seeing that the treasure must fall into the enemy's hands,
|
|
he burnt and scuttled every galleon, which went to the bottom
|
|
with their immense riches."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo stopped. I admit I could not see yet why this history
|
|
should interest me.
|
|
|
|
"Well?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"Well, M. Aronnax," replied Captain Nemo, "we are in that Vigo Bay;
|
|
and it rests with yourself whether you will penetrate its mysteries."
|
|
|
|
The Captain rose, telling me to follow him. I had had time to recover.
|
|
I obeyed. The saloon was dark, but through the transparent glass the waves
|
|
were sparkling. I looked.
|
|
|
|
For half a mile around the Nautilus, the waters seemed bathed
|
|
in electric light. The sandy bottom was clean and bright.
|
|
Some of the ship's crew in their diving-dresses were clearing away
|
|
half-rotten barrels and empty cases from the midst of the blackened wrecks.
|
|
From these cases and from these barrels escaped ingots of gold and silver,
|
|
cascades of piastres and jewels. The sand was heaped up with them.
|
|
Laden with their precious booty, the men returned to the Nautilus,
|
|
disposed of their burden, and went back to this inexhaustible fishery of
|
|
gold and silver.
|
|
|
|
I understood now. This was the scene of the battle of the 22nd
|
|
of October, 1702. Here on this very spot the galleons laden for the Spanish
|
|
Government had sunk. Here Captain Nemo came, according to his wants,
|
|
to pack up those millions with which he burdened the Nautilus.
|
|
It was for him and him alone America had given up her precious metals.
|
|
He was heir direct, without anyone to share, in those treasures torn
|
|
from the Incas and from the conquered of Ferdinand Cortez.
|
|
|
|
"Did you know, sir," he asked, smiling, "that the sea contained such riches?"
|
|
|
|
"I knew," I answered, "that they value money held in suspension
|
|
in these waters at two millions."
|
|
|
|
"Doubtless; but to extract this money the expense would be greater
|
|
than the profit. Here, on the contrary, I have but to pick up what man
|
|
has lost--and not only in Vigo Bay, but in a thousand other ports where
|
|
shipwrecks have happened, and which are marked on my submarine map.
|
|
Can you understand now the source of the millions I am worth?"
|
|
|
|
"I understand, Captain. But allow me to tell you that in exploring
|
|
Vigo Bay you have only been beforehand with a rival society."
|
|
|
|
"And which?"
|
|
|
|
"A society which has received from the Spanish Government
|
|
the privilege of seeking those buried galleons.
|
|
The shareholders are led on by the allurement of an enormous bounty,
|
|
for they value these rich shipwrecks at five hundred millions."
|
|
|
|
"Five hundred millions they were," answered Captain Nemo,
|
|
"but they are so no longer."
|
|
|
|
"Just so," said I; "and a warning to those shareholders would be
|
|
an act of charity. But who knows if it would be well received?
|
|
What gamblers usually regret above all is less the loss
|
|
of their money than of their foolish hopes. After all,
|
|
I pity them less than the thousands of unfortunates to whom
|
|
so much riches well-distributed would have been profitable,
|
|
whilst for them they will be for ever barren."
|
|
|
|
I had no sooner expressed this regret than I felt that it must
|
|
have wounded Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"Barren!" he exclaimed, with animation. "Do you think then,
|
|
sir, that these riches are lost because I gather them?
|
|
Is it for myself alone, according to your idea, that I take
|
|
the trouble to collect these treasures? Who told you that I
|
|
did not make a good use of it? Do you think I am ignorant
|
|
that there are suffering beings and oppressed races on
|
|
this earth, miserable creatures to console, victims to avenge?
|
|
Do you not understand?"
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo stopped at these last words, regretting perhaps
|
|
that he had spoken so much. But I had guessed that,
|
|
whatever the motive which had forced him to seek independence
|
|
under the sea, it had left him still a man, that his heart
|
|
still beat for the sufferings of humanity, and that his immense
|
|
charity was for oppressed races as well as individuals.
|
|
And I then understood for whom those millions were destined
|
|
which were forwarded by Captain Nemo when the Nautilus was cruising
|
|
in the waters of Crete.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER IX
|
|
|
|
A VANISHED CONTINENT
|
|
|
|
The next morning, the 19th of February, I saw the Canadian enter my room.
|
|
I expected this visit. He looked very disappointed.
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir?" said he.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Ned, fortune was against us yesterday."
|
|
|
|
"Yes; that Captain must needs stop exactly at the hour we intended
|
|
leaving his vessel."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Ned, he had business at his bankers."
|
|
|
|
"His bankers!"
|
|
|
|
"Or rather his banking-house; by that I mean the ocean,
|
|
where his riches are safer than in the chests of the State."
|
|
|
|
I then related to the Canadian the incidents of the preceding night,
|
|
hoping to bring him back to the idea of not abandoning the Captain;
|
|
but my recital had no other result than an energetically expressed regret
|
|
from Ned that he had not been able to take a walk on the battlefield
|
|
of Vigo on his own account.
|
|
|
|
"However," said he, "all is not ended. It is only a blow
|
|
of the harpoon lost. Another time we must succeed;
|
|
and to-night, if necessary----"
|
|
|
|
"In what direction is the Nautilus going?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"I do not know," replied Ned.
|
|
|
|
"Well, at noon we shall see the point."
|
|
|
|
The Canadian returned to Conseil. As soon as I was dressed,
|
|
I went into the saloon. The compass was not reassuring.
|
|
The course of the Nautilus was S.S.W. We were turning our
|
|
backs on Europe.
|
|
|
|
I waited with some impatience till the ship's place was pricked
|
|
on the chart. At about half-past eleven the reservoirs
|
|
were emptied, and our vessel rose to the surface of the ocean.
|
|
I rushed towards the platform. Ned Land had preceded me.
|
|
No more land in sight. Nothing but an immense sea.
|
|
Some sails on the horizon, doubtless those going to San Roque
|
|
in search of favourable winds for doubling the Cape of Good Hope.
|
|
The weather was cloudy. A gale of wind was preparing.
|
|
Ned raved, and tried to pierce the cloudy horizon.
|
|
He still hoped that behind all that fog stretched the land he so
|
|
longed for.
|
|
|
|
At noon the sun showed itself for an instant. The second profited by this
|
|
brightness to take its height. Then, the sea becoming more billowy,
|
|
we descended, and the panel closed.
|
|
|
|
An hour after, upon consulting the chart, I saw the position
|
|
of the Nautilus was marked at 16@ 17' long., and 33@ 22'
|
|
lat., at 150 leagues from the nearest coast. There was no means
|
|
of flight, and I leave you to imagine the rage of the Canadian
|
|
when I informed him of our situation.
|
|
|
|
For myself, I was not particularly sorry. I felt lightened
|
|
of the load which had oppressed me, and was able to return
|
|
with some degree of calmness to my accustomed work.
|
|
|
|
That night, about eleven o'clock, I received a most unexpected
|
|
visit from Captain Nemo. He asked me very graciously
|
|
if I felt fatigued from my watch of the preceding night.
|
|
I answered in the negative.
|
|
|
|
"Then, M. Aronnax, I propose a curious excursion."
|
|
|
|
"Propose, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"You have hitherto only visited the submarine depths by daylight,
|
|
under the brightness of the sun. Would it suit you to see them
|
|
in the darkness of the night?"
|
|
|
|
"Most willingly."
|
|
|
|
"I warn you, the way will be tiring. We shall have far to walk,
|
|
and must climb a mountain. The roads are not well kept."
|
|
|
|
"What you say, Captain, only heightens my curiosity;
|
|
I am ready to follow you."
|
|
|
|
"Come then, sir, we will put on our diving-dresses."
|
|
|
|
Arrived at the robing-room, I saw that neither of my companions
|
|
nor any of the ship's crew were to follow us on this excursion.
|
|
Captain Nemo had not even proposed my taking with me either
|
|
Ned or Conseil.
|
|
|
|
In a few moments we had put on our diving-dresses; they placed
|
|
on our backs the reservoirs, abundantly filled with air,
|
|
but no electric lamps were prepared. I called the Captain's
|
|
attention to the fact.
|
|
|
|
"They will be useless," he replied.
|
|
|
|
I thought I had not heard aright, but I could not repeat my observation,
|
|
for the Captain's head had already disappeared in its metal case.
|
|
I finished harnessing myself. I felt them put an iron-pointed stick
|
|
into my hand, and some minutes later, after going through the usual form,
|
|
we set foot on the bottom of the Atlantic at a depth of 150 fathoms.
|
|
Midnight was near. The waters were profoundly dark, but Captain Nemo
|
|
pointed out in the distance a reddish spot, a sort of large light shining
|
|
brilliantly about two miles from the Nautilus. What this fire might be,
|
|
what could feed it, why and how it lit up the liquid mass, I could not say.
|
|
In any case, it did light our way, vaguely, it is true, but I soon accustomed
|
|
myself to the peculiar darkness, and I understood, under such circumstances,
|
|
the uselessness of the Ruhmkorff apparatus.
|
|
|
|
As we advanced, I heard a kind of pattering above my head.
|
|
The noise redoubling, sometimes producing a continual shower,
|
|
I soon understood the cause. It was rain falling violently,
|
|
and crisping the surface of the waves. Instinctively the
|
|
thought flashed across my mind that I should be wet through!
|
|
By the water! in the midst of the water! I could not help
|
|
laughing at the odd idea. But, indeed, in the thick diving-dress,
|
|
the liquid element is no longer felt, and one only seems to be
|
|
in an atmosphere somewhat denser than the terrestrial atmosphere.
|
|
Nothing more.
|
|
|
|
After half an hour's walk the soil became stony.
|
|
Medusae, microscopic crustacea, and pennatules lit it slightly
|
|
with their phosphorescent gleam. I caught a glimpse of pieces
|
|
of stone covered with millions of zoophytes and masses of sea weed.
|
|
My feet often slipped upon this sticky carpet of sea weed,
|
|
and without my iron-tipped stick I should have fallen more than once.
|
|
In turning round, I could still see the whitish lantern of the
|
|
Nautilus beginning to pale in the distance.
|
|
|
|
But the rosy light which guided us increased and lit up the horizon.
|
|
The presence of this fire under water puzzled me in the highest degree.
|
|
Was I going towards a natural phenomenon as yet unknown to the savants
|
|
of the earth? Or even (for this thought crossed my brain) had the hand
|
|
of man aught to do with this conflagration? Had he fanned this flame?
|
|
Was I to meet in these depths companions and friends of Captain Nemo whom
|
|
he was going to visit, and who, like him, led this strange existence?
|
|
Should I find down there a whole colony of exiles who, weary of the miseries
|
|
of this earth, had sought and found independence in the deep ocean?
|
|
All these foolish and unreasonable ideas pursued me. And in this condition
|
|
of mind, over-excited by the succession of wonders continually passing before
|
|
my eyes, I should not have been surprised to meet at the bottom of the sea one
|
|
of those submarine towns of which Captain Nemo dreamed.
|
|
|
|
Our road grew lighter and lighter. The white glimmer came in rays
|
|
from the summit of a mountain about 800 feet high. But what I saw
|
|
was simply a reflection, developed by the clearness of the waters.
|
|
The source of this inexplicable light was a fire on the opposite side
|
|
of the mountain.
|
|
|
|
In the midst of this stony maze furrowing the bottom of the Atlantic,
|
|
Captain Nemo advanced without hesitation. He knew this dreary road.
|
|
Doubtless he had often travelled over it, and could not lose himself.
|
|
I followed him with unshaken confidence. He seemed to me like a genie of
|
|
the sea; and, as he walked before me, I could not help admiring his stature,
|
|
which was outlined in black on the luminous horizon.
|
|
|
|
It was one in the morning when we arrived at the first slopes of the mountain;
|
|
but to gain access to them we must venture through the difficult paths
|
|
of a vast copse.
|
|
|
|
Yes; a copse of dead trees, without leaves, without sap,
|
|
trees petrified by the action of the water and here and there
|
|
overtopped by gigantic pines. It was like a coal-pit still standing,
|
|
holding by the roots to the broken soil, and whose branches, like fine
|
|
black paper cuttings, showed distinctly on the watery ceiling.
|
|
Picture to yourself a forest in the Hartz hanging on to the sides
|
|
of the mountain, but a forest swallowed up. The paths were
|
|
encumbered with seaweed and fucus, between which grovelled
|
|
a whole world of crustacea. I went along, climbing the rocks,
|
|
striding over extended trunks, breaking the sea bind-weed which hung
|
|
from one tree to the other; and frightening the fishes, which flew
|
|
from branch to branch. Pressing onward, I felt no fatigue.
|
|
I followed my guide, who was never tired. What a spectacle!
|
|
How can I express it? how paint the aspect of those woods and
|
|
rocks in this medium--their under parts dark and wild, the upper
|
|
coloured with red tints, by that light which the reflecting powers
|
|
of the waters doubled? We climbed rocks which fell directly
|
|
after with gigantic bounds and the low growling of an avalanche.
|
|
To right and left ran long, dark galleries, where sight was lost.
|
|
Here opened vast glades which the hand of man seemed to have worked;
|
|
and I sometimes asked myself if some inhabitant of these submarine
|
|
regions would not suddenly appear to me.
|
|
|
|
But Captain Nemo was still mounting. I could not stay behind.
|
|
I followed boldly. My stick gave me good help. A false step would
|
|
have been dangerous on the narrow passes sloping down to the sides
|
|
of the gulfs; but I walked with firm step, without feeling
|
|
any giddiness. Now I jumped a crevice, the depth of which would
|
|
have made me hesitate had it been among the glaciers on the land;
|
|
now I ventured on the unsteady trunk of a tree thrown across
|
|
from one abyss to the other, without looking under my feet,
|
|
having only eyes to admire the wild sites of this region.
|
|
|
|
There, monumental rocks, leaning on their regularly-cut bases, seemed to defy
|
|
all laws of equilibrium. From between their stony knees trees sprang,
|
|
like a jet under heavy pressure, and upheld others which upheld them.
|
|
Natural towers, large scarps, cut perpendicularly, like a "curtain," inclined
|
|
at an angle which the laws of gravitation could never have tolerated
|
|
in terrestrial regions.
|
|
|
|
Two hours after quitting the Nautilus we had crossed the line of trees,
|
|
and a hundred feet above our heads rose the top of the mountain,
|
|
which cast a shadow on the brilliant irradiation of the opposite slope.
|
|
Some petrified shrubs ran fantastically here and there. Fishes got up
|
|
under our feet like birds in the long grass. The massive rocks were
|
|
rent with impenetrable fractures, deep grottos, and unfathomable holes,
|
|
at the bottom of which formidable creatures might be heard moving.
|
|
My blood curdled when I saw enormous antennae blocking my road,
|
|
or some frightful claw closing with a noise in the shadow of some cavity.
|
|
Millions of luminous spots shone brightly in the midst of the darkness.
|
|
They were the eyes of giant crustacea crouched in their holes;
|
|
giant lobsters setting themselves up like halberdiers, and moving
|
|
their claws with the clicking sound of pincers; titanic crabs,
|
|
pointed like a gun on its carriage; and frightful-looking poulps,
|
|
interweaving their tentacles like a living nest of serpents.
|
|
|
|
We had now arrived on the first platform, where other surprises awaited me.
|
|
Before us lay some picturesque ruins, which betrayed the hand of man
|
|
and not that of the Creator. There were vast heaps of stone,
|
|
amongst which might be traced the vague and shadowy forms of castles
|
|
and temples, clothed with a world of blossoming zoophytes, and over which,
|
|
instead of ivy, sea-weed and fucus threw a thick vegetable mantle. But what
|
|
was this portion of the globe which had been swallowed by cataclysms?
|
|
Who had placed those rocks and stones like cromlechs of prehistoric times?
|
|
Where was I? Whither had Captain Nemo's fancy hurried me?
|
|
|
|
I would fain have asked him; not being able to, I stopped him--
|
|
I seized his arm. But, shaking his head, and pointing to the highest
|
|
point of the mountain, he seemed to say:
|
|
|
|
"Come, come along; come higher!"
|
|
|
|
I followed, and in a few minutes I had climbed to the top,
|
|
which for a circle of ten yards commanded the whole mass of rock.
|
|
|
|
I looked down the side we had just climbed. The mountain did
|
|
not rise more than seven or eight hundred feet above the level
|
|
of the plain; but on the opposite side it commanded from
|
|
twice that height the depths of this part of the Atlantic.
|
|
My eyes ranged far over a large space lit by a violent fulguration.
|
|
In fact, the mountain was a volcano.
|
|
|
|
At fifty feet above the peak, in the midst of a rain of stones
|
|
and scoriae, a large crater was vomiting forth torrents of lava
|
|
which fell in a cascade of fire into the bosom of the liquid mass.
|
|
Thus situated, this volcano lit the lower plain like an
|
|
immense torch, even to the extreme limits of the horizon.
|
|
I said that the submarine crater threw up lava, but no flames.
|
|
Flames require the oxygen of the air to feed upon and cannot be
|
|
developed under water; but streams of lava, having in themselves
|
|
the principles of their incandescence, can attain a white heat,
|
|
fight vigorously against the liquid element, and turn it to
|
|
vapour by contact.
|
|
|
|
Rapid currents bearing all these gases in diffusion and torrents
|
|
of lava slid to the bottom of the mountain like an eruption
|
|
of Vesuvius on another Terra del Greco.
|
|
|
|
There indeed under my eyes, ruined, destroyed, lay a town--
|
|
its roofs open to the sky, its temples fallen, its arches dislocated,
|
|
its columns lying on the ground, from which one would still
|
|
recognise the massive character of Tuscan architecture.
|
|
Further on, some remains of a gigantic aqueduct; here the high
|
|
base of an Acropolis, with the floating outline of a Parthenon;
|
|
there traces of a quay, as if an ancient port had formerly
|
|
abutted on the borders of the ocean, and disappeared with
|
|
its merchant vessels and its war-galleys. Farther on again,
|
|
long lines of sunken walls and broad, deserted streets--
|
|
a perfect Pompeii escaped beneath the waters. Such was the sight
|
|
that Captain Nemo brought before my eyes!
|
|
|
|
Where was I? Where was I? I must know at any cost.
|
|
I tried to speak, but Captain Nemo stopped me by a gesture,
|
|
and, picking up a piece of chalk-stone, advanced to a rock
|
|
of black basalt, and traced the one word:
|
|
|
|
|
|
ATLANTIS
|
|
|
|
|
|
What a light shot through my mind! Atlantis! the Atlantis
|
|
of Plato, that continent denied by Origen and Humbolt,
|
|
who placed its disappearance amongst the legendary tales.
|
|
I had it there now before my eyes, bearing upon it
|
|
the unexceptionable testimony of its catastrophe.
|
|
The region thus engulfed was beyond Europe, Asia, and Lybia,
|
|
beyond the columns of Hercules, where those powerful people,
|
|
the Atlantides, lived, against whom the first wars of ancient
|
|
Greeks were waged.
|
|
|
|
Thus, led by the strangest destiny, I was treading under foot
|
|
the mountains of this continent, touching with my hand those ruins
|
|
a thousand generations old and contemporary with the geological epochs.
|
|
I was walking on the very spot where the contemporaries of the first
|
|
man had walked.
|
|
|
|
Whilst I was trying to fix in my mind every detail of this
|
|
grand landscape, Captain Nemo remained motionless,
|
|
as if petrified in mute ecstasy, leaning on a mossy stone.
|
|
Was he dreaming of those generations long since disappeared?
|
|
Was he asking them the secret of human destiny? Was it here this
|
|
strange man came to steep himself in historical recollections,
|
|
and live again this ancient life--he who wanted no modern one?
|
|
What would I not have given to know his thoughts, to share them,
|
|
to understand them! We remained for an hour at this place,
|
|
contemplating the vast plains under the brightness of the lava,
|
|
which was some times wonderfully intense. Rapid tremblings ran
|
|
along the mountain caused by internal bubblings, deep noise,
|
|
distinctly transmitted through the liquid medium were echoed
|
|
with majestic grandeur. At this moment the moon appeared through
|
|
the mass of waters and threw her pale rays on the buried continent.
|
|
It was but a gleam, but what an indescribable effect!
|
|
The Captain rose, cast one last look on the immense plain,
|
|
and then bade me follow him.
|
|
|
|
We descended the mountain rapidly, and, the mineral forest
|
|
once passed, I saw the lantern of the Nautilus shining like a star.
|
|
The Captain walked straight to it, and we got on board as the first
|
|
rays of light whitened the surface of the ocean.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER X
|
|
|
|
THE SUBMARINE COAL-MINES
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 20th of February, I awoke very late: the fatigues
|
|
of the previous night had prolonged my sleep until eleven o'clock. I
|
|
dressed quickly, and hastened to find the course the Nautilus was taking.
|
|
The instruments showed it to be still toward the south, with a speed of
|
|
twenty miles an hour and a depth of fifty fathoms.
|
|
|
|
The species of fishes here did not differ much from those already noticed.
|
|
There were rays of giant size, five yards long, and endowed with great
|
|
muscular strength, which enabled them to shoot above the waves;
|
|
sharks of many kinds; amongst others, one fifteen feet long,
|
|
with triangular sharp teeth, and whose transparency rendered it almost
|
|
invisible in the water.
|
|
|
|
Amongst bony fish Conseil noticed some about three yards long, armed at
|
|
the upper jaw with a piercing sword; other bright-coloured creatures,
|
|
known in the time of Aristotle by the name of the sea-dragon, which are
|
|
dangerous to capture on account of the spikes on their back.
|
|
|
|
About four o'clock, the soil, generally composed of a thick mud mixed with
|
|
petrified wood, changed by degrees, and it became more stony, and seemed
|
|
strewn with conglomerate and pieces of basalt, with a sprinkling of lava.
|
|
I thought that a mountainous region was succeeding the long plains;
|
|
and accordingly, after a few evolutions of the Nautilus, I saw the southerly
|
|
horizon blocked by a high wall which seemed to close all exit.
|
|
Its summit evidently passed the level of the ocean. It must be a continent,
|
|
or at least an island--one of the Canaries, or of the Cape Verde Islands.
|
|
The bearings not being yet taken, perhaps designedly, I was ignorant
|
|
of our exact position. In any case, such a wall seemed to me to mark
|
|
the limits of that Atlantis, of which we had in reality passed over only
|
|
the smallest part.
|
|
|
|
Much longer should I have remained at the window admiring
|
|
the beauties of sea and sky, but the panels closed. At this moment
|
|
the Nautilus arrived at the side of this high, perpendicular wall.
|
|
What it would do, I could not guess. I returned to my room;
|
|
it no longer moved. I laid myself down with the full intention
|
|
of waking after a few hours' sleep; but it was eight o'clock
|
|
the next day when I entered the saloon. I looked at the manometer.
|
|
It told me that the Nautilus was floating on the surface of the ocean.
|
|
Besides, I heard steps on the platform. I went to the panel.
|
|
It was open; but, instead of broad daylight, as I expected,
|
|
I was surrounded by profound darkness. Where were we?
|
|
Was I mistaken? Was it still night? No; not a star was shining
|
|
and night has not that utter darkness.
|
|
|
|
I knew not what to think, when a voice near me said:
|
|
|
|
"Is that you, Professor?"
|
|
|
|
"Ah! Captain," I answered, "where are we?"
|
|
|
|
"Underground, sir."
|
|
|
|
"Underground!" I exclaimed. "And the Nautilus floating still?"
|
|
|
|
"It always floats."
|
|
|
|
"But I do not understand."
|
|
|
|
"Wait a few minutes, our lantern will be lit, and, if you like light places,
|
|
you will be satisfied."
|
|
|
|
I stood on the platform and waited. The darkness was so complete
|
|
that I could not even see Captain Nemo; but, looking to the zenith,
|
|
exactly above my head, I seemed to catch an undecided gleam,
|
|
a kind of twilight filling a circular hole. At this instant
|
|
the lantern was lit, and its vividness dispelled the faint light.
|
|
I closed my dazzled eyes for an instant, and then looked again.
|
|
The Nautilus was stationary, floating near a mountain which formed
|
|
a sort of quay. The lake, then, supporting it was a lake
|
|
imprisoned by a circle of walls, measuring two miles in diameter
|
|
and six in circumference. Its level (the manometer showed)
|
|
could only be the same as the outside level, for there must
|
|
necessarily be a communication between the lake and the sea.
|
|
The high partitions, leaning forward on their base, grew into
|
|
a vaulted roof bearing the shape of an immense funnel turned
|
|
upside down, the height being about five or six hundred yards.
|
|
At the summit was a circular orifice, by which I had caught the slight
|
|
gleam of light, evidently daylight.
|
|
|
|
"Where are we?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"In the very heart of an extinct volcano, the interior of which has
|
|
been invaded by the sea, after some great convulsion of the earth.
|
|
Whilst you were sleeping, Professor, the Nautilus penetrated
|
|
to this lagoon by a natural canal, which opens about ten yards
|
|
beneath the surface of the ocean. This is its harbour of refuge,
|
|
a sure, commodious, and mysterious one, sheltered from all gales.
|
|
Show me, if you can, on the coasts of any of your continents or islands,
|
|
a road which can give such perfect refuge from all storms."
|
|
|
|
"Certainly," I replied, "you are in safety here, Captain Nemo.
|
|
Who could reach you in the heart of a volcano? But did I not see
|
|
an opening at its summit?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes; its crater, formerly filled with lava, vapour, and flames,
|
|
and which now gives entrance to the life-giving air we breathe."
|
|
|
|
"But what is this volcanic mountain?"
|
|
|
|
"It belongs to one of the numerous islands with which this sea
|
|
is strewn--to vessels a simple sandbank--to us an immense cavern.
|
|
Chance led me to discover it, and chance served me well."
|
|
|
|
"But of what use is this refuge, Captain? The Nautilus wants no port."
|
|
|
|
"No, sir; but it wants electricity to make it move, and the wherewithal
|
|
to make the electricity--sodium to feed the elements, coal from
|
|
which to get the sodium, and a coal-mine to supply the coal.
|
|
And exactly on this spot the sea covers entire forests embedded during
|
|
the geological periods, now mineralised and transformed into coal;
|
|
for me they are an inexhaustible mine."
|
|
|
|
"Your men follow the trade of miners here, then, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"Exactly so. These mines extend under the waves like the mines of Newcastle.
|
|
Here, in their diving-dresses, pick axe and shovel in hand, my men
|
|
extract the coal, which I do not even ask from the mines of the earth.
|
|
When I burn this combustible for the manufacture of sodium, the smoke,
|
|
escaping from the crater of the mountain, gives it the appearance of
|
|
a still-active volcano."
|
|
|
|
"And we shall see your companions at work?"
|
|
|
|
"No; not this time at least; for I am in a hurry to continue
|
|
our submarine tour of the earth. So I shall content myself
|
|
with drawing from the reserve of sodium I already possess.
|
|
The time for loading is one day only, and we continue our voyage.
|
|
So, if you wish to go over the cavern and make the round of
|
|
the lagoon, you must take advantage of to-day, M. Aronnax."
|
|
|
|
I thanked the Captain and went to look for my companions, who had not yet
|
|
left their cabin. I invited them to follow me without saying where we were.
|
|
They mounted the platform. Conseil, who was astonished at nothing,
|
|
seemed to look upon it as quite natural that he should wake under
|
|
a mountain, after having fallen asleep under the waves. But Ned Land
|
|
thought of nothing but finding whether the cavern had any exit.
|
|
After breakfast, about ten o'clock, we went down on to the mountain.
|
|
|
|
"Here we are, once more on land," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"I do not call this land," said the Canadian. "And besides,
|
|
we are not on it, but beneath it."
|
|
|
|
Between the walls of the mountains and the waters of the lake lay a sandy
|
|
shore which, at its greatest breadth, measured five hundred feet.
|
|
On this soil one might easily make the tour of the lake. But the base
|
|
of the high partitions was stony ground, with volcanic locks and enormous
|
|
pumice-stones lying in picturesque heaps. All these detached masses,
|
|
covered with enamel, polished by the action of the subterraneous fires,
|
|
shone resplendent by the light of our electric lantern. The mica dust
|
|
from the shore, rising under our feet, flew like a cloud of sparks.
|
|
The bottom now rose sensibly, and we soon arrived at long circuitous slopes,
|
|
or inclined planes, which took us higher by degrees; but we were obliged
|
|
to walk carefully among these conglomerates, bound by no cement, the feet
|
|
slipping on the glassy crystal, felspar, and quartz.
|
|
|
|
The volcanic nature of this enormous excavation was confirmed on all sides,
|
|
and I pointed it out to my companions.
|
|
|
|
"Picture to yourselves," said I, "what this crater must
|
|
have been when filled with boiling lava, and when the level
|
|
of the incandescent liquid rose to the orifice of the mountain,
|
|
as though melted on the top of a hot plate."
|
|
|
|
"I can picture it perfectly," said Conseil. "But, sir,
|
|
will you tell me why the Great Architect has suspended operations,
|
|
and how it is that the furnace is replaced by the quiet waters
|
|
of the lake?"
|
|
|
|
"Most probably, Conseil, because some convulsion beneath the ocean produced
|
|
that very opening which has served as a passage for the Nautilus.
|
|
Then the waters of the Atlantic rushed into the interior of the mountain.
|
|
There must have been a terrible struggle between the two elements, a struggle
|
|
which ended in the victory of Neptune. But many ages have run out since then,
|
|
and the submerged volcano is now a peaceable grotto."
|
|
|
|
"Very well," replied Ned Land; "I accept the explanation, sir; but, in our
|
|
own interests, I regret that the opening of which you speak was not made
|
|
above the level of the sea."
|
|
|
|
"But, friend Ned," said Conseil, "if the passage had not been under the sea,
|
|
the Nautilus could not have gone through it."
|
|
|
|
We continued ascending. The steps became more and more perpendicular
|
|
and narrow. Deep excavations, which we were obliged to cross,
|
|
cut them here and there; sloping masses had to be turned.
|
|
We slid upon our knees and crawled along. But Conseil's
|
|
dexterity and the Canadian's strength surmounted all obstacles.
|
|
At a height of about 31 feet the nature of the ground changed
|
|
without becoming more practicable. To the conglomerate and trachyte
|
|
succeeded black basalt, the first dispread in layers full of bubbles,
|
|
the latter forming regular prisms, placed like a colonnade
|
|
supporting the spring of the immense vault, an admirable specimen
|
|
of natural architecture. Between the blocks of basalt wound long
|
|
streams of lava, long since grown cold, encrusted with bituminous rays;
|
|
and in some places there were spread large carpets of sulphur.
|
|
A more powerful light shone through the upper crater, shedding a
|
|
vague glimmer over these volcanic depressions for ever buried
|
|
in the bosom of this extinguished mountain. But our upward march
|
|
was soon stopped at a height of about two hundred and fifty feet
|
|
by impassable obstacles. There was a complete vaulted arch
|
|
overhanging us, and our ascent was changed to a circular walk.
|
|
At the last change vegetable life began to struggle with the mineral.
|
|
Some shrubs, and even some trees, grew from the fractures of the walls.
|
|
I recognised some euphorbias, with the caustic sugar coming
|
|
from them; heliotropes, quite incapable of justifying their name,
|
|
sadly drooped their clusters of flowers, both their colour
|
|
and perfume half gone. Here and there some chrysanthemums grew
|
|
timidly at the foot of an aloe with long, sickly-looking leaves.
|
|
But between the streams of lava, I saw some little violets still
|
|
slightly perfumed, and I admit that I smelt them with delight.
|
|
Perfume is the soul of the flower, and sea-flowers have no soul.
|
|
|
|
We had arrived at the foot of some sturdy dragon-trees,
|
|
which had pushed aside the rocks with their strong roots,
|
|
when Ned Land exclaimed:
|
|
|
|
"Ah! sir, a hive! a hive!"
|
|
|
|
"A hive!" I replied, with a gesture of incredulity.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, a hive," repeated the Canadian, "and bees humming round it."
|
|
|
|
I approached, and was bound to believe my own eyes. There at a hole bored
|
|
in one of the dragon-trees were some thousands of these ingenious insects,
|
|
so common in all the Canaries, and whose produce is so much esteemed.
|
|
Naturally enough, the Canadian wished to gather the honey, and I could
|
|
not well oppose his wish. A quantity of dry leaves, mixed with sulphur,
|
|
he lit with a spark from his flint, and he began to smoke out the bees.
|
|
The humming ceased by degrees, and the hive eventually yielded several pounds
|
|
of the sweetest honey, with which Ned Land filled his haversack.
|
|
|
|
"When I have mixed this honey with the paste of the bread-fruit,"
|
|
said he, "I shall be able to offer you a succulent cake."
|
|
|
|
{`bread-fruit' has been substituted for `artocarpus' in this ed.}
|
|
|
|
"'Pon my word," said Conseil, "it will be gingerbread."
|
|
|
|
"Never mind the gingerbread," said I; "let us continue our interesting walk."
|
|
|
|
At every turn of the path we were following, the lake appeared
|
|
in all its length and breadth. The lantern lit up the whole
|
|
of its peaceable surface, which knew neither ripple nor wave.
|
|
The Nautilus remained perfectly immovable. On the platform,
|
|
and on the mountain, the ship's crew were working like black
|
|
shadows clearly carved against the luminous atmosphere.
|
|
We were now going round the highest crest of the first layers of rock
|
|
which upheld the roof. I then saw that bees were not the only
|
|
representatives of the animal kingdom in the interior of this volcano.
|
|
Birds of prey hovered here and there in the shadows, or fled from
|
|
their nests on the top of the rocks. There were sparrow hawks,
|
|
with white breasts, and kestrels, and down the slopes scampered,
|
|
with their long legs, several fine fat bustards. I leave anyone
|
|
to imagine the covetousness of the Canadian at the sight of this
|
|
savoury game, and whether he did not regret having no gun.
|
|
But he did his best to replace the lead by stones, and, after several
|
|
fruitless attempts, he succeeded in wounding a magnificent bird.
|
|
To say that he risked his life twenty times before reaching
|
|
it is but the truth; but he managed so well that the creature
|
|
joined the honey-cakes in his bag. We were now obliged to
|
|
descend toward the shore, the crest becoming impracticable.
|
|
Above us the crater seemed to gape like the mouth of a well.
|
|
From this place the sky could be clearly seen, and clouds,
|
|
dissipated by the west wind, leaving behind them, even on the summit
|
|
of the mountain, their misty remnants--certain proof that they
|
|
were only moderately high, for the volcano did not rise more than
|
|
eight hundred feet above the level of the ocean. Half an hour
|
|
after the Canadian's last exploit we had regained the inner shore.
|
|
Here the flora was represented by large carpets of marine crystal,
|
|
a little umbelliferous plant very good to pickle, which also bears the name
|
|
of pierce-stone and sea-fennel. Conseil gathered some bundles of it.
|
|
As to the fauna, it might be counted by thousands of crustacea
|
|
of all sorts, lobsters, crabs, spider-crabs, chameleon shrimps,
|
|
and a large number of shells, rockfish, and limpets. Three-quarters of
|
|
an hour later we had finished our circuitous walk and were on board.
|
|
The crew had just finished loading the sodium, and the Nautilus
|
|
could have left that instant. But Captain Nemo gave no order.
|
|
Did he wish to wait until night, and leave the submarine passage secretly?
|
|
Perhaps so. Whatever it might be, the next day, the Nautilus,
|
|
having left its port, steered clear of all land at a few yards beneath
|
|
the waves of the Atlantic.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XI
|
|
|
|
THE SARGASSO SEA
|
|
|
|
That day the Nautilus crossed a singular part of the Atlantic Ocean.
|
|
No one can be ignorant of the existence of a current of warm
|
|
water known by the name of the Gulf Stream. After leaving
|
|
the Gulf of Florida, we went in the direction of Spitzbergen.
|
|
But before entering the Gulf of Mexico, about 45@ of N. lat., this
|
|
current divides into two arms, the principal one going towards
|
|
the coast of Ireland and Norway, whilst the second bends to the south
|
|
about the height of the Azores; then, touching the African shore,
|
|
and describing a lengthened oval, returns to the Antilles.
|
|
This second arm--it is rather a collar than an arm--surrounds with its
|
|
circles of warm water that portion of the cold, quiet, immovable ocean
|
|
called the Sargasso Sea, a perfect lake in the open Atlantic:
|
|
it takes no less than three years for the great current to pass round it.
|
|
Such was the region the Nautilus was now visiting, a perfect meadow,
|
|
a close carpet of seaweed, fucus, and tropical berries, so thick and so
|
|
compact that the stem of a vessel could hardly tear its way through it.
|
|
And Captain Nemo, not wishing to entangle his screw in this herbaceous mass,
|
|
kept some yards beneath the surface of the waves. The name Sargasso
|
|
comes from the Spanish word "sargazzo" which signifies kelp.
|
|
This kelp, or berry-plant, is the principal formation of this immense bank.
|
|
And this is the reason why these plants unite in the peaceful basin
|
|
of the Atlantic. The only explanation which can be given, he says,
|
|
seems to me to result from the experience known to all the world.
|
|
Place in a vase some fragments of cork or other floating body,
|
|
and give to the water in the vase a circular movement,
|
|
the scattered fragments will unite in a group in the centre of
|
|
the liquid surface, that is to say, in the part least agitated.
|
|
In the phenomenon we are considering, the Atlantic is the vase,
|
|
the Gulf Stream the circular current, and the Sargasso Sea the central
|
|
point at which the floating bodies unite.
|
|
|
|
I share Maury's opinion, and I was able to study the phenomenon
|
|
in the very midst, where vessels rarely penetrate. Above us floated
|
|
products of all kinds, heaped up among these brownish plants;
|
|
trunks of trees torn from the Andes or the Rocky Mountains, and floated
|
|
by the Amazon or the Mississippi; numerous wrecks, remains of keels,
|
|
or ships' bottoms, side-planks stove in, and so weighted with shells
|
|
and barnacles that they could not again rise to the surface.
|
|
And time will one day justify Maury's other opinion, that these
|
|
substances thus accumulated for ages will become petrified by
|
|
the action of the water and will then form inexhaustible coal-mines--
|
|
a precious reserve prepared by far-seeing Nature for the moment
|
|
when men shall have exhausted the mines of continents.
|
|
|
|
In the midst of this inextricable mass of plants and sea weed,
|
|
I noticed some charming pink halcyons and actiniae, with their long
|
|
tentacles trailing after them, and medusae, green, red, and blue.
|
|
|
|
All the day of the 22nd of February we passed in the Sargasso Sea,
|
|
where such fish as are partial to marine plants find abundant nourishment.
|
|
The next, the ocean had returned to its accustomed aspect.
|
|
From this time for nineteen days, from the 23rd of February to the 12th
|
|
of March, the Nautilus kept in the middle of the Atlantic, carrying us
|
|
at a constant speed of a hundred leagues in twenty-four hours.
|
|
Captain Nemo evidently intended accomplishing his submarine programme,
|
|
and I imagined that he intended, after doubling Cape Horn, to return
|
|
to the Australian seas of the Pacific. Ned Land had cause for fear.
|
|
In these large seas, void of islands, we could not attempt to leave
|
|
the boat. Nor had we any means of opposing Captain Nemo's will.
|
|
Our only course was to submit; but what we could neither gain by force
|
|
nor cunning, I liked to think might be obtained by persuasion.
|
|
This voyage ended, would he not consent to restore our liberty,
|
|
under an oath never to reveal his existence?--an oath of honour which we
|
|
should have religiously kept. But we must consider that delicate
|
|
question with the Captain. But was I free to claim this liberty?
|
|
Had he not himself said from the beginning, in the firmest manner,
|
|
that the secret of his life exacted from him our lasting imprisonment
|
|
on board the Nautilus? And would not my four months' silence appear
|
|
to him a tacit acceptance of our situation? And would not a return
|
|
to the subject result in raising suspicions which might be hurtful
|
|
to our projects, if at some future time a favourable opportunity offered
|
|
to return to them?
|
|
|
|
During the nineteen days mentioned above, no incident
|
|
of any kind happened to signalise our voyage. I saw little
|
|
of the Captain; he was at work. In the library I often found
|
|
his books left open, especially those on natural history.
|
|
My work on submarine depths, conned over by him, was covered
|
|
with marginal notes, often contradicting my theories and systems;
|
|
but the Captain contented himself with thus purging my work;
|
|
it was very rare for him to discuss it with me.
|
|
Sometimes I heard the melancholy tones of his organ;
|
|
but only at night, in the midst of the deepest obscurity,
|
|
when the Nautilus slept upon the deserted ocean. During this part
|
|
of our voyage we sailed whole days on the surface of the waves.
|
|
The sea seemed abandoned. A few sailing-vessels, on
|
|
the road to India, were making for the Cape of Good Hope.
|
|
One day we were followed by the boats of a whaler, who, no doubt,
|
|
took us for some enormous whale of great price; but Captain
|
|
Nemo did not wish the worthy fellows to lose their time
|
|
and trouble, so ended the chase by plunging under the water.
|
|
Our navigation continued until the 13th of March;
|
|
that day the Nautilus was employed in taking soundings,
|
|
which greatly interested me. We had then made about 13,000
|
|
leagues since our departure from the high seas of the Pacific.
|
|
The bearings gave us 45@ 37' S. lat., and 37@ 53' W. long.
|
|
It was the same water in which Captain Denham of the Herald
|
|
sounded 7,000 fathoms without finding the bottom.
|
|
There, too, Lieutenant Parker, of the American frigate Congress,
|
|
could not touch the bottom with 15,140 fathoms.
|
|
Captain Nemo intended seeking the bottom of the ocean by a
|
|
diagonal sufficiently lengthened by means of lateral planes
|
|
placed at an angle of 45@ with the water-line of the Nautilus.
|
|
Then the screw set to work at its maximum speed, its four
|
|
blades beating the waves with in describable force.
|
|
Under this powerful pressure, the hull of the Nautilus quivered
|
|
like a sonorous chord and sank regularly under the water.
|
|
|
|
At 7,000 fathoms I saw some blackish tops rising from the midst of the waters;
|
|
but these summits might belong to high mountains like the Himalayas or
|
|
Mont Blanc, even higher; and the depth of the abyss remained incalculable.
|
|
The Nautilus descended still lower, in spite of the great pressure.
|
|
I felt the steel plates tremble at the fastenings of the bolts;
|
|
its bars bent, its partitions groaned; the windows of the saloon
|
|
seemed to curve under the pressure of the waters. And this firm
|
|
structure would doubtless have yielded, if, as its Captain had said,
|
|
it had not been capable of resistance like a solid block. We had attained
|
|
a depth of 16,000 yards (four leagues), and the sides of the Nautilus
|
|
then bore a pressure of 1,600 atmospheres, that is to say, 3,200 lb.
|
|
to each square two-fifths of an inch of its surface.
|
|
|
|
"What a situation to be in!" I exclaimed. "To overrun these deep regions
|
|
where man has never trod! Look, Captain, look at these magnificent rocks,
|
|
these uninhabited grottoes, these lowest receptacles of the globe,
|
|
where life is no longer possible! What unknown sights are here!
|
|
Why should we be unable to preserve a remembrance of them?"
|
|
|
|
"Would you like to carry away more than the remembrance?"
|
|
said Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"What do you mean by those words?"
|
|
|
|
"I mean to say that nothing is easier than to make a photographic
|
|
view of this submarine region."
|
|
|
|
I had not time to express my surprise at this new proposition, when,
|
|
at Captain Nemo's call, an objective was brought into the saloon.
|
|
Through the widely-opened panel, the liquid mass was bright with electricity,
|
|
which was distributed with such uniformity that not a shadow, not a gradation,
|
|
was to be seen in our manufactured light. The Nautilus remained motionless,
|
|
the force of its screw subdued by the inclination of its planes:
|
|
the instrument was propped on the bottom of the oceanic site, and in a few
|
|
seconds we had obtained a perfect negative.
|
|
|
|
But, the operation being over, Captain Nemo said, "Let us go up;
|
|
we must not abuse our position, nor expose the Nautilus too long
|
|
to such great pressure."
|
|
|
|
"Go up again!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"Hold well on."
|
|
|
|
I had not time to understand why the Captain cautioned me thus, when I
|
|
was thrown forward on to the carpet. At a signal from the Captain,
|
|
its screw was shipped, and its blades raised vertically; the Nautilus
|
|
shot into the air like a balloon, rising with stunning rapidity,
|
|
and cutting the mass of waters with a sonorous agitation.
|
|
Nothing was visible; and in four minutes it had shot through the four
|
|
leagues which separated it from the ocean, and, after emerging like a
|
|
flying-fish, fell, making the waves rebound to an enormous height.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XII
|
|
|
|
CACHALOTS AND WHALES
|
|
|
|
During the nights of the 13th and 14th of March, the Nautilus returned
|
|
to its southerly course. I fancied that, when on a level with Cape Horn,
|
|
he would turn the helm westward, in order to beat the Pacific seas,
|
|
and so complete the tour of the world. He did nothing of the kind,
|
|
but continued on his way to the southern regions. Where was he going to?
|
|
To the pole? It was madness! I began to think that the Captain's
|
|
temerity justified Ned Land's fears. For some time past the Canadian
|
|
had not spoken to me of his projects of flight; he was less communicative,
|
|
almost silent. I could see that this lengthened imprisonment was
|
|
weighing upon him, and I felt that rage was burning within him.
|
|
When he met the Captain, his eyes lit up with suppressed anger;
|
|
and I feared that his natural violence would lead him into some extreme.
|
|
That day, the 14th of March, Conseil and he came to me in my room.
|
|
I inquired the cause of their visit.
|
|
|
|
"A simple question to ask you, sir," replied the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Speak, Ned."
|
|
|
|
"How many men are there on board the Nautilus, do you think?"
|
|
|
|
"I cannot tell, my friend."
|
|
|
|
"I should say that its working does not require a large crew."
|
|
|
|
"Certainly, under existing conditions, ten men, at the most,
|
|
ought to be enough."
|
|
|
|
"Well, why should there be any more?"
|
|
|
|
"Why?" I replied, looking fixedly at Ned Land, whose meaning was easy
|
|
to guess. "Because," I added, "if my surmises are correct, and if I have
|
|
well understood the Captain's existence, the Nautilus is not only a vessel:
|
|
it is also a place of refuge for those who, like its commander, have broken
|
|
every tie upon earth."
|
|
|
|
"Perhaps so," said Conseil; "but, in any case, the Nautilus can only contain
|
|
a certain number of men. Could not you, sir, estimate their maximum?"
|
|
|
|
"How, Conseil?"
|
|
|
|
"By calculation; given the size of the vessel, which you know, sir,
|
|
and consequently the quantity of air it contains, knowing also how much
|
|
each man expends at a breath, and comparing these results with the fact
|
|
that the Nautilus is obliged to go to the surface every twenty-four hours."
|
|
|
|
Conseil had not finished the sentence before I saw what he was driving at.
|
|
|
|
"I understand," said I; "but that calculation, though simple enough,
|
|
can give but a very uncertain result."
|
|
|
|
"Never mind," said Ned Land urgently.
|
|
|
|
"Here it is, then," said I. "In one hour each man consumes the oxygen
|
|
contained in twenty gallons of air; and in twenty-four, that contained
|
|
in 480 gallons. We must, therefore find how many times 480 gallons
|
|
of air the Nautilus contains."
|
|
|
|
"Just so," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Or," I continued, "the size of the Nautilus being 1,500 tons;
|
|
and one ton holding 200 gallons, it contains 300,000 gallons
|
|
of air, which, divided by 480, gives a quotient of 625.
|
|
Which means to say, strictly speaking, that the air contained in
|
|
the Nautilus would suffice for 625 men for twenty-four hours."
|
|
|
|
"Six hundred and twenty-five!" repeated Ned.
|
|
|
|
"But remember that all of us, passengers, sailors, and officers included,
|
|
would not form a tenth part of that number."
|
|
|
|
"Still too many for three men," murmured Conseil.
|
|
|
|
The Canadian shook his head, passed his hand across his forehead,
|
|
and left the room without answering.
|
|
|
|
"Will you allow me to make one observation, sir?" said Conseil.
|
|
"Poor Ned is longing for everything that he can not have. His past life
|
|
is always present to him; everything that we are forbidden he regrets.
|
|
His head is full of old recollections. And we must understand him.
|
|
What has he to do here? Nothing; he is not learned like you, sir;
|
|
and has not the same taste for the beauties of the sea that we have.
|
|
He would risk everything to be able to go once more into a tavern
|
|
in his own country."
|
|
|
|
Certainly the monotony on board must seem intolerable to the Canadian,
|
|
accustomed as he was to a life of liberty and activity.
|
|
Events were rare which could rouse him to any show of spirit; but that day
|
|
an event did happen which recalled the bright days of the harpooner.
|
|
About eleven in the morning, being on the surface of the ocean,
|
|
the Nautilus fell in with a troop of whales--an encounter which did
|
|
not astonish me, knowing that these creatures, hunted to death,
|
|
had taken refuge in high latitudes.
|
|
|
|
We were seated on the platform, with a quiet sea. The month of October
|
|
in those latitudes gave us some lovely autumnal days. It was the Canadian--
|
|
he could not be mistaken--who signalled a whale on the eastern horizon.
|
|
Looking attentively, one might see its black back rise and fall with the waves
|
|
five miles from the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" exclaimed Ned Land, "if I was on board a whaler, now such
|
|
a meeting would give me pleasure. It is one of large size.
|
|
See with what strength its blow-holes throw up columns of air an steam!
|
|
Confound it, why am I bound to these steel plates?"
|
|
|
|
"What, Ned," said I, "you have not forgotten your old ideas of fishing?"
|
|
|
|
"Can a whale-fisher ever forget his old trade, sir? Can he ever
|
|
tire of the emotions caused by such a chase?"
|
|
|
|
"You have never fished in these seas, Ned?"
|
|
|
|
"Never, sir; in the northern only, and as much in Behring
|
|
as in Davis Straits."
|
|
|
|
"Then the southern whale is still unknown to you. It is the Greenland
|
|
whale you have hunted up to this time, and that would not risk passing
|
|
through the warm waters of the equator. Whales are localised,
|
|
according to their kinds, in certain seas which they never leave.
|
|
And if one of these creatures went from Behring to Davis Straits,
|
|
it must be simply because there is a passage from one sea to the other,
|
|
either on the American or the Asiatic side."
|
|
|
|
"In that case, as I have never fished in these seas, I do not know
|
|
the kind of whale frequenting them!"
|
|
|
|
"I have told you, Ned."
|
|
|
|
"A greater reason for making their acquaintance," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Look! look!" exclaimed the Canadian, "they approach:
|
|
they aggravate me; they know that I cannot get at them!"
|
|
|
|
Ned stamped his feet. His hand trembled, as he grasped an imaginary harpoon.
|
|
|
|
"Are these cetaceans as large as those of the northern seas?" asked he.
|
|
|
|
"Very nearly, Ned."
|
|
|
|
"Because I have seen large whales, sir, whales measuring a hundred feet.
|
|
I have even been told that those of Hullamoch and Umgallick,
|
|
of the Aleutian Islands, are sometimes a hundred and fifty feet long."
|
|
|
|
"That seems to me exaggeration. These creatures are generally much smaller
|
|
than the Greenland whale." {this paragraph has been edited}
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" exclaimed the Canadian, whose eyes had never left the ocean,
|
|
"they are coming nearer; they are in the same water as the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
Then, returning to the conversation, he said:
|
|
|
|
"You spoke of the cachalot as a small creature.
|
|
I have heard of gigantic ones. They are intelligent cetacea.
|
|
It is said of some that they cover themselves with seaweed and fucus,
|
|
and then are taken for islands. People encamp upon them,
|
|
and settle there; lights a fire----"
|
|
|
|
"And build houses," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, joker," said Ned Land. "And one fine day the creature plunges,
|
|
carrying with it all the inhabitants to the bottom of the sea."
|
|
|
|
"Something like the travels of Sinbad the Sailor," I replied, laughing.
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" suddenly exclaimed Ned Land, "it is not one whale;
|
|
there are ten--there are twenty--it is a whole troop!
|
|
And I not able to do anything! hands and feet tied!"
|
|
|
|
"But, friend Ned," said Conseil, "why do you not ask Captain
|
|
Nemo's permission to chase them?"
|
|
|
|
Conseil had not finished his sentence when Ned Land had
|
|
lowered himself through the panel to seek the Captain.
|
|
A few minutes afterwards the two appeared together on the platform.
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo watched the troop of cetacea playing on the waters
|
|
about a mile from the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
"They are southern whales," said he; "there goes the fortune
|
|
of a whole fleet of whalers."
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir," asked the Canadian, "can I not chase them,
|
|
if only to remind me of my old trade of harpooner?"
|
|
|
|
"And to what purpose?" replied Captain Nemo; "only to destroy!
|
|
We have nothing to do with the whale-oil on board."
|
|
|
|
"But, sir," continued the Canadian, "in the Red Sea you allowed
|
|
us to follow the dugong."
|
|
|
|
"Then it was to procure fresh meat for my crew. Here it would
|
|
be killing for killing's sake. I know that is a privilege
|
|
reserved for man, but I do not approve of such murderous pastime.
|
|
In destroying the southern whale (like the Greenland whale,
|
|
an inoffensive creature), your traders do a culpable action,
|
|
Master Land. They have already depopulated the whole of
|
|
Baffin's Bay, and are annihilating a class of useful animals.
|
|
Leave the unfortunate cetacea alone. They have plenty
|
|
of natural enemies--cachalots, swordfish, and sawfish--
|
|
without you troubling them."
|
|
|
|
The Captain was right. The barbarous and inconsiderate greed of these
|
|
fishermen will one day cause the disappearance of the last whale
|
|
in the ocean. Ned Land whistled "Yankee-doodle" between his teeth,
|
|
thrust his hands into his pockets, and turned his back upon us.
|
|
But Captain Nemo watched the troop of cetacea, and, addressing me, said:
|
|
|
|
"I was right in saying that whales had natural enemies enough,
|
|
without counting man. These will have plenty to do before long.
|
|
Do you see, M. Aronnax, about eight miles to leeward,
|
|
those blackish moving points?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Captain," I replied.
|
|
|
|
"Those are cachalots--terrible animals, which I have met in troops of two
|
|
or three hundred. As to those, they are cruel, mischievous creatures;
|
|
they would be right in exterminating them."
|
|
|
|
The Canadian turned quickly at the last words.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Captain," said he, "it is still time, in the interest
|
|
of the whales."
|
|
|
|
"It is useless to expose one's self, Professor. The Nautilus
|
|
will disperse them. It is armed with a steel spur as good
|
|
as Master Land's harpoon, I imagine."
|
|
|
|
The Canadian did not put himself out enough to shrug his shoulders.
|
|
Attack cetacea with blows of a spur! Who had ever heard of such a thing?
|
|
|
|
"Wait, M. Aronnax," said Captain Nemo. "We will show you something you
|
|
have never yet seen. We have no pity for these ferocious creatures.
|
|
They are nothing but mouth and teeth."
|
|
|
|
Mouth and teeth! No one could better describe the macrocephalous
|
|
cachalot, which is sometimes more than seventy-five feet long.
|
|
Its enormous head occupies one-third of its entire body.
|
|
Better armed than the whale, whose upper jaw is furnished only
|
|
with whalebone, it is supplied with twenty-five large tusks,
|
|
about eight inches long, cylindrical and conical at the top,
|
|
each weighing two pounds. It is in the upper part of this
|
|
enormous head, in great cavities divided by cartilages, that is
|
|
to be found from six to eight hundred pounds of that precious
|
|
oil called spermaceti. The cachalot is a disagreeable creature,
|
|
more tadpole than fish, according to Fredol's description.
|
|
It is badly formed, the whole of its left side being
|
|
(if we may say it), a "failure," and being only able to see
|
|
with its right eye. But the formidable troop was nearing us.
|
|
They had seen the whales and were preparing to attack them.
|
|
One could judge beforehand that the cachalots would be victorious,
|
|
not only because they were better built for attack than
|
|
their inoffensive adversaries, but also because they could
|
|
remain longer under water without coming to the surface.
|
|
There was only just time to go to the help of the whales.
|
|
The Nautilus went under water. Conseil, Ned Land,
|
|
and I took our places before the window in the saloon,
|
|
and Captain Nemo joined the pilot in his cage to work
|
|
his apparatus as an engine of destruction. Soon I felt
|
|
the beatings of the screw quicken, and our speed increased.
|
|
The battle between the cachalots and the whales had already begun
|
|
when the Nautilus arrived. They did not at first show any fear
|
|
at the sight of this new monster joining in the conflict.
|
|
But they soon had to guard against its blows. What a battle!
|
|
The Nautilus was nothing but a formidable harpoon,
|
|
brandished by the hand of its Captain. It hurled itself against
|
|
the fleshy mass, passing through from one part to the other,
|
|
leaving behind it two quivering halves of the animal.
|
|
It could not feel the formidable blows from their tails upon
|
|
its sides, nor the shock which it produced itself, much more.
|
|
One cachalot killed, it ran at the next, tacked on the spot
|
|
that it might not miss its prey, going forwards and backwards,
|
|
answering to its helm, plunging when the cetacean dived into
|
|
the deep waters, coming up with it when it returned to the surface,
|
|
striking it front or sideways, cutting or tearing in all
|
|
directions and at any pace, piercing it with its terrible spur.
|
|
What carnage! What a noise on the surface of the waves!
|
|
What sharp hissing, and what snorting peculiar to
|
|
these enraged animals! In the midst of these waters,
|
|
generally so peaceful, their tails made perfect billows.
|
|
For one hour this wholesale massacre continued, from which the
|
|
cachalots could not escape. Several times ten or twelve united
|
|
tried to crush the Nautilus by their weight. From the window
|
|
we could see their enormous mouths, studded with tusks,
|
|
and their formidable eyes. Ned Land could not contain himself;
|
|
he threatened and swore at them. We could feel them clinging
|
|
to our vessel like dogs worrying a wild boar in a copse.
|
|
But the Nautilus, working its screw, carried them here and there,
|
|
or to the upper levels of the ocean, without caring for their
|
|
enormous weight, nor the powerful strain on the vessel.
|
|
At length the mass of cachalots broke up, the waves
|
|
became quiet, and I felt that we were rising to the surface.
|
|
The panel opened, and we hurried on to the platform.
|
|
The sea was covered with mutilated bodies. A formidable explosion
|
|
could not have divided and torn this fleshy mass with more violence.
|
|
We were floating amid gigantic bodies, bluish on the back
|
|
and white underneath, covered with enormous protuberances.
|
|
Some terrified cachalots were flying towards the horizon.
|
|
The waves were dyed red for several miles, and the Nautilus
|
|
floated in a sea of blood: Captain Nemo joined
|
|
us.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Master Land?" said he.
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir," replied the Canadian, whose enthusiasm had somewhat calmed;
|
|
"it is a terrible spectacle, certainly. But I am not a butcher.
|
|
I am a hunter, and I call this a butchery."
|
|
|
|
"It is a massacre of mischievous creatures," replied the Captain;
|
|
"and the Nautilus is not a butcher's knife."
|
|
|
|
"I like my harpoon better," said the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Every one to his own," answered the Captain, looking fixedly
|
|
at Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
I feared he would commit some act of violence, which would end
|
|
in sad consequences. But his anger was turned by the sight
|
|
of a whale which the Nautilus had just come up with.
|
|
The creature had not quite escaped from the cachalot's teeth.
|
|
I recognised the southern whale by its flat head,
|
|
which is entirely black. Anatomically, it is distinguished
|
|
from the white whale and the North Cape whale by the seven
|
|
cervical vertebrae, and it has two more ribs than its congeners.
|
|
The unfortunate cetacean was lying on its side,
|
|
riddled with holes from the bites, and quite dead.
|
|
From its mutilated fin still hung a young whale which it could
|
|
not save from the massacre. Its open mouth let the water flow
|
|
in and out, murmuring like the waves breaking on the shore.
|
|
Captain Nemo steered close to the corpse of the creature.
|
|
Two of his men mounted its side, and I saw, not without surprise,
|
|
that they were drawing from its breasts all the milk which
|
|
they contained, that is to say, about two or three tons.
|
|
The Captain offered me a cup of the milk, which was still warm.
|
|
I could not help showing my repugnance to the drink;
|
|
but he assured me that it was excellent, and not to be distinguished
|
|
from cow's milk. I tasted it, and was of his opinion.
|
|
It was a useful reserve to us, for in the shape of salt butter
|
|
or cheese it would form an agreeable variety from our ordinary food.
|
|
From that day I noticed with uneasiness that Ned Land's ill-will
|
|
towards Captain Nemo increased, and I resolved to watch the
|
|
Canadian's gestures closely.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER VIII
|
|
|
|
THE ICEBERG
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus was steadily pursuing its southerly course,
|
|
following the fiftieth meridian with considerable speed.
|
|
Did he wish to reach the pole? I did not think so,
|
|
for every attempt to reach that point had hitherto failed.
|
|
Again, the season was far advanced, for in the Antarctic regions
|
|
the 13th of March corresponds with the 13th of September
|
|
of northern regions, which begin at the equinoctial season.
|
|
On the 14th of March I saw floating ice in latitude 55@,
|
|
merely pale bits of debris from twenty to twenty-five
|
|
feet long, forming banks over which the sea curled.
|
|
The Nautilus remained on the surface of the ocean.
|
|
Ned Land, who had fished in the Arctic Seas, was familiar with
|
|
its icebergs; but Conseil and I admired them for the first time.
|
|
In the atmosphere towards the southern horizon stretched
|
|
a white dazzling band. English whalers have given it
|
|
the name of "ice blink." However thick the clouds may be,
|
|
it is always visible, and announces the presence of an ice
|
|
pack or bank. Accordingly, larger blocks soon appeared,
|
|
whose brilliancy changed with the caprices of the fog.
|
|
Some of these masses showed green veins, as if long undulating
|
|
lines had been traced with sulphate of copper; others resembled
|
|
enormous amethysts with the light shining through them.
|
|
Some reflected the light of day upon a thousand crystal facets.
|
|
Others shaded with vivid calcareous reflections resembled a perfect
|
|
town of marble. The more we neared the south the more these floating
|
|
islands increased both in number and importance.
|
|
|
|
At 60@ lat. every pass had disappeared. But, seeking carefully,
|
|
Captain Nemo soon found a narrow opening, through which he boldly slipped,
|
|
knowing, however, that it would close behind him. Thus, guided by this
|
|
clever hand, the Nautilus passed through all the ice with a precision
|
|
which quite charmed Conseil; icebergs or mountains, ice-fields or
|
|
smooth plains, seeming to have no limits, drift-ice or floating ice-packs,
|
|
plains broken up, called palchs when they are circular, and streams
|
|
when they are made up of long strips. The temperature was very low;
|
|
the thermometer exposed to the air marked 2@ or 3@ below zero, but we
|
|
were warmly clad with fur, at the expense of the sea-bear and seal.
|
|
The interior of the Nautilus, warmed regularly by its electric apparatus,
|
|
defied the most intense cold. Besides, it would only have been necessary
|
|
to go some yards beneath the waves to find a more bearable temperature.
|
|
Two months earlier we should have had perpetual daylight in these latitudes;
|
|
but already we had had three or four hours of night, and by and by there
|
|
would be six months of darkness in these circumpolar regions. On the 15th
|
|
of March we were in the latitude of New Shetland and South Orkney.
|
|
The Captain told me that formerly numerous tribes of seals inhabited them;
|
|
but that English and American whalers, in their rage for destruction,
|
|
massacred both old and young; thus, where there was once life and animation,
|
|
they had left silence and death.
|
|
|
|
About eight o'clock on the morning of the 16th of March the Nautilus,
|
|
following the fifty-fifth meridian, cut the Antarctic polar circle.
|
|
Ice surrounded us on all sides, and closed the horizon.
|
|
But Captain Nemo went from one opening to another, still going higher.
|
|
I cannot express my astonishment at the beauties of these new regions.
|
|
The ice took most surprising forms. Here the grouping formed an
|
|
oriental town, with innumerable mosques and minarets; there a fallen
|
|
city thrown to the earth, as it were, by some convulsion of nature.
|
|
The whole aspect was constantly changed by the oblique rays
|
|
of the sun, or lost in the greyish fog amidst hurricanes of snow.
|
|
Detonations and falls were heard on all sides, great overthrows of icebergs,
|
|
which altered the whole landscape like a diorama. Often seeing no exit,
|
|
I thought we were definitely prisoners; but, instinct guiding him
|
|
at the slightest indication, Captain Nemo would discover a new pass.
|
|
He was never mistaken when he saw the thin threads of bluish water
|
|
trickling along the ice-fields; and I had no doubt that he had
|
|
already ventured into the midst of these Antarctic seas before.
|
|
On the 16th of March, however, the ice-fields absolutely blocked our road.
|
|
It was not the iceberg itself, as yet, but vast fields cemented
|
|
by the cold. But this obstacle could not stop Captain Nemo:
|
|
he hurled himself against it with frightful violence. The Nautilus entered
|
|
the brittle mass like a wedge, and split it with frightful crackings.
|
|
It was the battering ram of the ancients hurled by infinite strength.
|
|
The ice, thrown high in the air, fell like hail around us.
|
|
By its own power of impulsion our apparatus made a canal for itself;
|
|
some times carried away by its own impetus, it lodged on the ice-field,
|
|
crushing it with its weight, and sometimes buried beneath it,
|
|
dividing it by a simple pitching movement, producing large rents in it.
|
|
Violent gales assailed us at this time, accompanied by thick fogs,
|
|
through which, from one end of the platform to the other, we could
|
|
see nothing. The wind blew sharply from all parts of the compass,
|
|
and the snow lay in such hard heaps that we had to break it with
|
|
blows of a pickaxe. The temperature was always at 5@ below zero;
|
|
every outward part of the Nautilus was covered with ice.
|
|
A rigged vessel would have been entangled in the blocked up gorges.
|
|
A vessel without sails, with electricity for its motive power,
|
|
and wanting no coal, could alone brave such high latitudes. At length,
|
|
on the 18th of March, after many useless assaults, the Nautilus was
|
|
positively blocked. It was no longer either streams, packs, or ice-fields,
|
|
but an interminable and immovable barrier, formed by mountains soldered
|
|
together.
|
|
|
|
"An iceberg!" said the Canadian to me.
|
|
|
|
I knew that to Ned Land, as well as to all other navigators who had
|
|
preceded us, this was an inevitable obstacle. The sun appearing for an
|
|
instant at noon, Captain Nemo took an observation as near as possible,
|
|
which gave our situation at 51@ 30' long. and 67@ 39' of S. lat.
|
|
We had advanced one degree more in this Antarctic region.
|
|
Of the liquid surface of the sea there was no longer a glimpse.
|
|
Under the spur of the Nautilus lay stretched a vast plain,
|
|
entangled with confused blocks. Here and there sharp points and slender
|
|
needles rising to a height of 200 feet; further on a steep shore,
|
|
hewn as it were with an axe and clothed with greyish tints;
|
|
huge mirrors, reflecting a few rays of sunshine, half drowned in the fog.
|
|
And over this desolate face of nature a stern silence reigned,
|
|
scarcely broken by the flapping of the wings of petrels and puffins.
|
|
Everything was frozen--even the noise. The Nautilus was then
|
|
obliged to stop in its adventurous course amid these fields of ice.
|
|
In spite of our efforts, in spite of the powerful means
|
|
employed to break up the ice, the Nautilus remained immovable.
|
|
Generally, when we can proceed no further, we have return still
|
|
open to us; but here return was as impossible as advance,
|
|
for every pass had closed behind us; and for the few moments
|
|
when we were stationary, we were likely to be entirely blocked,
|
|
which did indeed happen about two o'clock in the afternoon,
|
|
the fresh ice forming around its sides with astonishing rapidity.
|
|
I was obliged to admit that Captain Nemo was more than imprudent.
|
|
I was on the platform at that moment. The Captain had been observing
|
|
our situation for some time past, when he said to me:
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir, what do you think of this?"
|
|
|
|
"I think that we are caught, Captain."
|
|
|
|
"So, M. Aronnax, you really think that the Nautilus cannot disengage itself?"
|
|
|
|
"With difficulty, Captain; for the season is already too far
|
|
advanced for you to reckon on the breaking of the ice."
|
|
|
|
"Ah! sir," said Captain Nemo, in an ironical tone, "you will always
|
|
be the same. You see nothing but difficulties and obstacles.
|
|
I affirm that not only can the Nautilus disengage itself,
|
|
but also that it can go further still."
|
|
|
|
"Further to the South?" I asked, looking at the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir; it shall go to the pole."
|
|
|
|
"To the pole!" I exclaimed, unable to repress a gesture of incredulity.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," replied the Captain, coldly, "to the Antarctic pole--
|
|
to that unknown point from whence springs every meridian of the globe.
|
|
You know whether I can do as I please with the Nautilus!"
|
|
|
|
Yes, I knew that. I knew that this man was bold, even to rashness.
|
|
But to conquer those obstacles which bristled round the South Pole,
|
|
rendering it more inaccessible than the North, which had not yet
|
|
been reached by the boldest navigators--was it not a mad enterprise,
|
|
one which only a maniac would have conceived? It then came into
|
|
my head to ask Captain Nemo if he had ever discovered that pole
|
|
which had never yet been trodden by a human creature?
|
|
|
|
"No, sir," he replied; "but we will discover it together.
|
|
Where others have failed, I will not fail. I have never yet led
|
|
my Nautilus so far into southern seas; but, I repeat, it shall
|
|
go further yet."
|
|
|
|
"I can well believe you, Captain," said I, in a slightly ironical tone.
|
|
"I believe you! Let us go ahead! There are no obstacles for us!
|
|
Let us smash this iceberg! Let us blow it up; and, if it resists,
|
|
let us give the Nautilus wings to fly over it!"
|
|
|
|
"Over it, sir!" said Captain Nemo, quietly; "no, not over it,
|
|
but under it!"
|
|
|
|
"Under it!" I exclaimed, a sudden idea of the Captain's projects flashing
|
|
upon my mind. I understood; the wonderful qualities of the Nautilus were
|
|
going to serve us in this superhuman enterprise.
|
|
|
|
"I see we are beginning to understand one another, sir," said the Captain,
|
|
half smiling. "You begin to see the possibility--I should say the success--
|
|
of this attempt. That which is impossible for an ordinary vessel is easy
|
|
to the Nautilus. If a continent lies before the pole, it must stop before
|
|
the continent; but if, on the contrary, the pole is washed by open sea,
|
|
it will go even to the pole."
|
|
|
|
"Certainly," said I, carried away by the Captain's reasoning;
|
|
"if the surface of the sea is solidified by the ice,
|
|
the lower depths are free by the Providential law which has
|
|
placed the maximum of density of the waters of the ocean one
|
|
degree higher than freezing-point; and, if I am not mistaken,
|
|
the portion of this iceberg which is above the water is as one
|
|
to four to that which is below."
|
|
|
|
"Very nearly, sir; for one foot of iceberg above the sea there
|
|
are three below it. If these ice mountains are not more than 300
|
|
feet above the surface, they are not more than 900 beneath.
|
|
And what are 900 feet to the Nautilus?"
|
|
|
|
"Nothing, sir."
|
|
|
|
"It could even seek at greater depths that uniform temperature
|
|
of sea-water, and there brave with impunity the thirty or forty
|
|
degrees of surface cold."
|
|
|
|
"Just so, sir--just so," I replied, getting animated.
|
|
|
|
"The only difficulty," continued Captain Nemo, "is that of remaining
|
|
several days without renewing our provision of air."
|
|
|
|
"Is that all? The Nautilus has vast reservoirs; we can fill them,
|
|
and they will supply us with all the oxygen we want."
|
|
|
|
"Well thought of, M. Aronnax," replied the Captain, smiling.
|
|
"But, not wishing you to accuse me of rashness, I will first give
|
|
you all my objections."
|
|
|
|
"Have you any more to make?"
|
|
|
|
"Only one. It is possible, if the sea exists at the South Pole,
|
|
that it may be covered; and, consequently, we shall be unable
|
|
to come to the surface."
|
|
|
|
"Good, sir! but do you forget that the Nautilus is armed with a powerful spur,
|
|
and could we not send it diagonally against these fields of ice, which would
|
|
open at the shocks."
|
|
|
|
"Ah! sir, you are full of ideas to-day."
|
|
|
|
"Besides, Captain," I added, enthusiastically, "why should we
|
|
not find the sea open at the South Pole as well as at the North?
|
|
The frozen poles of the earth do not coincide, either in the southern
|
|
or in the northern regions; and, until it is proved to the contrary,
|
|
we may suppose either a continent or an ocean free from ice at these two
|
|
points of the globe."
|
|
|
|
"I think so too, M. Aronnax," replied Captain Nemo.
|
|
"I only wish you to observe that, after having made so many
|
|
objections to my project, you are now crushing me with arguments
|
|
in its favour!"
|
|
|
|
The preparations for this audacious attempt now began.
|
|
The powerful pumps of the Nautilus were working air into the
|
|
reservoirs and storing it at high pressure. About four o'clock,
|
|
Captain Nemo announced the closing of the panels on the platform.
|
|
I threw one last look at the massive iceberg which we were going
|
|
to cross. The weather was clear, the atmosphere pure enough,
|
|
the cold very great, being 12@ below zero; but, the wind
|
|
having gone down, this temperature was not so unbearable.
|
|
About ten men mounted the sides of the Nautilus, armed with
|
|
pickaxes to break the ice around the vessel, which was soon free.
|
|
The operation was quickly performed, for the fresh ice was still
|
|
very thin. We all went below. The usual reservoirs were filled
|
|
with the newly-liberated water, and the Nautilus soon descended.
|
|
I had taken my place with Conseil in the saloon; through the open
|
|
window we could see the lower beds of the Southern Ocean.
|
|
The thermometer went up, the needle of the compass deviated
|
|
on the dial. At about 900 feet, as Captain Nemo had foreseen,
|
|
we were floating beneath the undulating bottom of the iceberg.
|
|
But the Nautilus went lower still--it went to the depth of four
|
|
hundred fathoms. The temperature of the water at the surface
|
|
showed twelve degrees, it was now only ten; we had gained two.
|
|
I need not say the temperature of the Nautilus was raised by its heating
|
|
apparatus to a much higher degree; every manoeuvre was accomplished
|
|
with wonderful precision.
|
|
|
|
"We shall pass it, if you please, sir," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"I believe we shall," I said, in a tone of firm conviction.
|
|
|
|
In this open sea, the Nautilus had taken its course direct
|
|
to the pole, without leaving the fifty-second meridian.
|
|
From 67@ 30' to 90@, twenty-two degrees and a half of latitude
|
|
remained to travel; that is, about five hundred leagues.
|
|
The Nautilus kept up a mean speed of twenty-six miles an hour--
|
|
the speed of an express train. If that was kept up, in forty hours we
|
|
should reach the pole.
|
|
|
|
For a part of the night the novelty of the situation kept us
|
|
at the window. The sea was lit with the electric lantern; but it
|
|
was deserted; fishes did not sojourn in these imprisoned waters;
|
|
they only found there a passage to take them from the
|
|
Antarctic Ocean to the open polar sea. Our pace was rapid;
|
|
we could feel it by the quivering of the long steel body.
|
|
About two in the morning I took some hours' repose, and Conseil
|
|
did the same. In crossing the waist I did not meet Captain Nemo:
|
|
I supposed him to be in the pilot's cage. The next morning,
|
|
the 19th of March, I took my post once more in the saloon.
|
|
The electric log told me that the speed of the Nautilus
|
|
had been slackened. It was then going towards the surface;
|
|
but prudently emptying its reservoirs very slowly.
|
|
My heart beat fast. Were we going to emerge and regain the open
|
|
polar atmosphere? No! A shock told me that the Nautilus
|
|
had struck the bottom of the iceberg, still very thick,
|
|
judging from the deadened sound. We had in deed "struck," to use
|
|
a sea expression, but in an inverse sense, and at a thousand
|
|
feet deep. This would give three thousand feet of ice above us;
|
|
one thousand being above the water-mark. The iceberg was then
|
|
higher than at its borders--not a very reassuring fact.
|
|
Several times that day the Nautilus tried again, and every
|
|
time it struck the wall which lay like a ceiling above it.
|
|
Sometimes it met with but 900 yards, only 200 of which
|
|
rose above the surface. It was twice the height it was
|
|
when the Nautilus had gone under the waves. I carefully
|
|
noted the different depths, and thus obtained a submarine
|
|
profile of the chain as it was developed under the water.
|
|
That night no change had taken place in our situation.
|
|
Still ice between four and five hundred yards in depth!
|
|
It was evidently diminishing, but, still, what a thickness
|
|
between us and the surface of the ocean! It was then eight.
|
|
According to the daily custom on board the Nautilus,
|
|
its air should have been renewed four hours ago;
|
|
but I did not suffer much, although Captain Nemo had not yet
|
|
made any demand upon his reserve of oxygen. My sleep was
|
|
painful that night; hope and fear besieged me by turns:
|
|
I rose several times. The groping of the Nautilus continued.
|
|
About three in the morning, I noticed that the lower surface
|
|
of the iceberg was only about fifty feet deep. One hundred
|
|
and fifty feet now separated us from the surface of the waters.
|
|
The iceberg was by degrees becoming an ice-field, the mountain
|
|
a plain. My eyes never left the manometer. We were still rising
|
|
diagonally to the surface, which sparkled under the electric rays.
|
|
The iceberg was stretching both above and beneath into
|
|
lengthening slopes; mile after mile it was getting thinner.
|
|
At length, at six in the morning of that memorable day,
|
|
the 19th of March, the door of the saloon opened, and Captain Nemo
|
|
appeared.
|
|
|
|
"The sea is open!!" was all he said.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XIV
|
|
|
|
THE SOUTH POLE
|
|
|
|
I rushed on to the platform. Yes! the open sea, with but a few
|
|
scattered pieces of ice and moving icebergs--a long stretch of sea;
|
|
a world of birds in the air, and myriads of fishes under those waters,
|
|
which varied from intense blue to olive green, according to the bottom.
|
|
The thermometer marked 3@ C. above zero. It was comparatively spring,
|
|
shut up as we were behind this iceberg, whose lengthened mass was dimly
|
|
seen on our northern horizon.
|
|
|
|
"Are we at the pole?" I asked the Captain, with a beating heart.
|
|
|
|
"I do not know," he replied. "At noon I will take our bearings."
|
|
|
|
"But will the sun show himself through this fog?" said I,
|
|
looking at the leaden sky.
|
|
|
|
"However little it shows, it will be enough," replied the Captain.
|
|
|
|
About ten miles south a solitary island rose to a height
|
|
of one hundred and four yards. We made for it, but carefully,
|
|
for the sea might be strewn with banks. One hour afterwards we
|
|
had reached it, two hours later we had made the round of it.
|
|
It measured four or five miles in circumference.
|
|
A narrow canal separated it from a considerable stretch of land,
|
|
perhaps a continent, for we could not see its limits.
|
|
The existence of this land seemed to give some colour to Maury's theory.
|
|
The ingenious American has remarked that, between the South Pole
|
|
and the sixtieth parallel, the sea is covered with floating ice
|
|
of enormous size, which is never met with in the North Atlantic.
|
|
From this fact he has drawn the conclusion that the Antarctic
|
|
Circle encloses considerable continents, as icebergs cannot form
|
|
in open sea, but only on the coasts. According to these calculations,
|
|
the mass of ice surrounding the southern pole forms a vast cap,
|
|
the circumference of which must be, at least, 2,500 miles.
|
|
But the Nautilus, for fear of running aground, had stopped
|
|
about three cable-lengths from a strand over which reared
|
|
a superb heap of rocks. The boat was launched; the Captain,
|
|
two of his men, bearing instruments, Conseil, and myself were in it.
|
|
It was ten in the morning. I had not seen Ned Land.
|
|
Doubtless the Canadian did not wish to admit the presence of
|
|
the South Pole. A few strokes of the oar brought us to the sand,
|
|
where we ran ashore. Conseil was going to jump on to the land,
|
|
when I held him back.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said I to Captain Nemo, "to you belongs the honour of first setting
|
|
foot on this land."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir," said the Captain, "and if I do not hesitate
|
|
to tread this South Pole, it is because, up to this time,
|
|
no human being has left a trace there."
|
|
|
|
Saying this, he jumped lightly on to the sand. His heart beat
|
|
with emotion. He climbed a rock, sloping to a little promontory,
|
|
and there, with his arms crossed, mute and motionless, and with an
|
|
eager look, he seemed to take possession of these southern regions.
|
|
After five minutes passed in this ecstasy, he turned to us.
|
|
|
|
"When you like, sir."
|
|
|
|
I landed, followed by Conseil, leaving the two men in the boat.
|
|
For a long way the soil was composed of a reddish sandy stone,
|
|
something like crushed brick, scoriae, streams of lava,
|
|
and pumice-stones. One could not mistake its volcanic origin.
|
|
In some parts, slight curls of smoke emitted a sulphurous smell,
|
|
proving that the internal fires had lost nothing of their
|
|
expansive powers, though, having climbed a high acclivity,
|
|
I could see no volcano for a radius of several miles.
|
|
We know that in those Antarctic countries, James Ross found
|
|
two craters, the Erebus and Terror, in full activity,
|
|
on the 167th meridian, latitude 77@ 32'. The vegetation
|
|
of this desolate continent seemed to me much restricted.
|
|
Some lichens lay upon the black rocks; some microscopic plants,
|
|
rudimentary diatomas, a kind of cells placed between two quartz shells;
|
|
long purple and scarlet weed, supported on little swimming bladders,
|
|
which the breaking of the waves brought to the shore.
|
|
These constituted the meagre flora of this region.
|
|
The shore was strewn with molluscs, little mussels, and limpets.
|
|
I also saw myriads of northern clios, one-and-a-quarter inches long,
|
|
of which a whale would swallow a whole world at a mouthful;
|
|
and some perfect sea-butterflies, animating the waters on the skirts
|
|
of the shore.
|
|
|
|
There appeared on the high bottoms some coral shrubs,
|
|
of the kind which, according to James Ross, live in
|
|
the Antarctic seas to the depth of more than 1,000 yards.
|
|
Then there were little kingfishers and starfish studding the soil.
|
|
But where life abounded most was in the air. There thousands
|
|
of birds fluttered and flew of all kinds, deafening us with
|
|
their cries; others crowded the rock, looking at us as we passed
|
|
by without fear, and pressing familiarly close by our feet.
|
|
There were penguins, so agile in the water, heavy and awkward
|
|
as they are on the ground; they were uttering harsh cries,
|
|
a large assembly, sober in gesture, but extravagant in clamour.
|
|
Albatrosses passed in the air, the expanse of their wings being
|
|
at least four yards and a half, and justly called the vultures
|
|
of the ocean; some gigantic petrels, and some damiers, a kind
|
|
of small duck, the underpart of whose body is black and white;
|
|
then there were a whole series of petrels, some whitish, with
|
|
brown-bordered wings, others blue, peculiar to the Antarctic seas,
|
|
and so oily, as I told Conseil, that the inhabitants of the Ferroe
|
|
Islands had nothing to do before lighting them but to put
|
|
a wick in.
|
|
|
|
"A little more," said Conseil, "and they would be perfect lamps!
|
|
After that, we cannot expect Nature to have previously furnished
|
|
them with wicks!"
|
|
|
|
About half a mile farther on the soil was riddled with ruffs'
|
|
nests, a sort of laying-ground, out of which many birds were issuing.
|
|
Captain Nemo had some hundreds hunted. They uttered a cry like the braying
|
|
of an ass, were about the size of a goose, slate-colour on the body,
|
|
white beneath, with a yellow line round their throats; they allowed
|
|
themselves to be killed with a stone, never trying to escape.
|
|
But the fog did not lift, and at eleven the sun had not yet shown itself.
|
|
Its absence made me uneasy. Without it no observations were possible.
|
|
How, then, could we decide whether we had reached the pole? When I rejoined
|
|
Captain Nemo, I found him leaning on a piece of rock, silently watching
|
|
the sky. He seemed impatient and vexed. But what was to be done?
|
|
This rash and powerful man could not command the sun as he did the sea.
|
|
Noon arrived without the orb of day showing itself for an instant.
|
|
We could not even tell its position behind the curtain of fog; and soon
|
|
the fog turned to snow.
|
|
|
|
"Till to-morrow," said the Captain, quietly, and we returned
|
|
to the Nautilus amid these atmospheric disturbances.
|
|
|
|
The tempest of snow continued till the next day.
|
|
It was impossible to remain on the platform. From the saloon,
|
|
where I was taking notes of incidents happening during this
|
|
excursion to the polar continent, I could hear the cries of petrels
|
|
and albatrosses sporting in the midst of this violent storm.
|
|
The Nautilus did not remain motionless, but skirted the coast,
|
|
advancing ten miles more to the south in the half-light
|
|
left by the sun as it skirted the edge of the horizon.
|
|
The next day, the 20th of March, the snow had ceased.
|
|
The cold was a little greater, the thermometer showing 2@
|
|
below zero. The fog was rising, and I hoped that that day
|
|
our observations might be taken. Captain Nemo not having
|
|
yet appeared, the boat took Conseil and myself to land.
|
|
The soil was still of the same volcanic nature;
|
|
everywhere were traces of lava, scoriae, and basalt;
|
|
but the crater which had vomited them I could not see.
|
|
Here, as lower down, this continent was alive with myriads
|
|
of birds. But their rule was now divided with large troops
|
|
of sea-mammals, looking at us with their soft eyes.
|
|
There were several kinds of seals, some stretched on the earth,
|
|
some on flakes of ice, many going in and out of the sea. They did
|
|
not flee at our approach, never having had anything to do with man;
|
|
and I reckoned that there were provisions there for hundreds
|
|
of vessels.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said Conseil, "will you tell me the names of these creatures?"
|
|
|
|
"They are seals and morses."
|
|
|
|
It was now eight in the morning. Four hours remained to us before
|
|
the sun could be observed with advantage. I directed our steps
|
|
towards a vast bay cut in the steep granite shore. There, I can aver
|
|
that earth and ice were lost to sight by the numbers of sea-mammals
|
|
covering them, and I involuntarily sought for old Proteus,
|
|
the mythological shepherd who watched these immense flocks of Neptune.
|
|
There were more seals than anything else, forming distinct groups,
|
|
male and female, the father watching over his family, the mother
|
|
suckling her little ones, some already strong enough to go a few steps.
|
|
When they wished to change their place, they took little jumps,
|
|
made by the contraction of their bodies, and helped awkwardly enough
|
|
by their imperfect fin, which, as with the lamantin, their cousins,
|
|
forms a perfect forearm. I should say that, in the water,
|
|
which is their element--the spine of these creatures is flexible;
|
|
with smooth and close skin and webbed feet--they swim admirably.
|
|
In resting on the earth they take the most graceful attitudes.
|
|
Thus the ancients, observing their soft and expressive looks,
|
|
which cannot be surpassed by the most beautiful look a woman can give,
|
|
their clear voluptuous eyes, their charming positions, and the poetry
|
|
of their manners, metamorphosed them, the male into a triton and
|
|
the female into a mermaid. I made Conseil notice the considerable
|
|
development of the lobes of the brain in these interesting cetaceans.
|
|
No mammal, except man, has such a quantity of brain matter;
|
|
they are also capable of receiving a certain amount of education,
|
|
are easily domesticated, and I think, with other naturalists,
|
|
that if properly taught they would be of great service as fishing-dogs.
|
|
The greater part of them slept on the rocks or on the sand.
|
|
Amongst these seals, properly so called, which have no external ears
|
|
(in which they differ from the otter, whose ears are prominent),
|
|
I noticed several varieties of seals about three yards long,
|
|
with a white coat, bulldog heads, armed with teeth in both jaws,
|
|
four incisors at the top and four at the bottom, and two large
|
|
canine teeth in the shape of a fleur-de-lis. Amongst them glided
|
|
sea-elephants, a kind of seal, with short, flexible trunks.
|
|
The giants of this species measured twenty feet round and ten yards
|
|
and a half in length; but they did not move as we approached.
|
|
|
|
"These creatures are not dangerous?" asked Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"No; not unless you attack them. When they have to defend
|
|
their young their rage is terrible, and it is not uncommon
|
|
for them to break the fishing-boats to pieces."
|
|
|
|
"They are quite right," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"I do not say they are not."
|
|
|
|
Two miles farther on we were stopped by the promontory which shelters
|
|
the bay from the southerly winds. Beyond it we heard loud bellowings
|
|
such as a troop of ruminants would produce.
|
|
|
|
"Good!" said Conseil; "a concert of bulls!"
|
|
|
|
"No; a concert of morses."
|
|
|
|
"They are fighting!"
|
|
|
|
"They are either fighting or playing."
|
|
|
|
We now began to climb the blackish rocks, amid unforeseen stumbles,
|
|
and over stones which the ice made slippery. More than once I rolled
|
|
over at the expense of my loins. Conseil, more prudent or more steady,
|
|
did not stumble, and helped me up, saying:
|
|
|
|
"If, sir, you would have the kindness to take wider steps,
|
|
you would preserve your equilibrium better."
|
|
|
|
Arrived at the upper ridge of the promontory, I saw a vast white
|
|
plain covered with morses. They were playing amongst themselves,
|
|
and what we heard were bellowings of pleasure, not of anger.
|
|
|
|
As I passed these curious animals I could examine them leisurely,
|
|
for they did not move. Their skins were thick and rugged,
|
|
of a yellowish tint, approaching to red; their hair was short
|
|
and scant. Some of them were four yards and a quarter long.
|
|
Quieter and less timid than their cousins of the north, they did not,
|
|
like them, place sentinels round the outskirts of their encampment.
|
|
After examining this city of morses, I began to think of returning.
|
|
It was eleven o'clock, and, if Captain Nemo found the conditions
|
|
favourable for observations, I wished to be present at the operation.
|
|
We followed a narrow pathway running along the summit of the steep shore.
|
|
At half-past eleven we had reached the place where we landed.
|
|
The boat had run aground, bringing the Captain. I saw him standing on a block
|
|
of basalt, his instruments near him, his eyes fixed on the northern horizon,
|
|
near which the sun was then describing a lengthened curve. I took my place
|
|
beside him, and waited without speaking. Noon arrived, and, as before,
|
|
the sun did not appear. It was a fatality. Observations were still wanting.
|
|
If not accomplished to-morrow, we must give up all idea of taking any.
|
|
We were indeed exactly at the 20th of March. To-morrow, the 21st,
|
|
would be the equinox; the sun would disappear behind the horizon for
|
|
six months, and with its disappearance the long polar night would begin.
|
|
Since the September equinox it had emerged from the northern horizon,
|
|
rising by lengthened spirals up to the 21st of December. At this period,
|
|
the summer solstice of the northern regions, it had begun to descend;
|
|
and to-morrow was to shed its last rays upon them. I communicated my fears
|
|
and observations to Captain Nemo.
|
|
|
|
"You are right, M. Aronnax," said he; "if to-morrow I cannot take
|
|
the altitude of the sun, I shall not be able to do it for six months.
|
|
But precisely because chance has led me into these seas on the 21st
|
|
of March, my bearings will be easy to take, if at twelve we can
|
|
see the sun."
|
|
|
|
"Why, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"Because then the orb of day described such lengthened curves that it
|
|
is difficult to measure exactly its height above the horizon,
|
|
and grave errors may be made with instruments."
|
|
|
|
"What will you do then?"
|
|
|
|
"I shall only use my chronometer," replied Captain Nemo.
|
|
"If to-morrow, the 21st of March, the disc of the sun,
|
|
allowing for refraction, is exactly cut by the northern horizon,
|
|
it will show that I am at the South Pole."
|
|
|
|
"Just so," said I. "But this statement is not mathematically correct,
|
|
because the equinox does not necessarily begin at noon."
|
|
|
|
"Very likely, sir; but the error will not be a hundred yards
|
|
and we do not want more. Till to-morrow, then!"
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo returned on board. Conseil and I remained to survey
|
|
the shore, observing and studying until five o'clock. Then I
|
|
went to bed, not, however, without invoking, like the Indian,
|
|
the favour of the radiant orb. The next day, the 21st
|
|
of March, at five in the morning, I mounted the platform.
|
|
I found Captain Nemo there.
|
|
|
|
"The weather is lightening a little," said he. "I have some hope.
|
|
After breakfast we will go on shore and choose a post for observation."
|
|
|
|
That point settled, I sought Ned Land. I wanted to take him with me.
|
|
But the obstinate Canadian refused, and I saw that his taciturnity and his
|
|
bad humour grew day by day. After all, I was not sorry for his obstinacy
|
|
under the circumstances. Indeed, there were too many seals on shore,
|
|
and we ought not to lay such temptation in this unreflecting fisherman's way.
|
|
Breakfast over, we went on shore. The Nautilus had gone some miles
|
|
further up in the night. It was a whole league from the coast,
|
|
above which reared a sharp peak about five hundred yards high.
|
|
The boat took with me Captain Nemo, two men of the crew, and the instruments,
|
|
which consisted of a chronometer, a telescope, and a barometer.
|
|
While crossing, I saw numerous whales belonging to the three kinds
|
|
peculiar to the southern seas; the whale, or the English "right whale,"
|
|
which has no dorsal fin; the "humpback," with reeved chest and large,
|
|
whitish fins, which, in spite of its name, do not form wings;
|
|
and the fin-back, of a yellowish brown, the liveliest of all the cetacea.
|
|
This powerful creature is heard a long way off when he throws to a great
|
|
height columns of air and vapour, which look like whirlwinds of smoke.
|
|
These different mammals were disporting themselves in troops in the
|
|
quiet waters; and I could see that this basin of the Antarctic Pole serves
|
|
as a place of refuge to the cetacea too closely tracked by the hunters.
|
|
I also noticed large medusae floating between the reeds.
|
|
|
|
At nine we landed; the sky was brightening, the clouds were flying to
|
|
the south, and the fog seemed to be leaving the cold surface of the waters.
|
|
Captain Nemo went towards the peak, which he doubtless meant
|
|
to be his observatory. It was a painful ascent over the sharp lava
|
|
and the pumice-stones, in an atmosphere often impregnated with a
|
|
sulphurous smell from the smoking cracks. For a man unaccustomed
|
|
to walk on land, the Captain climbed the steep slopes with an
|
|
agility I never saw equalled and which a hunter would have envied.
|
|
We were two hours getting to the summit of this peak, which was half
|
|
porphyry and half basalt. From thence we looked upon a vast sea which,
|
|
towards the north, distinctly traced its boundary line upon the sky.
|
|
At our feet lay fields of dazzling whiteness. Over our heads
|
|
a pale azure, free from fog. To the north the disc of the sun seemed
|
|
like a ball of fire, already horned by the cutting of the horizon.
|
|
From the bosom of the water rose sheaves of liquid jets by hundreds.
|
|
In the distance lay the Nautilus like a cetacean asleep on the water.
|
|
Behind us, to the south and east, an immense country and a chaotic
|
|
heap of rocks and ice, the limits of which were not visible.
|
|
On arriving at the summit Captain Nemo carefully took the mean height
|
|
of the barometer, for he would have to consider that in taking
|
|
his observations. At a quarter to twelve the sun, then seen only
|
|
by refraction, looked like a golden disc shedding its last rays upon
|
|
this deserted continent and seas which never man had yet ploughed.
|
|
Captain Nemo, furnished with a lenticular glass which, by means
|
|
of a mirror, corrected the refraction, watched the orb sinking
|
|
below the horizon by degrees, following a lengthened diagonal.
|
|
I held the chronometer. My heart beat fast. If the disappearance of
|
|
the half-disc of the sun coincided with twelve o'clock on the chronometer,
|
|
we were at the pole itself.
|
|
|
|
"Twelve!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"The South Pole!" replied Captain Nemo, in a grave voice,
|
|
handing me the glass, which showed the orb cut in exactly equal
|
|
parts by the horizon.
|
|
|
|
I looked at the last rays crowning the peak, and the shadows
|
|
mounting by degrees up its slopes. At that moment Captain Nemo,
|
|
resting with his hand on my shoulder, said:
|
|
|
|
"I, Captain Nemo, on this 21st day of March, 1868, have reached the South Pole
|
|
on the ninetieth degree; and I take possession of this part of the globe,
|
|
equal to one-sixth of the known continents."
|
|
|
|
"In whose name, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"In my own, sir!"
|
|
|
|
Saying which, Captain Nemo unfurled a black banner, bearing an "N"
|
|
in gold quartered on its bunting. Then, turning towards the orb of day,
|
|
whose last rays lapped the horizon of the sea, he exclaimed:
|
|
|
|
"Adieu, sun! Disappear, thou radiant orb! rest beneath this open sea,
|
|
and let a night of six months spread its shadows over my new domains!"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XV
|
|
|
|
ACCIDENT OR INCIDENT?
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 22nd of March, at six in the morning,
|
|
preparations for departure were begun. The last gleams
|
|
of twilight were melting into night. The cold was great,
|
|
the constellations shone with wonderful intensity.
|
|
In the zenith glittered that wondrous Southern Cross--
|
|
the polar bear of Antarctic regions. The thermometer showed 120
|
|
below zero, and when the wind freshened it was most biting.
|
|
Flakes of ice increased on the open water. The sea seemed
|
|
everywhere alike. Numerous blackish patches spread on the surface,
|
|
showing the formation of fresh ice. Evidently the southern basin,
|
|
frozen during the six winter months, was absolutely inaccessible.
|
|
What became of the whales in that time? Doubtless they
|
|
went beneath the icebergs, seeking more practicable seas.
|
|
As to the seals and morses, accustomed to live in a hard climate,
|
|
they remained on these icy shores. These creatures have the
|
|
instinct to break holes in the ice-field and to keep them open.
|
|
To these holes they come for breath; when the birds,
|
|
driven away by the cold, have emigrated to the north,
|
|
these sea mammals remain sole masters of the polar continent.
|
|
But the reservoirs were filling with water, and the Nautilus
|
|
was slowly descending. At 1,000 feet deep it stopped;
|
|
its screw beat the waves, and it advanced straight towards
|
|
the north at a speed of fifteen miles an hour. Towards night
|
|
it was already floating under the immense body of the iceberg.
|
|
At three in the morning I was awakened by a violent shock.
|
|
I sat up in my bed and listened in the darkness,
|
|
when I was thrown into the middle of the room.
|
|
The Nautilus, after having struck, had rebounded violently.
|
|
I groped along the partition, and by the staircase to the saloon,
|
|
which was lit by the luminous ceiling. The furniture was upset.
|
|
Fortunately the windows were firmly set, and had held fast.
|
|
The pictures on the starboard side, from being no longer vertical,
|
|
were clinging to the paper, whilst those of the port side
|
|
were hanging at least a foot from the wall. The Nautilus
|
|
was lying on its starboard side perfectly motionless.
|
|
I heard footsteps, and a confusion of voices; but Captain Nemo did
|
|
not appear. As I was leaving the saloon, Ned Land and Conseil
|
|
entered.
|
|
|
|
"What is the matter?" said I, at once.
|
|
|
|
"I came to ask you, sir," replied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Confound it!" exclaimed the Canadian, "I know well enough!
|
|
The Nautilus has struck; and, judging by the way she lies,
|
|
I do not think she will right herself as she did the first time
|
|
in Torres Straits."
|
|
|
|
"But," I asked, "has she at least come to the surface of the sea?"
|
|
|
|
"We do not know," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"It is easy to decide," I answered. I consulted the manometer.
|
|
To my great surprise, it showed a depth of more than 180 fathoms.
|
|
"What does that mean?" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"We must ask Captain Nemo," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"But where shall we find him?" said Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"Follow me," said I, to my companions.
|
|
|
|
We left the saloon. There was no one in the library.
|
|
At the centre staircase, by the berths of the ship's crew, there was
|
|
no one. I thought that Captain Nemo must be in the pilot's cage.
|
|
It was best to wait. We all returned to the saloon. For twenty
|
|
minutes we remained thus, trying to hear the slightest noise which
|
|
might be made on board the Nautilus, when Captain Nemo entered.
|
|
He seemed not to see us; his face, generally so impassive,
|
|
showed signs of uneasiness. He watched the compass silently,
|
|
then the manometer; and, going to the planisphere,
|
|
placed his finger on a spot representing the southern seas.
|
|
I would not interrupt him; but, some minutes later, when he
|
|
turned towards me, I said, using one of his own expressions
|
|
in the Torres Straits:
|
|
|
|
"An incident, Captain?"
|
|
|
|
"No, sir; an accident this time."
|
|
|
|
"Serious?"
|
|
|
|
"Perhaps."
|
|
|
|
"Is the danger immediate?"
|
|
|
|
"No."
|
|
|
|
"The Nautilus has stranded?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes."
|
|
|
|
"And this has happened--how?"
|
|
|
|
"From a caprice of nature, not from the ignorance of man.
|
|
Not a mistake has been made in the working. But we cannot prevent
|
|
equilibrium from producing its effects. We may brave human laws,
|
|
but we cannot resist natural ones."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo had chosen a strange moment for uttering this
|
|
philosophical reflection. On the whole, his answer helped me little.
|
|
|
|
"May I ask, sir, the cause of this accident?"
|
|
|
|
"An enormous block of ice, a whole mountain, has turned over," he replied.
|
|
"When icebergs are undermined at their base by warmer water or reiterated
|
|
shocks their centre of gravity rises, and the whole thing turns over.
|
|
This is what has happened; one of these blocks, as it fell,
|
|
struck the Nautilus, then, gliding under its hull, raised it with
|
|
irresistible force, bringing it into beds which are not so thick,
|
|
where it is lying on its side."
|
|
|
|
"But can we not get the Nautilus off by emptying its reservoirs,
|
|
that it might regain its equilibrium?"
|
|
|
|
"That, sir, is being done at this moment. You can hear the pump working.
|
|
Look at the needle of the manometer; it shows that the Nautilus is rising,
|
|
but the block of ice is floating with it; and, until some obstacle stops its
|
|
ascending motion, our position cannot be altered."
|
|
|
|
Indeed, the Nautilus still held the same position to starboard;
|
|
doubtless it would right itself when the block stopped.
|
|
But at this moment who knows if we may not be frightfully
|
|
crushed between the two glassy surfaces? I reflected on all
|
|
the consequences of our position. Captain Nemo never took
|
|
his eyes off the manometer. Since the fall of the iceberg,
|
|
the Nautilus had risen about a hundred and fifty feet,
|
|
but it still made the same angle with the perpendicular.
|
|
Suddenly a slight movement was felt in the hold.
|
|
Evidently it was righting a little. Things hanging in
|
|
the saloon were sensibly returning to their normal position.
|
|
The partitions were nearing the upright. No one spoke.
|
|
With beating hearts we watched and felt the straightening.
|
|
The boards became horizontal under our feet.
|
|
Ten minutes passed.
|
|
|
|
"At last we have righted!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," said Captain Nemo, going to the door of the saloon.
|
|
|
|
"But are we floating?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"Certainly," he replied; "since the reservoirs are not empty; and, when empty,
|
|
the Nautilus must rise to the surface of the sea."
|
|
|
|
We were in open sea; but at a distance of about ten yards,
|
|
on either side of the Nautilus, rose a dazzling wall of ice.
|
|
Above and beneath the same wall. Above, because the lower surface
|
|
of the iceberg stretched over us like an immense ceiling.
|
|
Beneath, because the overturned block, having slid by degrees, had found
|
|
a resting-place on the lateral walls, which kept it in that position.
|
|
The Nautilus was really imprisoned in a perfect tunnel of ice
|
|
more than twenty yards in breadth, filled with quiet water.
|
|
It was easy to get out of it by going either forward or backward,
|
|
and then make a free passage under the iceberg, some hundreds
|
|
of yards deeper. The luminous ceiling had been extinguished,
|
|
but the saloon was still resplendent with intense light.
|
|
It was the powerful reflection from the glass partition sent violently
|
|
back to the sheets of the lantern. I cannot describe the effect
|
|
of the voltaic rays upon the great blocks so capriciously cut;
|
|
upon every angle, every ridge, every facet was thrown a different light,
|
|
according to the nature of the veins running through the ice;
|
|
a dazzling mine of gems, particularly of sapphires, their blue rays
|
|
crossing with the green of the emerald. Here and there were opal
|
|
shades of wonderful softness, running through bright spots like
|
|
diamonds of fire, the brilliancy of which the eye could not bear.
|
|
The power of the lantern seemed increased a hundredfold, like a lamp
|
|
through the lenticular plates of a first-class lighthouse.
|
|
|
|
"How beautiful! how beautiful!" cried Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," I said, "it is a wonderful sight. Is it not, Ned?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, confound it! Yes," answered Ned Land, "it is superb!
|
|
I am mad at being obliged to admit it. No one has ever seen anything
|
|
like it; but the sight may cost us dear. And, if I must say all,
|
|
I think we are seeing here things which God never intended
|
|
man to see."
|
|
|
|
Ned was right, it was too beautiful. Suddenly a cry from Conseil
|
|
made me turn.
|
|
|
|
"What is it?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"Shut your eyes, sir! Do not look, sir!" Saying which,
|
|
Conseil clapped his hands over his eyes.
|
|
|
|
"But what is the matter, my boy?"
|
|
|
|
"I am dazzled, blinded."
|
|
|
|
My eyes turned involuntarily towards the glass, but I could not stand
|
|
the fire which seemed to devour them. I understood what had happened.
|
|
The Nautilus had put on full speed. All the quiet lustre of the ice-walls
|
|
was at once changed into flashes of lightning. The fire from these myriads
|
|
of diamonds was blinding. It required some time to calm our troubled looks.
|
|
At last the hands were taken down.
|
|
|
|
"Faith, I should never have believed it," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
It was then five in the morning; and at that moment a shock was
|
|
felt at the bows of the Nautilus. I knew that its spur had struck
|
|
a block of ice. It must have been a false manoeuvre, for this
|
|
submarine tunnel, obstructed by blocks, was not very easy navigation.
|
|
I thought that Captain Nemo, by changing his course, would either
|
|
turn these obstacles or else follow the windings of the tunnel.
|
|
In any case, the road before us could not be entirely blocked.
|
|
But, contrary to my expectations, the Nautilus took a decided
|
|
retrograde motion.
|
|
|
|
"We are going backwards?" said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," I replied. "This end of the tunnel can have no egress."
|
|
|
|
"And then?"
|
|
|
|
"Then," said I, "the working is easy. We must go back again,
|
|
and go out at the southern opening. That is all."
|
|
|
|
In speaking thus, I wished to appear more confident than I really was.
|
|
But the retrograde motion of the Nautilus was increasing; and, reversing
|
|
the screw, it carried us at great speed.
|
|
|
|
"It will be a hindrance," said Ned.
|
|
|
|
"What does it matter, some hours more or less, provided we get
|
|
out at last?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes," repeated Ned Land, "provided we do get out at last!"
|
|
|
|
For a short time I walked from the saloon to the library.
|
|
My companions were silent. I soon threw myself on an ottoman,
|
|
and took a book, which my eyes overran mechanically. A quarter
|
|
of an hour after, Conseil, approaching me, said, "Is what you are
|
|
reading very interesting, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"Very interesting!" I replied.
|
|
|
|
"I should think so, sir. It is your own book you are reading."
|
|
|
|
"My book?"
|
|
|
|
And indeed I was holding in my hand the work on the Great Submarine Depths.
|
|
I did not even dream of it. I closed the book and returned to my walk.
|
|
Ned and Conseil rose to go.
|
|
|
|
"Stay here, my friends," said I, detaining them.
|
|
"Let us remain together until we are out of this block."
|
|
|
|
"As you please, sir," Conseil replied.
|
|
|
|
Some hours passed. I often looked at the instruments hanging
|
|
from the partition. The manometer showed that the Nautilus kept
|
|
at a constant depth of more than three hundred yards; the compass
|
|
still pointed to south; the log indicated a speed of twenty
|
|
miles an hour, which, in such a cramped space, was very great.
|
|
But Captain Nemo knew that he could not hasten too much,
|
|
and that minutes were worth ages to us. At twenty-five minutes
|
|
past eight a second shock took place, this time from behind.
|
|
I turned pale. My companions were close by my side.
|
|
I seized Conseil's hand. Our looks expressed our feelings better
|
|
than words. At this moment the Captain entered the saloon.
|
|
I went up to him.
|
|
|
|
"Our course is barred southward?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir. The iceberg has shifted and closed every outlet."
|
|
|
|
"We are blocked up then?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes."
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XVI
|
|
|
|
WANT OF AIR
|
|
|
|
Thus around the Nautilus, above and below, was an impenetrable wall
|
|
of ice. We were prisoners to the iceberg. I watched the Captain.
|
|
His countenance had resumed its habitual imperturbability.
|
|
|
|
"Gentlemen," he said calmly, "there are two ways of dying in
|
|
the circumstances in which we are placed." (This puzzling person
|
|
had the air of a mathematical professor lecturing to his pupils.)
|
|
"The first is to be crushed; the second is to die of suffocation.
|
|
I do not speak of the possibility of dying of hunger, for the supply
|
|
of provisions in the Nautilus will certainly last longer than we shall.
|
|
Let us, then, calculate our chances."
|
|
|
|
"As to suffocation, Captain," I replied, "that is not to be feared,
|
|
because our reservoirs are full."
|
|
|
|
"Just so; but they will only yield two days' supply of air.
|
|
Now, for thirty-six hours we have been hidden under the water,
|
|
and already the heavy atmosphere of the Nautilus requires renewal.
|
|
In forty-eight hours our reserve will be exhausted."
|
|
|
|
"Well, Captain, can we be delivered before forty-eight hours?"
|
|
|
|
"We will attempt it, at least, by piercing the wall that surrounds us."
|
|
|
|
"On which side?"
|
|
|
|
"Sound will tell us. I am going to run the Nautilus aground
|
|
on the lower bank, and my men will attack the iceberg on the side
|
|
that is least thick."
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo went out. Soon I discovered by a hissing noise
|
|
that the water was entering the reservoirs. The Nautilus
|
|
sank slowly, and rested on the ice at a depth of 350 yards,
|
|
the depth at which the lower bank was immersed.
|
|
|
|
"My friends," I said, "our situation is serious, but I rely
|
|
on your courage and energy."
|
|
|
|
"Sir," replied the Canadian, "I am ready to do anything
|
|
for the general safety."
|
|
|
|
"Good! Ned," and I held out my hand to the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"I will add," he continued, "that, being as handy with the pickaxe
|
|
as with the harpoon, if I can be useful to the Captain, he can
|
|
command my services."
|
|
|
|
"He will not refuse your help. Come, Ned!"
|
|
|
|
I led him to the room where the crew of the Nautilus
|
|
were putting on their cork-jackets. I told the Captain
|
|
of Ned's proposal, which he accepted. The Canadian put on
|
|
his sea-costume, and was ready as soon as his companions.
|
|
When Ned was dressed, I re-entered the drawing-room, where
|
|
the panes of glass were open, and, posted near Conseil,
|
|
I examined the ambient beds that supported the Nautilus.
|
|
Some instants after, we saw a dozen of the crew set foot on the bank
|
|
of ice, and among them Ned Land, easily known by his stature.
|
|
Captain Nemo was with them. Before proceeding to dig the walls,
|
|
he took the soundings, to be sure of working in the right direction.
|
|
Long sounding lines were sunk in the side walls, but after
|
|
fifteen yards they were again stopped by the thick wall.
|
|
It was useless to attack it on the ceiling-like surface,
|
|
since the iceberg itself measured more than 400 yards in height.
|
|
Captain Nemo then sounded the lower surface. There ten yards
|
|
of wall separated us from the water, so great was the thickness
|
|
of the ice-field. It was necessary, therefore, to cut from it
|
|
a piece equal in extent to the waterline of the Nautilus.
|
|
There were about 6,000 cubic yards to detach, so as to dig
|
|
a hole by which we could descend to the ice-field. The work
|
|
had begun immediately and carried on with indefatigable energy.
|
|
Instead of digging round the Nautilus which would have involved
|
|
greater difficulty, Captain Nemo had an immense trench made at eight
|
|
yards from the port-quarter. Then the men set to work simultaneously
|
|
with their screws on several points of its circumference.
|
|
Presently the pickaxe attacked this compact matter vigorously,
|
|
and large blocks were detached from the mass. By a curious
|
|
effect of specific gravity, these blocks, lighter than water,
|
|
fled, so to speak, to the vault of the tunnel, that increased
|
|
in thickness at the top in proportion as it diminished at the base.
|
|
But that mattered little, so long as the lower part grew thinner.
|
|
After two hours' hard work, Ned Land came in exhausted. He and his
|
|
comrades were replaced by new workers, whom Conseil and I joined.
|
|
The second lieutenant of the Nautilus superintended us.
|
|
The water seemed singularly cold, but I soon got warm
|
|
handling the pickaxe. My movements were free enough,
|
|
although they were made under a pressure of thirty atmospheres.
|
|
When I re-entered, after working two hours, to take some food
|
|
and rest, I found a perceptible difference between the pure
|
|
fluid with which the Rouquayrol engine supplied me and the
|
|
atmosphere of the Nautilus, already charged with carbonic acid.
|
|
The air had not been renewed for forty-eight hours, and its vivifying
|
|
qualities were considerably enfeebled. However, after a lapse
|
|
of twelve hours, we had only raised a block of ice one yard thick,
|
|
on the marked surface, which was about 600 cubic yards!
|
|
Reckoning that it took twelve hours to accomplish this much it
|
|
would take five nights and four days to bring this enterprise
|
|
to a satisfactory conclusion. Five nights and four days!
|
|
And we have only air enough for two days in the reservoirs!
|
|
"Without taking into account," said Ned, "that, even if we get out
|
|
of this infernal prison, we shall also be imprisoned under the iceberg,
|
|
shut out from all possible communication with the atmosphere."
|
|
True enough! Who could then foresee the minimum of time
|
|
necessary for our deliverance? We might be suffocated before
|
|
the Nautilus could regain the surface of the waves? Was it
|
|
destined to perish in this ice-tomb, with all those it enclosed?
|
|
The situation was terrible. But everyone had looked the danger
|
|
in the face, and each was determined to do his duty to the
|
|
last.
|
|
|
|
As I expected, during the night a new block a yard square
|
|
was carried away, and still further sank the immense hollow.
|
|
But in the morning when, dressed in my cork-jacket, I traversed
|
|
the slushy mass at a temperature of six or seven degrees below zero,
|
|
I remarked that the side walls were gradually closing in.
|
|
The beds of water farthest from the trench, that were not warmed
|
|
by the men's work, showed a tendency to solidification. In presence
|
|
of this new and imminent danger, what would become of our chances
|
|
of safety, and how hinder the solidification of this liquid medium,
|
|
that would burst the partitions of the Nautilus like glass?
|
|
|
|
I did not tell my companions of this new danger.
|
|
What was the good of damping the energy they displayed in
|
|
the painful work of escape? But when I went on board again,
|
|
I told Captain Nemo of this grave complication.
|
|
|
|
"I know it," he said, in that calm tone which could counteract
|
|
the most terrible apprehensions. "It is one danger more;
|
|
but I see no way of escaping it; the only chance of safety is to go
|
|
quicker than solidification. We must be beforehand with it,
|
|
that is all."
|
|
|
|
On this day for several hours I used my pickaxe vigorously.
|
|
The work kept me up. Besides, to work was to quit the Nautilus,
|
|
and breathe directly the pure air drawn from the reservoirs,
|
|
and supplied by our apparatus, and to quit the impoverished and
|
|
vitiated atmosphere. Towards evening the trench was dug one yard deeper.
|
|
When I returned on board, I was nearly suffocated by the carbonic
|
|
acid with which the air was filled--ah! if we had only the chemical
|
|
means to drive away this deleterious gas. We had plenty of oxygen;
|
|
all this water contained a considerable quantity, and by dissolving
|
|
it with our powerful piles, it would restore the vivifying fluid.
|
|
I had thought well over it; but of what good was that,
|
|
since the carbonic acid produced by our respiration had invaded
|
|
every part of the vessel? To absorb it, it was necessary to fill
|
|
some jars with caustic potash, and to shake them incessantly.
|
|
Now this substance was wanting on board, and nothing could replace it.
|
|
On that evening, Captain Nemo ought to open the taps of his reservoirs,
|
|
and let some pure air into the interior of the Nautilus; without this
|
|
precaution we could not get rid of the sense of suffocation. The next day,
|
|
March 26th, I resumed my miner's work in beginning the fifth yard.
|
|
The side walls and the lower surface of the iceberg thickened visibly.
|
|
It was evident that they would meet before the Nautilus was
|
|
able to disengage itself. Despair seized me for an instant;
|
|
my pickaxe nearly fell from my hands. What was the good of digging
|
|
if I must be suffocated, crushed by the water that was turning
|
|
into stone?--a punishment that the ferocity of the savages even
|
|
would not have invented! Just then Captain Nemo passed near me.
|
|
I touched his hand and showed him the walls of our prison.
|
|
The wall to port had advanced to at least four yards from the hull of
|
|
the Nautilus. The Captain understood me, and signed me to follow him.
|
|
We went on board. I took off my cork-jacket and accompanied him into the
|
|
drawing-room.
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax, we must attempt some desperate means, or we shall
|
|
be sealed up in this solidified water as in cement."
|
|
|
|
"Yes; but what is to be done?"
|
|
|
|
"Ah! if my Nautilus were strong enough to bear this pressure
|
|
without being crushed!"
|
|
|
|
"Well?" I asked, not catching the Captain's idea.
|
|
|
|
"Do you not understand," he replied, "that this congelation of water
|
|
will help us? Do you not see that by its solidification, it would
|
|
burst through this field of ice that imprisons us, as, when it freezes,
|
|
it bursts the hardest stones? Do you not perceive that it would be
|
|
an agent of safety instead of destruction?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Captain, perhaps. But, whatever resistance to crushing
|
|
the Nautilus possesses, it could not support this terrible pressure,
|
|
and would be flattened like an iron plate."
|
|
|
|
"I know it, sir. Therefore we must not reckon on the aid of nature,
|
|
but on our own exertions. We must stop this solidification.
|
|
Not only will the side walls be pressed together; but there
|
|
is not ten feet of water before or behind the Nautilus.
|
|
The congelation gains on us on all sides."
|
|
|
|
"How long will the air in the reservoirs last for us to breathe on board?"
|
|
|
|
The Captain looked in my face. "After to-morrow they will be empty!"
|
|
|
|
A cold sweat came over me. However, ought I to have been astonished
|
|
at the answer? On March 22, the Nautilus was in the open polar seas.
|
|
We were at 26@. For five days we had lived on the reserve on board.
|
|
And what was left of the respirable air must be kept for the workers.
|
|
Even now, as I write, my recollection is still so vivid that an
|
|
involuntary terror seizes me and my lungs seem to be without air.
|
|
Meanwhile, Captain Nemo reflected silently, and evidently an idea
|
|
had struck him; but he seemed to reject it. At last, these words
|
|
escaped his lips:
|
|
|
|
"Boiling water!" he muttered.
|
|
|
|
"Boiling water?" I cried.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir. We are enclosed in a space that is relatively confined.
|
|
Would not jets of boiling water, constantly injected by the pumps,
|
|
raise the temperature in this part and stay the congelation?"
|
|
|
|
"Let us try it," I said resolutely.
|
|
|
|
"Let us try it, Professor."
|
|
|
|
The thermometer then stood at 7@ outside. Captain Nemo took
|
|
me to the galleys, where the vast distillatory machines
|
|
stood that furnished the drinkable water by evaporation.
|
|
They filled these with water, and all the electric heat from
|
|
the piles was thrown through the worms bathed in the liquid.
|
|
In a few minutes this water reached 100@. It was directed
|
|
towards the pumps, while fresh water replaced it in proportion.
|
|
The heat developed by the troughs was such that cold water,
|
|
drawn up from the sea after only having gone through the machines,
|
|
came boiling into the body of the pump. The injection was begun,
|
|
and three hours after the thermometer marked 6@ below zero outside.
|
|
One degree was gained. Two hours later the thermometer only marked
|
|
4@.
|
|
|
|
"We shall succeed," I said to the Captain, after having anxiously
|
|
watched the result of the operation.
|
|
|
|
"I think," he answered, "that we shall not be crushed.
|
|
We have no more suffocation to fear."
|
|
|
|
During the night the temperature of the water rose to 1@ below zero.
|
|
The injections could not carry it to a higher point. But, as the congelation
|
|
of the sea-water produces at least 2@, I was at least reassured against
|
|
the dangers of solidification.
|
|
|
|
The next day, March 27th, six yards of ice had been cleared, twelve feet
|
|
only remaining to be cleared away. There was yet forty-eight hours' work.
|
|
The air could not be renewed in the interior of the Nautilus.
|
|
And this day would make it worse. An intolerable weight oppressed me.
|
|
Towards three o'clock in the evening this feeling rose to a violent degree.
|
|
Yawns dislocated my jaws. My lungs panted as they inhaled this burning fluid,
|
|
which became rarefied more and more. A moral torpor took hold of me.
|
|
I was powerless, almost unconscious. My brave Conseil, though exhibiting
|
|
the same symptoms and suffering in the same manner, never left me.
|
|
He took my hand and encouraged me, and I heard him murmur, "Oh! if I could
|
|
only not breathe, so as to leave more air for my master!"
|
|
|
|
Tears came into my eyes on hearing him speak thus. If our
|
|
situation to all was intolerable in the interior, with what haste
|
|
and gladness would we put on our cork-jackets to work in our turn!
|
|
Pickaxes sounded on the frozen ice-beds. Our arms ached,
|
|
the skin was torn off our hands. But what were these fatigues,
|
|
what did the wounds matter? Vital air came to the lungs!
|
|
We breathed! we breathed!
|
|
|
|
All this time no one prolonged his voluntary task beyond the prescribed time.
|
|
His task accomplished, each one handed in turn to his panting companions
|
|
the apparatus that supplied him with life. Captain Nemo set the example,
|
|
and submitted first to this severe discipline. When the time came,
|
|
he gave up his apparatus to another and returned to the vitiated air
|
|
on board, calm, unflinching, unmurmuring.
|
|
|
|
On that day the ordinary work was accomplished with unusual vigour.
|
|
Only two yards remained to be raised from the surface.
|
|
Two yards only separated us from the open sea. But the reservoirs
|
|
were nearly emptied of air. The little that remained ought
|
|
to be kept for the workers; not a particle for the Nautilus.
|
|
When I went back on board, I was half suffocated. What a night!
|
|
I know not how to describe it. The next day my breathing
|
|
was oppressed. Dizziness accompanied the pain in my head and made
|
|
me like a drunken man. My companions showed the same symptoms.
|
|
Some of the crew had rattling in the throat.
|
|
|
|
On that day, the sixth of our imprisonment, Captain Nemo,
|
|
finding the pickaxes work too slowly, resolved to crush
|
|
the ice-bed that still separated us from the liquid sheet.
|
|
This man's coolness and energy never forsook him. He subdued his
|
|
physical pains by moral force.
|
|
|
|
By his orders the vessel was lightened, that is to say,
|
|
raised from the ice-bed by a change of specific gravity.
|
|
When it floated they towed it so as to bring it above
|
|
the immense trench made on the level of the water-line. Then,
|
|
filling his reservoirs of water, he descended and shut himself up
|
|
in the hole.
|
|
|
|
Just then all the crew came on board, and the double door of communication
|
|
was shut. The Nautilus then rested on the bed of ice, which was not one
|
|
yard thick, and which the sounding leads had perforated in a thousand places.
|
|
The taps of the reservoirs were then opened, and a hundred cubic yards
|
|
of water was let in, increasing the weight of the Nautilus to 1,800 tons.
|
|
We waited, we listened, forgetting our sufferings in hope. Our safety
|
|
depended on this last chance. Notwithstanding the buzzing in my head,
|
|
I soon heard the humming sound under the hull of the Nautilus. The ice
|
|
cracked with a singular noise, like tearing paper, and the Nautilus sank.
|
|
|
|
"We are off!" murmured Conseil in my ear.
|
|
|
|
I could not answer him. I seized his hand, and pressed it convulsively.
|
|
All at once, carried away by its frightful overcharge, the Nautilus sank like
|
|
a bullet under the waters, that is to say, it fell as if it was in a vacuum.
|
|
Then all the electric force was put on the pumps, that soon began to let
|
|
the water out of the reservoirs. After some minutes, our fall was stopped.
|
|
Soon, too, the manometer indicated an ascending movement. The screw,
|
|
going at full speed, made the iron hull tremble to its very bolts and drew
|
|
us towards the north. But if this floating under the iceberg is to last
|
|
another day before we reach the open sea, I shall be dead first.
|
|
|
|
Half stretched upon a divan in the library, I was suffocating.
|
|
My face was purple, my lips blue, my faculties suspended.
|
|
I neither saw nor heard. All notion of time had gone from my mind.
|
|
My muscles could not contract. I do not know how many hours
|
|
passed thus, but I was conscious of the agony that was coming over me.
|
|
I felt as if I was going to die. Suddenly I came to.
|
|
Some breaths of air penetrated my lungs. Had we risen to the surface
|
|
of the waves? Were we free of the iceberg? No! Ned and Conseil,
|
|
my two brave friends, were sacrificing themselves to save me.
|
|
Some particles of air still remained at the bottom of one apparatus.
|
|
Instead of using it, they had kept it for me, and, while they
|
|
were being suffocated, they gave me life, drop by drop.
|
|
I wanted to push back the thing; they held my hands,
|
|
and for some moments I breathed freely. I looked at the clock;
|
|
it was eleven in the morning. It ought to be the 28th of March.
|
|
The Nautilus went at a frightful pace, forty miles an hour. It literally
|
|
tore through the water. Where was Captain Nemo? Had he succumbed?
|
|
Were his companions dead with him? At the moment the manometer
|
|
indicated that we were not more than twenty feet from the surface.
|
|
A mere plate of ice separated us from the atmosphere. Could we not
|
|
break it? Perhaps. In any case the Nautilus was going to attempt it.
|
|
I felt that it was in an oblique position, lowering the stern,
|
|
and raising the bows. The introduction of water had been the means
|
|
of disturbing its equilibrium. Then, impelled by its powerful screw,
|
|
it attacked the ice-field from beneath like a formidable battering-ram.
|
|
It broke it by backing and then rushing forward against the field,
|
|
which gradually gave way; and at last, dashing suddenly against it,
|
|
shot forwards on the ice-field, that crushed beneath its weight.
|
|
The panel was opened--one might say torn off--and the pure air came in in
|
|
abundance to all parts of the Nautilus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XVII
|
|
|
|
FROM CAPE HORN TO THE AMAZON
|
|
|
|
How I got on to the platform, I have no idea; perhaps the Canadian
|
|
had carried me there. But I breathed, I inhaled the vivifying sea-air.
|
|
My two companions were getting drunk with the fresh particles.
|
|
The other unhappy men had been so long without food, that they
|
|
could not with impunity indulge in the simplest aliments that were
|
|
given them. We, on the contrary, had no end to restrain ourselves;
|
|
we could draw this air freely into our lungs, and it was the breeze,
|
|
the breeze alone, that filled us with this keen enjoyment.
|
|
|
|
"Ah!" said Conseil, "how delightful this oxygen is!
|
|
Master need not fear to breathe it. There is enough for everybody."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land did not speak, but he opened his jaws wide enough
|
|
to frighten a shark. Our strength soon returned, and, when I
|
|
looked round me, I saw we were alone on the platform.
|
|
The foreign seamen in the Nautilus were contented with the air
|
|
that circulated in the interior; none of them had come to drink
|
|
in the open air.
|
|
|
|
The first words I spoke were words of gratitude and
|
|
thankfulness to my two companions. Ned and Conseil had
|
|
prolonged my life during the last hours of this long agony.
|
|
All my gratitude could not repay such devotion.
|
|
|
|
"My friends," said I, "we are bound one to the other for ever,
|
|
and I am under infinite obligations to you."
|
|
|
|
"Which I shall take advantage of," exclaimed the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"What do you mean?" said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"I mean that I shall take you with me when I leave this infernal Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"Well," said Conseil, "after all this, are we going right?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes," I replied, "for we are going the way of the sun,
|
|
and here the sun is in the north."
|
|
|
|
"No doubt," said Ned Land; "but it remains to be seen whether
|
|
he will bring the ship into the Pacific or the Atlantic Ocean,
|
|
that is, into frequented or deserted seas."
|
|
|
|
I could not answer that question, and I feared that Captain Nemo
|
|
would rather take us to the vast ocean that touches the coasts
|
|
of Asia and America at the same time. He would thus complete
|
|
the tour round the submarine world, and return to those waters
|
|
in which the Nautilus could sail freely. We ought, before long,
|
|
to settle this important point. The Nautilus went at a rapid pace.
|
|
The polar circle was soon passed, and the course shaped for Cape Horn.
|
|
We were off the American point, March 31st, at seven o'clock
|
|
in the evening. Then all our past sufferings were forgotten.
|
|
The remembrance of that imprisonment in the ice was effaced
|
|
from our minds. We only thought of the future. Captain Nemo did
|
|
not appear again either in the drawing-room or on the platform.
|
|
The point shown each day on the planisphere, and, marked by
|
|
the lieutenant, showed me the exact direction of the Nautilus.
|
|
Now, on that evening, it was evident, to, my great satisfaction,
|
|
that we were going back to the North by the Atlantic.
|
|
The next day, April 1st, when the Nautilus ascended to the surface
|
|
some minutes before noon, we sighted land to the west.
|
|
It was Terra del Fuego, which the first navigators named thus from
|
|
seeing the quantity of smoke that rose from the natives' huts.
|
|
The coast seemed low to me, but in the distance rose high mountains.
|
|
I even thought I had a glimpse of Mount Sarmiento, that rises 2,070
|
|
yards above the level of the sea, with a very pointed summit, which,
|
|
according as it is misty or clear, is a sign of fine or of wet weather.
|
|
At this moment the peak was clearly defined against the sky.
|
|
The Nautilus, diving again under the water, approached the coast,
|
|
which was only some few miles off. From the glass windows in
|
|
the drawing-room, I saw long seaweeds and gigantic fuci and varech,
|
|
of which the open polar sea contains so many specimens, with their
|
|
sharp polished filaments; they measured about 300 yards in length--
|
|
real cables, thicker than one's thumb; and, having great tenacity,
|
|
they are often used as ropes for vessels. Another weed known as velp,
|
|
with leaves four feet long, buried in the coral concretions,
|
|
hung at the bottom. It served as nest and food for myriads
|
|
of crustacea and molluscs, crabs, and cuttlefish.
|
|
There seals and otters had splendid repasts, eating the flesh
|
|
of fish with sea-vegetables, according to the English fashion.
|
|
Over this fertile and luxuriant ground the Nautilus passed with
|
|
great rapidity. Towards evening it approached the Falkland group,
|
|
the rough summits of which I recognised the following day.
|
|
The depth of the sea was moderate. On the shores our nets brought
|
|
in beautiful specimens of sea weed, and particularly a certain fucus,
|
|
the roots of which were filled with the best mussels in the world.
|
|
Geese and ducks fell by dozens on the platform, and soon took
|
|
their places in the pantry on board.
|
|
|
|
When the last heights of the Falklands had disappeared
|
|
from the horizon, the Nautilus sank to between twenty
|
|
and twenty-five yards, and followed the American coast.
|
|
Captain Nemo did not show himself. Until the 3rd of April we
|
|
did not quit the shores of Patagonia, sometimes under the ocean,
|
|
sometimes at the surface. The Nautilus passed beyond the large
|
|
estuary formed by the Uraguay. Its direction was northwards,
|
|
and followed the long windings of the coast of South America.
|
|
We had then made 1,600 miles since our embarkation in the seas
|
|
of Japan. About eleven o'clock in the morning the Tropic
|
|
of Capricorn was crossed on the thirty-seventh meridian,
|
|
and we passed Cape Frio standing out to sea. Captain Nemo,
|
|
to Ned Land's great displeasure, did not like the neighbourhood
|
|
of the inhabited coasts of Brazil, for we went at a giddy speed.
|
|
Not a fish, not a bird of the swiftest kind could follow us,
|
|
and the natural curiosities of these seas escaped all observation.
|
|
|
|
This speed was kept up for several days, and in the evening
|
|
of the 9th of April we sighted the most westerly point of South
|
|
America that forms Cape San Roque. But then the Nautilus
|
|
swerved again, and sought the lowest depth of a submarine valley
|
|
which is between this Cape and Sierra Leone on the African coast.
|
|
This valley bifurcates to the parallel of the Antilles,
|
|
and terminates at the mouth by the enormous depression of 9,000 yards.
|
|
In this place, the geological basin of the ocean forms,
|
|
as far as the Lesser Antilles, a cliff to three and a half
|
|
miles perpendicular in height, and, at the parallel of
|
|
the Cape Verde Islands, an other wall not less considerable,
|
|
that encloses thus all the sunk continent of the Atlantic.
|
|
The bottom of this immense valley is dotted with some mountains,
|
|
that give to these submarine places a picturesque aspect.
|
|
I speak, moreover, from the manuscript charts that were in the library
|
|
of the Nautilus--charts evidently due to Captain Nemo's hand,
|
|
and made after his personal observations. For two days the desert
|
|
and deep waters were visited by means of the inclined planes.
|
|
The Nautilus was furnished with long diagonal broadsides which carried
|
|
it to all elevations. But on the 11th of April it rose suddenly,
|
|
and land appeared at the mouth of the Amazon River, a vast estuary,
|
|
the embouchure of which is so considerable that it freshens
|
|
the sea-water for the distance of several leagues. {8 paragraphs
|
|
are deleted from this edition}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XVIII
|
|
|
|
THE POULPS
|
|
|
|
For several days the Nautilus kept off from the American coast.
|
|
Evidently it did not wish to risk the tides of the Gulf of
|
|
Mexico or of the sea of the Antilles. April 16th, we sighted
|
|
Martinique and Guadaloupe from a distance of about thirty miles.
|
|
I saw their tall peaks for an instant. The Canadian,
|
|
who counted on carrying out his projects in the Gulf,
|
|
by either landing or hailing one of the numerous boats that
|
|
coast from one island to another, was quite disheartened.
|
|
Flight would have been quite practicable, if Ned Land had been able
|
|
to take possession of the boat without the Captain's knowledge.
|
|
But in the open sea it could not be thought of. The Canadian,
|
|
Conseil, and I had a long conversation on this subject.
|
|
For six months we had been prisoners on board the Nautilus.
|
|
We had travelled 17,000 leagues; and, as Ned Land said, there was
|
|
no reason why it should come to an end. We could hope nothing
|
|
from the Captain of the Nautilus, but only from ourselves.
|
|
Besides, for some time past he had become graver, more retired,
|
|
less sociable. He seemed to shun me. I met him rarely.
|
|
Formerly he was pleased to explain the submarine marvels to me;
|
|
now he left me to my studies, and came no more to the saloon.
|
|
What change had come over him? For what cause? For my part,
|
|
I did not wish to bury with me my curious and novel studies.
|
|
I had now the power to write the true book of the sea;
|
|
and this book, sooner or later, I wished to see daylight.
|
|
The land nearest us was the archipelago of the Bahamas. There rose
|
|
high submarine cliffs covered with large weeds. It was about eleven
|
|
o'clock when Ned Land drew my attention to a formidable pricking,
|
|
like the sting of an ant, which was produced by means of large
|
|
seaweeds.
|
|
|
|
"Well," I said, "these are proper caverns for poulps, and I
|
|
should not be astonished to see some of these monsters."
|
|
|
|
"What!" said Conseil; "cuttlefish, real cuttlefish of the cephalopod class?"
|
|
|
|
"No," I said, "poulps of huge dimensions."
|
|
|
|
"I will never believe that such animals exist," said Ned.
|
|
|
|
"Well," said Conseil, with the most serious air in the world,
|
|
"I remember perfectly to have seen a large vessel drawn under
|
|
the waves by an octopus's arm."
|
|
|
|
"You saw that?" said the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Ned."
|
|
|
|
"With your own eyes?"
|
|
|
|
"With my own eyes."
|
|
|
|
"Where, pray, might that be?"
|
|
|
|
"At St. Malo," answered Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"In the port?" said Ned, ironically.
|
|
|
|
"No; in a church," replied Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"In a church!" cried the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Yes; friend Ned. In a picture representing the poulp in question."
|
|
|
|
"Good!" said Ned Land, bursting out laughing.
|
|
|
|
"He is quite right," I said. "I have heard of this picture;
|
|
but the subject represented is taken from a legend, and you know
|
|
what to think of legends in the matter of natural history.
|
|
Besides, when it is a question of monsters, the imagination
|
|
is apt to run wild. Not only is it supposed that these poulps
|
|
can draw down vessels, but a certain Olaus Magnus speaks of an
|
|
octopus a mile long that is more like an island than an animal.
|
|
It is also said that the Bishop of Nidros was building
|
|
an altar on an immense rock. Mass finished, the rock began
|
|
to walk, and returned to the sea. The rock was a poulp.
|
|
Another Bishop, Pontoppidan, speaks also of a poulp on which
|
|
a regiment of cavalry could manoeuvre. Lastly, the ancient
|
|
naturalists speak of monsters whose mouths were like gulfs,
|
|
and which were too large to pass through the Straits of Gibraltar."
|
|
|
|
"But how much is true of these stories?" asked Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"Nothing, my friends; at least of that which passes the limit of truth
|
|
to get to fable or legend. Nevertheless, there must be some ground
|
|
for the imagination of the story-tellers. One cannot deny that poulps and
|
|
cuttlefish exist of a large species, inferior, however, to the cetaceans.
|
|
Aristotle has stated the dimensions of a cuttlefish as five cubits,
|
|
or nine feet two inches. Our fishermen frequently see some that are
|
|
more than four feet long. Some skeletons of poulps are preserved in
|
|
the museums of Trieste and Montpelier, that measure two yards in length.
|
|
Besides, according to the calculations of some naturalists, one of these
|
|
animals only six feet long would have tentacles twenty-seven feet long.
|
|
That would suffice to make a formidable monster."
|
|
|
|
"Do they fish for them in these days?" asked Ned.
|
|
|
|
"If they do not fish for them, sailors see them at least.
|
|
One of my friends, Captain Paul Bos of Havre, has often affirmed
|
|
that he met one of these monsters of colossal dimensions in
|
|
the Indian seas. But the most astonishing fact, and which does
|
|
not permit of the denial of the existence of these gigantic animals,
|
|
happened some years ago, in 1861."
|
|
|
|
"What is the fact?" asked Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
"This is it. In 1861, to the north-east of Teneriffe, very nearly
|
|
in the same latitude we are in now, the crew of the despatch-boat
|
|
Alector perceived a monstrous cuttlefish swimming in the waters.
|
|
Captain Bouguer went near to the animal, and attacked it with
|
|
harpoon and guns, without much success, for balls and harpoons
|
|
glided over the soft flesh. After several fruitless attempts
|
|
the crew tried to pass a slip-knot round the body of the mollusc.
|
|
The noose slipped as far as the tail fins and there stopped.
|
|
They tried then to haul it on board, but its weight was so
|
|
considerable that the tightness of the cord separated the tail
|
|
from the body, and, deprived of this ornament, he disappeared
|
|
under the water."
|
|
|
|
"Indeed! is that a fact?"
|
|
|
|
"An indisputable fact, my good Ned. They proposed to name this
|
|
poulp `Bouguer's cuttlefish.'"
|
|
|
|
"What length was it?" asked the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
"Did it not measure about six yards?" said Conseil, who, posted at the window,
|
|
was examining again the irregular windings of the cliff.
|
|
|
|
"Precisely," I replied.
|
|
|
|
"Its head," rejoined Conseil, "was it not crowned with eight tentacles,
|
|
that beat the water like a nest of serpents?"
|
|
|
|
"Precisely."
|
|
|
|
"Had not its eyes, placed at the back of its head, considerable development?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Conseil."
|
|
|
|
"And was not its mouth like a parrot's beak?"
|
|
|
|
"Exactly, Conseil."
|
|
|
|
"Very well! no offence to master," he replied, quietly; "if this
|
|
is not Bouguer's cuttlefish, it is, at least, one of its brothers."
|
|
|
|
I looked at Conseil. Ned Land hurried to the window.
|
|
|
|
"What a horrible beast!" he cried.
|
|
|
|
I looked in my turn, and could not repress a gesture of disgust.
|
|
Before my eyes was a horrible monster worthy to figure in the legends
|
|
of the marvellous. It was an immense cuttlefish, being eight yards long.
|
|
It swam crossways in the direction of the Nautilus with great speed,
|
|
watching us with its enormous staring green eyes. Its eight arms,
|
|
or rather feet, fixed to its head, that have given the name
|
|
of cephalopod to these animals, were twice as long as its body,
|
|
and were twisted like the furies' hair. One could see the 250 air
|
|
holes on the inner side of the tentacles. The monster's mouth,
|
|
a horned beak like a parrot's, opened and shut vertically.
|
|
Its tongue, a horned substance, furnished with several rows
|
|
of pointed teeth, came out quivering from this veritable pair
|
|
of shears. What a freak of nature, a bird's beak on a mollusc!
|
|
Its spindle-like body formed a fleshy mass that might weigh 4,000
|
|
to 5,000 lb.; the, varying colour changing with great rapidity,
|
|
according to the irritation of the animal, passed successively
|
|
from livid grey to reddish brown. What irritated this mollusc?
|
|
No doubt the presence of the Nautilus, more formidable than itself,
|
|
and on which its suckers or its jaws had no hold. Yet, what monsters
|
|
these poulps are! what vitality the Creator has given them!
|
|
what vigour in their movements! and they possess three hearts!
|
|
Chance had brought us in presence of this cuttlefish, and I did not wish
|
|
to lose the opportunity of carefully studying this specimen of cephalopods.
|
|
I overcame the horror that inspired me, and, taking a pencil, began
|
|
to draw it.
|
|
|
|
"Perhaps this is the same which the Alector saw," said Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"No," replied the Canadian; "for this is whole, and the other
|
|
had lost its tail."
|
|
|
|
"That is no reason," I replied. "The arms and tails of these animals
|
|
are re-formed by renewal; and in seven years the tail of Bouguer's
|
|
cuttlefish has no doubt had time to grow."
|
|
|
|
By this time other poulps appeared at the port light. I counted seven.
|
|
They formed a procession after the Nautilus, and I heard their beaks
|
|
gnashing against the iron hull. I continued my work. These monsters
|
|
kept in the water with such precision that they seemed immovable.
|
|
Suddenly the Nautilus stopped. A shock made it tremble in every plate.
|
|
|
|
"Have we struck anything?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"In any case," replied the Canadian, "we shall be free,
|
|
for we are floating."
|
|
|
|
The Nautilus was floating, no doubt, but it did not move.
|
|
A minute passed. Captain Nemo, followed by his lieutenant,
|
|
entered the drawing-room. I had not seen him for some time.
|
|
He seemed dull. Without noticing or speaking to us, he went
|
|
to the panel, looked at the poulps, and said something to
|
|
his lieutenant. The latter went out. Soon the panels were shut.
|
|
The ceiling was lighted. I went towards the Captain.
|
|
|
|
"A curious collection of poulps?" I said.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, indeed, Mr. Naturalist," he replied; "and we are going to fight them,
|
|
man to beast."
|
|
|
|
I looked at him. I thought I had not heard aright.
|
|
|
|
"Man to beast?" I repeated.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir. The screw is stopped. I think that the horny
|
|
jaws of one of the cuttlefish is entangled in the blades.
|
|
That is what prevents our moving."
|
|
|
|
"What are you going to do?"
|
|
|
|
"Rise to the surface, and slaughter this vermin."
|
|
|
|
"A difficult enterprise."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, indeed. The electric bullets are powerless against the
|
|
soft flesh, where they do not find resistance enough to go off.
|
|
But we shall attack them with the hatchet."
|
|
|
|
"And the harpoon, sir," said the Canadian, "if you do not refuse my help."
|
|
|
|
"I will accept it, Master Land."
|
|
|
|
"We will follow you," I said, and, following Captain Nemo,
|
|
we went towards the central staircase.
|
|
|
|
There, about ten men with boarding-hatchets were ready for the attack.
|
|
Conseil and I took two hatchets; Ned Land seized a harpoon.
|
|
The Nautilus had then risen to the surface. One of the sailors,
|
|
posted on the top ladderstep, unscrewed the bolts of the panels.
|
|
But hardly were the screws loosed, when the panel rose with
|
|
great violence, evidently drawn by the suckers of a poulp's arm.
|
|
Immediately one of these arms slid like a serpent down the opening
|
|
and twenty others were above. With one blow of the axe, Captain Nemo
|
|
cut this formidable tentacle, that slid wriggling down the ladder.
|
|
Just as we were pressing one on the other to reach the platform,
|
|
two other arms, lashing the air, came down on the seaman placed
|
|
before Captain Nemo, and lifted him up with irresistible power.
|
|
Captain Nemo uttered a cry, and rushed out. We hurried after him.
|
|
|
|
What a scene! The unhappy man, seized by the tentacle and fixed
|
|
to the suckers, was balanced in the air at the caprice of this
|
|
enormous trunk. He rattled in his throat, he was stifled, he cried,
|
|
"Help! help!" These words, spoken in French, startled me!
|
|
I had a fellow-countryman on board, perhaps several!
|
|
That heart-rending cry! I shall hear it all my life.
|
|
The unfortunate man was lost. Who could rescue him from that
|
|
powerful pressure? However, Captain Nemo had rushed to the poulp,
|
|
and with one blow of the axe had cut through one arm.
|
|
His lieutenant struggled furiously against other monsters that crept
|
|
on the flanks of the Nautilus. The crew fought with their axes.
|
|
The Canadian, Conseil, and I buried our weapons in the fleshy masses;
|
|
a strong smell of musk penetrated the atmosphere.
|
|
It was horrible!
|
|
|
|
For one instant, I thought the unhappy man, entangled with the poulp, would be
|
|
torn from its powerful suction. Seven of the eight arms had been cut off.
|
|
One only wriggled in the air, brandishing the victim like a feather. But just
|
|
as Captain Nemo and his lieutenant threw themselves on it, the animal ejected
|
|
a stream of black liquid. We were blinded with it. When the cloud dispersed,
|
|
the cuttlefish had disappeared, and my unfortunate countryman with it.
|
|
Ten or twelve poulps now invaded the platform and sides of the Nautilus.
|
|
We rolled pell-mell into the midst of this nest of serpents, that wriggled
|
|
on the platform in the waves of blood and ink. It seemed as though these
|
|
slimy tentacles sprang up like the hydra's heads. Ned Land's harpoon,
|
|
at each stroke, was plunged into the staring eyes of the cuttle fish.
|
|
But my bold companion was suddenly overturned by the tentacles of a monster
|
|
he had not been able to avoid.
|
|
|
|
Ah! how my heart beat with emotion and horror!
|
|
The formidable beak of a cuttlefish was open over Ned Land.
|
|
The unhappy man would be cut in two. I rushed to his succour.
|
|
But Captain Nemo was before me; his axe disappeared between
|
|
the two enormous jaws, and, miraculously saved, the Canadian,
|
|
rising, plunged his harpoon deep into the triple heart
|
|
of the poulp.
|
|
|
|
"I owed myself this revenge!" said the Captain to the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
Ned bowed without replying. The combat had lasted a quarter of an hour.
|
|
The monsters, vanquished and mutilated, left us at last, and disappeared
|
|
under the waves. Captain Nemo, covered with blood, nearly exhausted,
|
|
gazed upon the sea that had swallowed up one of his companions, and great
|
|
tears gathered in his eyes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XIX
|
|
|
|
THE GULF STREAM
|
|
|
|
This terrible scene of the 20th of April none of us can ever forget.
|
|
I have written it under the influence of violent emotion. Since then I
|
|
have revised the recital; I have read it to Conseil and to the Canadian.
|
|
They found it exact as to facts, but insufficient as to effect.
|
|
To paint such pictures, one must have the pen of the most illustrious
|
|
of our poets, the author of The Toilers of the Deep.
|
|
|
|
I have said that Captain Nemo wept while watching the waves;
|
|
his grief was great. It was the second companion he had
|
|
lost since our arrival on board, and what a death!
|
|
That friend, crushed, stifled, bruised by the dreadful
|
|
arms of a poulp, pounded by his iron jaws, would not
|
|
rest with his comrades in the peaceful coral cemetery!
|
|
In the midst of the struggle, it was the despairing cry
|
|
uttered by the unfortunate man that had torn my heart.
|
|
The poor Frenchman, forgetting his conventional language,
|
|
had taken to his own mother tongue, to utter a last appeal!
|
|
Amongst the crew of the Nautilus, associated with
|
|
the body and soul of the Captain, recoiling like him
|
|
from all contact with men, I had a fellow-countryman. Did
|
|
he alone represent France in this mysterious association,
|
|
evidently composed of individuals of divers nationalities?
|
|
It was one of these insoluble problems that rose up unceasingly
|
|
before my mind!
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo entered his room, and I saw him no more for some time.
|
|
But that he was sad and irresolute I could see by the vessel,
|
|
of which he was the soul, and which received all his impressions.
|
|
The Nautilus did not keep on in its settled course; it floated
|
|
about like a corpse at the will of the waves. It went at random.
|
|
He could not tear himself away from the scene of the last struggle,
|
|
from this sea that had devoured one of his men. Ten days passed thus.
|
|
It was not till the 1st of May that the Nautilus resumed its northerly course,
|
|
after having sighted the Bahamas at the mouth of the Bahama Canal.
|
|
We were then following the current from the largest river to the sea,
|
|
that has its banks, its fish, and its proper temperatures. I mean
|
|
the Gulf Stream. It is really a river, that flows freely to the middle
|
|
of the Atlantic, and whose waters do not mix with the ocean waters.
|
|
It is a salt river, salter than the surrounding sea. Its mean depth is
|
|
1,500 fathoms, its mean breadth ten miles. In certain places the current
|
|
flows with the speed of two miles and a half an hour. The body of its
|
|
waters is more considerable than that of all the rivers in the globe.
|
|
It was on this ocean river that the Nautilus then sailed.
|
|
|
|
I must add that, during the night, the phosphorescent waters
|
|
of the Gulf Stream rivalled the electric power of our watch-light,
|
|
especially in the stormy weather that threatened us so frequently.
|
|
May 8th, we were still crossing Cape Hatteras, at the height
|
|
of the North Caroline. The width of the Gulf Stream there
|
|
is seventy-five miles, and its depth 210 yards. The Nautilus
|
|
still went at random; all supervision seemed abandoned.
|
|
I thought that, under these circumstances, escape would be possible.
|
|
Indeed, the inhabited shores offered anywhere an easy refuge.
|
|
The sea was incessantly ploughed by the steamers that ply
|
|
between New York or Boston and the Gulf of Mexico, and overrun
|
|
day and night by the little schooners coasting about the several
|
|
parts of the American coast. We could hope to be picked up.
|
|
It was a favourable opportunity, notwithstanding the thirty
|
|
miles that separated the Nautilus from the coasts of the Union.
|
|
One unfortunate circumstance thwarted the Canadian's plans.
|
|
The weather was very bad. We were nearing those shores
|
|
where tempests are so frequent, that country of waterspouts and
|
|
cyclones actually engendered by the current of the Gulf Stream.
|
|
To tempt the sea in a frail boat was certain destruction. Ned Land
|
|
owned this himself. He fretted, seized with nostalgia that flight
|
|
only could cure.
|
|
|
|
"Master," he said that day to me, "this must come to an end. I must make
|
|
a clean breast of it. This Nemo is leaving land and going up to the north.
|
|
But I declare to you that I have had enough of the South Pole, and I will not
|
|
follow him to the North."
|
|
|
|
"What is to be done, Ned, since flight is impracticable just now?"
|
|
|
|
"We must speak to the Captain," said he; "you said nothing when we
|
|
were in your native seas. I will speak, now we are in mine.
|
|
When I think that before long the Nautilus will be by Nova Scotia,
|
|
and that there near New foundland is a large bay, and into that bay
|
|
the St. Lawrence empties itself, and that the St. Lawrence is my river,
|
|
the river by Quebec, my native town--when I think of this,
|
|
I feel furious, it makes my hair stand on end. Sir, I would
|
|
rather throw myself into the sea! I will not stay here!
|
|
I am stifled!"
|
|
|
|
The Canadian was evidently losing all patience.
|
|
His vigorous nature could not stand this prolonged imprisonment.
|
|
His face altered daily; his temper became more surly. I knew
|
|
what he must suffer, for I was seized with home-sickness myself.
|
|
Nearly seven months had passed without our having had any news
|
|
from land; Captain Nemo's isolation, his altered spirits,
|
|
especially since the fight with the poulps, his taciturnity, all made
|
|
me view things in a different light.
|
|
|
|
"Well, sir?" said Ned, seeing I did not reply.
|
|
|
|
"Well, Ned, do you wish me to ask Captain Nemo his intentions concerning us?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir."
|
|
|
|
"Although he has already made them known?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes; I wish it settled finally. Speak for me, in my name only,
|
|
if you like."
|
|
|
|
"But I so seldom meet him. He avoids me."
|
|
|
|
"That is all the more reason for you to go to see him."
|
|
|
|
I went to my room. From thence I meant to go to Captain Nemo's.
|
|
It would not do to let this opportunity of meeting him slip.
|
|
I knocked at the door. No answer. I knocked again, then turned
|
|
the handle. The door opened, I went in. The Captain was there.
|
|
Bending over his work-table, he had not heard me.
|
|
Resolved not to go without having spoken, I approached him.
|
|
He raised his head quickly, frowned, and said roughly, "You here!
|
|
What do you want?"
|
|
|
|
"To speak to you, Captain."
|
|
|
|
"But I am busy, sir; I am working. I leave you at liberty to shut
|
|
yourself up; cannot I be allowed the same?"
|
|
|
|
This reception was not encouraging; but I was determined to hear
|
|
and answer everything.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," I said coldly, "I have to speak to you on a matter that admits
|
|
of no delay."
|
|
|
|
"What is that, sir?" he replied, ironically. "Have you discovered something
|
|
that has escaped me, or has the sea delivered up any new secrets?"
|
|
|
|
We were at cross-purposes. But, before I could reply, he showed me
|
|
an open manuscript on his table, and said, in a more serious tone,
|
|
"Here, M. Aronnax, is a manuscript written in several languages.
|
|
It contains the sum of my studies of the sea; and, if it please God,
|
|
it shall not perish with me. This manuscript, signed with my name,
|
|
complete with the history of my life, will be shut up in a little
|
|
floating case. The last survivor of all of us on board the Nautilus
|
|
will throw this case into the sea, and it will go whither it is borne
|
|
by the waves."
|
|
|
|
This man's name! his history written by himself!
|
|
His mystery would then be revealed some day.
|
|
|
|
"Captain," I said, "I can but approve of the idea that makes you act thus.
|
|
The result of your studies must not be lost. But the means you employ seem
|
|
to me to be primitive. Who knows where the winds will carry this case,
|
|
and in whose hands it will fall? Could you not use some other means?
|
|
Could not you, or one of yours----"
|
|
|
|
"Never, sir!" he said, hastily interrupting me.
|
|
|
|
"But I and my companions are ready to keep this manuscript
|
|
in store; and, if you will put us at liberty----"
|
|
|
|
"At liberty?" said the Captain, rising.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir; that is the subject on which I wish to question you.
|
|
For seven months we have been here on board, and I ask you to-day,
|
|
in the name of my companions and in my own, if your intention is
|
|
to keep us here always?"
|
|
|
|
"M. Aronnax, I will answer you to-day as I did seven months ago:
|
|
Whoever enters the Nautilus, must never quit it."
|
|
|
|
"You impose actual slavery upon us!"
|
|
|
|
"Give it what name you please."
|
|
|
|
"But everywhere the slave has the right to regain his liberty."
|
|
|
|
"Who denies you this right? Have I ever tried to chain you with an oath?"
|
|
|
|
He looked at me with his arms crossed.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," I said, "to return a second time to this subject will be neither
|
|
to your nor to my taste; but, as we have entered upon it, let us go
|
|
through with it. I repeat, it is not only myself whom it concerns.
|
|
Study is to me a relief, a diversion, a passion that could make
|
|
me forget everything. Like you, I am willing to live obscure,
|
|
in the frail hope of bequeathing one day, to future time,
|
|
the result of my labours. But it is otherwise with Ned Land.
|
|
Every man, worthy of the name, deserves some consideration.
|
|
Have you thought that love of liberty, hatred of slavery,
|
|
can give rise to schemes of revenge in a nature like the Canadian's;
|
|
that he could think, attempt, and try----"
|
|
|
|
I was silenced; Captain Nemo rose.
|
|
|
|
"Whatever Ned Land thinks of, attempts, or tries, what does it matter to me?
|
|
I did not seek him! It is not for my pleasure that I keep him on board!
|
|
As for you, M. Aronnax, you are one of those who can understand everything,
|
|
even silence. I have nothing more to say to you. Let this first time you
|
|
have come to treat of this subject be the last, for a second time I will not
|
|
listen to you."
|
|
|
|
I retired. Our situation was critical. I related my conversation
|
|
to my two companions.
|
|
|
|
"We know now," said Ned, "that we can expect nothing from this man.
|
|
The Nautilus is nearing Long Island. We will escape, whatever the
|
|
weather may be."
|
|
|
|
But the sky became more and more threatening. Symptoms of a hurricane
|
|
became manifest. The atmosphere was becoming white and misty.
|
|
On the horizon fine streaks of cirrhous clouds were succeeded
|
|
by masses of cumuli. Other low clouds passed swiftly by.
|
|
The swollen sea rose in huge billows. The birds disappeared
|
|
with the exception of the petrels, those friends of the storm.
|
|
The barometer fell sensibly, and indicated an extreme extension
|
|
of the vapours. The mixture of the storm glass was decomposed
|
|
under the influence of the electricity that pervaded the atmosphere.
|
|
The tempest burst on the 18th of May, just as the Nautilus was
|
|
floating off Long Island, some miles from the port of New York.
|
|
I can describe this strife of the elements! for,
|
|
instead of fleeing to the depths of the sea, Captain Nemo,
|
|
by an unaccountable caprice, would brave it at the surface.
|
|
The wind blew from the south-west at first. Captain Nemo,
|
|
during the squalls, had taken his place on the platform.
|
|
He had made himself fast, to prevent being washed overboard
|
|
by the monstrous waves. I had hoisted myself up, and made myself
|
|
fast also, dividing my admiration between the tempest and this
|
|
extraordinary man who was coping with it. The raging sea was swept
|
|
by huge cloud-drifts, which were actually saturated with the waves.
|
|
The Nautilus, sometimes lying on its side, sometimes standing up
|
|
like a mast, rolled and pitched terribly. About five o'clock
|
|
a torrent of rain fell, that lulled neither sea nor wind.
|
|
The hurri cane blew nearly forty leagues an hour. It is under
|
|
these conditions that it overturns houses, breaks iron gates,
|
|
displaces twenty-four pounders. However, the Nautilus, in the midst
|
|
of the tempest, confirmed the words of a clever engineer,
|
|
"There is no well-constructed hull that cannot defy the sea."
|
|
This was not a resisting rock; it was a steel spindle,
|
|
obedient and movable, without rigging or masts, that braved its fury
|
|
with impunity. However, I watched these raging waves attentively.
|
|
They measured fifteen feet in height, and 150 to 175 yards long,
|
|
and their speed of propagation was thirty feet per second.
|
|
Their bulk and power increased with the depth of the water.
|
|
Such waves as these, at the Hebrides, have displaced a mass
|
|
weighing 8,400 lb. They are they which, in the tempest of
|
|
December 23rd, 1864, after destroying the town of Yeddo, in Japan,
|
|
broke the same day on the shores of America. The intensity of
|
|
the tempest increased with the night. The barometer, as in 1860
|
|
at Reunion during a cyclone, fell seven-tenths at the close of day.
|
|
I saw a large vessel pass the horizon struggling painfully.
|
|
She was trying to lie to under half steam, to keep up above the waves.
|
|
It was probably one of the steamers of the line from New York
|
|
to Liverpool, or Havre. It soon disappeared in the gloom.
|
|
At ten o'clock in the evening the sky was on fire.
|
|
The atmosphere was streaked with vivid lightning.
|
|
I could not bear the brightness of it; while the captain,
|
|
looking at it, seemed to envy the spirit of the tempest.
|
|
A terrible noise filled the air, a complex noise, made up
|
|
of the howls of the crushed waves, the roaring of the wind,
|
|
and the claps of thunder. The wind veered suddenly to all
|
|
points of the horizon; and the cyclone, rising in the east,
|
|
returned after passing by the north, west, and south, in the inverse
|
|
course pursued by the circular storm of the southern hemisphere.
|
|
Ah, that Gulf Stream! It deserves its name of the King of Tempests.
|
|
It is that which causes those formidable cyclones, by the
|
|
difference of temperature between its air and its currents.
|
|
A shower of fire had succeeded the rain. The drops of water were
|
|
changed to sharp spikes. One would have thought that Captain Nemo
|
|
was courting a death worthy of himself, a death by lightning.
|
|
As the Nautilus, pitching dreadfully, raised its steel spur in the air,
|
|
it seemed to act as a conductor, and I saw long sparks burst from it.
|
|
Crushed and without strength I crawled to the panel, opened it,
|
|
and descended to the saloon. The storm was then at its height.
|
|
It was impossible to stand upright in the interior of the Nautilus.
|
|
Captain Nemo came down about twelve. I heard the reservoirs filling
|
|
by degrees, and the Nautilus sank slowly beneath the waves.
|
|
Through the open windows in the saloon I saw large fish terrified,
|
|
passing like phantoms in the water. Some were struck before my eyes.
|
|
The Nautilus was still descending. I thought that at about eight
|
|
fathoms deep we should find a calm. But no! the upper beds
|
|
were too violently agitated for that. We had to seek repose
|
|
at more than twenty-five fathoms in the bowels of the deep.
|
|
But there, what quiet, what silence, what peace! Who could have told
|
|
that such a hurricane had been let loose on the surface of that
|
|
ocean?
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XX
|
|
|
|
FROM LATITUDE 47@ 24' TO LONGITUDE 17@ 28'
|
|
|
|
In consequence of the storm, we had been thrown eastward once more.
|
|
All hope of escape on the shores of New York or St. Lawrence had faded away;
|
|
and poor Ned, in despair, had isolated himself like Captain Nemo.
|
|
Conseil and I, however, never left each other. I said that the Nautilus
|
|
had gone aside to the east. I should have said (to be more exact)
|
|
the north-east. For some days, it wandered first on the surface,
|
|
and then beneath it, amid those fogs so dreaded by sailors.
|
|
What accidents are due to these thick fogs! What shocks upon
|
|
these reefs when the wind drowns the breaking of the waves!
|
|
What collisions between vessels, in spite of their warning lights,
|
|
whistles, and alarm bells! And the bottoms of these seas look like
|
|
a field of battle, where still lie all the conquered of the ocean;
|
|
some old and already encrusted, others fresh and reflecting from their
|
|
iron bands and copper plates the brilliancy of our lantern.
|
|
|
|
On the 15th of May we were at the extreme south of the Bank of Newfoundland.
|
|
This bank consists of alluvia, or large heaps of organic matter,
|
|
brought either from the Equator by the Gulf Stream, or from the North Pole
|
|
by the counter-current of cold water which skirts the American coast.
|
|
There also are heaped up those erratic blocks which are carried along
|
|
by the broken ice; and close by, a vast charnel-house of molluscs,
|
|
which perish here by millions. The depth of the sea is not great
|
|
at Newfoundland--not more than some hundreds of fathoms; but towards
|
|
the south is a depression of 1,500 fathoms. There the Gulf Stream widens.
|
|
It loses some of its speed and some of its temperature, but it
|
|
becomes a sea.
|
|
|
|
It was on the 17th of May, about 500 miles from Heart's Content,
|
|
at a depth of more than 1,400 fathoms, that I saw the electric cable lying
|
|
on the bottom. Conseil, to whom I had not mentioned it, thought at first
|
|
that it was a gigantic sea-serpent. But I undeceived the worthy fellow,
|
|
and by way of consolation related several particulars in the laying
|
|
of this cable. The first one was laid in the years 1857 and 1858;
|
|
but, after transmitting about 400 telegrams, would not act any longer.
|
|
In 1863 the engineers constructed an other one, measuring 2,000 miles
|
|
in length, and weighing 4,500 tons, which was embarked on the Great Eastern.
|
|
This attempt also failed.
|
|
|
|
On the 25th of May the Nautilus, being at a depth of more
|
|
than 1,918 fathoms, was on the precise spot where the rupture
|
|
occurred which ruined the enterprise. It was within 638 miles
|
|
of the coast of Ireland; and at half-past two in the afternoon
|
|
they discovered that communication with Europe had ceased.
|
|
The electricians on board resolved to cut the cable before
|
|
fishing it up, and at eleven o'clock at night they had recovered
|
|
the damaged part. They made another point and spliced it,
|
|
and it was once more submerged. But some days after it broke again,
|
|
and in the depths of the ocean could not be recaptured.
|
|
The Americans, however, were not discouraged. Cyrus Field, the bold
|
|
promoter of the enterprise, as he had sunk all his own fortune,
|
|
set a new subscription on foot, which was at once answered,
|
|
and another cable was constructed on better principles.
|
|
The bundles of conducting wires were each enveloped in gutta-percha,
|
|
and protected by a wadding of hemp, contained in a metallic covering.
|
|
The Great Eastern sailed on the 13th of July, 1866. The operation
|
|
worked well. But one incident occurred. Several times in
|
|
unrolling the cable they observed that nails had recently been
|
|
forced into it, evidently with the motive of destroying it.
|
|
Captain Anderson, the officers, and engineers consulted together,
|
|
and had it posted up that, if the offender was surprised on board,
|
|
he would be thrown without further trial into the sea.
|
|
From that time the criminal attempt was never repeated.
|
|
|
|
On the 23rd of July the Great Eastern was not more than 500 miles
|
|
from Newfoundland, when they telegraphed from Ireland the news
|
|
of the armistice concluded between Prussia and Austria after Sadowa.
|
|
On the 27th, in the midst of heavy fogs, they reached the port
|
|
of Heart's Content. The enterprise was successfully terminated;
|
|
and for its first despatch, young America addressed old Europe in these
|
|
words of wisdom, so rarely understood: "Glory to God in the highest,
|
|
and on earth peace, goodwill towards men."
|
|
|
|
I did not expect to find the electric cable in its
|
|
primitive state, such as it was on leaving the manufactory.
|
|
The long serpent, covered with the remains of shells,
|
|
bristling with foraminiferae, was encrusted with a strong coating
|
|
which served as a protection against all boring molluscs.
|
|
It lay quietly sheltered from the motions of the sea, and under
|
|
a favourable pressure for the transmission of the electric
|
|
spark which passes from Europe to America in .32 of a second.
|
|
Doubtless this cable will last for a great length of time,
|
|
for they find that the gutta-percha covering is improved
|
|
by the sea-water. Besides, on this level, so well chosen,
|
|
the cable is never so deeply submerged as to cause it to break.
|
|
The Nautilus followed it to the lowest depth, which was more than
|
|
2,212 fathoms, and there it lay without any anchorage; and then
|
|
we reached the spot where the accident had taken place in 1863.
|
|
The bottom of the ocean then formed a valley about 100
|
|
miles broad, in which Mont Blanc might have been placed without
|
|
its summit appearing above the waves. This valley is closed
|
|
at the east by a perpendicular wall more than 2,000 yards high.
|
|
We arrived there on the 28th of May, and the Nautilus was then not
|
|
more than 120 miles from Ireland.
|
|
|
|
Was Captain Nemo going to land on the British Isles?
|
|
No. To my great surprise he made for the south, once more coming
|
|
back towards European seas. In rounding the Emerald Isle,
|
|
for one instant I caught sight of Cape Clear, and the light which
|
|
guides the thousands of vessels leaving Glasgow or Liverpool.
|
|
An important question then arose in my mind. Did the Nautilus
|
|
dare entangle itself in the Manche? Ned Land, who had re-appeared
|
|
since we had been nearing land, did not cease to question me.
|
|
How could I answer? Captain Nemo reminded invisible.
|
|
After having shown the Canadian a glimpse of American shores,
|
|
was he going to show me the coast of France?
|
|
|
|
But the Nautilus was still going southward. On the 30th of May,
|
|
it passed in sight of Land's End, between the extreme point
|
|
of England and the Scilly Isles, which were left to starboard.
|
|
If we wished to enter the Manche, he must go straight to the east.
|
|
He did not do so.
|
|
|
|
During the whole of the 31st of May, the Nautilus described
|
|
a series of circles on the water, which greatly interested me.
|
|
It seemed to be seeking a spot it had some trouble in finding.
|
|
At noon, Captain Nemo himself came to work the ship's log.
|
|
He spoke no word to me, but seemed gloomier than ever. What could
|
|
sadden him thus? Was it his proxim ity to European shores?
|
|
Had he some recollections of his abandoned country?
|
|
If not, what did he feel? Remorse or regret?
|
|
For a long while this thought haunted my mind, and I had
|
|
a kind of presentiment that before long chance would betray
|
|
the captain's secrets.
|
|
|
|
The next day, the 1st of June, the Nautilus continued the same process.
|
|
It was evidently seeking some particular spot in the ocean.
|
|
Captain Nemo took the sun's altitude as he had done the day before.
|
|
The sea was beautiful, the sky clear. About eight miles to the east,
|
|
a large steam vessel could be discerned on the horizon.
|
|
No flag fluttered from its mast, and I could not discover
|
|
its nationality. Some minutes before the sun passed the meridian,
|
|
Captain Nemo took his sextant, and watched with great attention.
|
|
The perfect rest of the water greatly helped the operation.
|
|
The Nautilus was motionless; it neither rolled nor pitched.
|
|
|
|
I was on the platform when the altitude was taken, and the Captain
|
|
pronounced these words: "It is here."
|
|
|
|
He turned and went below. Had he seen the vessel which
|
|
was changing its course and seemed to be nearing us?
|
|
I could not tell. I returned to the saloon. The panels closed,
|
|
I heard the hissing of the water in the reservoirs.
|
|
The Nautilus began to sink, following a vertical line, for its
|
|
screw communicated no motion to it. Some minutes later it stopped
|
|
at a depth of more than 420 fathoms, resting on the ground.
|
|
The luminous ceiling was darkened, then the panels were opened,
|
|
and through the glass I saw the sea brilliantly illuminated by
|
|
the rays of our lantern for at least half a mile round us.
|
|
|
|
I looked to the port side, and saw nothing but an immensity
|
|
of quiet waters. But to starboard, on the bottom appeared
|
|
a large protuberance, which at once attracted my attention.
|
|
One would have thought it a ruin buried under a coating
|
|
of white shells, much resembling a covering of snow.
|
|
Upon examining the mass attentively, I could recognise
|
|
the ever-thickening form of a vessel bare of its masts,
|
|
which must have sunk. It certainly belonged to past times.
|
|
This wreck, to be thus encrusted with the lime of the water,
|
|
must already be able to count many years passed at the bottom
|
|
of the ocean.
|
|
|
|
What was this vessel? Why did the Nautilus visit its tomb?
|
|
Could it have been aught but a shipwreck which had drawn it under the water?
|
|
I knew not what to think, when near me in a slow voice I heard
|
|
Captain Nemo say:
|
|
|
|
"At one time this ship was called the Marseillais. It carried
|
|
seventy-four guns, and was launched in 1762. In 1778, the 13th of August,
|
|
commanded by La Poype-Ver trieux, it fought boldly against the Preston.
|
|
In 1779, on the 4th of July, it was at the taking of Grenada,
|
|
with the squadron of Admiral Estaing. In 1781, on the 5th of September,
|
|
it took part in the battle of Comte de Grasse, in Chesapeake Bay.
|
|
In 1794, the French Republic changed its name. On the 16th of April,
|
|
in the same year, it joined the squadron of Villaret Joyeuse, at Brest,
|
|
being entrusted with the escort of a cargo of corn coming from America,
|
|
under the command of Admiral Van Stebel. On the 11th and 12th Prairal
|
|
of the second year, this squadron fell in with an English vessel.
|
|
Sir, to-day is the 13th Prairal, the first of June, 1868. It is now
|
|
seventy-four years ago, day for day on this very spot, in latitude 47@
|
|
24', longitude 17@ 28', that this vessel, after fighting heroically,
|
|
losing its three masts, with the water in its hold, and the third of its
|
|
crew disabled, preferred sinking with its 356 sailors to surrendering;
|
|
and, nailing its colours to the poop, disappeared under the waves to
|
|
the cry of `Long live the Republic!'"
|
|
|
|
"The Avenger!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"Yes, sir, the Avenger! A good name!" muttered Captain Nemo,
|
|
crossing his arms.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XXI
|
|
|
|
A HECATOMB
|
|
|
|
The way of describing this unlooked-for scene, the history
|
|
of the patriot ship, told at first so coldly, and the emotion
|
|
with which this strange man pronounced the last words,
|
|
the name of the Avenger, the significance of which could
|
|
not escape me, all impressed itself deeply on my mind.
|
|
My eyes did not leave the Captain, who, with his hand stretched
|
|
out to sea, was watching with a glowing eye the glorious wreck.
|
|
Perhaps I was never to know who he was, from whence he came,
|
|
or where he was going to, but I saw the man move, and apart
|
|
from the savant. It was no common misanthropy which had
|
|
shut Captain Nemo and his companions within the Nautilus,
|
|
but a hatred, either monstrous or sublime, which time could
|
|
never weaken. Did this hatred still seek for vengeance?
|
|
The future would soon teach me that. But the Nautilus
|
|
was rising slowly to the surface of the sea, and the form
|
|
of the Avenger disappeared by degrees from my sight.
|
|
Soon a slight rolling told me that we were in the open air.
|
|
At that moment a dull boom was heard. I looked at the Captain.
|
|
He did not move.
|
|
|
|
"Captain?" said I.
|
|
|
|
He did not answer. I left him and mounted the platform.
|
|
Conseil and the Canadian were already there.
|
|
|
|
"Where did that sound come from?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"It was a gunshot," replied Ned Land.
|
|
|
|
I looked in the direction of the vessel I had already seen.
|
|
It was nearing the Nautilus, and we could see that it was putting on steam.
|
|
It was within six miles of us.
|
|
|
|
"What is that ship, Ned?"
|
|
|
|
"By its rigging, and the height of its lower masts," said the Canadian,
|
|
"I bet she is a ship-of-war. May it reach us; and, if necessary,
|
|
sink this cursed Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
"Friend Ned," replied Conseil, "what harm can it do to the Nautilus?
|
|
Can it attack it beneath the waves? Can its cannonade us at the bottom
|
|
of the sea?"
|
|
|
|
"Tell me, Ned," said I, "can you recognise what country she belongs to?"
|
|
|
|
The Canadian knitted his eyebrows, dropped his eyelids,
|
|
and screwed up the corners of his eyes, and for a few moments
|
|
fixed a piercing look upon the vessel.
|
|
|
|
"No, sir," he replied; "I cannot tell what nation she belongs to,
|
|
for she shows no colours. But I can declare she is a man-of-war,
|
|
for a long pennant flutters from her main mast."
|
|
|
|
For a quarter of an hour we watched the ship which was steaming
|
|
towards us. I could not, however, believe that she could
|
|
see the Nautilus from that distance; and still less that she
|
|
could know what this submarine engine was. Soon the Canadian
|
|
informed me that she was a large, armoured, two-decker ram.
|
|
A thick black smoke was pouring from her two funnels.
|
|
Her closely-furled sails were stopped to her yards.
|
|
She hoisted no flag at her mizzen-peak. The distance
|
|
prevented us from distinguishing the colours of her pennant,
|
|
which floated like a thin ribbon. She advanced rapidly.
|
|
If Captain Nemo allowed her to approach, there was a chance of
|
|
salvation for us.
|
|
|
|
"Sir," said Ned Land, "if that vessel passes within a mile of us I shall
|
|
throw myself into the sea, and I should advise you to do the same."
|
|
|
|
I did not reply to the Canadian's suggestion, but continued
|
|
watching the ship. Whether English, French, American, or Russian,
|
|
she would be sure to take us in if we could only reach her.
|
|
Presently a white smoke burst from the fore part of the vessel;
|
|
some seconds after, the water, agitated by the fall of a heavy body,
|
|
splashed the stern of the Nautilus, and shortly afterwards a loud
|
|
explosion struck my ear.
|
|
|
|
"What! they are firing at us!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"So please you, sir," said Ned, "they have recognised the unicorn,
|
|
and they are firing at us."
|
|
|
|
"But," I exclaimed, "surely they can see that there are men in the case?"
|
|
|
|
"It is, perhaps, because of that," replied Ned Land, looking at me.
|
|
|
|
A whole flood of light burst upon my mind. Doubtless they knew
|
|
now how to believe the stories of the pretended monster. No doubt,
|
|
on board the Abraham Lincoln, when the Canadian struck it with the harpoon,
|
|
Commander Farragut had recognised in the supposed narwhal a submarine vessel,
|
|
more dangerous than a supernatural cetacean. Yes, it must have been so;
|
|
and on every sea they were now seeking this engine of destruction.
|
|
Terrible indeed! if, as we supposed, Captain Nemo employed the Nautilus
|
|
in works of vengeance. On the night when we were imprisoned in that cell,
|
|
in the midst of the Indian Ocean, had he not attacked some vessel?
|
|
The man buried in the coral cemetery, had he not been a victim to
|
|
the shock caused by the Nautilus? Yes, I repeat it, it must be so.
|
|
One part of the mysterious existence of Captain Nemo had been unveiled;
|
|
and, if his identity had not been recognised, at least, the nations
|
|
united against him were no longer hunting a chimerical creature,
|
|
but a man who had vowed a deadly hatred against them.
|
|
All the formidable past rose before me. Instead of meeting friends
|
|
on board the approaching ship, we could only expect pitiless enemies.
|
|
But the shot rattled about us. Some of them struck the sea
|
|
and ricochetted, losing themselves in the distance. But none touched
|
|
the Nautilus. The vessel was not more than three miles from us.
|
|
In spite of the serious cannonade, Captain Nemo did not appear
|
|
on the platform; but, if one of the conical projectiles had struck
|
|
the shell of the Nautilus, it would have been fatal. The Canadian
|
|
then said, "Sir, we must do all we can to get out of this dilemma.
|
|
Let us signal them. They will then, perhaps, understand that we
|
|
are honest folks."
|
|
|
|
Ned Land took his handkerchief to wave in the air; but he had
|
|
scarcely displayed it, when he was struck down by an iron hand,
|
|
and fell, in spite of his great strength, upon the deck.
|
|
|
|
"Fool!" exclaimed the Captain, "do you wish to be pierced by the spur
|
|
of the Nautilus before it is hurled at this vessel?"
|
|
|
|
Captain Nemo was terrible to hear; he was still more terrible to see.
|
|
His face was deadly pale, with a spasm at his heart. For an instant
|
|
it must have ceased to beat. His pupils were fearfully contracted.
|
|
He did not speak, he roared, as, with his body thrown forward,
|
|
he wrung the Canadian's shoulders. Then, leaving him, and turning
|
|
to the ship of war, whose shot was still raining around him,
|
|
he exclaimed, with a powerful voice, "Ah, ship of an accursed nation,
|
|
you know who I am! I do not want your colours to know you by!
|
|
Look! and I will show you mine!"
|
|
|
|
And on the fore part of the platform Captain Nemo unfurled
|
|
a black flag, similar to the one he had placed at the South Pole.
|
|
At that moment a shot struck the shell of the Nautilus obliquely,
|
|
without piercing it; and, rebounding near the Captain, was lost in the sea.
|
|
He shrugged his shoulders; and, addressing me, said shortly, "Go down,
|
|
you and your companions, go down!"
|
|
|
|
"Sir," I cried, "are you going to attack this vessel?"
|
|
|
|
"Sir, I am going to sink it."
|
|
|
|
"You will not do that?"
|
|
|
|
"I shall do it," he replied coldly. "And I advise you not to
|
|
judge me, sir. Fate has shown you what you ought not to have seen.
|
|
The attack has begun; go down."
|
|
|
|
"What is this vessel?"
|
|
|
|
"You do not know? Very well! so much the better!
|
|
Its nationality to you, at least, will be a secret. Go down!"
|
|
|
|
We could but obey. About fifteen of the sailors surrounded the Captain,
|
|
looking with implacable hatred at the vessel nearing them.
|
|
One could feel that the same desire of vengeance animated every soul.
|
|
I went down at the moment another projectile struck the Nautilus, and I
|
|
heard the Captain exclaim:
|
|
|
|
"Strike, mad vessel! Shower your useless shot! And then, you will not
|
|
escape the spur of the Nautilus. But it is not here that you shall perish!
|
|
I would not have your ruins mingle with those of the Avenger!"
|
|
|
|
I reached my room. The Captain and his second had remained on the platform.
|
|
The screw was set in motion, and the Nautilus, moving with speed,
|
|
was soon beyond the reach of the ship's guns. But the pursuit continued,
|
|
and Captain Nemo contented himself with keeping his distance.
|
|
|
|
About four in the afternoon, being no longer able to
|
|
contain my impatience, I went to the central staircase.
|
|
The panel was open, and I ventured on to the platform.
|
|
The Captain was still walking up and down with an agitated step.
|
|
He was looking at the ship, which was five or six miles to leeward.
|
|
|
|
He was going round it like a wild beast, and, drawing it eastward,
|
|
he allowed them to pursue. But he did not attack.
|
|
Perhaps he still hesitated? I wished to mediate once more.
|
|
But I had scarcely spoken, when Captain Nemo imposed silence, saying:
|
|
|
|
"I am the law, and I am the judge! I am the oppressed, and there is
|
|
the oppressor! Through him I have lost all that I loved, cherished,
|
|
and venerated--country, wife, children, father, and mother.
|
|
I saw all perish! All that I hate is there! Say no more!"
|
|
|
|
I cast a last look at the man-of-war, which was putting on steam,
|
|
and rejoined Ned and Conseil.
|
|
|
|
"We will fly!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"Good!" said Ned. "What is this vessel?"
|
|
|
|
"I do not know; but, whatever it is, it will be sunk before night.
|
|
In any case, it is better to perish with it, than be made accomplices
|
|
in a retaliation the justice of which we cannot judge."
|
|
|
|
"That is my opinion too," said Ned Land, coolly. "Let us wait for night."
|
|
|
|
Night arrived. Deep silence reigned on board.
|
|
The compass showed that the Nautilus had not altered its course.
|
|
It was on the surface, rolling slightly. My companions and I
|
|
resolved to fly when the vessel should be near enough either
|
|
to hear us or to see us; for the moon, which would be full
|
|
in two or three days, shone brightly. Once on board the ship,
|
|
if we could not prevent the blow which threatened it, we could,
|
|
at least we would, do all that circumstances would allow.
|
|
Several times I thought the Nautilus was preparing for attack;
|
|
but Captain Nemo contented himself with allowing his adversary
|
|
to approach, and then fled once more before it.
|
|
|
|
Part of the night passed without any incident. We watched the
|
|
opportunity for action. We spoke little, for we were too much moved.
|
|
Ned Land would have thrown himself into the sea, but I forced him to wait.
|
|
According to my idea, the Nautilus would attack the ship at her waterline,
|
|
and then it would not only be possible, but easy to fly.
|
|
|
|
At three in the morning, full of uneasiness, I mounted the platform.
|
|
Captain Nemo had not left it. He was standing at the fore part near
|
|
his flag, which a slight breeze displayed above his head. He did not take
|
|
his eyes from the vessel. The intensity of his look seemed to attract,
|
|
and fascinate, and draw it onward more surely than if he had been towing it.
|
|
The moon was then passing the meridian. Jupiter was rising in the east.
|
|
Amid this peaceful scene of nature, sky and ocean rivalled each other
|
|
in tranquillity, the sea offering to the orbs of night the finest mirror
|
|
they could ever have in which to reflect their image. As I thought of
|
|
the deep calm of these elements, compared with all those passions brooding
|
|
imperceptibly within the Nautilus, I shuddered.
|
|
|
|
The vessel was within two miles of us. It was ever nearing that
|
|
phosphorescent light which showed the presence of the Nautilus.
|
|
I could see its green and red lights, and its white lantern hanging
|
|
from the large foremast. An indistinct vibration quivered through
|
|
its rigging, showing that the furnaces were heated to the uttermost.
|
|
Sheaves of sparks and red ashes flew from the funnels, shining in the
|
|
atmosphere like stars.
|
|
|
|
I remained thus until six in the morning, without Captain Nemo noticing me.
|
|
The ship stood about a mile and a half from us, and with the first dawn
|
|
of day the firing began afresh. The moment could not be far off when,
|
|
the Nautilus attacking its adversary, my companions and myself should
|
|
for ever leave this man. I was preparing to go down to remind them,
|
|
when the second mounted the platform, accompanied by several sailors.
|
|
Captain Nemo either did not or would not see them. Some steps were taken
|
|
which might be called the signal for action. They were very simple.
|
|
The iron balustrade around the platform was lowered, and the lantern and pilot
|
|
cages were pushed within the shell until they were flush with the deck.
|
|
The long surface of the steel cigar no longer offered a single point to check
|
|
its manoeuvres. I returned to the saloon. The Nautilus still floated;
|
|
some streaks of light were filtering through the liquid beds.
|
|
With the undulations of the waves the windows were brightened by
|
|
the red streaks of the rising sun, and this dreadful day of the 2nd of
|
|
June had dawned.
|
|
|
|
At five o'clock, the log showed that the speed of the Nautilus
|
|
was slackening, and I knew that it was allowing them to
|
|
draw nearer. Besides, the reports were heard more distinctly,
|
|
and the projectiles, labouring through the ambient water,
|
|
were extinguished with a strange hissing noise.
|
|
|
|
"My friends," said I, "the moment is come. One grasp of the hand,
|
|
and may God protect us!"
|
|
|
|
Ned Land was resolute, Conseil calm, myself so nervous
|
|
that I knew not how to contain myself. We all passed into
|
|
the library; but the moment I pushed the door opening on to
|
|
the central staircase, I heard the upper panel close sharply.
|
|
The Canadian rushed on to the stairs, but I stopped him.
|
|
A well-known hissing noise told me that the water was running
|
|
into the reservoirs, and in a few minutes the Nautilus
|
|
was some yards beneath the surface of the waves.
|
|
I understood the manoeuvre. It was too late to act.
|
|
The Nautilus did not wish to strike at the impenetrable cuirass,
|
|
but below the water-line, where the metallic covering no
|
|
longer protected it.
|
|
|
|
We were again imprisoned, unwilling witnesses of the dreadful
|
|
drama that was preparing. We had scarcely time to reflect;
|
|
taking refuge in my room, we looked at each other without speaking.
|
|
A deep stupor had taken hold of my mind: thought seemed to stand still.
|
|
I was in that painful state of expectation preceding a dreadful report.
|
|
I waited, I listened, every sense was merged in that of hearing!
|
|
The speed of the Nautilus was accelerated. It was preparing to rush.
|
|
The whole ship trembled. Suddenly I screamed. I felt the shock,
|
|
but comparatively light. I felt the penetrating power of the steel spur.
|
|
I heard rattlings and scrapings. But the Nautilus, carried along
|
|
by its propelling power, passed through the mass of the vessel like a
|
|
needle through sailcloth!
|
|
|
|
I could stand it no longer. Mad, out of my mind, I rushed
|
|
from my room into the saloon. Captain Nemo was there,
|
|
mute, gloomy, implacable; he was looking through the port panel.
|
|
A large mass cast a shadow on the water; and, that it might
|
|
lose nothing of her agony, the Nautilus was going down into
|
|
the abyss with her. Ten yards from me I saw the open shell,
|
|
through which the water was rushing with the noise of thunder,
|
|
then the double line of guns and the netting. The bridge was
|
|
covered with black, agitated shadows.
|
|
|
|
The water was rising. The poor creatures were crowding the ratlines,
|
|
clinging to the masts, struggling under the water. It was a human ant-heap
|
|
overtaken by the sea. Paralysed, stiffened with anguish, my hair standing
|
|
on end, with eyes wide open, panting, without breath, and without voice,
|
|
I too was watching! An irresistible attraction glued me to the glass!
|
|
Suddenly an explosion took place. The compressed air blew up her decks,
|
|
as if the magazines had caught fire. Then the unfortunate vessel sank
|
|
more rapidly. Her topmast, laden with victims, now appeared; then her spars,
|
|
bending under the weight of men; and, last of all, the top of her mainmast.
|
|
Then the dark mass disappeared, and with it the dead crew, drawn down by
|
|
the strong eddy.
|
|
|
|
I turned to Captain Nemo. That terrible avenger, a perfect
|
|
archangel of hatred, was still looking. When all was over,
|
|
he turned to his room, opened the door, and entered.
|
|
I followed him with my eyes. On the end wall beneath his heroes,
|
|
I saw the portrait of a woman, still young, and two little children.
|
|
Captain Nemo looked at them for some moments, stretched his arms
|
|
towards them, and, kneeling down, burst into deep sobs.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XXII
|
|
|
|
THE LAST WORDS OF CAPTAIN NEMO
|
|
|
|
The panels had closed on this dreadful vision, but light had not returned
|
|
to the saloon: all was silence and darkness within the Nautilus.
|
|
At wonderful speed, a hundred feet beneath the water, it was leaving
|
|
this desolate spot. Whither was it going? To the north or south?
|
|
Where was the man flying to after such dreadful retaliation?
|
|
I had returned to my room, where Ned and Conseil had remained silent enough.
|
|
I felt an insurmountable horror for Captain Nemo. Whatever he had
|
|
suffered at the hands of these men, he had no right to punish thus.
|
|
He had made me, if not an accomplice, at least a witness of his vengeance.
|
|
At eleven the electric light reappeared. I passed into the saloon.
|
|
It was deserted. I consulted the different instruments. The Nautilus was
|
|
flying northward at the rate of twenty-five miles an hour, now on the surface,
|
|
and now thirty feet below it. On taking the bearings by the chart,
|
|
I saw that we were passing the mouth of the Manche, and that our course
|
|
was hurrying us towards the northern seas at a frightful speed. That night
|
|
we had crossed two hundred leagues of the Atlantic. The shadows fell,
|
|
and the sea was covered with darkness until the rising of the moon. I went
|
|
to my room, but could not sleep. I was troubled with dreadful nightmare.
|
|
The horrible scene of destruction was continually before my eyes.
|
|
From that day, who could tell into what part of the North Atlantic
|
|
basin the Nautilus would take us? Still with unaccountable speed.
|
|
Still in the midst of these northern fogs. Would it touch at Spitzbergen,
|
|
or on the shores of Nova Zembla? Should we explore those unknown seas,
|
|
the White Sea, the Sea of Kara, the Gulf of Obi, the Archipelago of Liarrov,
|
|
and the unknown coast of Asia? I could not say. I could no longer judge
|
|
of the time that was passing. The clocks had been stopped on board.
|
|
It seemed, as in polar countries, that night and day no longer followed
|
|
their regular course. I felt myself being drawn into that strange
|
|
region where the foundered imagination of Edgar Poe roamed at will.
|
|
Like the fabulous Gordon Pym, at every moment I expected to see "that veiled
|
|
human figure, of larger proportions than those of any inhabitant of the earth,
|
|
thrown across the cataract which defends the approach to the pole."
|
|
I estimated (though, perhaps, I may be mistaken)--I estimated this
|
|
adventurous course of the Nautilus to have lasted fifteen or twenty days.
|
|
And I know not how much longer it might have lasted, had it not been
|
|
for the catastrophe which ended this voyage. Of Captain Nemo I saw nothing
|
|
whatever now, nor of his second. Not a man of the crew was visible for
|
|
an instant. The Nautilus was almost incessantly under water. When we came
|
|
to the surface to renew the air, the panels opened and shut mechanically.
|
|
There were no more marks on the planisphere. I knew not where we were.
|
|
And the Canadian, too, his strength and patience at an end, appeared no more.
|
|
Conseil could not draw a word from him; and, fearing that, in a dreadful
|
|
fit of madness, he might kill himself, watched him with constant devotion.
|
|
One morning (what date it was I could not say) I had fallen into a heavy
|
|
sleep towards the early hours, a sleep both painful and unhealthy, when I
|
|
suddenly awoke. Ned Land was leaning over me, saying, in a low voice,
|
|
"We are going to fly." I sat up.
|
|
|
|
"When shall we go?" I asked.
|
|
|
|
"To-night. All inspection on board the Nautilus seems to have ceased.
|
|
All appear to be stupefied. You will be ready, sir?"
|
|
|
|
"Yes; where are we?"
|
|
|
|
"In sight of land. I took the reckoning this morning in the fog--
|
|
twenty miles to the east."
|
|
|
|
"What country is it?"
|
|
|
|
"I do not know; but, whatever it is, we will take refuge there."
|
|
|
|
"Yes, Ned, yes. We will fly to-night, even if the sea should swallow us up."
|
|
|
|
"The sea is bad, the wind violent, but twenty miles in that light
|
|
boat of the Nautilus does not frighten me. Unknown to the crew,
|
|
I have been able to procure food and some bottles of water."
|
|
|
|
"I will follow you."
|
|
|
|
"But," continued the Canadian, "if I am surprised, I will defend myself;
|
|
I will force them to kill me."
|
|
|
|
"We will die together, friend Ned."
|
|
|
|
I had made up my mind to all. The Canadian left me.
|
|
I reached the platform, on which I could with difficulty support
|
|
myself against the shock of the waves. The sky was threatening;
|
|
but, as land was in those thick brown shadows, we must fly.
|
|
I returned to the saloon, fearing and yet hoping to see Captain Nemo,
|
|
wishing and yet not wishing to see him. What could I have said to him?
|
|
Could I hide the involuntary horror with which he inspired me?
|
|
No. It was better that I should not meet him face to face;
|
|
better to forget him. And yet---- How long seemed that day, the last
|
|
that I should pass in the Nautilus. I remained alone. Ned Land
|
|
and Conseil avoided speaking, for fear of betraying themselves.
|
|
At six I dined, but I was not hungry; I forced myself to eat in spite
|
|
of my disgust, that I might not weaken myself. At half-past six
|
|
Ned Land came to my room, saying, "We shall not see each other
|
|
again before our departure. At ten the moon will not be risen.
|
|
We will profit by the darkness. Come to the boat; Conseil and I
|
|
will wait for you."
|
|
|
|
The Canadian went out without giving me time to answer.
|
|
Wishing to verify the course of the Nautilus, I went to the saloon.
|
|
We were running N.N.E. at frightful speed, and more than fifty yards deep.
|
|
I cast a last look on these wonders of nature, on the riches of art
|
|
heaped up in this museum, upon the unrivalled collection destined
|
|
to perish at the bottom of the sea, with him who had formed it.
|
|
I wished to fix an indelible impression of it in my mind.
|
|
I remained an hour thus, bathed in the light of that luminous ceiling,
|
|
and passing in review those treasures shining under their glasses.
|
|
Then I returned to my room.
|
|
|
|
I dressed myself in strong sea clothing. I collected my notes,
|
|
placing them carefully about me. My heart beat loudly.
|
|
I could not check its pulsations. Certainly my trouble and agitation
|
|
would have betrayed me to Captain Nemo's eyes. What was he doing
|
|
at this moment? I listened at the door of his room. I heard steps.
|
|
Captain Nemo was there. He had not gone to rest. At every moment
|
|
I expected to see him appear, and ask me why I wished to fly.
|
|
I was constantly on the alert. My imagination magnified everything.
|
|
The impression became at last so poignant that I asked myself if it
|
|
would not be better to go to the Captain's room, see him face to face,
|
|
and brave him with look and gesture.
|
|
|
|
It was the inspiration of a madman; fortunately I resisted the desire,
|
|
and stretched myself on my bed to quiet my bodily agitation.
|
|
My nerves were somewhat calmer, but in my excited brain I saw
|
|
over again all my existence on board the Nautilus; every incident,
|
|
either happy or unfortunate, which had happened since my disappearance
|
|
from the Abraham Lincoln--the submarine hunt, the Torres Straits,
|
|
the savages of Papua, the running ashore, the coral cemetery,
|
|
the passage of Suez, the Island of Santorin, the Cretan diver,
|
|
Vigo Bay, Atlantis, the iceberg, the South Pole, the imprisonment
|
|
in the ice, the fight among the poulps, the storm in the Gulf Stream,
|
|
the Avenger, and the horrible scene of the vessel sunk with all her crew.
|
|
All these events passed before my eyes like scenes in a drama.
|
|
Then Captain Nemo seemed to grow enormously, his features to assume
|
|
superhuman proportions. He was no longer my equal, but a man of the waters,
|
|
the genie of the sea.
|
|
|
|
It was then half-past nine. I held my head between my hands to keep
|
|
it from bursting. I closed my eyes; I would not think any longer.
|
|
There was another half-hour to wait, another half-hour of a nightmare,
|
|
which might drive me mad.
|
|
|
|
At that moment I heard the distant strains of the organ, a sad harmony to an
|
|
undefinable chant, the wail of a soul longing to break these earthly bonds.
|
|
I listened with every sense, scarcely breathing; plunged, like Captain Nemo,
|
|
in that musical ecstasy, which was drawing him in spirit to the end of life.
|
|
|
|
Then a sudden thought terrified me. Captain Nemo had left his room.
|
|
He was in the saloon, which I must cross to fly. There I should
|
|
meet him for the last time. He would see me, perhaps speak to me.
|
|
A gesture of his might destroy me, a single word chain me on board.
|
|
|
|
But ten was about to strike. The moment had come for me to leave my room,
|
|
and join my companions.
|
|
|
|
I must not hesitate, even if Captain Nemo himself should rise before me.
|
|
I opened my door carefully; and even then, as it turned on its hinges,
|
|
it seemed to me to make a dreadful noise. Perhaps it only existed in
|
|
my own imagination.
|
|
|
|
I crept along the dark stairs of the Nautilus, stopping at each step
|
|
to check the beating of my heart. I reached the door of the saloon,
|
|
and opened it gently. It was plunged in profound darkness.
|
|
The strains of the organ sounded faintly. Captain Nemo was there.
|
|
He did not see me. In the full light I do not think he would have
|
|
noticed me, so entirely was he absorbed in the ecstasy.
|
|
|
|
I crept along the carpet, avoiding the slightest sound which might
|
|
betray my presence. I was at least five minutes reaching the door,
|
|
at the opposite side, opening into the library.
|
|
|
|
I was going to open it, when a sigh from Captain Nemo nailed me to the spot.
|
|
I knew that he was rising. I could even see him, for the light from
|
|
the library came through to the saloon. He came towards me silently,
|
|
with his arms crossed, gliding like a spectre rather than walking.
|
|
His breast was swelling with sobs; and I heard him murmur these words
|
|
(the last which ever struck my ear):
|
|
|
|
"Almighty God! enough! enough!"
|
|
|
|
Was it a confession of remorse which thus escaped from this man's conscience?
|
|
|
|
In desperation, I rushed through the library, mounted the central
|
|
staircase, and, following the upper flight, reached the boat.
|
|
I crept through the opening, which had already admitted
|
|
my two companions.
|
|
|
|
"Let us go! let us go!" I exclaimed.
|
|
|
|
"Directly!" replied the Canadian.
|
|
|
|
The orifice in the plates of the Nautilus was first closed,
|
|
and fastened down by means of a false key, with which Ned Land
|
|
had provided himself; the opening in the boat was also closed.
|
|
The Canadian began to loosen the bolts which still held us to
|
|
the submarine boat.
|
|
|
|
Suddenly a noise was heard. Voices were answering each other loudly.
|
|
What was the matter? Had they discovered our flight?
|
|
I felt Ned Land slipping a dagger into my hand.
|
|
|
|
"Yes," I murmured, "we know how to die!"
|
|
|
|
The Canadian had stopped in his work. But one word many times repeated,
|
|
a dreadful word, revealed the cause of the agitation spreading on board
|
|
the Nautilus. It was not we the crew were looking after!
|
|
|
|
"The maelstrom! the maelstrom!" Could a more dreadful word in a more
|
|
dreadful situation have sounded in our ears! We were then upon
|
|
the dangerous coast of Norway. Was the Nautilus being drawn into
|
|
this gulf at the moment our boat was going to leave its sides?
|
|
We knew that at the tide the pent-up waters between the islands
|
|
of Ferroe and Loffoden rush with irresistible violence,
|
|
forming a whirlpool from which no vessel ever escapes.
|
|
From every point of the horizon enormous waves were meeting,
|
|
forming a gulf justly called the "Navel of the Ocean,"
|
|
whose power of attraction extends to a distance of twelve miles.
|
|
There, not only vessels, but whales are sacrificed, as well as white
|
|
bears from the northern regions.
|
|
|
|
It is thither that the Nautilus, voluntarily or involuntarily,
|
|
had been run by the Captain.
|
|
|
|
It was describing a spiral, the circumference of which was lessening
|
|
by degrees, and the boat, which was still fastened to its side,
|
|
was carried along with giddy speed. I felt that sickly giddiness
|
|
which arises from long-continued whirling round.
|
|
|
|
We were in dread. Our horror was at its height, circulation had stopped,
|
|
all nervous influence was annihilated, and we were covered with cold sweat,
|
|
like a sweat of agony! And what noise around our frail bark!
|
|
What roarings repeated by the echo miles away! What an uproar was that
|
|
of the waters broken on the sharp rocks at the bottom, where the hardest
|
|
bodies are crushed, and trees worn away, "with all the fur rubbed off,"
|
|
according to the Norwegian phrase!
|
|
|
|
What a situation to be in! We rocked frightfully. The Nautilus
|
|
defended itself like a human being. Its steel muscles cracked.
|
|
Sometimes it seemed to stand upright, and we with it!
|
|
|
|
"We must hold on," said Ned, "and look after the bolts.
|
|
We may still be saved if we stick to the Nautilus."
|
|
|
|
He had not finished the words, when we heard a crashing noise,
|
|
the bolts gave way, and the boat, torn from its groove, was hurled
|
|
like a stone from a sling into the midst of the whirlpool.
|
|
|
|
My head struck on a piece of iron, and with the violent shock
|
|
I lost all consciousness.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CHAPTER XXIII
|
|
|
|
CONCLUSION
|
|
|
|
Thus ends the voyage under the seas. What passed during that night--
|
|
how the boat escaped from the eddies of the maelstrom--
|
|
how Ned Land, Conseil, and myself ever came out of the gulf,
|
|
I cannot tell.
|
|
|
|
But when I returned to consciousness, I was lying in a fisherman's hut,
|
|
on the Loffoden Isles. My two companions, safe and sound, were near me
|
|
holding my hands. We embraced each other heartily.
|
|
|
|
At that moment we could not think of returning to France. The means
|
|
of communication between the north of Norway and the south are rare.
|
|
And I am therefore obliged to wait for the steamboat running monthly
|
|
from Cape North.
|
|
|
|
And, among the worthy people who have so kindly received us,
|
|
I revise my record of these adventures once more.
|
|
Not a fact has been omitted, not a detail exaggerated.
|
|
It is a faithful narrative of this incredible expedition in an
|
|
element inaccessible to man, but to which Progress will one day
|
|
open a road.
|
|
|
|
Shall I be believed? I do not know. And it matters little, after all.
|
|
What I now affirm is, that I have a right to speak of these seas, under which,
|
|
in less than ten months, I have crossed 20,000 leagues in that submarine tour
|
|
of the world, which has revealed so many wonders.
|
|
|
|
But what has become of the Nautilus? Did it resist the pressure
|
|
of the maelstrom? Does Captain Nemo still live? And does
|
|
he still follow under the ocean those frightful retaliations?
|
|
Or, did he stop after the last hecatomb?
|
|
|
|
Will the waves one day carry to him this manuscript containing
|
|
the history of his life? Shall I ever know the name of this man?
|
|
Will the missing vessel tell us by its nationality that of Captain Nemo?
|
|
|
|
I hope so. And I also hope that his powerful vessel has conquered
|
|
the sea at its most terrible gulf, and that the Nautilus has survived
|
|
where so many other vessels have been lost! If it be so--if Captain
|
|
Nemo still inhabits the ocean, his adopted country, may hatred be
|
|
appeased in that savage heart! May the contemplation of so many wonders
|
|
extinguish for ever the spirit of vengeance! May the judge disappear,
|
|
and the philosopher continue the peaceful exploration of the sea!
|
|
If his destiny be strange, it is also sublime. Have I not understood
|
|
it myself? Have I not lived ten months of this unnatural life?
|
|
And to the question asked by Ecclesiastes three thousand years ago,
|
|
"That which is far off and exceeding deep, who can find it out?"
|
|
two men alone of all now living have the right to give an answer----
|
|
|
|
CAPTAIN NEMO AND MYSELF.
|
|
|
|
|
|
The end of Project Gutenberg etext of "Twenty Thousand Leagues
|
|
Under the Sea"
|
|
|
|
|
|
I have made the following changes to the text:
|
|
|
|
PAGE LINE ORIGINAL CHANGED TO
|
|
32 36 mizen-mast mizzen-mast
|
|
66 5 Arronax Aronnax
|
|
87 33 zoophites zoophytes
|
|
89 22 aparatus apparatus
|
|
96 28 dirunal diurnal
|
|
97 8 Arronax Aronnax
|
|
123 23 porphry porphyry
|
|
141 8 Arronax Aronnax
|
|
146 30 sideral sidereal
|
|
177 30 Arronax Aronnax
|
|
223 4 commmit commit
|
|
258 16 swiftiest swiftest
|
|
274 2 occured occurred
|
|
|
|
|